Add debug output about skipping files and functions
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2715 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2716 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2717
2718 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2719
2720 @enumerate
2721 @item
2722 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2723
2724 @item
2725 the target system's inferior identifier
2726
2727 @item
2728 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2729
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2734 indicates the current inferior.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2742 Num Description Executable
2743 2 process 2307 hello
2744 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2751 @item inferior @var{infno}
2752 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2753 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2754 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2755 @end table
2756
2757 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2758 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2759 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2760 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2761 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2762 information on convenience variables.
2763
2764 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2765 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2766 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2767 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2768 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2769 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex add-inferior
2773 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2775 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2776 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2777 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2778 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2779
2780 @kindex clone-inferior
2781 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2782 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2783 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2784 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2785 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2786
2787 @smallexample
2788 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2789 Num Description Executable
2790 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2791 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2792 Added inferior 2.
2793 1 inferiors added.
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 2 <null> helloworld
2797 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2798 @end smallexample
2799
2800 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2801
2802 @kindex remove-inferiors
2803 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2804 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2805 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2806 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2807
2808 @end table
2809
2810 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2811 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2812 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2813 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2818 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2819 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2820 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2821 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2822
2823 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2825 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2826 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2827 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2828 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2829 @end table
2830
2831 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2832 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2833 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2834 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2835
2836
2837 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2838 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set print inferior-events
2842 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2843 @item set print inferior-events
2844 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2845 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2846 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2847 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2848 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2849 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2850
2851 @kindex show print inferior-events
2852 @item show print inferior-events
2853 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2854 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2855 @end table
2856
2857 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2858 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2859 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2860
2861
2862 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2863 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2864 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2865 info program-spaces}} command.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2869 @item maint info program-spaces
2870 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2871 @value{GDBN}.
2872
2873 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2874
2875 @enumerate
2876 @item
2877 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2878
2879 @item
2880 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2881 the @code{file} command.
2882
2883 @end enumerate
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2887 indicates the current program space.
2888
2889 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2890 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2891 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2895 Id Executable
2896 * 1 hello
2897 2 goodbye
2898 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2902 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2903 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2904 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2905 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2906
2907 @smallexample
2908 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2909 Id Executable
2910 * 1 vfork-test
2911 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2912 @end smallexample
2913
2914 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2915 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @node Threads
2919 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2920
2921 @cindex threads of execution
2922 @cindex multiple threads
2923 @cindex switching threads
2924 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2925 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2926 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2927 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2928 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2929 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2930 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2931
2932 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2933 programs:
2934
2935 @itemize @bullet
2936 @item automatic notification of new threads
2937 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2938 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2939 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2940 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2941 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2942 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2943 messages on thread start and exit.
2944 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2945 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2946 isn't compatible with the program.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 @cindex focus of debugging
2950 @cindex current thread
2951 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2952 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2953 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2954 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2955 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2956
2957 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2958 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2959 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2960 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2961 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2962 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2963 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2964 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2965 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2966 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2974 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2975 further qualifier.
2976
2977 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2978 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2979 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2980 @c program?
2981 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2982 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2983 @c threads ab initio?
2984
2985 @anchor{thread numbers}
2986 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2987 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2988 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2989 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2990 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2991 between threads of different inferiors.
2992
2993 @cindex qualified thread ID
2994 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2995 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2996 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2997 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2998 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2999 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3000 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3001 inferior.
3002
3003 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3004 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3005 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3006 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3007
3008 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3009 @cindex thread ID lists
3010 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3011 argument. A list element can be:
3012
3013 @enumerate
3014 @item
3015 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3016 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3017 @samp{1}.
3018
3019 @item
3020 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3021 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3022 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3023
3024 @item
3025 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3026 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3027 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3028 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3029 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3030
3031 @end enumerate
3032
3033 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3034 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3035 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3036 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3037 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3038 7.1}.
3039
3040
3041 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3042 @cindex global thread number
3043 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3044 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3045 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3046 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3047 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3048 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3049
3050 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3051 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3052 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3053
3054 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3055 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3056 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3057 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3058 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3059 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3060 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3061 general information on convenience variables.
3062
3063 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3064 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3065 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3066
3067 @smallexample
3068 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3069 @end smallexample
3070
3071 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 @table @code
3078 @kindex info threads
3079 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3080
3081 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3082 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3083 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3084 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3085
3086 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3087
3088 @enumerate
3089 @item
3090 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3091
3092 @item
3093 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3094 option was specified
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3098
3099 @item
3100 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3101 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3102 program itself.
3103
3104 @item
3105 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3106 @end enumerate
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3110 indicates the current thread.
3111
3112 For example,
3113 @end table
3114 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3122 at threadtest.c:68
3123 @end smallexample
3124
3125 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3126 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3127 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3128
3129 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3130 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3134 Id GId Target Id Frame
3135 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3137 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3138 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3139 @end smallexample
3140
3141 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3142 Solaris-specific command:
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @item maint info sol-threads
3146 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3147 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3148 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3149 @end table
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3153 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3154 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3155 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3156 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3157 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3160 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3164 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3165 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3166 8 printf ("hello\n");
3167 @end smallexample
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3171 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3172 threads.
3173
3174 @kindex thread apply
3175 @cindex apply command to several threads
3176 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3177 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3178 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3179 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3180 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3181 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3182 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3183 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3184
3185 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3186 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3187 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3188 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3189 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3190
3191 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3192 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3193 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3194 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3195
3196 @table @code
3197 @item -c
3198 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3199 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3200 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3201 @item -s
3202 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3203 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3204 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3205 are not printed.
3206 @item -q
3207 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3208 information.
3209 @end table
3210
3211 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3212
3213 @kindex taas
3214 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3215 @item taas @var{command}
3216 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3217 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3218
3219 @kindex tfaas
3220 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item tfaas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3224 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3225 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3226 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3227 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3228 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3229 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3230
3231 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3232 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3233 is, using:
3234 @smallexample
3235 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3236 @end smallexample
3237
3238
3239 @kindex thread name
3240 @cindex name a thread
3241 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3242 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3243 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3244 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3245
3246 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3247 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3248 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3249 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3250 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3251
3252 @kindex thread find
3253 @cindex search for a thread
3254 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3255 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3256 matches the supplied regular expression.
3257
3258 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3259 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3260 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3261 is the LWP id.
3262
3263 @smallexample
3264 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3265 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3266 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3267 Id Target Id Frame
3268 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3269 @end smallexample
3270
3271 @kindex set print thread-events
3272 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3273 @item set print thread-events
3274 @itemx set print thread-events on
3275 @itemx set print thread-events off
3276 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3277 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3278 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3279 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3280 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3281
3282 @kindex show print thread-events
3283 @item show print thread-events
3284 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3285 have started and exited.
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3289 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3290 programs with multiple threads.
3291
3292 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3293 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3294
3295 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3298 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3299 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3300 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3301 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3302 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3303 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3304 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3305 macro.
3306
3307 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3308 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3309 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3310 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3311 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3312 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3313
3314 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3315 refers to the default system directories that are
3316 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3317 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3318 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3322 was loaded in the inferior process.
3323
3324 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3325 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3326 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3327 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3328 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3329 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3330 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3331
3332 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3333 only on some platforms.
3334
3335 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3336 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3337 Display current libthread_db search path.
3338
3339 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3340 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3341 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3342 @item set debug libthread-db
3343 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3344 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3345 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 @node Forks
3349 @section Debugging Forks
3350
3351 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3352 @cindex multiple processes
3353 @cindex processes, multiple
3354 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3355 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3356 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3357 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3358 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3359 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3360 will cause it to terminate.
3361
3362 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3363 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3364 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3365 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3366 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3367 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3368 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3369 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3370 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3371 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3372
3373 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3374 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3375 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3376 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3377
3378 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3379 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3383 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3384
3385 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3386 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3387
3388 @table @code
3389 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3390 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3391 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3392 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3393 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3394
3395 @table @code
3396 @item parent
3397 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3398 unimpeded. This is the default.
3399
3400 @item child
3401 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3402 unimpeded.
3403
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3407 @item show follow-fork-mode
3408 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3409 @end table
3410
3411 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3412 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3413 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3417 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3418 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3419 retain debugger control over them both.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @item on
3423 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3424 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3425 independently. This is the default.
3426
3427 @item off
3428 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3429 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3431 is held suspended.
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3436 @item show detach-on-fork
3437 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3441 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3442 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3443 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3444 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3445 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3446
3447 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3448 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3449 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3450 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3451 and Programs}.
3452
3453 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3454 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3455 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3456 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3457 the child process's @code{main}.
3458
3459 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3460 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3461
3462 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3463 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3464 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3465 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3466 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3467 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3468 command.
3469
3470 @table @code
3471 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3472 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3473
3474 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3475 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3476
3477 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3478
3479 @table @code
3480 @item new
3481 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3482 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3483 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3484 original inferior.
3485
3486 For example:
3487
3488 @smallexample
3489 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3490 (gdb) info inferior
3491 Id Description Executable
3492 * 1 <null> prog1
3493 (@value{GDBP}) run
3494 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3495 Program exited normally.
3496 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 1 <null> prog1
3499 * 2 <null> prog2
3500 @end smallexample
3501
3502 @item same
3503 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3504 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3505 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3506 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3507 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3508
3509 For example:
3510
3511 @smallexample
3512 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3513 Id Description Executable
3514 * 1 <null> prog1
3515 (@value{GDBP}) run
3516 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3517 Program exited normally.
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog2
3521 @end smallexample
3522
3523 @end table
3524 @end table
3525
3526 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3527 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3528
3529 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3530 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3531 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3532
3533 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3534 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3535
3536 @cindex checkpoint
3537 @cindex restart
3538 @cindex bookmark
3539 @cindex snapshot of a process
3540 @cindex rewind program state
3541
3542 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3543 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3544 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3545 later.
3546
3547 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3548 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3549 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3550 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3551 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3552
3553 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3554 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3555 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3556 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3557 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3558 start again from there.
3559
3560 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3561 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3562
3563 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3564
3565 @table @code
3566 @kindex checkpoint
3567 @item checkpoint
3568 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3569 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3570 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3571
3572 @kindex info checkpoints
3573 @item info checkpoints
3574 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3575 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3576 listed:
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @item Checkpoint ID
3580 @item Process ID
3581 @item Code Address
3582 @item Source line, or label
3583 @end table
3584
3585 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3586 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3587 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3588 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3589 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3590 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3591 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3592
3593 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3594 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3595 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3596 the debugger.
3597
3598 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3599 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3600 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3601
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3605 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3606 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3607 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3608 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3609 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3610 previously read data can be read again.
3611
3612 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3613 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3614 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3615 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3616 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3617 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3618
3619 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3620 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3621 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3622 different execution path this time.
3623
3624 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3625 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3626 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3627 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3628 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3629 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3630 potentially pose a problem.
3631
3632 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3633
3634 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3635 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3636 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3637 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3638 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3639 next.
3640
3641 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3642 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3643 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3644 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3645 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3646
3647 @node Stopping
3648 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3649
3650 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3651 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3652 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3653
3654 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3655 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3656 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3657 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3658 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3659 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3660 explicitly request this information at any time.
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @kindex info program
3664 @item info program
3665 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3666 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3667 @end table
3668
3669 @menu
3670 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3671 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3672 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3673 Skipping over functions and files
3674 * Signals:: Signals
3675 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3676 @end menu
3677
3678 @node Breakpoints
3679 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3680
3681 @cindex breakpoints
3682 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3683 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3684 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3685 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3686 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3687 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3688 program.
3689
3690 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3691 the executable is run.
3692
3693 @cindex watchpoints
3694 @cindex data breakpoints
3695 @cindex memory tracing
3696 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3697 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3698 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3699 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3700 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3701 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3702 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3703 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3704 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3705 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3706 same commands.
3707
3708 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3709 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3710 Automatic Display}.
3711
3712 @cindex catchpoints
3713 @cindex breakpoint on events
3714 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3715 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3716 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3717 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3718 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3719 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3720 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3721
3722 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3723 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3724 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3725 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3726 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3727 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3728 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3729 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3730 enable it again.
3731
3732 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3733 @cindex breakpoint lists
3734 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3735 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3736 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3737 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3738 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3739 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3740 are operated on.
3741
3742 @menu
3743 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3744 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3745 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3746 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3747 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3748 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3749 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3750 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3751 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3752 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3753 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3754 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3755 @end menu
3756
3757 @node Set Breaks
3758 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3759
3760 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3761 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3762 @c
3763 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3764
3765 @kindex break
3766 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3767 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3768 @cindex latest breakpoint
3769 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3770 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3771 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3772 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3773 convenience variables.
3774
3775 @table @code
3776 @item break @var{location}
3777 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3778 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3779 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3780 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3781 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3782
3783 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3784 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3785 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3786 that situation.
3787
3788 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3789 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3790 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3791
3792 @item break
3793 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3794 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3795 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3796 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3797 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3798 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3799 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3800 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3801 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3802 inside loops.
3803
3804 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3805 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3806 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3807 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3808 existed when your program stopped.
3809
3810 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3811 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3812 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3813 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3814 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3815 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3816 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3817
3818 @kindex tbreak
3819 @item tbreak @var{args}
3820 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3821 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3822 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3823 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3824
3825 @kindex hbreak
3826 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3827 @item hbreak @var{args}
3828 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3829 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3830 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3831 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3832 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3833 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3834 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3835 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3836 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3837 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3838 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3839 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3840 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3841 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3842 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3843 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3844 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3845 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3846
3847 @kindex thbreak
3848 @item thbreak @var{args}
3849 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3850 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3851 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3852 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3853 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3854 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3855 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3856 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3857
3858 @kindex rbreak
3859 @cindex regular expression
3860 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3861 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3862 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3863 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3864 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3865 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3866 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3867 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3868 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3869
3870 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3871 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3872 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3873 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3874 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3875 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3876
3877 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3878 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3879 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3880 classes.
3881
3882 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3883 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3884 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3885
3886 @smallexample
3887 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3888 @end smallexample
3889
3890 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3891 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3892 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3893 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3894 every function in a given file:
3895
3896 @smallexample
3897 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3898 @end smallexample
3899
3900 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3901 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3902
3903 @kindex info breakpoints
3904 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3905 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3906 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3907 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3908 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3909 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3910 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3911
3912 @table @emph
3913 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3914 @item Type
3915 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3916 @item Disposition
3917 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3918 @item Enabled or Disabled
3919 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3920 that are not enabled.
3921 @item Address
3922 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3923 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3924 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3925 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3926 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3927 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3928 @item What
3929 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3930 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3931 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3932 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3933 @end table
3934
3935 @noindent
3936 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3937 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3938 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3939 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3940 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3941 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3942
3943 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3944 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3945 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3946 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3950 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3951 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3952 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3953 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3954
3955 @noindent
3956 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3957 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3958 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3959 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3960 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3961 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3962
3963 @noindent
3964 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3965 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3966
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3970 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3971 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3972 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3973
3974 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3975 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3976 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3977 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3978
3979 @itemize @bullet
3980 @item
3981 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3982
3983 @item
3984 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3985 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3986
3987 @item
3988 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3989 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3990
3991 @item
3992 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3993 several places where that function is inlined.
3994 @end itemize
3995
3996 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3997 the relevant locations.
3998
3999 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4000 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4001 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4002 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4003 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4004 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4005 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4006
4007 For example:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4011 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4012 stop only if i==1
4013 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4014 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4015 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4016 @end smallexample
4017
4018 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4019 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4020 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4021 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4022 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4023 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4024 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4025 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4026 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4027 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4028 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4029
4030 @cindex pending breakpoints
4031 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4032 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4033 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4034 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4035 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4036 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4037 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4038 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4039 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4040 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4041 is not yet resolved.
4042
4043 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4044 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4045 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4046 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4047 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4048 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4049
4050 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4051 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4052 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4053 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4054
4055 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4056 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4057 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4058
4059 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4060 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4061 address specification to an address:
4062
4063 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4064 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4065 @table @code
4066 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4067 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4068 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4069
4070 @item set breakpoint pending on
4071 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4072 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4073
4074 @item set breakpoint pending off
4075 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4076 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4077 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4078
4079 @item show breakpoint pending
4080 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4081 @end table
4082
4083 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4084 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4085 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4086
4087 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4088 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4089 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4090 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4091 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4092 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4093 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4094 breakpoints.
4095
4096 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4097
4098 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4099 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4100 @table @code
4101 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4102 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4103 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4104 breakpoint must be used.
4105
4106 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4107 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4108 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4109 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4110 @end table
4111
4112 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4113 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4114 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4115 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4116 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4117 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4118 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4119 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4120 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4121
4122 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4123 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4124 @table @code
4125 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4126 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4127 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4128 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4129
4130 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4131 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4132 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4133 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4134 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4138 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4139 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4140
4141 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4142 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4143
4144 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4145
4146 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4147 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4148 @table @code
4149 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4150 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4151 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4152 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4153 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4154
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4157 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4158 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4159 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4160 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4161 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4162 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4163 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4164 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4165 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4166 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4167 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4168
4169 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4170 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4171 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4172 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4173 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4174 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4175 @end table
4176
4177
4178 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4179 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4180 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4181 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4182 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4183 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4184 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4185 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4186
4187
4188 @node Set Watchpoints
4189 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4190
4191 @cindex setting watchpoints
4192 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4193 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4194 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4195 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4196 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4197
4198 @itemize @bullet
4199 @item
4200 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4201
4202 @item
4203 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4204 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4205 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4206
4207 @item
4208 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4209 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4210 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4211 @end itemize
4212
4213 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4214 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4215 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4216 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4217 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4218 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4219 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4220 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4221 the expression changes.
4222
4223 @cindex software watchpoints
4224 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4225 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4226 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4227 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4228 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4229 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4230 culprit.)
4231
4232 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4233 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4234 slow down the running of your program.
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @kindex watch
4238 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4239 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4240 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4241 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4242 to watch the value of a single variable:
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4249 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4250 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4251 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4252 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4253 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4254
4255 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4256 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4257 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4258 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4259 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4260 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4261 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4262 error.
4263
4264 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4265 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4266 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4267 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4268 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4269 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4270 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4271 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4272 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4273 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4274 Examples:
4275
4276 @smallexample
4277 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4278 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4279 @end smallexample
4280
4281 @kindex rwatch
4282 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4283 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4284 by the program.
4285
4286 @kindex awatch
4287 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4288 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4289 or written into by the program.
4290
4291 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4292 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4293 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4294 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4295 @end table
4296
4297 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4298 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4299 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4300 a never-changing value:
4301
4302 @smallexample
4303 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4304 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4305 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4306 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4310 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4311 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4312 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4313 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4314 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4315
4316 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4317 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4318 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4319 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4320 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4321 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4322 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4323 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4324
4325 @table @code
4326 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4327 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4328 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4329
4330 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4331 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4332 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4333 @end table
4334
4335 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4336 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4337 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4338
4339 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 @noindent
4346 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4347
4348 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4349 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4350 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4351 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4352 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4353 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4354 will print a message like this:
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4361 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4362 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4363 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4364 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4365 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4366 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4367 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4368
4369 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4370 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4371 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4372 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4373 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4374 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4378 @end smallexample
4379
4380 @noindent
4381 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4382
4383 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4384 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4385 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4386 expression with separately allocated resources.
4387
4388 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4389 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4390 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4391
4392 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4393 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4394 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4395 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4396 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4397 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4398 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4399 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4400 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4401
4402 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4403 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4404 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4405 watched expression from every thread.
4406
4407 @quotation
4408 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4409 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4410 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4411 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4412 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4413 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4414 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4415 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4416 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4417 @end quotation
4418
4419 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4420
4421 @node Set Catchpoints
4422 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4423 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4424 @cindex exception handlers
4425 @cindex event handling
4426
4427 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4428 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4429 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4430
4431 @table @code
4432 @kindex catch
4433 @item catch @var{event}
4434 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4438 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4439 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4440 @kindex catch throw
4441 @kindex catch rethrow
4442 @kindex catch catch
4443 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4444 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4445
4446 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4447 regular expression will be caught.
4448
4449 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4450 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4451 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4452 exception being thrown.
4453
4454 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4455 @value{GDBN}:
4456
4457 @itemize @bullet
4458 @item
4459 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4460 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4461 supported.
4462
4463 @item
4464 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4465 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4466 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4467 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4468 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4469 built.
4470
4471 @item
4472 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4473 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4474
4475 @item
4476 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4477 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4478 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4479 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4480
4481 @item
4482 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4483 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4484 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4485 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4486 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4487 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4488 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4489 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4490 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4491
4492 @item
4493 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4494
4495 @item
4496 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4497 @end itemize
4498
4499 @item exception
4500 @kindex catch exception
4501 @cindex Ada exception catching
4502 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4503 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4504 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4505 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4506 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4507
4508 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4509 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4510 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4511 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4512 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4513 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4514 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4515 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4516
4517 @item handlers
4518 @kindex catch handlers
4519 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4520 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4521 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4522 specified at the end of the command
4523 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4524 only when this specific exception is handled.
4525 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4526
4527 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4528 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4529 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4530 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4531 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4532 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4533 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4534 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4535 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4536
4537 @item exception unhandled
4538 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4539 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4540
4541 @item assert
4542 @kindex catch assert
4543 A failed Ada assertion.
4544
4545 @item exec
4546 @kindex catch exec
4547 @cindex break on fork/exec
4548 A call to @code{exec}.
4549
4550 @item syscall
4551 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4552 @kindex catch syscall
4553 @cindex break on a system call.
4554 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4555 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4556 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4557 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4558 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4559 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4560 will be caught.
4561
4562 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4563 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4564 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4565 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4566
4567 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4568 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4569 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4570 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4571
4572 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4573 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4574 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4575 available choices.
4576
4577 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4578 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4579 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4580 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4581 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4582 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4583 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4584 behind the OS upgrades).
4585
4586 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4587 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4588 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4589 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4590 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4591 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4592 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4593 syscall groups available on your environment.
4594
4595 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4596 arguments to it:
4597
4598 @smallexample
4599 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4600 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4601 (@value{GDBP}) r
4602 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4603
4604 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4605 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4606 (@value{GDBP}) c
4607 Continuing.
4608
4609 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4610 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4611 (@value{GDBP})
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4615
4616 @smallexample
4617 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4618 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4619 (@value{GDBP}) r
4620 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4621
4622 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4623 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4624 (@value{GDBP}) c
4625 Continuing.
4626
4627 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4628 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4629 (@value{GDBP})
4630 @end smallexample
4631
4632 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4633 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4634 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4635
4636 @smallexample
4637 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4638 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4639 (@value{GDBP}) r
4640 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4641
4642 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4643 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4644 (@value{GDBP}) c
4645 Continuing.
4646
4647 Program exited normally.
4648 (@value{GDBP})
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4655 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4656 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4657 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4658 (@value{GDBP}) r
4659 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4660
4661 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4662 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4663
4664 (@value{GDBP}) c
4665 Continuing.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4669 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4670 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4671 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4672
4673 @smallexample
4674 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4675 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4676 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4677 (@value{GDBP})
4678 @end smallexample
4679
4680 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4681 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4682 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4683 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4684 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4685 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4689 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4690 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4691 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4692 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4693 (@value{GDBP})
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4697
4698 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4699 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4703 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4704 @end smallexample
4705
4706 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4707
4708 @item fork
4709 @kindex catch fork
4710 A call to @code{fork}.
4711
4712 @item vfork
4713 @kindex catch vfork
4714 A call to @code{vfork}.
4715
4716 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4717 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4718 @kindex catch load
4719 @kindex catch unload
4720 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4721 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4722 matches one of the affected libraries.
4723
4724 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4725 @kindex catch signal
4726 The delivery of a signal.
4727
4728 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4729 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4730 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4731
4732 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4733 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4734 signal names.
4735
4736 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4737 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4738 will be caught.
4739
4740 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4741 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4742 catchpoint.
4743
4744 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4745 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4746 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4747 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4748 commands.
4749
4750 @end table
4751
4752 @item tcatch @var{event}
4753 @kindex tcatch
4754 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4755 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4756
4757 @end table
4758
4759 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4760
4761
4762 @node Delete Breaks
4763 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4764
4765 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4766 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4767 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4768 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4769 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4770 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4771
4772 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4773 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4774 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4775 their breakpoint numbers.
4776
4777 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4778 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4779 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4780
4781 @table @code
4782 @kindex clear
4783 @item clear
4784 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4785 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4786 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4787 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4788
4789 @item clear @var{location}
4790 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4791 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4792 most useful ones are listed below:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item clear @var{function}
4796 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4797 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4798
4799 @item clear @var{linenum}
4800 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4801 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4802 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4803 @end table
4804
4805 @cindex delete breakpoints
4806 @kindex delete
4807 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4808 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4809 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4810 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4811 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4812 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4813 @end table
4814
4815 @node Disabling
4816 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4817
4818 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4819 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4820 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4821 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4822 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4823
4824 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4825 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4826 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4827 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4828 do not know which numbers to use.
4829
4830 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4831 affects all of its locations.
4832
4833 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4834 different states of enablement:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item
4838 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4839 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4840 @item
4841 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4842 @item
4843 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4844 disabled.
4845 @item
4846 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4847 N times, then becomes disabled.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4850 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4851 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4852 @end itemize
4853
4854 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4855 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4856
4857 @table @code
4858 @kindex disable
4859 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4860 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4861 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4862 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4863 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4864 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4865 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4866
4867 @kindex enable
4868 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4869 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4870 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4871
4872 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4873 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4874 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4875
4876 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4877 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4878 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4879 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4880 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4881 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4882 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4883
4884 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4885 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4886 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4887 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4888 @end table
4889
4890 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4891 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4892 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4893 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4894 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4895 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4896 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4897 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4898 Stepping}.)
4899
4900 @node Conditions
4901 @subsection Break Conditions
4902 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4903 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4904
4905 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4906 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4907 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4908 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4909 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4910 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4911 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4912 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4913
4914 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4915 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4916 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4917 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4918 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4919
4920 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4921 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4922 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4923 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4924 one.
4925
4926 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4927 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4928 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4929 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4930 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4931 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4932 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4933 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4934 conditions for the
4935 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4936 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4937
4938 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4939 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4940 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4941 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4942 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4943 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4944
4945 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4946 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4947 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4948 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4949 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4950
4951 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4952 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4954 with the @code{condition} command.
4955
4956 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4957 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4958 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4959 catchpoint.
4960
4961 @table @code
4962 @kindex condition
4963 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4964 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4965 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4966 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4967 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4968 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4969 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4970 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4971 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4972 prints an error message:
4973
4974 @smallexample
4975 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4976 @end smallexample
4977
4978 @noindent
4979 @value{GDBN} does
4980 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4981 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4982 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4983
4984 @item condition @var{bnum}
4985 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4986 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4987 @end table
4988
4989 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4990 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4991 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4992 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4993 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4994 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4995 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4996 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4997 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4998 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4999 your program reaches it.
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @kindex ignore
5003 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5004 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5005 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5006 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5007 takes no action.
5008
5009 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5010 a count of zero.
5011
5012 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5013 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5014 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5015 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5016
5017 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5018 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5019 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5020
5021 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5022 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5023 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5024 Variables}.
5025 @end table
5026
5027 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5028
5029
5030 @node Break Commands
5031 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5032
5033 @cindex breakpoint commands
5034 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5035 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5036 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5037 enable other breakpoints.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @kindex commands
5041 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5042 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5043 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5044 @itemx end
5045 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5046 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5047 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5048
5049 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5050 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5051
5052 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5053 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5054 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5055 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5056 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5057 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5058 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5059 Expressions}).
5060 @end table
5061
5062 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5063 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5064
5065 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5066 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5067 that resumes execution.
5068
5069 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5070 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5071 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5072 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5073 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5074
5075 @kindex silent
5076 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5077 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5078 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5079 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5080 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5081 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5082
5083 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5084 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5085 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5086
5087 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5088 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 break foo if x>0
5092 commands
5093 silent
5094 printf "x is %d\n",x
5095 cont
5096 end
5097 @end smallexample
5098
5099 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5100 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5101 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5102 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5103 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5104 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5105 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 break 403
5109 commands
5110 silent
5111 set x = y + 4
5112 cont
5113 end
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @node Dynamic Printf
5117 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5118
5119 @cindex dynamic printf
5120 @cindex dprintf
5121 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5122 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5123 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5124 having to recompile it.
5125
5126 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5127 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5128 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5129 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5130 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5131 redirects to files and so forth.
5132
5133 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5134 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5135 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5136 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5137 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5138 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5139 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex dprintf
5143 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5144 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5145 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5146 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5147
5148 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5149 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5150 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5151 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5152 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5153 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @item gdb
5157 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5158 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5159
5160 @item call
5161 @kindex dprintf-style call
5162 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5163 @code{printf}).
5164
5165 @item agent
5166 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5167 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5168 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5169 support running commands on the target.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5173 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5174 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5175 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5176 command.
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5179 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5180 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5181 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5182 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5183 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5184
5185 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5186 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5187 you could do the following:
5188
5189 @example
5190 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5191 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5192 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5193 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5194 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5195 (gdb) info break
5196 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5197 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5198 continue
5199 (gdb)
5200 @end example
5201
5202 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5203 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5204 the variable settings.
5205
5206 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5207 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5208 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5209 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5210 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5211 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5212
5213 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5215 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5216
5217 @end table
5218
5219 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5220 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5221 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5222 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5223 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5224 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5225
5226 @node Save Breakpoints
5227 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5228
5229 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5230 breakpoints}} command.
5231
5232 @table @code
5233 @kindex save breakpoints
5234 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5235 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5236 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5237 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5238 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5239 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5240 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5241 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5242 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5243 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5244 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5245 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5246 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5247 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5248 that can no longer be recreated.
5249 @end table
5250
5251 @node Static Probe Points
5252 @subsection Static Probe Points
5253
5254 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5255 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5256 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5257 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5258 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5259
5260 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5261 ELF-compatible systems:
5262
5263 @itemize @bullet
5264
5265 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5266 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5267 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5268 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5269 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5270 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5271 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5272 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5273
5274 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5275 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5276 C@t{++} languages.
5277 @end itemize
5278
5279 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5280 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5281 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5282 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5283 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5284 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5285 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5286 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5287 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5288
5289 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5290 probes}, with optional arguments:
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex info probes
5294 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5295 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5296 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5297 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5298
5299 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5300 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5301 probes from all providers are listed.
5302
5303 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5304 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5305 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5306
5307 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5308 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5309 given, all object files are considered.
5310
5311 @item info probes all
5312 List the available static probes, from all types.
5313 @end table
5314
5315 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5316 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5317 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5318 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5319 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5320
5321 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5322 commands, with optional arguments:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @kindex enable probes
5326 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5327 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5328 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5329 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5330
5331 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5332 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5333 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5334
5335 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5336 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5337 given, all object files are considered.
5338
5339 @kindex disable probes
5340 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5342 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5343 @end table
5344
5345 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5346 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5347 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5348 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5349 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5350 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5351 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5352 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5353 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5354 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5355 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5356 at the current probe point.
5357
5358 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5359 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5360 an error message.
5361
5362
5363 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5364 @node Error in Breakpoints
5365 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5366
5367 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5368 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5369
5370 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5371 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5372 @smallexample
5373 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5374 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5379 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5380 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5381
5382 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5383 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5384
5385 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5386 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5387 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5388
5389 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5390 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5391 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5392 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5393
5394 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5395 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5396 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5397 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5398 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5399 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5400 first in the bundle.
5401
5402 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5403 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5404 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5405 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5406 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5407 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5408 is hit.
5409
5410 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5411 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5412
5413 @smallexample
5414 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5415 @end smallexample
5416
5417 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5418 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5419 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5420 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5421 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5422 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5423 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5424 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5425
5426 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5427 adjusted breakpoints:
5428
5429 @smallexample
5430 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5431 to 0x00010410.
5432 @end smallexample
5433
5434 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5435 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5436 frequently than expected.
5437
5438 @node Continuing and Stepping
5439 @section Continuing and Stepping
5440
5441 @cindex stepping
5442 @cindex continuing
5443 @cindex resuming execution
5444 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5445 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5446 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5447 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5448 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5449 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5450 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5451 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5452 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5453 handlers}).)
5454
5455 @table @code
5456 @kindex continue
5457 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5458 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5459 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5460 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5461 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5462 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5463 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5464 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5465 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5466 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5467
5468 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5469 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5470 @code{continue} is ignored.
5471
5472 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5473 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5474 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5475 @code{continue}.
5476 @end table
5477
5478 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5479 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5480 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5481 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5482
5483 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5484 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5485 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5486 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5487 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5488 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5489
5490 @table @code
5491 @kindex step
5492 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5493 @item step
5494 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5495 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5496 abbreviated @code{s}.
5497
5498 @quotation
5499 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5500 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5501 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5502 @c distinction here.
5503 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5504 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5505 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5506 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5507 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5508 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5509 below.
5510 @end quotation
5511
5512 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5513 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5514 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5515 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5516 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5517 called within the line.
5518
5519 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5520 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5521 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5522 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5523 was any debugging information about the routine.
5524
5525 @item step @var{count}
5526 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5527 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5528 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5529
5530 @kindex next
5531 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5532 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5533 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5534 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5535 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5536 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5537 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5538 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5539
5540 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5541
5542
5543 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5544 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5545 @c
5546 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5547 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5548 @c function are executed without stopping.
5549
5550 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5551 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5552 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5553
5554 @kindex set step-mode
5555 @item set step-mode
5556 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5557 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5558 @itemx set step-mode on
5559 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5560 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5561 information rather than stepping over it.
5562
5563 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5564 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5565 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5566
5567 @item set step-mode off
5568 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5569 debug information. This is the default.
5570
5571 @item show step-mode
5572 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5573 source line debug information.
5574
5575 @kindex finish
5576 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5577 @item finish
5578 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5579 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5580 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5581
5582 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5583 ,Returning from a Function}).
5584
5585 @kindex until
5586 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5587 @cindex run until specified location
5588 @item until
5589 @itemx u
5590 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5591 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5592 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5593 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5594 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5595 than the address of the jump.
5596
5597 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5598 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5599 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5600 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5601 through the next iteration.
5602
5603 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5604 stack frame.
5605
5606 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5607 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5608 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5609 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5610 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5611
5612 @smallexample
5613 (@value{GDBP}) f
5614 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5615 206 expand_input();
5616 (@value{GDBP}) until
5617 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5618 @end smallexample
5619
5620 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5621 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5622 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5623 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5624 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5625 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5626 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5627
5628 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5629 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5630 argument.
5631
5632 @item until @var{location}
5633 @itemx u @var{location}
5634 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5635 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5636 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5637 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5638 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5639 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5640 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5641 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5642 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5643 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5644 invocations have returned.
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 94 int factorial (int value)
5648 95 @{
5649 96 if (value > 1) @{
5650 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5651 98 @}
5652 99 return (value);
5653 100 @}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656
5657 @kindex advance @var{location}
5658 @item advance @var{location}
5659 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5660 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5661 @ref{Specify Location}.
5662 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5663 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5664 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5665 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5666
5667
5668 @kindex stepi
5669 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5670 @item stepi
5671 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5672 @itemx si
5673 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5674
5675 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5676 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5677 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5678 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5679
5680 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5681
5682 @need 750
5683 @kindex nexti
5684 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5685 @item nexti
5686 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5687 @itemx ni
5688 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5689 proceed until the function returns.
5690
5691 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5692
5693 @end table
5694
5695 @anchor{range stepping}
5696 @cindex range stepping
5697 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5698 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5699 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5700 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5701 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5702 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5703 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5704 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5705 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5706 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5707 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5708 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5709 if necessary:
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex set range-stepping
5713 @kindex show range-stepping
5714 @item set range-stepping
5715 @itemx show range-stepping
5716 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5717
5718 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5719 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5720 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5721 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5722 default is @code{on}.
5723
5724 @end table
5725
5726 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5727 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5728 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5729
5730 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5731 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5732 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5733 a particular file when stepping.
5734
5735 For example, consider the following C function:
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 101 int func()
5739 102 @{
5740 103 foo(boring());
5741 104 bar(boring());
5742 105 @}
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5747 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5748 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5749 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5750
5751 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5752 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5753 is called from many places.
5754
5755 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5756 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5757 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5758 @code{foo}.
5759
5760 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5761 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5762 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5763
5764 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5765 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5766 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5767 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5768 the underlying system.
5769 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5770 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @kindex skip
5774 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5775 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5776 that specify what to skip.
5777 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5778
5779 @table @code
5780 @item -file @var{file}
5781 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5782 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5783
5784 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5785 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5786 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5787 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5788 over when stepping.
5789
5790 @smallexample
5791 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5792 @end smallexample
5793
5794 @item -function @var{linespec}
5795 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5796 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5797 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5798 @xref{Specify Location}.
5799
5800 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5801 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5802 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5803 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804
5805 This form is useful for complex function names.
5806 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5807 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5808 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5809 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5810 regular expression makes this easier.
5811
5812 @smallexample
5813 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5817 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5818
5819 @smallexample
5820 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5821 @end smallexample
5822 @end table
5823
5824 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5825 will be skipped.
5826
5827 @kindex skip function
5828 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5829 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5830 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5831 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5832
5833 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5834 will be skipped.
5835
5836 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5837 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5838
5839 @kindex skip file
5840 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5841 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5842 will be skipped over when stepping.
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5846 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5850 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5851 @end table
5852
5853 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5854 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex info skip
5858 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5859 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5860 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5861 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5862
5863 @table @emph
5864 @item Identifier
5865 A number identifying this skip.
5866 @item Enabled or Disabled
5867 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5868 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5869 @item Glob
5870 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5871 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5872 @item File
5873 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5874 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5875 @item RE
5876 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item Function
5879 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5880 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @kindex skip delete
5884 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5885 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5886 skips.
5887
5888 @kindex skip enable
5889 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5890 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5891 skips.
5892
5893 @kindex skip disable
5894 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5895 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5896 skips.
5897
5898 @kindex set debug skip
5899 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5900 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5901
5902 @kindex show debug skip
5903 @item show debug skip
5904 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5905
5906 @end table
5907
5908 @node Signals
5909 @section Signals
5910 @cindex signals
5911
5912 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5913 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5914 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5915 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5916 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5917 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5918 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5919 requested an alarm).
5920
5921 @cindex fatal signals
5922 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5923 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5924 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5925 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5926 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5927 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5928
5929 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5930 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5931 signal.
5932
5933 @cindex handling signals
5934 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5935 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5936 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5937 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5938 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5939
5940 @table @code
5941 @kindex info signals
5942 @kindex info handle
5943 @item info signals
5944 @itemx info handle
5945 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5946 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5947 the defined types of signals.
5948
5949 @item info signals @var{sig}
5950 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5951
5952 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5953
5954 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5955 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5956 for details about this command.
5957
5958 @kindex handle
5959 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5960 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5961 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5962 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5963 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5964 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5965 say what change to make.
5966 @end table
5967
5968 @c @group
5969 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5970 Their full names are:
5971
5972 @table @code
5973 @item nostop
5974 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5975 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5976
5977 @item stop
5978 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5979 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5980
5981 @item print
5982 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5983
5984 @item noprint
5985 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5986 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5987
5988 @item pass
5989 @itemx noignore
5990 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5991 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5992 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5993
5994 @item nopass
5995 @itemx ignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5997 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5998 @end table
5999 @c @end group
6000
6001 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6002 program until you
6003 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6004 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6005 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6006 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6007 program sees that signal when you continue.
6008
6009 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6010 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6011 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6012 erroneous signals.
6013
6014 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6015 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6016 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6017 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6018 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6019 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6020 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6021 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6022 Program a Signal}.
6023
6024 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6025 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6026
6027 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6028 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6029 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6030 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6031 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6032 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6033 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6034 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6035 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6036 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6037 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6038 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6039 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6040
6041 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6042
6043 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6044 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6045 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6046 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6047
6048 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6049 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6050 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6051 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6052
6053 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6054 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6055
6056 @smallexample
6057 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6058 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6059 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6060 (@value{GDBP}) c
6061 Continuing.
6062
6063 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6064 main () sigusr1.c:28
6065 28 p = 0;
6066 (@value{GDBP}) si
6067 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6068 9 @{
6069 @end smallexample
6070
6071 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6072 program to receive the signal first:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (@value{GDBP}) n
6076 28 p = 0;
6077 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6078 (@value{GDBP}) si
6079 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6080 9 @{
6081 (@value{GDBP})
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @cindex extra signal information
6085 @anchor{extra signal information}
6086
6087 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6088 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6089 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6090 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6091 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6092 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6093 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6094 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6095 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6096 system header.
6097
6098 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6099 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 @group
6103 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6104 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6105 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6106 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6107 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6108 type = struct @{
6109 int si_signo;
6110 int si_errno;
6111 int si_code;
6112 union @{
6113 int _pad[28];
6114 struct @{...@} _kill;
6115 struct @{...@} _timer;
6116 struct @{...@} _rt;
6117 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6118 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6119 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6120 @} _sifields;
6121 @}
6122 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6123 type = struct @{
6124 void *si_addr;
6125 @}
6126 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6127 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6128 @end group
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6132
6133 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6134 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6135 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6136 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6137 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6138 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6139 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6140 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6141 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6142 information is displayed.
6143
6144 The usual output of a segfault is:
6145 @smallexample
6146 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6147 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6148 68 value = *(p + len);
6149 @end smallexample
6150
6151 While a bound violation is presented as:
6152 @smallexample
6153 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6154 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6155 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6156 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6157 68 value = *(p + len);
6158 @end smallexample
6159
6160 @node Thread Stops
6161 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6162
6163 @cindex stopped threads
6164 @cindex threads, stopped
6165
6166 @cindex continuing threads
6167 @cindex threads, continuing
6168
6169 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6170 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6171 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6172 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6173 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6174 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6175 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6176 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6177 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6178
6179 @menu
6180 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6181 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6182 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6183 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6184 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6185 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6186 @end menu
6187
6188 @node All-Stop Mode
6189 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6190
6191 @cindex all-stop mode
6192
6193 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6194 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6195 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6196 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6197 underfoot.
6198
6199 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6200 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6201 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6202
6203 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6204 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6205 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6206 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6207 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6208 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6209 stops.
6210
6211 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6212 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6213 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6214 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6215
6216 @cindex automatic thread selection
6217 @cindex switching threads automatically
6218 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6219 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6220 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6221 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6222 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6223 thread.
6224
6225 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6226 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6230 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6231 @cindex lock scheduler
6232 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6233 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6234 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6235 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6236 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6237 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6238 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6239 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6240 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6241 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6242 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6243 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6244 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6245 @code{on} in replay mode.
6246
6247 @item show scheduler-locking
6248 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6249 @end table
6250
6251 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6252 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6253 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6254 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6255 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6256 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6257 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6258 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6259 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6260 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6261 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6262 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6263 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6264 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6268 @item set schedule-multiple
6269 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6270 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6271 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6272 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6273 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6274 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6275
6276 @item show schedule-multiple
6277 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6278 multiple processes.
6279 @end table
6280
6281 @node Non-Stop Mode
6282 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6283
6284 @cindex non-stop mode
6285
6286 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6287 @c with more details.
6288
6289 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6290 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6291 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6292 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6293 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6294 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6295
6296 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6297 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6298 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6299 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6300 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6301 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6302 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6303 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6304 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6305 independently and simultaneously.
6306
6307 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6308 or attach to your program:
6309
6310 @smallexample
6311 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6312 set pagination off
6313
6314 # Finally, turn it on!
6315 set non-stop on
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6319
6320 @table @code
6321 @kindex set non-stop
6322 @item set non-stop on
6323 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6324 @item set non-stop off
6325 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6326 @kindex show non-stop
6327 @item show non-stop
6328 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6329 @end table
6330
6331 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6332 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6333 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6334 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6335 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6336 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6337 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6338 default.
6339
6340 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6341 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6342 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6343
6344 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6345 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6346 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6347 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6348 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6349
6350 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6351 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6352 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6353 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6354 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6355
6356 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6357
6358 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6359 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6360 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6361 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6362 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6363 previously current thread.
6364
6365 @node Background Execution
6366 @subsection Background Execution
6367
6368 @cindex foreground execution
6369 @cindex background execution
6370 @cindex asynchronous execution
6371 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6372
6373 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6374 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6375 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6376 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6377 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6378 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6379
6380 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6381 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6382
6383 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6384 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6385 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6386 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6387 are:
6388
6389 @table @code
6390 @kindex run&
6391 @item run
6392 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6393
6394 @item attach
6395 @kindex attach&
6396 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6397
6398 @item step
6399 @kindex step&
6400 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6401
6402 @item stepi
6403 @kindex stepi&
6404 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6405
6406 @item next
6407 @kindex next&
6408 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6409
6410 @item nexti
6411 @kindex nexti&
6412 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6413
6414 @item continue
6415 @kindex continue&
6416 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6417
6418 @item finish
6419 @kindex finish&
6420 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6421
6422 @item until
6423 @kindex until&
6424 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6425
6426 @end table
6427
6428 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6429 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6430 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6431 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6432 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6433 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6434
6435 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6436 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6437
6438 @table @code
6439 @kindex interrupt
6440 @item interrupt
6441 @itemx interrupt -a
6442
6443 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6444 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6445 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6446 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6447 @end table
6448
6449 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6450 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6451
6452 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6453 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6454 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6455
6456 @table @code
6457 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6458 @cindex thread breakpoints
6459 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6460 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6461 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6462 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6463 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6464 specify some source line.
6465
6466 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6467 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6468 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6469 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6470 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6471
6472 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6473 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6474 program.
6475
6476 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6477 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6478 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6479
6480 @smallexample
6481 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6482 @end smallexample
6483
6484 @end table
6485
6486 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6487 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6488 thread list. For example:
6489
6490 @smallexample
6491 (@value{GDBP}) c
6492 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6493 @end smallexample
6494
6495 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6496 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6497 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6498 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6499 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6500 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6501 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6502 command.
6503
6504 @node Interrupted System Calls
6505 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6506
6507 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6508 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6509 @cindex premature return from system calls
6510 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6511 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6512 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6513 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6514 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6515 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6516 stop execution.
6517
6518 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6519 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6520 style anyways.
6521
6522 For example, do not write code like this:
6523
6524 @smallexample
6525 sleep (10);
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6529 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6530
6531 Instead, write this:
6532
6533 @smallexample
6534 int unslept = 10;
6535 while (unslept > 0)
6536 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6537 @end smallexample
6538
6539 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6540 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6541 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6542 @value{GDBN}.
6543
6544 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6545 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6546 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6547 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6548
6549 @node Observer Mode
6550 @subsection Observer Mode
6551
6552 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6553 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6554 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6555 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6556 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6557
6558 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6559 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6560 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6561 mode.
6562
6563 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6564 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6565 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6566 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6567 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6568
6569 @table @code
6570
6571 @kindex observer
6572 @item set observer on
6573 @itemx set observer off
6574 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6575 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6576 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6577 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6578
6579 @item show observer
6580 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6581
6582 @kindex may-write-registers
6583 @item set may-write-registers on
6584 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6585 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6586 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6587 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6588
6589 @item show may-write-registers
6590 Show the current permission to write registers.
6591
6592 @kindex may-write-memory
6593 @item set may-write-memory on
6594 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6595 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6596 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6597 defaults to @code{on}.
6598
6599 @item show may-write-memory
6600 Show the current permission to write memory.
6601
6602 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6603 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6604 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6605 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6606 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6607 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6608
6609 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6610 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6611
6612 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6613 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6614 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6615 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6616 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6617 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6618 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6619
6620 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6621 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6622
6623 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6624 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6625 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6626 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6627 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6628 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6629 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6630
6631 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6632 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6633
6634 @kindex may-interrupt
6635 @item set may-interrupt on
6636 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6637 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6638 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6639 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6640 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6641
6642 @item show may-interrupt
6643 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6644
6645 @end table
6646
6647 @node Reverse Execution
6648 @chapter Running programs backward
6649 @cindex reverse execution
6650 @cindex running programs backward
6651
6652 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6653 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6654 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6655 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6656
6657 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6658 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6659 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6660 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6661 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6662 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6663
6664 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6665 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6666 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6667 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6668 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6669 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6670 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6671 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6672 prior values@footnote{
6673 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6674 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6675 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6676
6677 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6678 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6679 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6680 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6681 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6682 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6683 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6684 }.
6685
6686 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6687 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex reverse-continue
6691 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6692 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6693 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6694 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6695 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6696 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6697 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6698
6699 @kindex reverse-step
6700 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6701 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6702 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6703 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6704
6705 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6706 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6707 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6708 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6709 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6710 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6711
6712 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6713 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6714
6715 @kindex reverse-stepi
6716 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6717 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6718 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6719 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6720 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6721 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6722 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6723
6724 @kindex reverse-next
6725 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6726 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6727 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6728 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6729 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6730 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6731 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6732 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6733 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6734 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6735
6736 @kindex reverse-nexti
6737 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6738 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6739 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6740 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6741 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6742 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6743 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6744 frame) is reached.
6745
6746 @kindex reverse-finish
6747 @item reverse-finish
6748 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6749 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6750 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6751 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6752
6753 @kindex set exec-direction
6754 @item set exec-direction
6755 Set the direction of target execution.
6756 @item set exec-direction reverse
6757 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6758 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6759 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6760 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6761 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6762 @item set exec-direction forward
6763 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6764 This is the default.
6765 @end table
6766
6767
6768 @node Process Record and Replay
6769 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6770 @cindex process record and replay
6771 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6772
6773 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6774 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6775 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6776
6777 @cindex replay mode
6778 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6779 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6780 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6781 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6782 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6783 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6784 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6785 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6786 execution log.
6787
6788 @cindex record mode
6789 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6790 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6791 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6792 for future replay.
6793
6794 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6795 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6796 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6797 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6798 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6799 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6800
6801 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6802 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6803 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6804 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6805
6806 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6807 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6808
6809 @table @code
6810 @kindex target record
6811 @kindex target record-full
6812 @kindex target record-btrace
6813 @kindex record
6814 @kindex record full
6815 @kindex record btrace
6816 @kindex record btrace bts
6817 @kindex record btrace pt
6818 @kindex record bts
6819 @kindex record pt
6820 @kindex rec
6821 @kindex rec full
6822 @kindex rec btrace
6823 @kindex rec btrace bts
6824 @kindex rec btrace pt
6825 @kindex rec bts
6826 @kindex rec pt
6827 @item record @var{method}
6828 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6829 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6830 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6831 recording methods are available:
6832
6833 @table @code
6834 @item full
6835 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6836 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6837 execution.
6838
6839 @item btrace @var{format}
6840 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6841 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6842 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6843 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6844 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6845 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6846 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6847
6848 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6849 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6850 formats are available:
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @item bts
6854 @cindex branch trace store
6855 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6856 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6857 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6858
6859 @item pt
6860 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6861 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6862 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6863 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6864
6865 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6866 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6867 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6868
6869 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6870 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6871 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6872 buffer-size with care.
6873 @end table
6874
6875 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6876 @end table
6877
6878 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6879 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6880 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6881 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6882
6883 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6884 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6885 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6886 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6887 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6888
6889 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6890 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6891 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6892 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6893 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6894 does not support these two modes.
6895
6896 @kindex record stop
6897 @kindex rec s
6898 @item record stop
6899 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6900 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6901 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6902
6903 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6904 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6905 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6906 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6907 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6908
6909 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6910 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6911 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6912 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6913 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6914
6915 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6916 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6917
6918 @kindex record goto
6919 @item record goto
6920 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6921 ways to specify the location to go to:
6922
6923 @table @code
6924 @item record goto begin
6925 @itemx record goto start
6926 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6927
6928 @item record goto end
6929 Go to the end of the execution log.
6930
6931 @item record goto @var{n}
6932 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @kindex record save
6936 @item record save @var{filename}
6937 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6938 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6939 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6940
6941 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6942
6943 @kindex record restore
6944 @item record restore @var{filename}
6945 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6946 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6947
6948 @kindex set record full
6949 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6950 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6951 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6952 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6953
6954 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6955 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6956 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6957 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6958 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6959 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6960 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6961 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6962
6963 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6964 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6965 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6966
6967 @kindex show record full
6968 @item show record full insn-number-max
6969 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6970 recording method.
6971
6972 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6973 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6974 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6975 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6976 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6977 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6978 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6979 oldest one to be deleted.
6980
6981 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6982 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6983
6984 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6985 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6986
6987 @item set record full memory-query
6988 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6989 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6990 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6991 case.
6992
6993 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6994 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6995 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6996 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6997 results.
6998
6999 @item show record full memory-query
7000 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7001
7002 @kindex set record btrace
7003 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7004 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7005 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7006 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7007 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7008 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7009 You can use the following command for that:
7010
7011 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7012 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7013 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7014 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7015 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7016 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7017 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7018 position.
7019
7020 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7021 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7022 errata when decoding the trace.
7023
7024 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7025 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7026 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7027 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7028 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7029 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7030 which the trace was recorded.
7031
7032 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7033 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7034 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7035 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7036 disable the workarounds.
7037
7038 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7039 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7040 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7041 (default).
7042
7043 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7044 identifiers are currently supported:
7045
7046 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7047
7048 @item @code{intel}
7049 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7050
7051 @end multitable
7052
7053 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7054 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7055
7056 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7057 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7058 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7059
7060 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7061 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7062 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7063 supports.
7064
7065 @smallexample
7066 (gdb) info record
7067 Active record target: record-btrace
7068 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7069 Buffer size: 16kB.
7070 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7071 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7077 @end smallexample
7078
7079 @kindex show record btrace
7080 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7081 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7082
7083 @item show record btrace cpu
7084 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7085 workarounds.
7086
7087 @kindex set record btrace bts
7088 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7089 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7090 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7091 format. Default is 64KB.
7092
7093 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7094 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7095 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7096 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7097 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7098 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7099 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7100
7101 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7102 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7103
7104 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7105 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7106
7107 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7108 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7109 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7110
7111 @kindex set record btrace pt
7112 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7113 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7114 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7115 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7116
7117 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7118 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7119 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7120 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7121 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7122 actual buffer size for each thread.
7123
7124 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7125 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7126
7127 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7128 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7129
7130 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7131 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7132 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7133
7134 @kindex info record
7135 @item info record
7136 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7137 method:
7138
7139 @table @code
7140 @item full
7141 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7142 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7143
7144 @itemize @bullet
7145 @item
7146 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7147 @item
7148 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7149 @item
7150 Highest recorded instruction number.
7151 @item
7152 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7153 @item
7154 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7155 @item
7156 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7157 @end itemize
7158
7159 @item btrace
7160 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7161
7162 @itemize @bullet
7163 @item
7164 Recording format.
7165 @item
7166 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7167 @item
7168 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7169 instructions.
7170 @item
7171 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7172 @end itemize
7173
7174 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7175 @itemize @bullet
7176 @item
7177 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185 @end table
7186
7187 @kindex record delete
7188 @kindex rec del
7189 @item record delete
7190 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7191 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7192 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7193 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7194
7195 @kindex record instruction-history
7196 @kindex rec instruction-history
7197 @item record instruction-history
7198 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7199 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7200 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7201 are printed in execution order.
7202
7203 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7204 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7205 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7206
7207 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7208 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7209 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7210 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7211 @code{/p} modifier.
7212
7213 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7214 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7215 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7216
7217 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7218 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7219
7220 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7221 disassemble:
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7225 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7226 @var{insn}.
7227
7228 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7229 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7230 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7231 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7232 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7233 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7234
7235 @item record instruction-history
7236 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7237
7238 @item record instruction-history -
7239 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7242 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7243 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7244 number @var{end} is included.
7245 @end table
7246
7247 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7248
7249 @kindex set record
7250 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7251 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7252 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7253 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7254 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7255
7256 @kindex show record
7257 @item show record instruction-history-size
7258 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command.
7260
7261 @kindex record function-call-history
7262 @kindex rec function-call-history
7263 @item record function-call-history
7264 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7265 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7266 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7267 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7268 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7269 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7270 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7271 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7272 given together.
7273
7274 @smallexample
7275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7276 1 void foo (void)
7277 2 @{
7278 3 @}
7279 4
7280 5 void bar (void)
7281 6 @{
7282 7 ...
7283 8 foo ();
7284 9 ...
7285 10 @}
7286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7287 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7288 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7289 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7290 @end smallexample
7291
7292 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7293 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7294 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7295 to print:
7296
7297 @table @code
7298 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7299 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7300
7301 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7302 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7303 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7304 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7305 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history
7308 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7309
7310 @item record function-call-history -
7311 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7314 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7315 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7316 @end table
7317
7318 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7319
7320 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7321 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7322 Define how many lines to print in the
7323 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7324 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7325
7326 @item show record function-call-history-size
7327 Show how many lines to print in the
7328 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7329 @end table
7330
7331
7332 @node Stack
7333 @chapter Examining the Stack
7334
7335 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7336 stopped and how it got there.
7337
7338 @cindex call stack
7339 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7340 is generated.
7341 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7342 the arguments of the call,
7343 and the local variables of the function being called.
7344 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7345 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7346 stack}.
7347
7348 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7349 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7350
7351 @cindex selected frame
7352 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7353 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7354 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7355 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7356 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7357 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7358
7359 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7360 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7361 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7362
7363 @menu
7364 * Frames:: Stack frames
7365 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7366 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7367 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7368 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7369 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7370
7371 @end menu
7372
7373 @node Frames
7374 @section Stack Frames
7375
7376 @cindex frame, definition
7377 @cindex stack frame
7378 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7379 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7380 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7381 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7382 which the function is executing.
7383
7384 @cindex initial frame
7385 @cindex outermost frame
7386 @cindex innermost frame
7387 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7388 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7389 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7390 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7391 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7392 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7393 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7394 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7395
7396 @cindex frame pointer
7397 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7398 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7399 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7400 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7401 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7402 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7403
7404 @cindex frame number
7405 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7406 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7407 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7408 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7409 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7410
7411 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7412 @c underflow problems.
7413 @cindex frameless execution
7414 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7415 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7416 @smallexample
7417 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7418 @end smallexample
7419 generates functions without a frame.)
7420 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7421 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7422 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7423 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7424 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7425 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7426 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7427
7428 @node Backtrace
7429 @section Backtraces
7430
7431 @cindex traceback
7432 @cindex call stack traces
7433 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7434 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7435 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7436 stack.
7437
7438 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7439 @kindex backtrace
7440 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7441 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7442 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7443 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7444 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7445 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7449 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7450 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7451 be one of the following:
7452
7453 @table @code
7454 @item @var{n}
7455 @itemx @var{n}
7456 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7457 number.
7458
7459 @item -@var{n}
7460 @itemx -@var{n}
7461 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7462 number.
7463
7464 @item full
7465 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7466 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7467
7468 @item no-filters
7469 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7470 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7471 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7472 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7473 support.
7474
7475 @item hide
7476 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7477 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7478 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7479 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7480 @end table
7481 @end table
7482
7483 @kindex where
7484 @kindex info stack
7485 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7486 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7487
7488 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7489 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7490 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7491 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7492 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7493 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7494 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7495 multi-threaded program.
7496
7497 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7498 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7499 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7500 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7501 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7502 line number.
7503
7504 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7505 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7506
7507 @smallexample
7508 @group
7509 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7510 at builtin.c:993
7511 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7512 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7513 at macro.c:71
7514 (More stack frames follow...)
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7520 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7521 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7522
7523 @noindent
7524 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7525 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7526 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7527 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7528 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7529
7530 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7531 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7532 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7533 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7534 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7535 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7536 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7537 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7538 such a backtrace might look like:
7539
7540 @smallexample
7541 @group
7542 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7543 at builtin.c:993
7544 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7545 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7546 at macro.c:71
7547 (More stack frames follow...)
7548 @end group
7549 @end smallexample
7550
7551 @noindent
7552 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7553 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7554
7555 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7556 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7557 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7558
7559 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7560 @cindex program entry point
7561 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7562 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7563 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7564 @code{main}@footnote{
7565 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7566 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7567 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7568 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7569 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7570 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7571
7572 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7573 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7574
7575 @table @code
7576 @item set backtrace past-main
7577 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7578 @kindex set backtrace
7579 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7580
7581 @item set backtrace past-main off
7582 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7583 default.
7584
7585 @item show backtrace past-main
7586 @kindex show backtrace
7587 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-entry
7590 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7591 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7592 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7593 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7594
7595 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7596 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7597 application. This is the default.
7598
7599 @item show backtrace past-entry
7600 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7601
7602 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7603 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7604 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7605 @cindex backtrace limit
7606 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7607 or zero means unlimited levels.
7608
7609 @item show backtrace limit
7610 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7611 @end table
7612
7613 You can control how file names are displayed.
7614
7615 @table @code
7616 @item set filename-display
7617 @itemx set filename-display relative
7618 @cindex filename-display
7619 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7620
7621 @item set filename-display basename
7622 Display only basename of a filename.
7623
7624 @item set filename-display absolute
7625 Display an absolute filename.
7626
7627 @item show filename-display
7628 Show the current way to display filenames.
7629 @end table
7630
7631 @node Selection
7632 @section Selecting a Frame
7633
7634 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7635 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7636 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7637 of the stack frame just selected.
7638
7639 @table @code
7640 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7641 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7642 @item frame @var{n}
7643 @itemx f @var{n}
7644 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7645 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7646 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7647 @code{main}.
7648
7649 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7650 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7651 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7652 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7653 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7654 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7655 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7656 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7657
7658 @kindex up
7659 @item up @var{n}
7660 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7661 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7662 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7663
7664 @kindex down
7665 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7666 @item down @var{n}
7667 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7668 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7669 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7670 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7671 @end table
7672
7673 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7674 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7675 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7676 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7677
7678 @need 1000
7679 For example:
7680
7681 @smallexample
7682 @group
7683 (@value{GDBP}) up
7684 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7685 at env.c:10
7686 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7687 @end group
7688 @end smallexample
7689
7690 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7691 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7692 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7693 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7694 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7695 for details.
7696
7697 @table @code
7698 @kindex select-frame
7699 @item select-frame
7700 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7701 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7702 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7703 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7704
7705 @kindex down-silently
7706 @kindex up-silently
7707 @item up-silently @var{n}
7708 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7709 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7710 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7711 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7712 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7713 distracting.
7714 @end table
7715
7716 @node Frame Info
7717 @section Information About a Frame
7718
7719 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7720 stack frame.
7721
7722 @table @code
7723 @item frame
7724 @itemx f
7725 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7726 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7727 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7728 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7729 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7730
7731 @kindex info frame
7732 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7733 @item info frame
7734 @itemx info f
7735 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7736 including:
7737
7738 @itemize @bullet
7739 @item
7740 the address of the frame
7741 @item
7742 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7743 @item
7744 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7745 @item
7746 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7747 @item
7748 the address of the frame's arguments
7749 @item
7750 the address of the frame's local variables
7751 @item
7752 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7753 @item
7754 which registers were saved in the frame
7755 @end itemize
7756
7757 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7758 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7759 the usual conventions.
7760
7761 @item info frame @var{addr}
7762 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7763 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7764 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7765 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7766 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7767 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex info args
7770 @item info args
7771 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7772
7773 @item info locals
7774 @kindex info locals
7775 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7776 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7777 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7778
7779 @end table
7780
7781 @node Frame Apply
7782 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7783 @kindex frame apply
7784 @cindex apply command to several frames
7785 @table @code
7786 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7787 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7788 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7789
7790 @table @code
7791 @item @code{all}
7792 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7793
7794 @item @var{count}
7795 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7796 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7797
7798 @item @var{-count}
7799 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7800 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7801
7802 @item @code{level}
7803 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7804 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7805 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7806 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7807 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7808 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7809
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @end table
7813
7814 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7815 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7816 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7817 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7818
7819 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7820 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7821 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7822 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7823 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7824
7825 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7826 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7827 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7828 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7829
7830 @table @code
7831 @item -c
7832 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7833 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7834 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7835 @item -s
7836 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7837 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7838 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7839 are not printed.
7840 @item -q
7841 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7842 information.
7843 @end table
7844
7845 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7846 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7847 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7848 @code{#1 main} frame.
7849
7850 @smallexample
7851 @group
7852 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7853 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7854 No symbol "j" in current context.
7855 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7856 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7857 No symbol "j" in current context.
7858 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7859 $1 = 5
7860 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7861 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7862 $2 = 5
7863 (gdb)
7864 @end group
7865 @end smallexample
7866
7867 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7868 information before the command output:
7869
7870 @smallexample
7871 @group
7872 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7873 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7874 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7875 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7876 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7877 (gdb)
7878 @end group
7879 @end smallexample
7880
7881 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7882 @smallexample
7883 @group
7884 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7885 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7886 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7887 (gdb)
7888 @end group
7889 @end smallexample
7890
7891 @table @code
7892
7893 @kindex faas
7894 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7895 @item faas @var{command}
7896 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7897 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7898
7899 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7900 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7901 is, using:
7902 @smallexample
7903 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7904 @end smallexample
7905
7906 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7907 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7908 @end table
7909
7910
7911 @node Frame Filter Management
7912 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7913 @cindex managing frame filters
7914
7915 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7916 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7917
7918 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7919 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @kindex info frame-filter
7923 @item info frame-filter
7924 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7925 their name, priority and enabled status.
7926
7927 @kindex disable frame-filter
7928 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7929 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7930 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7931 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7932 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7933 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7934 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7935 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7936 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7937 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7938 may be enabled again later.
7939
7940 @kindex enable frame-filter
7941 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7942 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7943 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7944 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7945 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7946 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7947 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7948 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7949 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7950
7951 Example:
7952
7953 @smallexample
7954 (gdb) info frame-filter
7955
7956 global frame-filters:
7957 Priority Enabled Name
7958 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7959 100 Yes Reverse
7960
7961 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7962 Priority Enabled Name
7963 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7964
7965 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7966 Priority Enabled Name
7967 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7968
7969 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7970 (gdb) info frame-filter
7971
7972 global frame-filters:
7973 Priority Enabled Name
7974 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7975 100 Yes Reverse
7976
7977 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7978 Priority Enabled Name
7979 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7980
7981 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7982 Priority Enabled Name
7983 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7984
7985 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7986 (gdb) info frame-filter
7987
7988 global frame-filters:
7989 Priority Enabled Name
7990 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7991 100 Yes Reverse
7992
7993 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7994 Priority Enabled Name
7995 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7996
7997 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7998 Priority Enabled Name
7999 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8000 @end smallexample
8001
8002 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8003 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8004 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8005 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8006 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8007 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8008 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8009
8010 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8011 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8012 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8013 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8014 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8015 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8016 dictionary resides.
8017
8018 Example:
8019
8020 @smallexample
8021 (gdb) info frame-filter
8022
8023 global frame-filters:
8024 Priority Enabled Name
8025 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8026 100 Yes Reverse
8027
8028 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8029 Priority Enabled Name
8030 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8031
8032 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8033 Priority Enabled Name
8034 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8035
8036 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8037 (gdb) info frame-filter
8038
8039 global frame-filters:
8040 Priority Enabled Name
8041 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8042 50 Yes Reverse
8043
8044 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8045 Priority Enabled Name
8046 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8047
8048 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8049 Priority Enabled Name
8050 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8051 @end smallexample
8052 @end table
8053
8054 @node Source
8055 @chapter Examining Source Files
8056
8057 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8058 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8059 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8060 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8061 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8062 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8063 source files by explicit command.
8064
8065 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8066 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8067 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8068
8069 @menu
8070 * List:: Printing source lines
8071 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8072 * Edit:: Editing source files
8073 * Search:: Searching source files
8074 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8075 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8076 @end menu
8077
8078 @node List
8079 @section Printing Source Lines
8080
8081 @kindex list
8082 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8083 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8084 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8085 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8086 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8087
8088 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8089
8090 @table @code
8091 @item list @var{linenum}
8092 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8093 current source file.
8094
8095 @item list @var{function}
8096 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8097 @var{function}.
8098
8099 @item list
8100 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8101 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8102 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8103 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8104 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8105
8106 @item list -
8107 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8108 @end table
8109
8110 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8111 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8112 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8113
8114 @table @code
8115 @kindex set listsize
8116 @item set listsize @var{count}
8117 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8118 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8119 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8120 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8121
8122 @kindex show listsize
8123 @item show listsize
8124 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8125 @end table
8126
8127 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8128 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8129 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8130 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8131 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8132
8133 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8134 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8135 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8136 to specify some source line.
8137
8138 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8139
8140 @table @code
8141 @item list @var{location}
8142 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8143
8144 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8145 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8146 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8147 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8148 the same source file as the first location.
8149
8150 @item list ,@var{last}
8151 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8152
8153 @item list @var{first},
8154 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8155
8156 @item list +
8157 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8158
8159 @item list -
8160 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8161
8162 @item list
8163 As described in the preceding table.
8164 @end table
8165
8166 @node Specify Location
8167 @section Specifying a Location
8168 @cindex specifying location
8169 @cindex location
8170 @cindex source location
8171
8172 @menu
8173 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8174 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8175 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8176 @end menu
8177
8178 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8179 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8180 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8181 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8182 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8183
8184 @node Linespec Locations
8185 @subsection Linespec Locations
8186 @cindex linespec locations
8187
8188 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8189 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8190 specifying a linespec:
8191
8192 @table @code
8193 @item @var{linenum}
8194 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8195
8196 @item -@var{offset}
8197 @itemx +@var{offset}
8198 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8199 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8200 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8201 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8202 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8203 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8204 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8205 linespec.
8206
8207 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8208 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8209 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8210 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8211 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8212 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8213 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8214
8215 @item @var{function}
8216 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8217 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8218
8219 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8220 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8221 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8222 means in all packages.
8223
8224 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8225 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8226 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8227
8228 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8229 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8230 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8231 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8232
8233 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8234
8235 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8236 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8237
8238 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8239 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8240 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8241 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8242 functions in different source files.
8243
8244 @item @var{label}
8245 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8246 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8247 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8248 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8249
8250 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8251 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8252 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8253 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8254 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8255 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8256
8257 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8258 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8259 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8260 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8261 each one of those probes.
8262 @end table
8263
8264 @node Explicit Locations
8265 @subsection Explicit Locations
8266 @cindex explicit locations
8267
8268 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8269 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8270
8271 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8272 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8273 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8274 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8275 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8276
8277 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8278 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8279 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8280 the symbol table to know.
8281
8282 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8283 following table:
8284
8285 @table @code
8286 @item -source @var{filename}
8287 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8288 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8289 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8290 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8291 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8292
8293 @item -function @var{function}
8294 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8295 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8296 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8297 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8298
8299 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8300 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8301 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8302 means in all packages.
8303
8304 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8305 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8306 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8307 breakpoint on both symbols.
8308
8309 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8310
8311 @item -qualified
8312
8313 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8314 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8315
8316 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8317 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8318 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8319
8320 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8321 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8322 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8323
8324 @item -label @var{label}
8325 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8326 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8327 selected stack frame.
8328
8329 @item -line @var{number}
8330 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8331 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8332 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8333 relative to the current line.
8334 @end table
8335
8336 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8337 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8338
8339 @node Address Locations
8340 @subsection Address Locations
8341 @cindex address locations
8342
8343 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8344 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8345
8346 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8347 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8348 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8349 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8350 source files.
8351
8352 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8353 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8354 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8355 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8356 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8357 of @var{address}:
8358
8359 @table @code
8360 @item @var{expression}
8361 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8362
8363 @item @var{funcaddr}
8364 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8365 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8366 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8367 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8368 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8369 (although the Pascal form also works).
8370
8371 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8372 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8373
8374 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8375 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8376 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8377 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8378 functions with identical names in different source files.
8379 @end table
8380
8381 @node Edit
8382 @section Editing Source Files
8383 @cindex editing source files
8384
8385 @kindex edit
8386 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8387 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8388 The editing program of your choice
8389 is invoked with the current line set to
8390 the active line in the program.
8391 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8392 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8393
8394 @table @code
8395 @item edit @var{location}
8396 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8397 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8398 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8399 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8400 command most commonly used:
8401
8402 @table @code
8403 @item edit @var{number}
8404 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8405
8406 @item edit @var{function}
8407 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8408 @end table
8409
8410 @end table
8411
8412 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8413 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8414 @footnote{
8415 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8416 following command-line syntax:
8417 @smallexample
8418 ex +@var{number} file
8419 @end smallexample
8420 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8421 the file where to start editing.}.
8422 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8423 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8424 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8425 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8426 @smallexample
8427 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8428 export EDITOR
8429 gdb @dots{}
8430 @end smallexample
8431 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8432 @smallexample
8433 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8434 gdb @dots{}
8435 @end smallexample
8436
8437 @node Search
8438 @section Searching Source Files
8439 @cindex searching source files
8440
8441 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8442 regular expression.
8443
8444 @table @code
8445 @kindex search
8446 @kindex forward-search
8447 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8448 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8449 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8450 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8451 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8452 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8453 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8454 @code{fo}.
8455
8456 @kindex reverse-search
8457 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8458 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8459 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8460 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8461 this command as @code{rev}.
8462 @end table
8463
8464 @node Source Path
8465 @section Specifying Source Directories
8466
8467 @cindex source path
8468 @cindex directories for source files
8469 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8470 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8471 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8472 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8473 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8474 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8475 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8476
8477 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8478 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8479 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8480 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8481 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8482 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8483 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8484 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8485 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8486 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8487 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8488
8489 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8490 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8491 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8492 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8493 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8494 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8495
8496 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8497 source files.
8498
8499 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8500 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8501 each line is in the file.
8502
8503 @kindex directory
8504 @kindex dir
8505 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8506 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8507 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8508
8509 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8510 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8511
8512 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8513 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8514 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8515 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8516 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8517 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8518 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8519 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8520 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8521 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8522 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8523 name to look up the sources.
8524
8525 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8526 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8527 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8528 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8529 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8530 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8531 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8532 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8533
8534 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8535 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8536 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8537 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8538 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8539 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8540 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8541
8542 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8543 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8544 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8545 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8546 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8547 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8548 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8549 command.
8550
8551 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8552 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8553 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8554 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8555 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8556 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8557 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8558
8559 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8560 @cindex default source path substitution
8561 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8562 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8563 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8564 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8565 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8566 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8567 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8568 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8569 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8570 together.
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8574 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8575 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8576 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8577 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8578 part of absolute file names) or
8579 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8580 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8581
8582 @kindex cdir
8583 @kindex cwd
8584 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8585 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8586 @cindex compilation directory
8587 @cindex current directory
8588 @cindex working directory
8589 @cindex directory, current
8590 @cindex directory, compilation
8591 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8592 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8593 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8594 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8595 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8596 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8597
8598 @item directory
8599 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8600
8601 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8602 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8603
8604 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8605 @kindex set directories
8606 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8607 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8608
8609 @item show directories
8610 @kindex show directories
8611 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8612
8613 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8614 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8615 @kindex set substitute-path
8616 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8617 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8618 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8619
8620 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8621 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8622
8623 @smallexample
8624 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8625 @end smallexample
8626
8627 @noindent
8628 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8629 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8630 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8631
8632 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8633 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8634 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8635 the substitution.
8636
8637 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8638
8639 @smallexample
8640 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8641 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8642 @end smallexample
8643
8644 @noindent
8645 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8646 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8647 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8648 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8649
8650
8651 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8652 @kindex unset substitute-path
8653 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8654 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8655 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8656
8657 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8658
8659 @item show substitute-path [path]
8660 @kindex show substitute-path
8661 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8662 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8663
8664 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8665 rules.
8666
8667 @end table
8668
8669 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8670 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8671 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8672
8673 @enumerate
8674 @item
8675 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8676
8677 @item
8678 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8679 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8680 directories in one command.
8681 @end enumerate
8682
8683 @node Machine Code
8684 @section Source and Machine Code
8685 @cindex source line and its code address
8686
8687 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8688 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8689 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8690 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8691 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8692 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8693 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8694 well as hex.
8695
8696 @table @code
8697 @kindex info line
8698 @item info line
8699 @itemx info line @var{location}
8700 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8701 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8702 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8703 information about the current source line is printed.
8704 @end table
8705
8706 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8707 the object code for the first line of function
8708 @code{m4_changequote}:
8709
8710 @smallexample
8711 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8712 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8713 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8714 @end smallexample
8715
8716 @noindent
8717 @cindex code address and its source line
8718 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8719 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8720 @smallexample
8721 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8722 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8723 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8724 @end smallexample
8725
8726 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8727 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8728 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8729 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8730 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8731 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8732 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8733 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8734 Variables}).
8735
8736 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8737 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8738 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8739 line.
8740
8741 @table @code
8742 @kindex disassemble
8743 @cindex assembly instructions
8744 @cindex instructions, assembly
8745 @cindex machine instructions
8746 @cindex listing machine instructions
8747 @item disassemble
8748 @itemx disassemble /m
8749 @itemx disassemble /s
8750 @itemx disassemble /r
8751 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8752 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8753 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8754 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8755 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8756 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8757 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8758 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8759 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8760 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8761
8762 @table @code
8763 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8764 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8765 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8766 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8767 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8768 @end table
8769
8770 @noindent
8771 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8772 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8773
8774 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8775 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8776
8777 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8778 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8779 @end table
8780
8781 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8782 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8786 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8787 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8788 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8789 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8790 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8791 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8792 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8793 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8794 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8795 End of assembler dump.
8796 @end smallexample
8797
8798 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8799 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8800 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8801
8802 @smallexample
8803 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8804 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8805 5 @{
8806 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8807 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8808 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8809 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8810 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8811
8812 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8813 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8814 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8815
8816 7 return 0;
8817 8 @}
8818 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8819 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8820 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8821
8822 End of assembler dump.
8823 @end smallexample
8824
8825 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8826 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8827 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8828 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8829 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8830 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8831 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8832 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8833 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8834
8835 @file{foo.h}:
8836
8837 @smallexample
8838 int
8839 foo (int a)
8840 @{
8841 if (a < 0)
8842 return a * 2;
8843 if (a == 0)
8844 return 1;
8845 return a + 10;
8846 @}
8847 @end smallexample
8848
8849 @file{foo.c}:
8850
8851 @smallexample
8852 #include "foo.h"
8853 volatile int x, y;
8854 int
8855 main ()
8856 @{
8857 x = foo (y);
8858 return 0;
8859 @}
8860 @end smallexample
8861
8862 @smallexample
8863 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8864 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8865 5 @{
8866
8867 6 x = foo (y);
8868 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8869 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8870
8871 7 return 0;
8872 8 @}
8873 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8874 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8875 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8876 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8877
8878 End of assembler dump.
8879 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8880 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8881 foo.c:
8882 5 @{
8883 6 x = foo (y);
8884 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8885
8886 foo.h:
8887 4 if (a < 0)
8888 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8889 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8890
8891 6 if (a == 0)
8892 7 return 1;
8893 8 return a + 10;
8894 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8895 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8896 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8897 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8898
8899 foo.c:
8900 6 x = foo (y);
8901 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8902
8903 7 return 0;
8904 8 @}
8905 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8906 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8907
8908 foo.h:
8909 5 return a * 2;
8910 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8911 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8912 End of assembler dump.
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8916
8917 @smallexample
8918 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8919 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8920 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8921 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8922 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8923 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8924 End of assembler dump.
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8928 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8929 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8930 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8931
8932 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8933 mnemonics or other syntax.
8934
8935 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8936 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8937 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8938 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8939 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8940
8941 @table @code
8942 @kindex set disassembler-options
8943 @cindex disassembler options
8944 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8945 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8946 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8947 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8948 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8949 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8950 The default value is the empty string.
8951
8952 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8953 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8954 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
8955 and S/390.
8956
8957 @kindex show disassembler-options
8958 @item show disassembler-options
8959 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8960 @end table
8961
8962 @table @code
8963 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8964 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8965 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8966 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8967 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8968 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8969
8970 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8971 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8972 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8973 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8974
8975 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8976 @item show disassembly-flavor
8977 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8978 @end table
8979
8980 @table @code
8981 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8982 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8983 @item set disassemble-next-line
8984 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8985 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8986 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8987 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8988 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8989 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8990 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8991 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8992 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8993 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8994 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8995 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8996 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8997 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8998 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8999 instruction.
9000 @end table
9001
9002
9003 @node Data
9004 @chapter Examining Data
9005
9006 @cindex printing data
9007 @cindex examining data
9008 @kindex print
9009 @kindex inspect
9010 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9011 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9012 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9013 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9014 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9015 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9016
9017 @table @code
9018 @item print @var{expr}
9019 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9020 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9021 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9022 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9023 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9024 Formats}.
9025
9026 @item print
9027 @itemx print /@var{f}
9028 @cindex reprint the last value
9029 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9030 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9031 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9032 @end table
9033
9034 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9035 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9036 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9037
9038 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9039 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9040 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9041 Table}.
9042
9043 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9044 @kindex explore
9045 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9046 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9047 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9048 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9049 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9050 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9051 embedded in the higher level data types.
9052
9053 @table @code
9054 @item explore @var{arg}
9055 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9056 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9057 @end table
9058
9059 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9060 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9061 C program as
9062
9063 @smallexample
9064 struct SimpleStruct
9065 @{
9066 int i;
9067 double d;
9068 @};
9069
9070 struct ComplexStruct
9071 @{
9072 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9073 int arr[10];
9074 @};
9075 @end smallexample
9076
9077 @noindent
9078 followed by variable declarations as
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9082 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 @noindent
9086 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9087 @code{explore} command as follows.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 (gdb) explore cs
9091 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9092 the following fields:
9093
9094 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9095 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9096
9097 Enter the field number of choice:
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 @noindent
9101 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9102 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9103 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9104 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9105 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9106 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9107 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9108 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9112 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9113 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9114 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9115
9116 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9117 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9118
9119 Press enter to return to parent value:
9120 @end smallexample
9121
9122 @noindent
9123 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9124 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9125 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9126 to explore.
9127
9128 @smallexample
9129 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9130 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9131
9132 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9133
9134 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9135
9136 Press enter to return to parent value:
9137 @end smallexample
9138
9139 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9140 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9141 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9142 level data structure).
9143
9144 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9145 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9146 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9147 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9148 same example as above, your can explore the type
9149 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9150 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9154 @end smallexample
9155
9156 @noindent
9157 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9158 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9159 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9160 example.
9161
9162 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9163 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9164 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9165 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9166 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9167
9168 @table @code
9169 @item explore value @var{expr}
9170 @cindex explore value
9171 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9172 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9173 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9174 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9175 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9176
9177 @item explore type @var{arg}
9178 @cindex explore type
9179 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9180 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9181 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9182 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9183 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9184 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9185 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9186 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9187 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 @menu
9191 * Expressions:: Expressions
9192 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9193 * Variables:: Program variables
9194 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9195 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9196 * Memory:: Examining memory
9197 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9198 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9199 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9200 * Value History:: Value history
9201 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9202 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9203 * Registers:: Registers
9204 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9205 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9206 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9207 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9208 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9209 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9210 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9211 character set than GDB does
9212 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9213 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9214 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9215 @end menu
9216
9217 @node Expressions
9218 @section Expressions
9219
9220 @cindex expressions
9221 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9222 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9223 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9224 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9225 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9226 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9227 @ref{Compilation}.
9228
9229 @cindex arrays in expressions
9230 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9231 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9232 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9233 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9234 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9235 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9236
9237 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9238 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9239 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9240 languages.
9241
9242 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9243 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9244
9245 @cindex casts, in expressions
9246 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9247 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9248 at that address in memory.
9249 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9250
9251 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9252 to programming languages:
9253
9254 @table @code
9255 @item @@
9256 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9257 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9258
9259 @item ::
9260 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9261 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9262
9263 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9264 @cindex type casting memory
9265 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9266 @cindex casts, to view memory
9267 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9268 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9269 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9270 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9271 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9272 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9273 @end table
9274
9275 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9276 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9277 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9278
9279 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9280 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9281 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9282 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9283 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9284 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9285 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9286
9287 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9288 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9289 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9290 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9291 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9292 as well.
9293
9294 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9295 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9296 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9297 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9298 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9299 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9300 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9301 choices.
9302
9303 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9304 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9305 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9306
9307 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9308 @smallexample
9309 @group
9310 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9311 [0] cancel
9312 [1] all
9313 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9314 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9315 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9316 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9317 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9318 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9319 > 2 4 6
9320 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9321 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9322 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9323 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9324 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9325 breakpoints.
9326 (@value{GDBP})
9327 @end group
9328 @end smallexample
9329
9330 @table @code
9331 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9332 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9333 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9334
9335 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9336 is ambiguous.
9337
9338 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9339 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9340 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9341 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9342 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9343 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9344 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9345 in the use of the menu.
9346
9347 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9348 when an ambiguity is detected.
9349
9350 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9351 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9352
9353 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9354 @item show multiple-symbols
9355 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9356 @end table
9357
9358 @node Variables
9359 @section Program Variables
9360
9361 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9362 in your program.
9363
9364 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9365 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9366
9367 @itemize @bullet
9368 @item
9369 global (or file-static)
9370 @end itemize
9371
9372 @noindent or
9373
9374 @itemize @bullet
9375 @item
9376 visible according to the scope rules of the
9377 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9378 @end itemize
9379
9380 @noindent This means that in the function
9381
9382 @smallexample
9383 foo (a)
9384 int a;
9385 @{
9386 bar (a);
9387 @{
9388 int b = test ();
9389 bar (b);
9390 @}
9391 @}
9392 @end smallexample
9393
9394 @noindent
9395 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9396 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9397 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9398 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9399
9400 @cindex variable name conflict
9401 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9402 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9403 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9404 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9405 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9406 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9407 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9408
9409 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9410 @ifnotinfo
9411 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9412 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9413 @end ifnotinfo
9414 @smallexample
9415 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9416 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9417 @end smallexample
9418
9419 @noindent
9420 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9421 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9422 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9423 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9424
9425 @smallexample
9426 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9427 @end smallexample
9428
9429 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9430 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9431 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9432 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9433 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9434
9435 @smallexample
9436 void
9437 foo (int a)
9438 @{
9439 if (a < 10)
9440 bar (a);
9441 else
9442 process (a); /* Stop here */
9443 @}
9444
9445 int
9446 bar (int a)
9447 @{
9448 foo (a + 5);
9449 @}
9450 @end smallexample
9451
9452 @noindent
9453 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9454 here is what you might see
9455 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9456
9457 @smallexample
9458 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9459 $1 = 10
9460 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9461 $2 = 5
9462 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9463 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9464 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9465 $3 = 5
9466 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9467 $4 = 0
9468 @end smallexample
9469
9470 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9471 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9472 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9473 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9474 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9475
9476 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9477 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9478 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9479 @code{some_global}.
9480
9481 @smallexample
9482 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9483 $1 = 23
9484 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9485 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9486 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9487 $2 = 27
9488 @end smallexample
9489
9490 @cindex wrong values
9491 @cindex variable values, wrong
9492 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9493 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9494 @quotation
9495 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9496 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9497 scope, and just before exit.
9498 @end quotation
9499 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9500 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9501 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9502 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9503 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9504 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9505 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9506 variable definitions may be gone.
9507
9508 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9509 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9510 when compiling.
9511
9512 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9513 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9514 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9515 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9516 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9517 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9518 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9519
9520 @smallexample
9521 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9522 @end smallexample
9523
9524 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9525 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9526 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9527 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9528 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9529
9530 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9531 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9532 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9533 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9534
9535 @cindex no debug info variables
9536 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9537 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9538 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9539 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9540 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9541 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9542 example, in a C program:
9543
9544 @smallexample
9545 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9546 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9547 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9548 $1 = 3.14
9549 @end smallexample
9550
9551 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9552 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9553 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9554 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9555 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9556
9557 @smallexample
9558 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9559 29 i++;
9560 (gdb) next
9561 30 e (i);
9562 (gdb) print i
9563 $1 = 31
9564 (gdb) print i@@entry
9565 $2 = 30
9566 @end smallexample
9567
9568 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9569 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9570 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9571 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9572 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9573 For program code
9574
9575 @smallexample
9576 char var0[] = "A";
9577 signed char var1[] = "A";
9578 @end smallexample
9579
9580 You get during debugging
9581 @smallexample
9582 (gdb) print var0
9583 $1 = "A"
9584 (gdb) print var1
9585 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9586 @end smallexample
9587
9588 @node Arrays
9589 @section Artificial Arrays
9590
9591 @cindex artificial array
9592 @cindex arrays
9593 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9594 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9595 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9596 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9597 program.
9598
9599 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9600 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9601 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9602 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9603 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9604 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9605 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9606 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9607 example. If a program says
9608
9609 @smallexample
9610 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9611 @end smallexample
9612
9613 @noindent
9614 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9615
9616 @smallexample
9617 p *array@@len
9618 @end smallexample
9619
9620 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9621 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9622 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9623 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9624 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9625
9626 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9627 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9628 The value need not be in memory:
9629 @smallexample
9630 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9631 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9635 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9636 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9637 @smallexample
9638 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9639 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9643 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9644 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9645 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9646 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9647 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9648 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9649 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9650 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9651 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9652
9653 @smallexample
9654 set $i = 0
9655 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9656 @key{RET}
9657 @key{RET}
9658 @dots{}
9659 @end smallexample
9660
9661 @node Output Formats
9662 @section Output Formats
9663
9664 @cindex formatted output
9665 @cindex output formats
9666 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9667 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9668 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9669 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9670 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9671
9672 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9673 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9674 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9675 letters supported are:
9676
9677 @table @code
9678 @item x
9679 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9680 hexadecimal.
9681
9682 @item d
9683 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9684
9685 @item u
9686 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9687
9688 @item o
9689 Print as integer in octal.
9690
9691 @item t
9692 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9693 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9694 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9695 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9696
9697 @item a
9698 @cindex unknown address, locating
9699 @cindex locate address
9700 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9701 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9702 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9703
9704 @smallexample
9705 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9706 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9707 @end smallexample
9708
9709 @noindent
9710 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9711 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9712
9713 @item c
9714 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9715 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9716 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9717 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9718
9719 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9720 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9721 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9722 data.
9723
9724 @item f
9725 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9726 using typical floating point syntax.
9727
9728 @item s
9729 @cindex printing strings
9730 @cindex printing byte arrays
9731 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9732 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9733 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9734 natural types.
9735
9736 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9737 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9738 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9739 array.
9740
9741 @item z
9742 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9743 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9744 to the size of the integer type.
9745
9746 @item r
9747 @cindex raw printing
9748 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9749 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9750 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9751 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9752 pretty-printer which might exist.
9753 @end table
9754
9755 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9756
9757 @smallexample
9758 p/x $pc
9759 @end smallexample
9760
9761 @noindent
9762 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9763 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9764
9765 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9766 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9767 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9768
9769 @node Memory
9770 @section Examining Memory
9771
9772 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9773 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9774
9775 @cindex examining memory
9776 @table @code
9777 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9778 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9779 @itemx x @var{addr}
9780 @itemx x
9781 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9782 @end table
9783
9784 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9785 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9786 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9787 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9788 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9789
9790 @table @r
9791 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9792 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9793 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9794 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9795 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9796 @c 4.1.2.
9797
9798 @item @var{f}, the display format
9799 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9800 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9801 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9802 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9803 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9804
9805 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9806 The unit size is any of
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item b
9810 Bytes.
9811 @item h
9812 Halfwords (two bytes).
9813 @item w
9814 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9815 @item g
9816 Giant words (eight bytes).
9817 @end table
9818
9819 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9820 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9821 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9822 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9823 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9824 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9825 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9826 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9827 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9828 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9829 be altered.
9830
9831 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9832 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9833 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9834 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9835 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9836 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9837 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9838 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9839 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9840 a value from memory).
9841 @end table
9842
9843 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9844 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9845 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9846 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9847 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9848
9849 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9850 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9851 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9852
9853 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9854 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9855 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9856 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9857 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9858
9859 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9860 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9861 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9862 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9863 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9864 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9865 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9866 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9867 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9868
9869 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9870 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9871 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9872 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9873 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9874 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9875
9876 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9877 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9878 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9879 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9880 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9881 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9882 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9883
9884 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9885 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9886
9887 @smallexample
9888 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9889 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9890 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9891 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9892 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9893 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9897 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9898 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9899 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9900 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9901 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9902 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9903 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9904 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9905
9906 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9907 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9908 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9909
9910 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9911 @cindex addressable memory unit
9912 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9913 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9914 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9915 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9916 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9917 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9918 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9919 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9920 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9921
9922 @cindex remote memory comparison
9923 @cindex target memory comparison
9924 @cindex verify remote memory image
9925 @cindex verify target memory image
9926 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9927 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9928 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9929 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9930 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9931 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9932
9933 @table @code
9934 @kindex compare-sections
9935 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9936 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9937 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9938 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9939 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9940 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9941
9942 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9943 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9944 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9945 @end table
9946
9947 @node Auto Display
9948 @section Automatic Display
9949 @cindex automatic display
9950 @cindex display of expressions
9951
9952 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9953 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9954 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9955 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9956 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9957 The automatic display looks like this:
9958
9959 @smallexample
9960 2: foo = 38
9961 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9962 @end smallexample
9963
9964 @noindent
9965 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9966 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9967 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9968 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9969 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9970 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9971
9972 @table @code
9973 @kindex display
9974 @item display @var{expr}
9975 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9976 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9977
9978 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9979
9980 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9981 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9982 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9983 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9984 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9985
9986 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9987 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9988 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9989 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9990 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9991 @end table
9992
9993 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9994 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9995 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9996
9997 @table @code
9998 @kindex delete display
9999 @kindex undisplay
10000 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10001 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10002 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10003 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10004 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10005 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10006 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10007
10008 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10009 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10010
10011 @kindex disable display
10012 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10013 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10014 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10015 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10016 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10017 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10018 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10019 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10020
10021 @kindex enable display
10022 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10023 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10024 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10025 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10026 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10027 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10028 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10029
10030 @item display
10031 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10032 done when your program stops.
10033
10034 @kindex info display
10035 @item info display
10036 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10037 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10038 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10039 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10040 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10041 @end table
10042
10043 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10044 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10045 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10046 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10047 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10048 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10049 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10050 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10051 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10052 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10053 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10054
10055 @node Print Settings
10056 @section Print Settings
10057
10058 @cindex format options
10059 @cindex print settings
10060 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10061 and symbols are printed.
10062
10063 @noindent
10064 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10065
10066 @table @code
10067 @kindex set print
10068 @item set print address
10069 @itemx set print address on
10070 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10071 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10072 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10073 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10074 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10075 @code{set print address on}:
10076
10077 @smallexample
10078 @group
10079 (@value{GDBP}) f
10080 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10081 at input.c:530
10082 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10083 @end group
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @item set print address off
10087 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10088 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 @group
10092 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10093 (@value{GDBP}) f
10094 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10095 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10096 @end group
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10100 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10101 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10102 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10103
10104 @kindex show print
10105 @item show print address
10106 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10107 @end table
10108
10109 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10110 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10111 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10112 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10113 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10114 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10115 it prints a symbolic address:
10116
10117 @table @code
10118 @item set print symbol-filename on
10119 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10120 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10121 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10122 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10123
10124 @item set print symbol-filename off
10125 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10126 default.
10127
10128 @item show print symbol-filename
10129 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10130 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10131 @end table
10132
10133 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10134 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10135 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10136
10137 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10138 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10139
10140 @table @code
10141 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10142 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10143 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10144 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10145 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10146 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10147 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10148 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10149
10150 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10151 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10152 symbolic address.
10153 @end table
10154
10155 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10156 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10157 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10158 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10159 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10160 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10161 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10162 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10163
10164 @smallexample
10165 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10166 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10167 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10168 @end smallexample
10169
10170 @quotation
10171 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10172 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10173 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10174 @end quotation
10175
10176 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10177 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10178
10179 @table @code
10180 @item set print symbol on
10181 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10182 one exists.
10183
10184 @item set print symbol off
10185 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10186 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10187 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10188
10189 @item show print symbol
10190 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10191 address.
10192 @end table
10193
10194 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10195
10196 @table @code
10197 @item set print array
10198 @itemx set print array on
10199 @cindex pretty print arrays
10200 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10201 but uses more space. The default is off.
10202
10203 @item set print array off
10204 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10205
10206 @item show print array
10207 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10208 arrays.
10209
10210 @cindex print array indexes
10211 @item set print array-indexes
10212 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10213 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10214 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10215 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10216
10217 @item set print array-indexes off
10218 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10219
10220 @item show print array-indexes
10221 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10222 arrays.
10223
10224 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10225 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10226 @cindex number of array elements to print
10227 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10228 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10229 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10230 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10231 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10232 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10233 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10234 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10235
10236 @item show print elements
10237 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10238 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10239
10240 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10241 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10242 @cindex printing frame argument values
10243 @cindex print all frame argument values
10244 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10245 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10246 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10247 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10248 values are:
10249
10250 @table @code
10251 @item all
10252 The values of all arguments are printed.
10253
10254 @item scalars
10255 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10256 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10257 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10258 only scalar arguments are shown:
10259
10260 @smallexample
10261 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10262 at frame-args.c:23
10263 @end smallexample
10264
10265 @item none
10266 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10267 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10268
10269 @smallexample
10270 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10271 at frame-args.c:23
10272 @end smallexample
10273 @end table
10274
10275 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10276 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10277 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10278 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10279 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10280 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10281 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10282 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10283 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10284 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10285
10286 @item show print frame-arguments
10287 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10288
10289 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10290 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10291
10292 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10293 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10294 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10295 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10296 This is the default.
10297
10298 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10299 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10300
10301 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10302 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10303 @kindex set print entry-values
10304 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10305 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10306 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10307 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10308 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10309
10310 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10311 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10312 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10313 @code{no} setting.
10314
10315 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10316 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10317 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10318 this information.
10319
10320 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10321
10322 @table @code
10323 @item no
10324 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10325 point.
10326 @smallexample
10327 #0 equal (val=5)
10328 #0 different (val=6)
10329 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10330 #0 born (val=10)
10331 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 @item only
10335 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10336 values are never printed.
10337 @smallexample
10338 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10339 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10340 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10341 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10342 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10343 @end smallexample
10344
10345 @item preferred
10346 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10347 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10348 value for such parameter.
10349 @smallexample
10350 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10351 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10352 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10353 #0 born (val=10)
10354 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10355 @end smallexample
10356
10357 @item if-needed
10358 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10359 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10360 parameter.
10361 @smallexample
10362 #0 equal (val=5)
10363 #0 different (val=6)
10364 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10365 #0 born (val=10)
10366 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10367 @end smallexample
10368
10369 @item both
10370 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10371 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10372 optimizations.
10373 @smallexample
10374 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10375 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10376 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10377 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10378 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10379 @end smallexample
10380
10381 @item compact
10382 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10383 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10384 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10385 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10386 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10387 @smallexample
10388 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10389 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10390 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10391 #0 born (val=10)
10392 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10393 @end smallexample
10394
10395 @item default
10396 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10397 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10398 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10399 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10400 @smallexample
10401 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10402 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10403 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10404 #0 born (val=10)
10405 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10406 @end smallexample
10407 @end table
10408
10409 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10410 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10411
10412 @item show print entry-values
10413 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10414 entry.
10415
10416 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10417 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10418 @cindex repeated array elements
10419 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10420 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10421 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10422 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10423 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10424 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10425 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10426 is 10.
10427
10428 @item show print repeats
10429 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10430 elements.
10431
10432 @item set print null-stop
10433 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10434 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10435 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10436 contain only short strings.
10437 The default is off.
10438
10439 @item show print null-stop
10440 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10441 @sc{null} character.
10442
10443 @item set print pretty on
10444 @cindex print structures in indented form
10445 @cindex indentation in structure display
10446 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10447 per line, like this:
10448
10449 @smallexample
10450 @group
10451 $1 = @{
10452 next = 0x0,
10453 flags = @{
10454 sweet = 1,
10455 sour = 1
10456 @},
10457 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10458 @}
10459 @end group
10460 @end smallexample
10461
10462 @item set print pretty off
10463 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10464
10465 @smallexample
10466 @group
10467 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10468 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10469 @end group
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @noindent
10473 This is the default format.
10474
10475 @item show print pretty
10476 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10477
10478 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10479 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10480 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10481 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10482 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10483 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10484 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10485 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10486
10487 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10488 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10489 international character sets, and is the default.
10490
10491 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10492 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10493
10494 @item set print union on
10495 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10496 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10497 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10498
10499 @item set print union off
10500 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10501 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10502 instead.
10503
10504 @item show print union
10505 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10506 structures and other unions.
10507
10508 For example, given the declarations
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10512 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10513 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10514 Bug_forms;
10515
10516 struct thing @{
10517 Species it;
10518 union @{
10519 Tree_forms tree;
10520 Bug_forms bug;
10521 @} form;
10522 @};
10523
10524 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10525 @end smallexample
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10529
10530 @smallexample
10531 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10532 @end smallexample
10533
10534 @noindent
10535 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10536
10537 @smallexample
10538 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10539 @end smallexample
10540
10541 @noindent
10542 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10543 and in Pascal.
10544 @end table
10545
10546 @need 1000
10547 @noindent
10548 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10549
10550 @table @code
10551 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10552 @item set print demangle
10553 @itemx set print demangle on
10554 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10555 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10556 linkage. The default is on.
10557
10558 @item show print demangle
10559 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10560
10561 @item set print asm-demangle
10562 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10563 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10564 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10565 The default is off.
10566
10567 @item show print asm-demangle
10568 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10569 or demangled form.
10570
10571 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10572 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10573 @kindex set demangle-style
10574 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10575 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10576 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10577
10578 @table @code
10579 @item auto
10580 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10581 This is the default.
10582
10583 @item gnu
10584 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10585
10586 @item hp
10587 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10588
10589 @item lucid
10590 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10591
10592 @item arm
10593 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10594 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10595 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10596 require further enhancement to permit that.
10597
10598 @end table
10599 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10600
10601 @item show demangle-style
10602 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10603
10604 @item set print object
10605 @itemx set print object on
10606 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10607 @cindex display derived types
10608 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10609 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10610 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10611 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10612 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10613 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10614 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10615
10616 @item set print object off
10617 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10618 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10619
10620 @item show print object
10621 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10622
10623 @item set print static-members
10624 @itemx set print static-members on
10625 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10626 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10627
10628 @item set print static-members off
10629 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10630
10631 @item show print static-members
10632 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10633
10634 @item set print pascal_static-members
10635 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10636 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10637 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10638 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10639
10640 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10641 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10642
10643 @item show print pascal_static-members
10644 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10645
10646 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10647 @item set print vtbl
10648 @itemx set print vtbl on
10649 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10650 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10651 @cindex VTBL display
10652 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10653 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10654 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10655
10656 @item set print vtbl off
10657 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10658
10659 @item show print vtbl
10660 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10661 @end table
10662
10663 @node Pretty Printing
10664 @section Pretty Printing
10665
10666 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10667 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10668 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10669
10670 @menu
10671 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10672 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10673 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10674 @end menu
10675
10676 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10677 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10678
10679 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10680 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10681 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10682
10683 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10684 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10685 pretty-printers with their names.
10686 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10687 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10688 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10689 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10690
10691 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10692 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10693 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10694 do anything special.
10695
10696 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10697
10698 @itemize @bullet
10699 @item
10700 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10701 all inferiors.
10702
10703 @item
10704 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10705 when debugging that program.
10706 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10707
10708 @item
10709 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10710 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10711 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10712 @end itemize
10713
10714 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10715 pretty-printers are selected,
10716
10717 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10718 for new types.
10719
10720 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10721 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10722
10723 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10724
10725 @smallexample
10726 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10727 $1 = @{
10728 static npos = 4294967295,
10729 _M_dataplus = @{
10730 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10731 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10732 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10733 @},
10734 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10735 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10736 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10737 @}
10738 @}
10739 @end smallexample
10740
10741 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10742
10743 @smallexample
10744 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10745 $2 = "abcd"
10746 @end smallexample
10747
10748 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10749 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10750 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10751
10752 @table @code
10753 @kindex info pretty-printer
10754 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10755 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10756 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10757
10758 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10759 whose pretty-printers to list.
10760 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10761 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10762 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10763 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10764 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10765
10766 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10767 to list.
10768
10769 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10770 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10771 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10772 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10773
10774 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10775 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10776 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10777 @end table
10778
10779 Example:
10780
10781 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10782 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10783 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10784 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10785
10786 @smallexample
10787 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10788 library1.so:
10789 foo
10790 library2.so:
10791 bar
10792 bar1
10793 bar2
10794 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10795 library2.so:
10796 bar
10797 bar1
10798 bar2
10799 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10800 1 printer disabled
10801 2 of 3 printers enabled
10802 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10803 library1.so:
10804 foo [disabled]
10805 library2.so:
10806 bar
10807 bar1
10808 bar2
10809 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10810 1 printer disabled
10811 1 of 3 printers enabled
10812 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10813 library1.so:
10814 foo [disabled]
10815 library2.so:
10816 bar
10817 bar1 [disabled]
10818 bar2
10819 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10820 1 printer disabled
10821 0 of 3 printers enabled
10822 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10823 library1.so:
10824 foo [disabled]
10825 library2.so:
10826 bar [disabled]
10827 bar1 [disabled]
10828 bar2
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10832 as can each individual subprinter.
10833
10834 @node Value History
10835 @section Value History
10836
10837 @cindex value history
10838 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10839 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10840 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10841 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10842 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10843 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10844 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10845 symbol table.
10846
10847 @cindex @code{$}
10848 @cindex @code{$$}
10849 @cindex history number
10850 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10851 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10852 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10853 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10854 history number.
10855
10856 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10857 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10858 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10859 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10860 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10861 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10862 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10863
10864 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10865 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10866
10867 @smallexample
10868 p *$
10869 @end smallexample
10870
10871 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10872 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10873
10874 @smallexample
10875 p *$.next
10876 @end smallexample
10877
10878 @noindent
10879 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10880 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10881
10882 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10883 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10884
10885 @smallexample
10886 print x
10887 set x=5
10888 @end smallexample
10889
10890 @noindent
10891 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10892 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10893
10894 @table @code
10895 @kindex show values
10896 @item show values
10897 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10898 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10899 values} does not change the history.
10900
10901 @item show values @var{n}
10902 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10903
10904 @item show values +
10905 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10906 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10907 @end table
10908
10909 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10910 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10911
10912 @node Convenience Vars
10913 @section Convenience Variables
10914
10915 @cindex convenience variables
10916 @cindex user-defined variables
10917 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10918 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10919 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10920 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10921 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10922
10923 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10924 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10925 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10926 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10927 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10928
10929 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10930 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10931 For example:
10932
10933 @smallexample
10934 set $foo = *object_ptr
10935 @end smallexample
10936
10937 @noindent
10938 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10939 @code{object_ptr}.
10940
10941 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10942 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10943 value with another assignment at any time.
10944
10945 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10946 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10947 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10948 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10949
10950 @table @code
10951 @kindex show convenience
10952 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10953 @item show convenience
10954 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10955 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10956 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10957
10958 @kindex init-if-undefined
10959 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10960 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10961 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10962 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10963 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10964 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10965 override default values used in a command script.
10966
10967 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10968 any side-effects do not occur.
10969 @end table
10970
10971 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10972 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10973 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10974
10975 @smallexample
10976 set $i = 0
10977 print bar[$i++]->contents
10978 @end smallexample
10979
10980 @noindent
10981 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10982
10983 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10984 values likely to be useful.
10985
10986 @table @code
10987 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10988 @item $_
10989 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10990 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10991 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10992 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10993 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10994 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10995 to the type of @code{$__}.
10996
10997 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10998 @item $__
10999 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11000 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11001 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11002
11003 @item $_exitcode
11004 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11005 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11006 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11007 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11008
11009 @item $_exitsignal
11010 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11011 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11012 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11013 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11014
11015 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11016 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11017 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11018 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11019 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11020
11021 @smallexample
11022 #include <signal.h>
11023
11024 int
11025 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11026 @{
11027 raise (SIGALRM);
11028 return 0;
11029 @}
11030 @end smallexample
11031
11032 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11033 or signalled would be:
11034
11035 @smallexample
11036 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11037 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11038 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11039 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11040 >echo The program has exited\n
11041 >else
11042 >echo The program has signalled\n
11043 >end
11044 >end
11045 (@value{GDBP}) run
11046 Starting program:
11047
11048 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11049 The program no longer exists.
11050 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11051 The program has signalled
11052 @end smallexample
11053
11054 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11055 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11056 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11057 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11058
11059 @smallexample
11060 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11061 The program has exited
11062 @end smallexample
11063
11064 @item $_exception
11065 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11066 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11067
11068 @item $_probe_argc
11069 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11070 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11071
11072 @item $_sdata
11073 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11074 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11075 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11076 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11077 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11078
11079 @item $_siginfo
11080 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11081 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11082 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11083 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11084 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11085
11086 @item $_tlb
11087 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11088 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11089 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11090 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11091 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11092 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11093
11094 @item $_inferior
11095 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11096 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11097
11098 @item $_thread
11099 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11100
11101 @item $_gthread
11102 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11103
11104 @end table
11105
11106 @node Convenience Funs
11107 @section Convenience Functions
11108
11109 @cindex convenience functions
11110 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11111 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11112 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11113 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11114 @value{GDBN}.
11115
11116 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11117 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11118
11119 @table @code
11120
11121 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11122 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11123 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11124 returns zero.
11125
11126 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11127 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11128 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11129 it is @code{void}:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11133 $1 = void
11134 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11135 $2 = 1
11136 (@value{GDBP}) run
11137 Starting program: ./a.out
11138 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11140 $3 = 0
11141 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11142 $4 = 0
11143 @end smallexample
11144
11145 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11146 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11147 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11148 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11149 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11150 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11151 anymore.
11152
11153 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11154 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11155
11156 @smallexample
11157 void
11158 foo (void)
11159 @{
11160 @}
11161 @end smallexample
11162
11163 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11164
11165 @smallexample
11166 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11167 $1 = void
11168 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11169 $2 = 1
11170 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11171 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11172 $3 = void
11173 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11174 $4 = 1
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 @end table
11178
11179 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11180 @code{Python} support.
11181
11182 @table @code
11183
11184 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11185 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11186 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11187 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11188 Otherwise it returns zero.
11189
11190 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11191 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11192 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11193 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11194 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11195 regular expression support.
11196
11197 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11198 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11199 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11200 Otherwise it returns zero.
11201
11202 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11203 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11204 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11205
11206 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11207 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11208 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11209 Otherwise it returns zero.
11210
11211 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11212 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11213 The default is 1.
11214
11215 Example:
11216
11217 @smallexample
11218 (gdb) backtrace
11219 #0 bottom_func ()
11220 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11221 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11222 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11223 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11224 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11225 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11226 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11227 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11228 $1 = 1
11229 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11230 $1 = 1
11231 @end smallexample
11232
11233 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11234 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11235 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11236 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11237
11238 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11239 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11240 The default is 1.
11241
11242 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11243 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11244 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11245 Otherwise it returns zero.
11246
11247 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11248 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11249 The default is 1.
11250
11251 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11252 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11253 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11254 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11255
11256 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11257 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11258 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11259 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11260
11261 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11262 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11263 The default is 1.
11264
11265 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11266 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11267 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11268 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11269
11270 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11271 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11272 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11273
11274 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11275 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11276 an enumerated type:
11277
11278 @smallexample
11279 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11280 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11281 @end smallexample
11282
11283 @end table
11284
11285 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11286 convenience functions.
11287
11288 @table @code
11289 @item help function
11290 @kindex help function
11291 @cindex show all convenience functions
11292 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11293 @end table
11294
11295 @node Registers
11296 @section Registers
11297
11298 @cindex registers
11299 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11300 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11301 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11302 your machine.
11303
11304 @table @code
11305 @kindex info registers
11306 @item info registers
11307 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11308 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11309
11310 @kindex info all-registers
11311 @cindex floating point registers
11312 @item info all-registers
11313 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11314 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11315
11316 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11317 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11318 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11319 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11320
11321 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11322 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11323 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11324 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11325 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11326 @end table
11327
11328 @anchor{standard registers}
11329 @cindex stack pointer register
11330 @cindex program counter register
11331 @cindex process status register
11332 @cindex frame pointer register
11333 @cindex standard registers
11334 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11335 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11336 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11337 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11338 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11339 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11340 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11341 you could print the program counter in hex with
11342
11343 @smallexample
11344 p/x $pc
11345 @end smallexample
11346
11347 @noindent
11348 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11349
11350 @smallexample
11351 x/i $pc
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 @noindent
11355 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11356 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11357 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11358 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11359 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11360 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11361 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11362
11363 @smallexample
11364 set $sp += 4
11365 @end smallexample
11366
11367 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11368 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11369 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11370 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11371 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11372 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11373 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11374
11375 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11376 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11377 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11378 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11379 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11380 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11381 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11382
11383 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11384 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11385 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11386 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11387 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11388 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11389 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11390 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11391 prints the data in both formats.
11392
11393 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11394 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11395 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11396 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11397 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11398 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11399 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11400
11401 @smallexample
11402 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11403 $1 = @{
11404 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11405 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11406 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11407 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11408 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11409 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11410 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11411 @}
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 @noindent
11415 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11416 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11417 value to a @code{struct} member:
11418
11419 @smallexample
11420 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11421 @end smallexample
11422
11423 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11424 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11425 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11426 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11427 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11428 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11429
11430 @cindex caller-saved registers
11431 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11432 @cindex volatile registers
11433 @cindex <not saved> values
11434 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11435 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11436 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11437 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11438 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11439 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11440 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11441 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11442 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11443 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11444 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11445 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11446 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11447 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11448 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11449 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11450 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11451 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11452 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11453 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11454 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11455 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11456 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11457
11458 @node Floating Point Hardware
11459 @section Floating Point Hardware
11460 @cindex floating point
11461
11462 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11463 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11464
11465 @table @code
11466 @kindex info float
11467 @item info float
11468 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11469 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11470 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11471 the ARM and x86 machines.
11472 @end table
11473
11474 @node Vector Unit
11475 @section Vector Unit
11476 @cindex vector unit
11477
11478 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11479 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11480
11481 @table @code
11482 @kindex info vector
11483 @item info vector
11484 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11485 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11486 @end table
11487
11488 @node OS Information
11489 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11490 @cindex OS information
11491
11492 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11493 you debug your program.
11494
11495 @cindex auxiliary vector
11496 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11497 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11498 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11499 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11500 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11501 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11502 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11503 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11504 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11505 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11506 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11507 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11508
11509 @table @code
11510 @kindex info auxv
11511 @item info auxv
11512 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11513 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11514 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11515 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11516 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11517 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11518 an unrecognized tag.
11519 @end table
11520
11521 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11522 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11523 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11524 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11525 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11526 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11527 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11528
11529 @table @code
11530 @kindex info os
11531 @item info os @var{infotype}
11532
11533 Display OS information of the requested type.
11534
11535 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11536
11537 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11538 @table @code
11539 @kindex info os cpus
11540 @item cpus
11541 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11542 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11543 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11544 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11545 kernel initialization.
11546
11547 @kindex info os files
11548 @item files
11549 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11550 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11551 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11552 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11553
11554 @kindex info os modules
11555 @item modules
11556 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11557 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11558 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11559 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11560 in memory.
11561
11562 @kindex info os msg
11563 @item msg
11564 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11565 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11566 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11567 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11568 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11569 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11570 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11571 the message queue was last changed.
11572
11573 @kindex info os processes
11574 @item processes
11575 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11576 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11577 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11578 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11579 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11580 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11581
11582 @kindex info os procgroups
11583 @item procgroups
11584 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11585 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11586 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11587 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11588 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11589 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11590 and the process group leader is listed first.
11591
11592 @kindex info os semaphores
11593 @item semaphores
11594 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11595 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11596 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11597 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11598 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11599
11600 @kindex info os shm
11601 @item shm
11602 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11603 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11604 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11605 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11606 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11607 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11608 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11609
11610 @kindex info os sockets
11611 @item sockets
11612 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11613 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11614 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11615 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11616 connection.
11617
11618 @kindex info os threads
11619 @item threads
11620 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11621 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11622 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11623 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11624 process is not listed.
11625 @end table
11626
11627 @item info os
11628 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11629 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11630 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11631 types, this command will report an error.
11632 @end table
11633
11634 @node Memory Region Attributes
11635 @section Memory Region Attributes
11636 @cindex memory region attributes
11637
11638 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11639 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11640 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11641 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11642 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11643 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11644 user can override the fetched regions.
11645
11646 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11647 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11648 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11649 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11650 all memory.
11651
11652 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11653 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11654
11655 @table @code
11656 @kindex mem
11657 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11658 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11659 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11660 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11661 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11662 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11663
11664 @item mem auto
11665 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11666 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11667
11668 @kindex delete mem
11669 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11670 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11671 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11672
11673 @kindex disable mem
11674 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11675 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11676 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11677 It may be enabled again later.
11678
11679 @kindex enable mem
11680 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11681 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11682
11683 @kindex info mem
11684 @item info mem
11685 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11686 for each region:
11687
11688 @table @emph
11689 @item Memory Region Number
11690 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11691 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11692 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11693
11694 @item Lo Address
11695 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11696
11697 @item Hi Address
11698 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11699
11700 @item Attributes
11701 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11702 @end table
11703 @end table
11704
11705
11706 @subsection Attributes
11707
11708 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11709 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11710 write accesses to a memory region.
11711
11712 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11713 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11714 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11715
11716 @table @code
11717 @item ro
11718 Memory is read only.
11719 @item wo
11720 Memory is write only.
11721 @item rw
11722 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11726 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11727 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11728 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11729 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11730
11731 @table @code
11732 @item 8
11733 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11734 @item 16
11735 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11736 @item 32
11737 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11738 @item 64
11739 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11740 @end table
11741
11742 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11743 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11744 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11745 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11746 @c
11747 @c @table @code
11748 @c @item hwbreak
11749 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11750 @c @item swbreak (default)
11751 @c @end table
11752
11753 @subsubsection Data Cache
11754 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11755 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11756 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11757 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11758 registers.
11759
11760 @table @code
11761 @item cache
11762 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11763 @item nocache
11764 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11765 @end table
11766
11767 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11768 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11769 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11770 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11771 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11772
11773 @table @code
11774 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11775 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11776 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11777 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11778 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11779 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11780 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11781 The default value is @code{on}.
11782 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11783 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11784 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11785 @end table
11786
11787
11788 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11789 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11790 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11791 @c
11792 @c @table @code
11793 @c @item verify
11794 @c @item noverify (default)
11795 @c @end table
11796
11797 @node Dump/Restore Files
11798 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11799 @cindex dump/restore files
11800 @cindex append data to a file
11801 @cindex dump data to a file
11802 @cindex restore data from a file
11803
11804 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11805 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11806 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11807 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11808 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11809 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11810 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11811
11812 @table @code
11813
11814 @kindex dump
11815 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11816 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11817 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11818 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11819
11820 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11821 @table @code
11822 @item binary
11823 Raw binary form.
11824 @item ihex
11825 Intel hex format.
11826 @item srec
11827 Motorola S-record format.
11828 @item tekhex
11829 Tektronix Hex format.
11830 @item verilog
11831 Verilog Hex format.
11832 @end table
11833
11834 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11835 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11836 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11837 form.
11838
11839 @kindex append
11840 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11841 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11842 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11843 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11844 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11845
11846 @kindex restore
11847 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11848 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11849 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11850 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11851 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11852
11853 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11854 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11855 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11856 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11857 from that location.
11858
11859 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11860 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11861 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11862 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11863
11864 @end table
11865
11866 @node Core File Generation
11867 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11868 @cindex dump core from inferior
11869
11870 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11871 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11872 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11873 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11874 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11875 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11876 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11877
11878 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11879 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11880 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11881
11882 @table @code
11883 @kindex gcore
11884 @kindex generate-core-file
11885 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11886 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11887 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11888 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11889 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11890 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11891
11892 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11893 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11894
11895 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11896 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11897 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11898 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11899 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11900
11901 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11902 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11903 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11904 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11905 Enable or disable the use of the file
11906 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11907 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11908 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11909 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11910
11911 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11912 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11913 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11914 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11915 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11916 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11917 about the bits that can be set in the
11918 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11919 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11920
11921 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11922 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11923 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11924 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11925 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11926 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11927 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11928 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11929
11930 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11931 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11932 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11933 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11934 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11935 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11936 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11937
11938 The default value is @code{off}.
11939 @end table
11940
11941 @node Character Sets
11942 @section Character Sets
11943 @cindex character sets
11944 @cindex charset
11945 @cindex translating between character sets
11946 @cindex host character set
11947 @cindex target character set
11948
11949 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11950 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11951 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11952 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11953 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11954 @dfn{target character set}.
11955
11956 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11957 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11958 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11959 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11960 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11961 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11962 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11963 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11964 character and string literals in expressions.
11965
11966 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11967 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11968 target-charset} command, described below.
11969
11970 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11971 support:
11972
11973 @table @code
11974 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11975 @kindex set target-charset
11976 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11977 list of supported target character sets, type
11978 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11979
11980 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11981 @kindex set host-charset
11982 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11983
11984 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11985 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11986 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11987 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11988 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11989
11990 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11991 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11992 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11993
11994 @item set charset @var{charset}
11995 @kindex set charset
11996 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11997 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11998 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11999 for both host and target.
12000
12001 @item show charset
12002 @kindex show charset
12003 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12004
12005 @item show host-charset
12006 @kindex show host-charset
12007 Show the name of the current host character set.
12008
12009 @item show target-charset
12010 @kindex show target-charset
12011 Show the name of the current target character set.
12012
12013 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12014 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12015 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12016 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12017 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12018 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12019
12020 @item show target-wide-charset
12021 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12022 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12023 @end table
12024
12025 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12026 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12027 @file{charset-test.c}:
12028
12029 @smallexample
12030 #include <stdio.h>
12031
12032 char ascii_hello[]
12033 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12034 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12035 char ibm1047_hello[]
12036 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12037 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12038
12039 main ()
12040 @{
12041 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12042 @}
12043 @end smallexample
12044
12045 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12046 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12047 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12048
12049 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12050
12051 @smallexample
12052 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12053 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12054 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12055 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12056 @dots{}
12057 (@value{GDBP})
12058 @end smallexample
12059
12060 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12061 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12062 strings:
12063
12064 @smallexample
12065 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12066 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12067 (@value{GDBP})
12068 @end smallexample
12069
12070 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12071 initial character set:
12072 @smallexample
12073 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12074 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12075 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12076 (@value{GDBP})
12077 @end smallexample
12078
12079 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12080 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12081 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12082 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12083 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12084
12085 @smallexample
12086 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12087 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12088 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12089 $2 = 72 'H'
12090 (@value{GDBP})
12091 @end smallexample
12092
12093 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12094 literals you use in expressions:
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12098 $3 = 43 '+'
12099 (@value{GDBP})
12100 @end smallexample
12101
12102 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12103 character.
12104
12105 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12106 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12107 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12108
12109 @smallexample
12110 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12111 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12112 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12113 $5 = 200 '\310'
12114 (@value{GDBP})
12115 @end smallexample
12116
12117 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12118 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12119
12120 @smallexample
12121 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12122 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12123 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12124 @end smallexample
12125
12126 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12127 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12128 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12129 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12130 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12131
12132 @smallexample
12133 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12134 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12135 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12136 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12137 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12138 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12139 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12140 $7 = 72 '\110'
12141 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12142 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12143 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12144 $9 = 200 'H'
12145 (@value{GDBP})
12146 @end smallexample
12147
12148 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12149 string literals you use in expressions:
12150
12151 @smallexample
12152 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12153 $10 = 78 '+'
12154 (@value{GDBP})
12155 @end smallexample
12156
12157 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12158 character.
12159
12160 @node Caching Target Data
12161 @section Caching Data of Targets
12162 @cindex caching data of targets
12163
12164 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12165 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12166 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12167 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12168 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12169 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12170 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12171 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12172 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12173 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12174 is executing.
12175 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12176 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12177 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12178 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12179 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12180 in the code segment.
12181 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12182 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12183
12184 @table @code
12185 @kindex set remotecache
12186 @item set remotecache on
12187 @itemx set remotecache off
12188 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12189 with old scripts.
12190
12191 @kindex show remotecache
12192 @item show remotecache
12193 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12194
12195 @kindex set stack-cache
12196 @item set stack-cache on
12197 @itemx set stack-cache off
12198 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12199 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12200
12201 @kindex show stack-cache
12202 @item show stack-cache
12203 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12204
12205 @kindex set code-cache
12206 @item set code-cache on
12207 @itemx set code-cache off
12208 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12209 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12210 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12211
12212 @kindex show code-cache
12213 @item show code-cache
12214 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12215 accesses.
12216
12217 @kindex info dcache
12218 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12219 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12220 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12221 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12222 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12223 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12224
12225 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12226 printed in hex.
12227
12228 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12229 @cindex dcache size
12230 @kindex set dcache size
12231 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12232
12233 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12234 @cindex dcache line-size
12235 @kindex set dcache line-size
12236 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12237 Must be a power of 2.
12238
12239 @item show dcache size
12240 @kindex show dcache size
12241 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12242
12243 @item show dcache line-size
12244 @kindex show dcache line-size
12245 Show default size of dcache lines.
12246
12247 @end table
12248
12249 @node Searching Memory
12250 @section Search Memory
12251 @cindex searching memory
12252
12253 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12254 @code{find} command.
12255
12256 @table @code
12257 @kindex find
12258 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12259 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12260 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12261 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12262 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12263 @end table
12264
12265 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12266 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12267
12268 @table @r
12269 @item @var{s}, search query size
12270 The size of each search query value.
12271
12272 @table @code
12273 @item b
12274 bytes
12275 @item h
12276 halfwords (two bytes)
12277 @item w
12278 words (four bytes)
12279 @item g
12280 giant words (eight bytes)
12281 @end table
12282
12283 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12284 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12285 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12286 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12287 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12288
12289 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12290 value's type in the current language.
12291 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12292 pattern as a mixture of types.
12293 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12294 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12295 which is typically four bytes.
12296
12297 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12298 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12299 @end table
12300
12301 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12302 (@code{"}).
12303 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12304 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12305
12306 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12307 number of matches found.
12308
12309 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12310 @samp{$_}.
12311 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12312
12313 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12314
12315 @smallexample
12316 void
12317 hello ()
12318 @{
12319 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12320 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12321 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12322 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12323 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12324 @}
12325 @end smallexample
12326
12327 @noindent
12328 you get during debugging:
12329
12330 @smallexample
12331 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12332 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12333 1 pattern found
12334 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12335 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12336 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12337 2 patterns found.
12338 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12339 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12340 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12341 2 patterns found.
12342 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12343 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12344 1 pattern found
12345 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12346 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12347 1 pattern found
12348 (gdb) print $numfound
12349 $1 = 1
12350 (gdb) print $_
12351 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 @node Value Sizes
12355 @section Value Sizes
12356
12357 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12358 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12359 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12360 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12361 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12362
12363 @table @code
12364 @kindex set max-value-size
12365 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12366 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12367 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12368 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12369 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12370
12371 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12372 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12373
12374 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12375 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12376 currently 16 bytes.
12377
12378 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12379 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12380 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12381 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12382 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12383 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12384 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12385 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12386
12387 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12388
12389 @kindex show max-value-size
12390 @item show max-value-size
12391 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12392 allocate for the contents of a value.
12393 @end table
12394
12395 @node Optimized Code
12396 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12397 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12398 @cindex debugging optimized code
12399
12400 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12401 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12402 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12403 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12404 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12405 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12406 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12407
12408 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12409 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12410 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12411 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12412
12413 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12414 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12415 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12416 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12417 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12418 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12419
12420 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12421 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12422 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12423 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12424 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12425
12426 @menu
12427 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12428 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12429 @end menu
12430
12431 @node Inline Functions
12432 @section Inline Functions
12433 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12434
12435 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12436 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12437 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12438 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12439 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12440 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12441 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12442 @code{info frame} command.
12443
12444 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12445 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12446 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12447 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12448 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12449 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12450 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12451 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12452 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12453 local variables in the caller.
12454
12455 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12456 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12457 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12458 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12459 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12460 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12461 instructions are executed.
12462
12463 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12464 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12465 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12466 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12467
12468 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12469 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12470
12471 @itemize @bullet
12472 @item
12473 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12474 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12475 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12476 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12477 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12478 or inside the inlined function instead.
12479
12480 @item
12481 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12482 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12483 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12484 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12485
12486 @end itemize
12487
12488 @node Tail Call Frames
12489 @section Tail Call Frames
12490 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12491
12492 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12493 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12494 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12495 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12496 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12497
12498 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12499 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12500 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12501 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12502 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12503 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12504 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12505
12506 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12507 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12508 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12509 this information.
12510
12511 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12512 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12513
12514 @smallexample
12515 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12516 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12517 (gdb) info frame
12518 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12519 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12520 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12521 source language c++.
12522 Arglist at unknown address.
12523 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12524 @end smallexample
12525
12526 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12527 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12528 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12529 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12530 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12531 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12532
12533 @table @code
12534 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12535 @item set debug entry-values
12536 @kindex set debug entry-values
12537 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12538 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12539 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12540 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12541 result.
12542
12543 @item show debug entry-values
12544 @kindex show debug entry-values
12545 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12546 values at function entry and tail calls.
12547 @end table
12548
12549 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12550 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12551 reference by variable @code{x}):
12552
12553 @smallexample
12554 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12555 void (*x) (void) = c;
12556 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12557 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12558 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12559
12560 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12561 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12562 a () at t.c:3
12563 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12564 (gdb) bt
12565 #0 a () at t.c:3
12566 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12567 @end smallexample
12568
12569 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12570
12571 @smallexample
12572 int i;
12573 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12574 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12575 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12576 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12578 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12580 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12581
12582 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12583 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12584 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12585 (gdb) bt
12586 #0 f () at t.c:2
12587 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12588 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12589 @end smallexample
12590
12591 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12592 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12593
12594 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12595 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12596 @set ARROW @click{}
12597 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12598 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12599 @end ifset
12600 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12601 @set ARROW ->
12602 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12603 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12604 @end ifclear
12605
12606 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12607 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12608 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12609
12610 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12611 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12612 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12613 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12614 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12615 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12616
12617 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12618 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12619 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12620 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12621 omitted.
12622
12623 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12624 entry may fail:
12625
12626 @smallexample
12627 int v;
12628 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12629 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12630 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12631 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12632 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12633 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12634
12635 (gdb) bt
12636 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12637 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12638 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12639 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12640 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12641 @end smallexample
12642
12643 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12644 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12645 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12646 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12647 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12648
12649 @node Macros
12650 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12651
12652 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12653 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12654 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12655 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12656 where it was defined.
12657
12658 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12659 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12660 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12661 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12662
12663 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12664 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12665 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12666 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12667 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12668 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12669 see @ref{List}.
12670
12671 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12672 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12673 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12674
12675 @table @code
12676
12677 @kindex macro expand
12678 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12679 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12680 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12681 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12682 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12683 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12684 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12685 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12686 it can be any string of tokens.
12687
12688 @kindex macro exp1
12689 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12690 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12691 @cindex expand macro once
12692 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12693 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12694 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12695 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12696 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12697 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12698 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12699 can be any string of tokens.
12700
12701 @kindex info macro
12702 @cindex macro definition, showing
12703 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12704 @cindex macros, from debug info
12705 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12706 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12707 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12708 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12709 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12710 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12711
12712 @kindex info macros
12713 @item info macros @var{location}
12714 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12715 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12716 command-line where those definitions were established.
12717
12718 @kindex macro define
12719 @cindex user-defined macros
12720 @cindex defining macros interactively
12721 @cindex macros, user-defined
12722 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12723 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12724 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12725 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12726 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12727 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12728 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12729 @var{arglist}.
12730
12731 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12732 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12733 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12734 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12735 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12736
12737 @kindex macro undef
12738 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12739 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12740 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12741 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12742 in the program being debugged.
12743
12744 @kindex macro list
12745 @item macro list
12746 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12747 @end table
12748
12749 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12750 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12751 show our source files:
12752
12753 @smallexample
12754 $ cat sample.c
12755 #include <stdio.h>
12756 #include "sample.h"
12757
12758 #define M 42
12759 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12760
12761 main ()
12762 @{
12763 #define N 28
12764 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12765 #undef N
12766 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12767 #define N 1729
12768 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12769 @}
12770 $ cat sample.h
12771 #define Q <
12772 $
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12776 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12777 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12778 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12779 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12780 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12781 information.
12782
12783 @smallexample
12784 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12785 $
12786 @end smallexample
12787
12788 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12789
12790 @smallexample
12791 $ gdb -nw sample
12792 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12793 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12794 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12795 (@value{GDBP})
12796 @end smallexample
12797
12798 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12799 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12800 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12801
12802 @smallexample
12803 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12804 3
12805 4 #define M 42
12806 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12807 6
12808 7 main ()
12809 8 @{
12810 9 #define N 28
12811 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12812 11 #undef N
12813 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12814 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12815 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12816 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12817 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12818 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12819 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12820 #define Q <
12821 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12822 expands to: (42 + 1)
12823 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12824 expands to: once (M + 1)
12825 (@value{GDBP})
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12829 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12830 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12831 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12832
12833 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12834 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12835
12836 @smallexample
12837 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12838 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12839 (@value{GDBP}) run
12840 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12841
12842 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12843 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12844 (@value{GDBP})
12845 @end smallexample
12846
12847 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12848
12849 @smallexample
12850 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12851 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12852 #define N 28
12853 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12854 expands to: 28 < 42
12855 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12856 $1 = 1
12857 (@value{GDBP})
12858 @end smallexample
12859
12860 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12861 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12862 thereof) in force at each point:
12863
12864 @smallexample
12865 (@value{GDBP}) next
12866 Hello, world!
12867 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12868 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12869 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12870 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12871 (@value{GDBP}) next
12872 We're so creative.
12873 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12874 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12875 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12876 #define N 1729
12877 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12878 expands to: 1729 < 42
12879 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12880 $2 = 0
12881 (@value{GDBP})
12882 @end smallexample
12883
12884 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12885 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12886 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12887 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12888
12889 @smallexample
12890 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12891 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12892 -D__STDC__=1
12893 (@value{GDBP})
12894 @end smallexample
12895
12896
12897 @node Tracepoints
12898 @chapter Tracepoints
12899 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12900 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12901
12902 @cindex tracepoints
12903 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12904 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12905 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12906 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12907 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12908 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12909 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12910
12911 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12912 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12913 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12914 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12915 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12916 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12917 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12918 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12919 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12920 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12921 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12922
12923 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12924 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12925 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12926 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12927 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12928 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12929 Packets}.
12930
12931 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12932 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12933 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12934
12935 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12936
12937 @menu
12938 * Set Tracepoints::
12939 * Analyze Collected Data::
12940 * Tracepoint Variables::
12941 * Trace Files::
12942 @end menu
12943
12944 @node Set Tracepoints
12945 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12946
12947 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12948 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12949 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12950 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12951 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12952 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12953 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12954
12955 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12956 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12957 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12958 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12959 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12960 tracepoint was hit.
12961
12962 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12963 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12964 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12965 either.
12966
12967 @cindex fast tracepoints
12968 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12969 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12970 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12971
12972 @cindex static tracepoints
12973 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12974 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12975 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12976 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12977 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12978 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12979 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12980 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12981 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12982 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12983 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12984 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12985 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12986 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12987 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12988 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12989 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12990 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12991 static tracepoint marker.
12992
12993 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12994 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12995
12996 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12997 conditions and actions.
12998
12999 @menu
13000 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13001 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13002 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13003 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13004 * Trace State Variables::
13005 * Tracepoint Actions::
13006 * Listing Tracepoints::
13007 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13008 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13009 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13010 @end menu
13011
13012 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13013 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13014
13015 @table @code
13016 @cindex set tracepoint
13017 @kindex trace
13018 @item trace @var{location}
13019 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13020 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13021 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13022 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13023 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13024 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13025 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13026 in tracing}).
13027 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13028 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13029 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13030 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13031 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13032 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13033 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13034 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13035 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13036 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13037 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13038 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13039
13040 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13041
13042 @smallexample
13043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13044
13045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13046
13047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13048
13049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13050
13051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13052 @end smallexample
13053
13054 @noindent
13055 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13056
13057 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13058 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13059 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13060 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13061 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13062 information on tracepoint conditions.
13063
13064 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13065 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13066 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13067 @kindex ftrace
13068 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13069 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13070 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13071 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13072 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13073 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13074 message.
13075
13076 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13077 @code{trace}.
13078
13079 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13080 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13081 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13082 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13083 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13084 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13085 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13086 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13087
13088 @example
13089 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13090 @end example
13091
13092 @noindent
13093 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13094 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13095
13096 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13097 @cindex set static tracepoint
13098 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13099 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13100 @kindex strace
13101 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13102 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13103 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13104 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13105 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13106
13107 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13108 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13109 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13110 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13111 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13112 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13113 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13114 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13115 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13116 tracing engine:
13117
13118 @smallexample
13119 main ()
13120 @{
13121 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13122 @}
13123 @end smallexample
13124
13125 @noindent
13126 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13127 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13128
13129 @smallexample
13130 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13131 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13132 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13133 Data: "str %s"
13134 [etc...]
13135 @end smallexample
13136
13137 @noindent
13138 so you may probe the marker above with:
13139
13140 @smallexample
13141 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13142 @end smallexample
13143
13144 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13145 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13146 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13147 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13148 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13149 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13150 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13151 the @samp{Data:} field.
13152
13153 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13154 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13155 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13156
13157 @vindex $tpnum
13158 @cindex last tracepoint number
13159 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13160 @cindex tracepoint number
13161 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13162 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13163
13164 @kindex delete tracepoint
13165 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13166 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13167 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13168 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13169 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13170
13171 Examples:
13172
13173 @smallexample
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13175
13176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13177 @end smallexample
13178
13179 @noindent
13180 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13181 @end table
13182
13183 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13184 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13185
13186 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13187
13188 @table @code
13189 @kindex disable tracepoint
13190 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13191 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13192 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13193 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13194 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13195 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13196 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13197 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13198 next trace experiment.
13199
13200 @kindex enable tracepoint
13201 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13202 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13203 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13204 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13205 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13206 next time a trace experiment is run.
13207 @end table
13208
13209 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13210 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13211
13212 @table @code
13213 @kindex passcount
13214 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13215 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13216 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13217 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13218 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13219 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13220 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13221 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13222 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13223 user.
13224
13225 Examples:
13226
13227 @smallexample
13228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13229 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13230
13231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13232 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13235 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13236 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13239 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13240 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13241 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13242 @end smallexample
13243 @end table
13244
13245 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13246 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13247 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13248 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13249
13250 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13251 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13252 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13253 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13254 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13255 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13256 is true.
13257
13258 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13259 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13260 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13261 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13262 just as with breakpoints.
13263
13264 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13265 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13266 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13267 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13268 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13269 accesses, and so forth.
13270
13271 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13272 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13273 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13274 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13275 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13276 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13277 search through.
13278
13279 @smallexample
13280 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13281 @end smallexample
13282
13283 @node Trace State Variables
13284 @subsection Trace State Variables
13285 @cindex trace state variables
13286
13287 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13288 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13289 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13290 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13291 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13292 integers.
13293
13294 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13295 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13296 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13297 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13298
13299 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13300 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13301 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13302 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13303 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13304 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13305 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13306 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13307 variable with the same name.
13308
13309 @table @code
13310
13311 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13312 @kindex tvariable
13313 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13314 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13315 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13316 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13317 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13318 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13319 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13320 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13321 value. The default initial value is 0.
13322
13323 @item info tvariables
13324 @kindex info tvariables
13325 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13326 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13327 currently running.
13328
13329 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13330 @kindex delete tvariable
13331 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13332 are specified.
13333
13334 @end table
13335
13336 @node Tracepoint Actions
13337 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13338
13339 @table @code
13340 @kindex actions
13341 @cindex tracepoint actions
13342 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13343 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13344 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13345 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13346 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13347 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13348 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13349 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13350 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13351 @code{while-stepping}.
13352
13353 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13354 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13355 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13356
13357 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13358 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13359 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13360
13361 @smallexample
13362 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13363
13364 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13365
13366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13367 @end smallexample
13368
13369 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13370 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13371 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13372 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13373 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13374 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13375 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13376 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13377
13378 @smallexample
13379 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13380 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13381 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13382 > collect bar,baz
13383 > collect $regs
13384 > while-stepping 12
13385 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13386 > end
13387 end
13388 @end smallexample
13389
13390 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13391 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13392 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13393 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13394 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13395 special arguments are supported:
13396
13397 @table @code
13398 @item $regs
13399 Collect all registers.
13400
13401 @item $args
13402 Collect all function arguments.
13403
13404 @item $locals
13405 Collect all local variables.
13406
13407 @item $_ret
13408 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13409 of a backtrace.
13410
13411 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13412 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13413 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13414 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13415 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13416 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13417
13418 @item $_probe_argc
13419 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13420 tracepoint is located.
13421 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13422
13423 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13424 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13425 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13426 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13427
13428 @item $_sdata
13429 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13430 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13431 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13432 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13433 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13434 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13435 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13436 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13437 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13438
13439 @smallexample
13440 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13441 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13442 @end smallexample
13443
13444 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13445 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13446 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13447 @value{GDBN}.
13448 @end table
13449
13450 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13451 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13452 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13453
13454 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13455 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13456 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13457 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13458 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13459 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13460 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13461 @samp{mystr}.
13462
13463 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13464 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13465
13466 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13467 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13468 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13469 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13470 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13471 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13472 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13473 action were used.
13474
13475 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13476 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13477 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13478 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13479 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13480 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13481
13482 @smallexample
13483 > while-stepping 12
13484 > collect $regs, myglobal
13485 > end
13486 >
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13491 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13492 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13493 @code{stepping}.
13494
13495 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13496 @kindex set default-collect
13497 @cindex default collection action
13498 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13499 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13500 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13501 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13502 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13503 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13504
13505 @item show default-collect
13506 @kindex show default-collect
13507 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13508 tracepoint hit.
13509
13510 @end table
13511
13512 @node Listing Tracepoints
13513 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13514
13515 @table @code
13516 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13517 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13518 @cindex information about tracepoints
13519 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13520 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13521 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13522 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13523 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13524 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13525
13526 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13527 tracing:
13528
13529 @itemize @bullet
13530 @item
13531 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13532
13533 @item
13534 the state about installed on target of each location
13535 @end itemize
13536
13537 @smallexample
13538 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13539 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13540 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13541 while-stepping 20
13542 collect globfoo, $regs
13543 end
13544 collect globfoo2
13545 end
13546 pass count 1200
13547 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13548 collect $eip
13549 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13550 installed on target
13551 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13552 installed on target
13553 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13554 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13555 not installed on target
13556 (@value{GDBP})
13557 @end smallexample
13558
13559 @noindent
13560 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13561 @end table
13562
13563 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13564 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13565
13566 @table @code
13567 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13568 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13569 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13570 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13571 program.
13572
13573 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13574
13575 @table @emph
13576 @item Count
13577 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13578 stable identifier.
13579 @item ID
13580 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13581 @item Enabled or Disabled
13582 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13583 that are not enabled.
13584 @item Address
13585 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13586 @item What
13587 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13588 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13589 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13590 will be left blank.
13591 @end table
13592
13593 @noindent
13594 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13595
13596 @table @emph
13597 @item Data
13598 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13599 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13600 marker call.
13601 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13602 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13603 @end table
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13607 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13608 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13609 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13610 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13611 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13612 Data: str %s
13613 (@value{GDBP})
13614 @end smallexample
13615 @end table
13616
13617 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13618 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13619
13620 @table @code
13621 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13622 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13623 @cindex collected data discarded
13624 @item tstart
13625 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13626 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13627 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13628 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13629 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13630 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13631 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13632 information, and so forth.
13633
13634 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13635 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13636 @item tstop
13637 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13638 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13639 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13640 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13641 needs to be stopped quickly.
13642
13643 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13644 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13645 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13646
13647 @kindex tstatus
13648 @cindex status of trace data collection
13649 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13650 @item tstatus
13651 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13652 collection.
13653 @end table
13654
13655 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13656
13657 @smallexample
13658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13660 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13661 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13662 > while-stepping 11
13663 > collect $regs
13664 > end
13665 > end
13666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13667 [time passes @dots{}]
13668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13669 @end smallexample
13670
13671 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13672 @cindex disconnected tracing
13673 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13674 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13675 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13676 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13677 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13678 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13679 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13680 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13681
13682 @table @code
13683 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13684 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13685 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13686 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13687 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13688 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13689 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13690 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13691
13692 @item show disconnected-tracing
13693 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13694 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13695
13696 @end table
13697
13698 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13699 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13700 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13701 it will continue after reconnection.
13702
13703 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13704 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13705 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13706 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13707 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13708 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13709 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13710 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13711 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13712 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13713
13714 @cindex circular trace buffer
13715 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13716 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13717 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13718 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13719 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13720 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13721 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13722 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13723 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13724 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13725 the next run.
13726
13727 @table @code
13728 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13729 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13730 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13731 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13732 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13733 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13734 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13735
13736 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13737 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13738 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13739 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13740 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13741 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13742
13743 @end table
13744
13745 @table @code
13746 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13747 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13748 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13749 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13750 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13751 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13752 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13753 likes. This is also the default.
13754
13755 @item show trace-buffer-size
13756 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13757 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13758 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13759 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13760 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13761 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13762 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13763 @end table
13764
13765 @table @code
13766 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13767 @kindex set trace-user
13768
13769 @item show trace-user
13770 @kindex show trace-user
13771
13772 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13773 @kindex set trace-notes
13774 Set the trace run's notes.
13775
13776 @item show trace-notes
13777 @kindex show trace-notes
13778 Show the trace run's notes.
13779
13780 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13781 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13782 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13783 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13784 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13785
13786 @item show trace-stop-notes
13787 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13788 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13789
13790 @end table
13791
13792 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13793 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13794
13795 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13796 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13797 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13798 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13799 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13800 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13801 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13802 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13803 mentioned here.
13804
13805 @itemize @bullet
13806
13807 @item
13808 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13809 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13810 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13811 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13812 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13813 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13814 cannot be collected either.
13815
13816 @item
13817 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13818 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13819 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13820 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13821 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13822 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13823 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13824 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13825 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13826 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13827
13828 @item
13829 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13830 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13831 in a misleading way.
13832
13833 @item
13834 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13835 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13836 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13837 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13838 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13839 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13840 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13841 by @code{ptr}.
13842
13843 @item
13844 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13845 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13846 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13847 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13848 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13849 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13850 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13851 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13852 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13853 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13854 invalid address.
13855
13856 @item
13857 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13858 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13859 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13860 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13861 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13862 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13863 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13864 it to zero.
13865
13866 @end itemize
13867
13868 @node Analyze Collected Data
13869 @section Using the Collected Data
13870
13871 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13872 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13873 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13874 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13875 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13876 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13877 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13878 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13879 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13880 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13881 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13882 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13883 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13884 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13885 the buffer will fail.
13886
13887 @menu
13888 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13889 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13890 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13891 @end menu
13892
13893 @node tfind
13894 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13895
13896 @kindex tfind
13897 @cindex select trace snapshot
13898 @cindex find trace snapshot
13899 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13900 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13901 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13902 snapshot is selected.
13903
13904 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13905
13906 @table @code
13907 @item tfind start
13908 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13909 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13910
13911 @item tfind none
13912 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13913
13914 @item tfind end
13915 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13916
13917 @item tfind
13918 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13919 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13920
13921 @item tfind -
13922 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13923 retracing earlier steps.
13924
13925 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13926 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13927 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13928 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13929 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13930
13931 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13932 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13933 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13934 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13935 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13936
13937 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13938 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13939 addresses (exclusive).
13940
13941 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13942 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13943 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13944
13945 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13946 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13947 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13948 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13949 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13950 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13951 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13952 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13953 @end table
13954
13955 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13956 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13957 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13958 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13959 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13960 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13961 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13962 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13963 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13964 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13965 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13966 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13967 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13968 tracepoint as the current one.
13969
13970 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13971 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13972 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13973 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13974 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13975
13976 @smallexample
13977 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13978 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13979 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13980 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13981 > tfind
13982 > end
13983
13984 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13985 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13986 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13987 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13988 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13989 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13990 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13991 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13992 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13993 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13994 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13995 @end smallexample
13996
13997 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13998 the buffer:
13999
14000 @smallexample
14001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14003 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14004 > tfind line
14005 > end
14006
14007 Frame 0, X = 1
14008 Frame 7, X = 2
14009 Frame 13, X = 255
14010 @end smallexample
14011
14012 @node tdump
14013 @subsection @code{tdump}
14014 @kindex tdump
14015 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14016 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14017
14018 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14019 the current trace snapshot.
14020
14021 @smallexample
14022 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14024 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14025 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14026 > end
14027
14028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14029
14030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14031 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14032 at gdb_test.c:444
14033 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14034
14035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14036 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14037 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14038 d1 0x18 24
14039 d2 0x80 128
14040 d3 0x33 51
14041 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14042 d5 0x22 34
14043 d6 0xe0 224
14044 d7 0x380035 3670069
14045 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14046 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14047 a2 0x100 256
14048 a3 0x322000 3284992
14049 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14050 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14051 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14052 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14053 ps 0x0 0
14054 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14055 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14056 fpstatus 0x0 0
14057 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14058 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14059 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14060 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14061 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14062 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14063 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14064 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14065 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14066
14067 (@value{GDBP})
14068 @end smallexample
14069
14070 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14071 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14072 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14073 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14074
14075 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14076 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14077 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14078 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14079 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14080 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14081 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14082 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14083 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14084 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14085
14086 @node save tracepoints
14087 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14088 @kindex save tracepoints
14089 @kindex save-tracepoints
14090 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14091
14092 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14093 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14094 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14095 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14096 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14097 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14098
14099 @node Tracepoint Variables
14100 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14101 @cindex tracepoint variables
14102 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14103
14104 @table @code
14105 @vindex $trace_frame
14106 @item (int) $trace_frame
14107 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14108 snapshot is selected.
14109
14110 @vindex $tracepoint
14111 @item (int) $tracepoint
14112 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14113
14114 @vindex $trace_line
14115 @item (int) $trace_line
14116 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14117
14118 @vindex $trace_file
14119 @item (char []) $trace_file
14120 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14121
14122 @vindex $trace_func
14123 @item (char []) $trace_func
14124 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14125 @end table
14126
14127 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14128 use @code{output} instead.
14129
14130 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14131 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14132 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14133 which are managed by the target.
14134
14135 @smallexample
14136 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14137
14138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14139 > output $trace_file
14140 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14141 > tfind
14142 > end
14143 @end smallexample
14144
14145 @node Trace Files
14146 @section Using Trace Files
14147 @cindex trace files
14148
14149 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14150 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14151 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14152 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14153 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14154
14155 @table @code
14156
14157 @kindex tsave
14158 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14159 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14160 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14161 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14162 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14163 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14164 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14165 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14166 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14167 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14168 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14169 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14170 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14171 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14172 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14173
14174 @kindex target tfile
14175 @kindex tfile
14176 @kindex target ctf
14177 @kindex ctf
14178 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14179 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14180 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14181 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14182 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14183 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14184 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14185 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14186 the host.
14187
14188 @smallexample
14189 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14190 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14191 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14192 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14193 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14194 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14195 i = 0
14196 a = 0
14197 b = 1 '\001'
14198 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14199 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14200 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14201 $1 = 1
14202 @end smallexample
14203
14204 @end table
14205
14206 @node Overlays
14207 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14208 @cindex overlays
14209
14210 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14211 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14212 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14213 use overlays.
14214
14215 @menu
14216 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14217 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14218 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14219 mapped by asking the inferior.
14220 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14221 @end menu
14222
14223 @node How Overlays Work
14224 @section How Overlays Work
14225 @cindex mapped overlays
14226 @cindex unmapped overlays
14227 @cindex load address, overlay's
14228 @cindex mapped address
14229 @cindex overlay area
14230
14231 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14232 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14233 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14234 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14235 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14236
14237 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14238 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14239 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14240 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14241 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14242 largest overlay as well.
14243
14244 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14245 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14246 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14247 there.
14248
14249 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14250 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14251 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14252
14253 @smallexample
14254 @group
14255 Data Instruction Larger
14256 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14257 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14258 | | | | | |
14259 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14260 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14261 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14262 | and heap | | | | | |
14263 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14264 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14265 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14266 | | | | | |
14267 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14268 address | | | | | |
14269 | overlay | <-' | | |
14270 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14271 | | <---. | | load address
14272 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14273 | | | |
14274 +-----------+ | |
14275 +-----------+
14276 | |
14277 +-----------+
14278
14279 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14280 @end group
14281 @end smallexample
14282
14283 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14284 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14285 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14286 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14287 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14288 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14289 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14290 program and the overlay area.
14291
14292 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14293 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14294 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14295 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14296 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14297 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14298 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14299
14300 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14301 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14302 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14303
14304 @itemize @bullet
14305
14306 @item
14307 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14308 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14309 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14310 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14311
14312 @item
14313 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14314 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14315 your program's performance.
14316
14317 @item
14318 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14319 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14320 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14321 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14322 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14323 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14324 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14325
14326 @item
14327 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14328 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14329 instruction and data spaces.
14330
14331 @end itemize
14332
14333 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14334 improved in many ways:
14335
14336 @itemize @bullet
14337
14338 @item
14339 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14340 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14341 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14342 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14343 area in the usual way.
14344
14345 @item
14346 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14347 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14348
14349 @item
14350 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14351 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14352 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14353 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14354 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14355 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14356 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14357
14358 @end itemize
14359
14360
14361 @node Overlay Commands
14362 @section Overlay Commands
14363
14364 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14365 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14366 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14367 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14368 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14369 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14370
14371 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14372 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14373
14374 @table @code
14375 @item overlay off
14376 @kindex overlay
14377 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14378 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14379 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14380 overlay support is disabled.
14381
14382 @item overlay manual
14383 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14384 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14385 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14386 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14387 commands described below.
14388
14389 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14390 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14391 @cindex map an overlay
14392 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14393 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14394 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14395 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14396 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14397 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14398
14399 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14400 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14401 @cindex unmap an overlay
14402 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14403 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14404 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14405 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14406
14407 @item overlay auto
14408 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14409 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14410 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14411 Overlay Debugging}.
14412
14413 @item overlay load-target
14414 @itemx overlay load
14415 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14416 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14417 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14418 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14419 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14420 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14421
14422 @item overlay list-overlays
14423 @itemx overlay list
14424 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14425 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14426 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14427
14428 @end table
14429
14430 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14431 of the function the address falls in:
14432
14433 @smallexample
14434 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14435 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14436 @end smallexample
14437 @noindent
14438 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14439 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14440 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14441 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14442
14443 @smallexample
14444 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14445 No sections are mapped.
14446 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14447 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14448 @end smallexample
14449 @noindent
14450 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14451 name normally:
14452
14453 @smallexample
14454 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14455 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14456 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14457 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14458 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14459 @end smallexample
14460
14461 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14462 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14463 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14464 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14465 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14466
14467 @itemize @bullet
14468 @item
14469 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14470 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14471 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14472 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14473 @item
14474 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14475 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14476 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14477 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14478 breakpoints properly.
14479 @end itemize
14480
14481
14482 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14483 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14484 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14485
14486 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14487 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14488 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14489 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14490 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14491 current state of the overlays.
14492
14493 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14494 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14495
14496 @table @asis
14497
14498 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14499 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14500
14501 @smallexample
14502 struct
14503 @{
14504 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14505 unsigned long vma;
14506
14507 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14508 unsigned long size;
14509
14510 /* The overlay's load address. */
14511 unsigned long lma;
14512
14513 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14514 zero otherwise. */
14515 unsigned long mapped;
14516 @}
14517 @end smallexample
14518
14519 @item @code{_novlys}:
14520 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14521 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14522
14523 @end table
14524
14525 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14526 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14527 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14528 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14529 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14530 currently mapped.
14531
14532 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14533 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14534 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14535 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14536 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14537 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14538 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14539 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14540 are not being executed.
14541
14542 @node Overlay Sample Program
14543 @section Overlay Sample Program
14544 @cindex overlay example program
14545
14546 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14547 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14548 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14549 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14550 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14551 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14552 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14553
14554 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14555 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14556 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14557 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14558
14559 @table @file
14560 @item overlays.c
14561 The main program file.
14562 @item ovlymgr.c
14563 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14564 @item foo.c
14565 @itemx bar.c
14566 @itemx baz.c
14567 @itemx grbx.c
14568 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14569 @item d10v.ld
14570 @itemx m32r.ld
14571 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14572 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14573 @end table
14574
14575 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14576 cross-compiler like this:
14577
14578 @smallexample
14579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14580 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14581 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14582 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14583 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14584 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14585 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14586 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14587 @end smallexample
14588
14589 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14590 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14591 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14592
14593
14594 @node Languages
14595 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14596 @cindex languages
14597
14598 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14599 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14600 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14601 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14602 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14603 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14604
14605 @cindex working language
14606 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14607 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14608 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14609 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14610 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14611 language}.
14612
14613 @menu
14614 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14615 * Show:: Displaying the language
14616 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14617 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14618 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14619 @end menu
14620
14621 @node Setting
14622 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14623
14624 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14625 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14626 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14627 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14628 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14629 are printed, etc.
14630
14631 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14632 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14633 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14634 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14635 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14636 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14637 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14638 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14639 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14640 Displaying the Language}.
14641
14642 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14643 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14644 another language. In that case, make the
14645 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14646 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14647 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14648
14649 @menu
14650 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14651 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14652 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14653 @end menu
14654
14655 @node Filenames
14656 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14657
14658 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14659 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14660
14661 @table @file
14662 @item .ada
14663 @itemx .ads
14664 @itemx .adb
14665 @itemx .a
14666 Ada source file.
14667
14668 @item .c
14669 C source file
14670
14671 @item .C
14672 @itemx .cc
14673 @itemx .cp
14674 @itemx .cpp
14675 @itemx .cxx
14676 @itemx .c++
14677 C@t{++} source file
14678
14679 @item .d
14680 D source file
14681
14682 @item .m
14683 Objective-C source file
14684
14685 @item .f
14686 @itemx .F
14687 Fortran source file
14688
14689 @item .mod
14690 Modula-2 source file
14691
14692 @item .s
14693 @itemx .S
14694 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14695 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14696 @end table
14697
14698 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14699 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14700
14701 @node Manually
14702 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14703
14704 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14705 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14706 your program.
14707
14708 @kindex set language
14709 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14710 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14711 a language, such as
14712 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14713 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14714
14715 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14716 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14717 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14718 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14719 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14720 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14721 command such as:
14722
14723 @smallexample
14724 print a = b + c
14725 @end smallexample
14726
14727 @noindent
14728 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14729 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14730 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14731 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14732
14733 @node Automatically
14734 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14735
14736 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14737 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14738 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14739 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14740 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14741 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14742 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14743 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14744 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14745
14746 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14747 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14748 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14749 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14750 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14751
14752 @node Show
14753 @section Displaying the Language
14754
14755 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14756 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14757
14758 @table @code
14759 @item show language
14760 @anchor{show language}
14761 @kindex show language
14762 Display the current working language. This is the
14763 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14764 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14765
14766 @item info frame
14767 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14768 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14769 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14770 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14771 information listed here.
14772
14773 @item info source
14774 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14775 Display the source language of this source file.
14776 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14777 information listed here.
14778 @end table
14779
14780 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14781 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14782 with a language explicitly:
14783
14784 @table @code
14785 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14786 @kindex set extension-language
14787 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14788 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14789
14790 @item info extensions
14791 @kindex info extensions
14792 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14793 @end table
14794
14795 @node Checks
14796 @section Type and Range Checking
14797
14798 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14799 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14800 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14801 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14802 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14803 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14804 errors when your program is running.
14805
14806 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14807 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14808 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14809 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14810
14811 @menu
14812 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14813 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14814 @end menu
14815
14816 @cindex type checking
14817 @cindex checks, type
14818 @node Type Checking
14819 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14820
14821 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14822 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14823 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14824 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14825
14826 @smallexample
14827 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14828
14829 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14830 $1 = 2
14831 @exdent but
14832 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14833 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14834 @end smallexample
14835
14836 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14837 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14838
14839 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14840 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14841 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14842 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14843 expressions like the second example above.
14844
14845 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14846 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14847 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14848 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14849 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14850 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14851
14852 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14853
14854 @kindex set check type
14855 @kindex show check type
14856 @table @code
14857 @item set check type on
14858 @itemx set check type off
14859 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14860 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14861 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14862
14863 @item show check type
14864 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14865 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14866 @end table
14867
14868 @cindex range checking
14869 @cindex checks, range
14870 @node Range Checking
14871 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14872
14873 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14874 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14875 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14876 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14877 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14878
14879 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14880 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14881 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14882 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14883
14884 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14885 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14886 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14887 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14888 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14889 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14890
14891 @smallexample
14892 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14893 @end smallexample
14894
14895 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14896 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14897 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14898
14899 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14900
14901 @kindex set check range
14902 @kindex show check range
14903 @table @code
14904 @item set check range auto
14905 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14906 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14907 each language.
14908
14909 @item set check range on
14910 @itemx set check range off
14911 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14912 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14913 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14914 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14915
14916 @item set check range warn
14917 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14918 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14919 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14920 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14921 systems).
14922
14923 @item show range
14924 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14925 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14926 @end table
14927
14928 @node Supported Languages
14929 @section Supported Languages
14930
14931 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14932 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14933 @c This is false ...
14934 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14935 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14936 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14937 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14938 language.
14939
14940 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14941 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14942 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14943 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14944 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14945 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14946 language reference or tutorial.
14947
14948 @menu
14949 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14950 * D:: D
14951 * Go:: Go
14952 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14953 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14954 * Fortran:: Fortran
14955 * Pascal:: Pascal
14956 * Rust:: Rust
14957 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14958 * Ada:: Ada
14959 @end menu
14960
14961 @node C
14962 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14963
14964 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14965 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14966
14967 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14968 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14969 together.
14970
14971 @cindex C@t{++}
14972 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14973 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14974 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14975 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14976 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14977 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14978 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14979
14980 @menu
14981 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14982 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14983 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14984 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14985 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14986 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14987 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14988 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14989 @end menu
14990
14991 @node C Operators
14992 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14993
14994 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14995
14996 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14997 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14998 often defined on groups of types.
14999
15000 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15001
15002 @itemize @bullet
15003
15004 @item
15005 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15006 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15007
15008 @item
15009 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15010 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15011
15012 @item
15013 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15014
15015 @item
15016 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15017
15018 @end itemize
15019
15020 @noindent
15021 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15022 in order of increasing precedence:
15023
15024 @table @code
15025 @item ,
15026 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15027 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15028 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15029
15030 @item =
15031 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15032 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15033
15034 @item @var{op}=
15035 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15036 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15037 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15038 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15039 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15040
15041 @item ?:
15042 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15043 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15044 should be of an integral type.
15045
15046 @item ||
15047 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15048
15049 @item &&
15050 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15051
15052 @item |
15053 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15054
15055 @item ^
15056 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15057
15058 @item &
15059 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15060
15061 @item ==@r{, }!=
15062 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15063 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15064
15065 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15066 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15067 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15068 and non-zero for true.
15069
15070 @item <<@r{, }>>
15071 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15072
15073 @item @@
15074 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15075
15076 @item +@r{, }-
15077 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15078 pointer types.
15079
15080 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15081 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15082 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15083 integral types.
15084
15085 @item ++@r{, }--
15086 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15087 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15088 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15089 operation takes place.
15090
15091 @item *
15092 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15093 @code{++}.
15094
15095 @item &
15096 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15097
15098 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15099 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15100 to examine the address
15101 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15102 stored.
15103
15104 @item -
15105 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15106 precedence as @code{++}.
15107
15108 @item !
15109 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15110 @code{++}.
15111
15112 @item ~
15113 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15114 @code{++}.
15115
15116
15117 @item .@r{, }->
15118 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15119 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15120 pointer based on the stored type information.
15121 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15122
15123 @item .*@r{, }->*
15124 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15125
15126 @item []
15127 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15128 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15129
15130 @item ()
15131 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15132
15133 @item ::
15134 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15135 and @code{class} types.
15136
15137 @item ::
15138 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15139 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15140 above.
15141 @end table
15142
15143 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15144 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15145 predefined meaning.
15146
15147 @node C Constants
15148 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15149
15150 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15151
15152 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15153 following ways:
15154
15155 @itemize @bullet
15156 @item
15157 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15158 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15159 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15160 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15161 @code{long} value.
15162
15163 @item
15164 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15165 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15166 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15167 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15168 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15169 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15170 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15171 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15172 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15173 constant.
15174
15175 @item
15176 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15177 integral equivalents.
15178
15179 @item
15180 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15181 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15182 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15183 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15184 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15185 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15186 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15187 @samp{\n} for newline.
15188
15189 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15190 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15191 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15192 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15193
15194 @item
15195 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15196 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15197 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15198 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15199 characters.
15200
15201 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15202 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15203 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15204
15205 @item
15206 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15207 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15208
15209 @item
15210 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15211 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15212 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15213 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15214 @end itemize
15215
15216 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15217 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15218
15219 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15220 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15221
15222 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15223 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15224 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15225 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15226 @quotation
15227 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15228 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15229 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15230 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15231 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15232 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15233 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15234 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15235 @end quotation
15236
15237 @enumerate
15238
15239 @cindex member functions
15240 @item
15241 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15245 @end smallexample
15246
15247 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15248 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15249 @item
15250 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15251 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15252 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15253 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15254 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15255
15256 @cindex call overloaded functions
15257 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15258 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15259 @item
15260 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15261 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15262 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15263 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15264 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15265 default arguments.
15266
15267 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15268 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15269 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15270 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15271 number of function arguments.
15272
15273 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15274 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15275 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15276
15277 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15278 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15279 @smallexample
15280 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15281 @end smallexample
15282
15283 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15284 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15285
15286 @cindex reference declarations
15287 @item
15288 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15289 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15290 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15291
15292 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15293 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15294 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15295 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15296 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15297
15298 @item
15299 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15300 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15301 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15302 necessary, for example in an expression like
15303 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15304 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15305 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15306
15307 @item
15308 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15309 specification.
15310 @end enumerate
15311
15312 @node C Defaults
15313 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15314
15315 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15316
15317 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15318 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15319 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15320 selects the working language.
15321
15322 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15323 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15324 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15325 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15326 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15327 for further details.
15328
15329 @node C Checks
15330 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15331
15332 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15333
15334 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15335 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15336 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15337 constants to pointers.
15338
15339 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15340 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15341 that is not itself an array.
15342
15343 @node Debugging C
15344 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15345
15346 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15347 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15348 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15349 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15350
15351 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15352 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15353 ,Expressions}.
15354
15355 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15356 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15357
15358 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15359
15360 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15361 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15362
15363 @table @code
15364 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15365 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15366 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15367 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15368 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15369 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15370
15371 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15372 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15373 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15374 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15375 classes.
15376 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15377
15378 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15379 @item catch throw
15380 @itemx catch rethrow
15381 @itemx catch catch
15382 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15383 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15384
15385 @cindex inheritance
15386 @item ptype @var{typename}
15387 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15388 @var{typename}.
15389 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15390
15391 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15392 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15393 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15394 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15395 multiple inheritance is in use.
15396
15397 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15398 @item demangle @var{name}
15399 Demangle @var{name}.
15400 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15401
15402 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15403 @item set print demangle
15404 @itemx show print demangle
15405 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15406 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15407 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15408 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15409 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15410
15411 @item set print object
15412 @itemx show print object
15413 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15414 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15415
15416 @item set print vtbl
15417 @itemx show print vtbl
15418 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15419 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15420 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15421 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15422
15423 @kindex set overload-resolution
15424 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15425 @item set overload-resolution on
15426 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15427 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15428 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15429 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15430 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15431 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15432
15433 @item set overload-resolution off
15434 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15435 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15436 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15437 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15438 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15439 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15440 argument types.
15441
15442 @kindex show overload-resolution
15443 @item show overload-resolution
15444 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15445
15446 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15447 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15448 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15449 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15450 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15451 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15452 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15453
15454 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15455
15456 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15457 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15458 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15459 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15460 for more detail.
15461
15462 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15463 function that returns a std::string:
15464
15465 @smallexample
15466 std::string function(int);
15467 @end smallexample
15468
15469 @noindent
15470 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15471 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15472
15473 @smallexample
15474 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15475 @end smallexample
15476
15477 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15478 tag. For example:
15479
15480 @smallexample
15481 (gdb) b function(int)
15482 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15483 (gdb) info breakpoints
15484 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15485 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15486 at main.cc:10
15487 @end smallexample
15488
15489 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15490 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15491 name, like:
15492
15493 @smallexample
15494 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15495 @end smallexample
15496 @end table
15497
15498 @node Decimal Floating Point
15499 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15500 @cindex decimal floating point format
15501
15502 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15503 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15504 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15505 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15506
15507 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15508 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15509 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15510 configured target.
15511
15512 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15513 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15514 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15515
15516 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15517 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15518 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15519
15520 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15521 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15522 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15523
15524 @node D
15525 @subsection D
15526
15527 @cindex D
15528 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15529 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15530 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15531
15532 @node Go
15533 @subsection Go
15534
15535 @cindex Go (programming language)
15536 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15537 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15538
15539 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15540
15541 @table @code
15542 @cindex current Go package
15543 @item The current Go package
15544 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15545 specifying global variables and functions.
15546
15547 For example, given the program:
15548
15549 @example
15550 package main
15551 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15552 func main () @{
15553 // ...
15554 @}
15555 @end example
15556
15557 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15558
15559 @example
15560 (gdb) p myglob
15561 (gdb) p main.myglob
15562 @end example
15563
15564 @cindex builtin Go types
15565 @item Builtin Go types
15566 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15567 as a string.
15568
15569 @cindex builtin Go functions
15570 @item Builtin Go functions
15571 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15572 function and handles it internally.
15573
15574 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15575 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15576 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15577 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15578 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15579 @end table
15580
15581 @node Objective-C
15582 @subsection Objective-C
15583
15584 @cindex Objective-C
15585 This section provides information about some commands and command
15586 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15587 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15588 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15589
15590 @menu
15591 * Method Names in Commands::
15592 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15593 @end menu
15594
15595 @node Method Names in Commands
15596 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15597
15598 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15599 names as line specifications:
15600
15601 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15602 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15603 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15604 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15605 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15606 @itemize
15607 @item @code{clear}
15608 @item @code{break}
15609 @item @code{info line}
15610 @item @code{jump}
15611 @item @code{list}
15612 @end itemize
15613
15614 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15615
15616 @smallexample
15617 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15618 @end smallexample
15619
15620 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15621 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15622 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15623 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15624 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15625 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15626 debugged, enter:
15627
15628 @smallexample
15629 break -[Fruit create]
15630 @end smallexample
15631
15632 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15633 enter:
15634
15635 @smallexample
15636 list +[NSText initialize]
15637 @end smallexample
15638
15639 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15640 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15641 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15642 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15643
15644 @smallexample
15645 break create
15646 @end smallexample
15647
15648 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15649 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15650 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15651 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15652 none apply.
15653
15654 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15655 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15656
15657 @smallexample
15658 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15659 @end smallexample
15660
15661 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15662 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15663 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15664 @kindex print-object
15665 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15666
15667 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15668
15669 @smallexample
15670 print -[@var{object} hash]
15671 @end smallexample
15672
15673 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15674 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15675 @noindent
15676 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15677 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15678 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15679 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15680 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15681 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15682
15683 @node OpenCL C
15684 @subsection OpenCL C
15685
15686 @cindex OpenCL C
15687 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15688
15689 @menu
15690 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15691 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15692 * OpenCL C Operators::
15693 @end menu
15694
15695 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15696 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15697
15698 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15699 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15700 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15701 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15702 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15703
15704 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15705 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15706
15707 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15708 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15709 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15710 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15711
15712 @node OpenCL C Operators
15713 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15714
15715 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15716 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15717 vector data types.
15718
15719 @node Fortran
15720 @subsection Fortran
15721 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15722
15723 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15724 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15725
15726 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15727 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15728 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15729 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15730 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15731 underscore.
15732
15733 @menu
15734 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15735 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15736 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15737 @end menu
15738
15739 @node Fortran Operators
15740 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15741
15742 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15743
15744 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15745 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15746 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15747
15748 @table @code
15749 @item **
15750 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15751 of the second one.
15752
15753 @item :
15754 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15755 represent a section of array.
15756
15757 @item %
15758 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15759 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15760 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15761 union type.
15762 @end table
15763
15764 @node Fortran Defaults
15765 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15766
15767 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15768
15769 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15770 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15771 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15772 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15773
15774 @node Special Fortran Commands
15775 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15776
15777 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15778
15779 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15780 such as displaying common blocks.
15781
15782 @table @code
15783 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15784 @kindex info common
15785 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15786 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15787 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15788 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15789 printed.
15790 @end table
15791
15792 @node Pascal
15793 @subsection Pascal
15794
15795 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15796 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15797 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15798 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15799 syntax.
15800
15801 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15802 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15803 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15804
15805 @node Rust
15806 @subsection Rust
15807
15808 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15809 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15810 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15811 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15812
15813 @itemize @bullet
15814 @item
15815 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15816 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15817 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15818
15819 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15820 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15821 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15822 @samp{B}.
15823
15824 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15825 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15826
15827 @item
15828 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15829 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15830 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15831 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15832 @samp{K::x::y}.
15833
15834 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15835 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15836 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15837 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15838 scope.
15839
15840 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15841 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15842
15843 @item
15844 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15845 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15846
15847 @item
15848 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15849
15850 @item
15851 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15852 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15853 never be destroyed.
15854
15855 @item
15856 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15857 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15858 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15859
15860 @item
15861 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15862 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15863 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15864 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15865 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15866 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15867 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15868 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15869
15870 @item
15871 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15872 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15873 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15874 @itemize @bullet
15875
15876 @item
15877 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15878
15879 @item
15880 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15881
15882 @item
15883 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15884 type names.
15885
15886 @item
15887 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15888
15889 @item
15890 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15891 available in the crate.
15892 @end itemize
15893 @end itemize
15894
15895 @node Modula-2
15896 @subsection Modula-2
15897
15898 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15899
15900 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15901 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15902 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15903 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15904 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15905 table.
15906
15907 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15908 @menu
15909 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15910 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15911 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15912 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15913 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15914 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15915 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15916 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15917 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15918 @end menu
15919
15920 @node M2 Operators
15921 @subsubsection Operators
15922 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15923
15924 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15925 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15926 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15927 following definitions hold:
15928
15929 @itemize @bullet
15930
15931 @item
15932 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15933 their subranges.
15934
15935 @item
15936 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15937
15938 @item
15939 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15940
15941 @item
15942 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15943 @var{type}}.
15944
15945 @item
15946 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15947
15948 @item
15949 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15950
15951 @item
15952 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15953 @end itemize
15954
15955 @noindent
15956 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15957 increasing precedence:
15958
15959 @table @code
15960 @item ,
15961 Function argument or array index separator.
15962
15963 @item :=
15964 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15965 @var{value}.
15966
15967 @item <@r{, }>
15968 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15969 types.
15970
15971 @item <=@r{, }>=
15972 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15973 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15974 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15975
15976 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15977 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15978 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15979 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15980 comment character.
15981
15982 @item IN
15983 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15984 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15985
15986 @item OR
15987 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15988
15989 @item AND@r{, }&
15990 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15991
15992 @item @@
15993 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15994
15995 @item +@r{, }-
15996 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15997 and difference on set types.
15998
15999 @item *
16000 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16001 on set types.
16002
16003 @item /
16004 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16005 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16006
16007 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16008 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16009 precedence as @code{*}.
16010
16011 @item -
16012 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16013
16014 @item ^
16015 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16016
16017 @item NOT
16018 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16019 @code{^}.
16020
16021 @item .
16022 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16023 precedence as @code{^}.
16024
16025 @item []
16026 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16027
16028 @item ()
16029 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16030 as @code{^}.
16031
16032 @item ::@r{, }.
16033 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16034 @end table
16035
16036 @quotation
16037 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16038 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16039 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16040 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16041 @end quotation
16042
16043
16044 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16045 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16046 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16047
16048 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16049 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16050
16051 @table @var
16052
16053 @item a
16054 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16055
16056 @item c
16057 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16058
16059 @item i
16060 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16061
16062 @item m
16063 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16064 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16065 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16066
16067 @item n
16068 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16069
16070 @item r
16071 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16072
16073 @item t
16074 represents a type.
16075
16076 @item v
16077 represents a variable.
16078
16079 @item x
16080 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16081 explanation of the function for details.
16082 @end table
16083
16084 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16085
16086 @table @code
16087 @item ABS(@var{n})
16088 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16089
16090 @item CAP(@var{c})
16091 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16092 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16093
16094 @item CHR(@var{i})
16095 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16096
16097 @item DEC(@var{v})
16098 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16099
16100 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16101 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16102 new value.
16103
16104 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16105 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16106 set.
16107
16108 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16109 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16110
16111 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16112 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16113
16114 @item INC(@var{v})
16115 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16116
16117 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16118 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16119 new value.
16120
16121 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16122 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16123 there. Returns the new set.
16124
16125 @item MAX(@var{t})
16126 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16127
16128 @item MIN(@var{t})
16129 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16130
16131 @item ODD(@var{i})
16132 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16133
16134 @item ORD(@var{x})
16135 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16136 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16137 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16138 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16139
16140 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16141 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16142 variable or a type.
16143
16144 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16145 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16146
16147 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16148 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16149 variable or a type.
16150
16151 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16152 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16153 @end table
16154
16155 @quotation
16156 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16157 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16158 an error.
16159 @end quotation
16160
16161 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16162 @node M2 Constants
16163 @subsubsection Constants
16164
16165 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16166 ways:
16167
16168 @itemize @bullet
16169
16170 @item
16171 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16172 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16173 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16174 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16175
16176 @item
16177 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16178 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16179 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16180 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16181 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16182 digits.
16183
16184 @item
16185 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16186 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16187 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16188 followed by a @samp{C}.
16189
16190 @item
16191 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16192 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16193 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16194 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16195 sequences.
16196
16197 @item
16198 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16199
16200 @item
16201 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16202 @code{FALSE}.
16203
16204 @item
16205 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16206
16207 @item
16208 Set constants are not yet supported.
16209 @end itemize
16210
16211 @node M2 Types
16212 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16213 @cindex Modula-2 types
16214
16215 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16216 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16217 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16218 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16219 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16220 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16221
16222 The first example contains the following section of code:
16223
16224 @smallexample
16225 VAR
16226 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16227 r: [20..40] ;
16228 @end smallexample
16229
16230 @noindent
16231 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16232 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16233
16234 @smallexample
16235 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16236 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16237 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16238 SET OF CHAR
16239 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16240 21
16241 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16242 [20..40]
16243 @end smallexample
16244
16245 @noindent
16246 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16247
16248 @smallexample
16249 VAR
16250 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16251 @end smallexample
16252
16253 @noindent
16254 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16255
16256 @smallexample
16257 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16258 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16259 @end smallexample
16260
16261 @noindent
16262 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16263 expressions using the debugger.
16264
16265 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16266 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16267
16268 @smallexample
16269 VAR
16270 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16271 @end smallexample
16272
16273 @smallexample
16274 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16275 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16276 @end smallexample
16277
16278 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16279 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16280 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16281 above.
16282
16283 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16284
16285 @smallexample
16286 TYPE
16287 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16288 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16289 VAR
16290 s: t ;
16291 BEGIN
16292 s := blue ;
16293 @end smallexample
16294
16295 @noindent
16296 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16297 and value of a variable.
16298
16299 @smallexample
16300 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16301 $1 = blue
16302 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16303 type = [blue..yellow]
16304 @end smallexample
16305
16306 @noindent
16307 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16308 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16309 their @code{C} counterparts.
16310
16311 @smallexample
16312 VAR
16313 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16314 BEGIN
16315 s[1] := 1 ;
16316 @end smallexample
16317
16318 @smallexample
16319 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16320 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16321 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16322 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16323 @end smallexample
16324
16325 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16326 pointer types as shown in this example:
16327
16328 @smallexample
16329 VAR
16330 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16331 BEGIN
16332 NEW(s) ;
16333 s^[1] := 1 ;
16334 @end smallexample
16335
16336 @noindent
16337 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16338
16339 @smallexample
16340 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16341 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16342 @end smallexample
16343
16344 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16345 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16346 types:
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 TYPE
16350 foo = RECORD
16351 f1: CARDINAL ;
16352 f2: CHAR ;
16353 f3: myarray ;
16354 END ;
16355
16356 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16357 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16358 VAR
16359 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 @noindent
16363 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16364 below.
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16368 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16369 f1 : CARDINAL;
16370 f2 : CHAR;
16371 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16372 END
16373 @end smallexample
16374
16375 @node M2 Defaults
16376 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16377 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16378
16379 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16380 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16381 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16382 selected the working language.
16383
16384 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16385 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16386 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16387 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16388
16389 @node Deviations
16390 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16391 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16392
16393 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16394 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16395
16396 @itemize @bullet
16397 @item
16398 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16399 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16400 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16401 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16402 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16403 returned a pointer.)
16404
16405 @item
16406 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16407 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16408 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16409 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16410
16411 @item
16412 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16413 argument.
16414
16415 @item
16416 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16417 @end itemize
16418
16419 @node M2 Checks
16420 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16421 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16422
16423 @quotation
16424 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16425 range checking.
16426 @end quotation
16427 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16428
16429 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16430
16431 @itemize @bullet
16432 @item
16433 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16434 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16435
16436 @item
16437 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16438 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16439 @end itemize
16440
16441 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16442 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16443
16444 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16445 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16446
16447 @node M2 Scope
16448 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16449 @cindex scope
16450 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16451 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16452 @ifinfo
16453 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16454 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16455 @end ifinfo
16456 @ifnotinfo
16457 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16458 @end ifnotinfo
16459
16460 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16461 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16462 similar syntax:
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465
16466 @var{module} . @var{id}
16467 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16468 @end smallexample
16469
16470 @noindent
16471 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16472 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16473 identifier within your program, except another module.
16474
16475 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16476 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16477 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16478 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16479
16480 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16481 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16482 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16483 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16484 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16485 @var{module}.
16486
16487 @node GDB/M2
16488 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16489
16490 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16491 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16492 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16493 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16494 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16495 analogue in Modula-2.
16496
16497 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16498 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16499 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16500 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16501 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16502 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16503
16504 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16505 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16506 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16507
16508 @node Ada
16509 @subsection Ada
16510 @cindex Ada
16511
16512 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16513 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16514 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16515 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16516 to be difficult.
16517
16518
16519 @cindex expressions in Ada
16520 @menu
16521 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16522 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16523 in @value{GDBN}.
16524 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16525 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16526 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16527 subprograms.
16528 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16529 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16530 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16531 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16532 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16533 Profile
16534 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16535 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16536 @end menu
16537
16538 @node Ada Mode Intro
16539 @subsubsection Introduction
16540 @cindex Ada mode, general
16541
16542 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16543 syntax, with some extensions.
16544 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16545
16546 @itemize @bullet
16547 @item
16548 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16549 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16550 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16551 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16552
16553 @item
16554 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16555 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16556
16557 @item
16558 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16559 @end itemize
16560
16561 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16562 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16563 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16564 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16565 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16566
16567 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16568 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16569 was translated from an Ada source file.
16570
16571 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16572 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16573 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16574 middle (to allow based literals).
16575
16576 @node Omissions from Ada
16577 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16578 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16579
16580 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16581
16582 @itemize @bullet
16583 @item
16584 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16585
16586 @itemize @minus
16587 @item
16588 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16589 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16590
16591 @item
16592 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16593
16594 @item
16595 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16596
16597 @item
16598 @t{'Tag}.
16599
16600 @item
16601 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16602 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16603
16604 @item
16605 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16606 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16607
16608 @item
16609 @t{'Address}.
16610 @end itemize
16611
16612 @item
16613 The names in
16614 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16615 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16616 not currently available.
16617
16618 @item
16619 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16620 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16621 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16622 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16623 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16624 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16625 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16626 indeterminate values.
16627
16628 @item
16629 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16630 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16631 are not implemented.
16632
16633 @item
16634 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16635 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16636 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16637 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16638 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16639
16640 @smallexample
16641 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16642 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16643 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16644 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16645 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16646 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16647 @end smallexample
16648
16649 Changing a
16650 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16651 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16652 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16653 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16654 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16655 declared to have a type such as:
16656
16657 @smallexample
16658 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16659 Id : Integer;
16660 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16661 end record;
16662 @end smallexample
16663
16664 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16665 assignments:
16666
16667 @smallexample
16668 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16669 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16670 @end smallexample
16671
16672 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16673 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16674 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16675 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16676 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16677 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16678 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16679 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16680
16681 @item
16682 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16683
16684 @item
16685 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16686 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16687 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16688 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16689 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16690 the proper resolution.
16691
16692 @item
16693 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16694
16695 @item
16696 Entry calls are not implemented.
16697
16698 @item
16699 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16700 formats are not supported.
16701
16702 @item
16703 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16704
16705 @item
16706 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16707 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16708 context.
16709 Should your program
16710 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16711 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16712 @end itemize
16713
16714 @node Additions to Ada
16715 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16716 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16717
16718 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16719 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16720
16721 @itemize @bullet
16722 @item
16723 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16724 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16725 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16726 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16727 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16728 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16729 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16730 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16731
16732 @item
16733 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16734 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16735 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16736
16737 @item
16738 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16739 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16740
16741 @item
16742 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16743 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16744 @end itemize
16745
16746 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16747 additions specific to Ada:
16748
16749 @itemize @bullet
16750 @item
16751 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16752 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16753
16754 @smallexample
16755 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16756 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16757 @end smallexample
16758
16759 @item
16760 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16761 the value of its right-hand operand.
16762 This allows, for example,
16763 complex conditional breaks:
16764
16765 @smallexample
16766 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16767 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16768 @end smallexample
16769
16770 @item
16771 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16772 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16773 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16774 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16775 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16776 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16777 in strings. For example,
16778 @smallexample
16779 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16780 @end smallexample
16781 @noindent
16782 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16783 after each period.
16784
16785 @item
16786 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16787 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16788 to write
16789
16790 @smallexample
16791 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16792 @end smallexample
16793
16794 @item
16795 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16796 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16797 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16798 of 3 might print as
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 @noindent
16805 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16806 clause.
16807
16808 @item
16809 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16810 multi-character subsequence of
16811 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16812 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16813 in place of @t{a'length}.
16814
16815 @item
16816 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16817 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16818 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16819 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16820 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16821 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16822 For example,
16823 @smallexample
16824 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16825 @end smallexample
16826
16827 @item
16828 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16829 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16830 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16831 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16832 object.
16833
16834 @end itemize
16835
16836 @node Overloading support for Ada
16837 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16838 @cindex overloading, Ada
16839
16840 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16841 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16842 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16843 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16844 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16845 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16846
16847 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16848 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16849 use, for instance:
16850
16851 @smallexample
16852 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16853 Multiple matches for f
16854 [0] cancel
16855 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16856 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16857 >
16858 @end smallexample
16859
16860 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16861 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16862 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16863
16864 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16865 case:
16866
16867 @table @code
16868
16869 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16870 @item set ada print-signatures
16871 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16872 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16873 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16874
16875 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16876 @item show ada print-signatures
16877 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16878 overloads selection menu.
16879 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16880
16881 @end table
16882
16883 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16884 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16885
16886 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16887 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16888 before reaching the main procedure.
16889 As defined in the Ada Reference
16890 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16891 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16892 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16893 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16894
16895 @node Ada Exceptions
16896 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16897
16898 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16899
16900 @table @code
16901 @kindex info exceptions
16902 @item info exceptions
16903 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16904 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16905 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16906 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16907 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16908 @end table
16909
16910 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16911 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16912 argument.
16913
16914 @smallexample
16915 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16916 All defined Ada exceptions:
16917 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16918 program_error: 0x613d20
16919 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16920 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16921 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16922 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16923 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16924 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16925 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16926 @end smallexample
16927
16928 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16929 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16930
16931 @node Ada Tasks
16932 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16933 @cindex Ada, tasking
16934
16935 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16936 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16937
16938 @table @code
16939 @kindex info tasks
16940 @item info tasks
16941 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16942
16943
16944 @smallexample
16945 @iftex
16946 @leftskip=0.5cm
16947 @end iftex
16948 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16949 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16950 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16951 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16952 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16953 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16954
16955 @end smallexample
16956
16957 @noindent
16958 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16959 task currently being inspected.
16960
16961 @table @asis
16962 @item ID
16963 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16964
16965 @item TID
16966 The Ada task ID.
16967
16968 @item P-ID
16969 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16970
16971 @item Pri
16972 The base priority of the task.
16973
16974 @item State
16975 Current state of the task.
16976
16977 @table @code
16978 @item Unactivated
16979 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16980 executing.
16981
16982 @item Runnable
16983 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16984 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16985
16986 @item Terminated
16987 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16988 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16989 terminated themselves.
16990
16991 @item Child Activation Wait
16992 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16993
16994 @item Accept Statement
16995 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16996
16997 @item Waiting on entry call
16998 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16999
17000 @item Async Select Wait
17001 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17002 select statement.
17003
17004 @item Delay Sleep
17005 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17006 alternative open.
17007
17008 @item Child Termination Wait
17009 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17010 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17011 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17012
17013 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17014 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17015 finish terminating.
17016
17017 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17018 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17019 @end table
17020
17021 @item Name
17022 Name of the task in the program.
17023
17024 @end table
17025
17026 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17027 @item info task @var{taskno}
17028 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17029 the following example:
17030 @smallexample
17031 @iftex
17032 @leftskip=0.5cm
17033 @end iftex
17034 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17035 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17036 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17037 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17038 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17039 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17040 Name: task_1
17041 Thread: 0x807f378
17042 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17043 Base Priority: 15
17044 State: Runnable
17045 @end smallexample
17046
17047 @item task
17048 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17049 @cindex current Ada task ID
17050 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17051
17052 @smallexample
17053 @iftex
17054 @leftskip=0.5cm
17055 @end iftex
17056 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17057 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17058 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17059 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17060 (@value{GDBP}) task
17061 [Current task is 2]
17062 @end smallexample
17063
17064 @item task @var{taskno}
17065 @cindex Ada task switching
17066 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17067 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17068 from the current task to the given task.
17069
17070 @smallexample
17071 @iftex
17072 @leftskip=0.5cm
17073 @end iftex
17074 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17075 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17076 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17077 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17078 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17079 [Switching to task 1]
17080 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17081 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17082 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17083 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17084 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17085 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17086 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17087 @end smallexample
17088
17089 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17090 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17091 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17092 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17093 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17094 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17095 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17096 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17097 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17098
17099 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17100 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17101 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17102 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17103 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17104
17105 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17106 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17107 program.
17108
17109 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17110 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17111 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17112
17113 For example,
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 @iftex
17117 @leftskip=0.5cm
17118 @end iftex
17119 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17120 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17121 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17122 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17123 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17124 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17125 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17126 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17127 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17128 Continuing.
17129 task # 1 running
17130 task # 2 running
17131
17132 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17133 15 flush;
17134 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17135 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17136 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17137 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17138 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17139 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17140 @end smallexample
17141 @end table
17142
17143 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17144 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17145 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17146
17147 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17148 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17149 the platform being used.
17150 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17151 switching is not supported.
17152
17153 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17154 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17155 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17156 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17157 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17158 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17159
17160 @node Ravenscar Profile
17161 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17162 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17163
17164 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17165 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17166 requirements.
17167
17168 @table @code
17169 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17170 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17171 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17172 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17173 Profile. This is the default.
17174
17175 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17176 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17177 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17178 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17179 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17180 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17181 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17182
17183 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17184 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17185 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17186 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17187
17188 @end table
17189
17190 @node Ada Settings
17191 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17192 @cindex Ada settings
17193
17194 @table @code
17195 @kindex set varsize-limit
17196 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17197 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17198 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17199 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17200 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17201 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17202 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17203
17204 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17205 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17206 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17207 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17208 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17209 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17210 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17211 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17212 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17213 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17214 size is less than @var{size}.
17215
17216 @kindex show varsize-limit
17217 @item show varsize-limit
17218 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17219 @end table
17220
17221 @node Ada Glitches
17222 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17223 @cindex Ada, problems
17224
17225 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17226 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17227 @value{GDBN},
17228 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17229 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17230
17231 @itemize @bullet
17232 @item
17233 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17234 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17235
17236 @item
17237 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17238 argument lists are treated as positional).
17239
17240 @item
17241 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17242
17243 @item
17244 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17245 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17246 the host machine.
17247
17248 @item
17249 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17250 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17251 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17252 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17253 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17254 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17255 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17256 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17257 you can usually resolve the confusion
17258 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17259 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17260 @end itemize
17261
17262 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17263 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17264 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17265 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17266 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17267 enabled.
17268
17269 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17270 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17271 @table @code
17272
17273 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17274 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17275 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17276 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17277 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17278 This is the default.
17279
17280 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17281 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17282 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17283 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17284 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17285 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17286 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17287
17288 @end table
17289
17290 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17291 @cindex GNAT encoding
17292 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17293 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17294 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17295 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17296 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17297 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17298
17299 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17300 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17301 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17302 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17303 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17304 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17305 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17306 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17307
17308 @table @code
17309
17310 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17311 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17312 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17313 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17314
17315 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17316 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17317 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17318
17319 @end table
17320
17321 @node Unsupported Languages
17322 @section Unsupported Languages
17323
17324 @cindex unsupported languages
17325 @cindex minimal language
17326 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17327 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17328 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17329 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17330 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17331 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17332
17333 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17334 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17335 language.
17336
17337 @node Symbols
17338 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17339
17340 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17341 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17342 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17343 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17344 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17345 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17346 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17347
17348 @cindex symbol names
17349 @cindex names of symbols
17350 @cindex quoting names
17351 @anchor{quoting names}
17352 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17353 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17354 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17355 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17356 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17357 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17358 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17359 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17360
17361 @smallexample
17362 p 'foo.c'::x
17363 @end smallexample
17364
17365 @noindent
17366 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17367
17368 @table @code
17369 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17370 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17371 @kindex set case-sensitive
17372 @item set case-sensitive on
17373 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17374 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17375 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17376 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17377 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17378 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17379 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17380 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17381 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17382 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17383 case-insensitive matches.
17384
17385 @kindex show case-sensitive
17386 @item show case-sensitive
17387 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17388 lookups.
17389
17390 @kindex set print type methods
17391 @item set print type methods
17392 @itemx set print type methods on
17393 @itemx set print type methods off
17394 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17395 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17396 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17397 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17398 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17399 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17400
17401 @kindex show print type methods
17402 @item show print type methods
17403 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17404 classes.
17405
17406 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17407 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17408 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17409 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17410 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17411 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17412 types defined in classes.
17413
17414 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17415 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17416 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17417 printing classes.
17418
17419 @kindex set print type typedefs
17420 @item set print type typedefs
17421 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17422 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17423
17424 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17425 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17426 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17427 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17428 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17429 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17430 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17431 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17432 types.
17433
17434 @kindex show print type typedefs
17435 @item show print type typedefs
17436 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17437 printing classes.
17438
17439 @kindex info address
17440 @cindex address of a symbol
17441 @item info address @var{symbol}
17442 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17443 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17444 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17445 is always stored.
17446
17447 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17448 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17449 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17450
17451 @kindex info symbol
17452 @cindex symbol from address
17453 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17454 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17455 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17456 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17457 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17458
17459 @smallexample
17460 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17461 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17462 @end smallexample
17463
17464 @noindent
17465 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17466 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17467
17468 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17469 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17470
17471 @smallexample
17472 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17473 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17474 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17475 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17476 @end smallexample
17477
17478 @kindex demangle
17479 @cindex demangle
17480 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17481 Demangle @var{name}.
17482 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17483 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17484
17485 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17486 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17487
17488 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17489 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17490
17491 @kindex whatis
17492 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17493 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17494 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17495 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17496
17497 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17498 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17499 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17500
17501 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17502 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17503 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17504 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17505 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17506 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17507 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17508 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17509 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17510
17511 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17512 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17513 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17514 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17515 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17516 unroll it.
17517
17518 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17519 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17520 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17521
17522 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17523 Available flags are:
17524
17525 @table @code
17526 @item r
17527 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17528 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17529 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17530
17531 @item m
17532 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17533
17534 @item M
17535 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17536 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17537
17538 @item t
17539 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17540 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17541 names are substituted when printing other types.
17542
17543 @item T
17544 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17545 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17546
17547 @item o
17548 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17549 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17550
17551 For example, given the following declarations:
17552
17553 @smallexample
17554 struct tuv
17555 @{
17556 int a1;
17557 char *a2;
17558 int a3;
17559 @};
17560
17561 struct xyz
17562 @{
17563 int f1;
17564 char f2;
17565 void *f3;
17566 struct tuv f4;
17567 @};
17568
17569 union qwe
17570 @{
17571 struct tuv fff1;
17572 struct xyz fff2;
17573 @};
17574
17575 struct tyu
17576 @{
17577 int a1 : 1;
17578 int a2 : 3;
17579 int a3 : 23;
17580 char a4 : 2;
17581 int64_t a5;
17582 int a6 : 5;
17583 int64_t a7 : 3;
17584 @};
17585 @end smallexample
17586
17587 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17588
17589 @smallexample
17590 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17591 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17592 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17593 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17594 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17595 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17596
17597 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17598 @}
17599 @end smallexample
17600
17601 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17602 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17603 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17604 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17605 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17606 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17607 its fields.
17608
17609 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17610
17611 @smallexample
17612 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17613 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17614 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17615 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17616 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17617 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17618 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17619
17620 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17621 @} fff1;
17622 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17623 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17624 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17625 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17626 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17627 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17628 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17629 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17630 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17631 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17632
17633 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17634 @} f4;
17635
17636 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17637 @} fff2;
17638
17639 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17640 @}
17641 @end smallexample
17642
17643 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17644 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17645 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17646 of these structures' fields.
17647
17648 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17649 bitfields:
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17653 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17654 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17655 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17656 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17657 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17658 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17659 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17660 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17661 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17662 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17663
17664 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17665 @}
17666 @end smallexample
17667
17668 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17669 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17670 @end table
17671
17672 @kindex ptype
17673 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17674 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17675 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17676 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17677
17678 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17679 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17680 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17681 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17682 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17683 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17684 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17685 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17686
17687 For example, for this variable declaration:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 typedef double real_t;
17691 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17692 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17693 complex_t var;
17694 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17695 @end smallexample
17696
17697 @noindent
17698 the two commands give this output:
17699
17700 @smallexample
17701 @group
17702 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17703 type = complex_t
17704 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17705 type = struct complex @{
17706 real_t real;
17707 double imag;
17708 @}
17709 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17710 type = struct complex
17711 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17712 type = struct complex
17713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17714 type = struct complex @{
17715 real_t real;
17716 double imag;
17717 @}
17718 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17719 type = real_t *
17720 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17721 type = double *
17722 @end group
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 @noindent
17726 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17727 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17728
17729 @cindex incomplete type
17730 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17731 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17732 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17733 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17734 given these declarations:
17735
17736 @smallexample
17737 struct foo;
17738 struct foo *fooptr;
17739 @end smallexample
17740
17741 @noindent
17742 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17743
17744 @smallexample
17745 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17746 $1 = <incomplete type>
17747 @end smallexample
17748
17749 @noindent
17750 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17751 completely specified.
17752
17753 @cindex unknown type
17754 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17755 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17756 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17757 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17758 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17759 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17760 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17761 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17762
17763 @smallexample
17764 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17765 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17766 @end smallexample
17767
17768 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17769 of such variables.
17770
17771 @kindex info types
17772 @item info types @var{regexp}
17773 @itemx info types
17774 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17775 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17776 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17777 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17778 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17779 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17780 name is @code{value}.
17781
17782 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17783 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17784 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17785
17786 @kindex info type-printers
17787 @item info type-printers
17788 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17789 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17790 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17791 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17792 type printers.
17793
17794 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17795
17796 @kindex enable type-printer
17797 @kindex disable type-printer
17798 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17799 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17800 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17801
17802 @kindex info scope
17803 @cindex local variables
17804 @item info scope @var{location}
17805 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17806 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17807 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17808 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17809 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17813 Scope for command_line_handler:
17814 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17815 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17816 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17817 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17818 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17819 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17820 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17821 @end smallexample
17822
17823 @noindent
17824 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17825 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17826 collect}.
17827
17828 @kindex info source
17829 @item info source
17830 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17831 the function containing the current point of execution:
17832 @itemize @bullet
17833 @item
17834 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17835 @item
17836 the directory it was compiled in,
17837 @item
17838 its length, in lines,
17839 @item
17840 which programming language it is written in,
17841 @item
17842 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17843 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17844 @item
17845 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17846 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17847 @item
17848 whether the debugging information includes information about
17849 preprocessor macros.
17850 @end itemize
17851
17852
17853 @kindex info sources
17854 @item info sources
17855 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17856 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17857 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17858
17859 @kindex info functions
17860 @item info functions
17861 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17862 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17863 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17864 number.
17865
17866 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17867 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17868 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17869 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17870 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17871 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17872 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17873 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17874
17875 @kindex info variables
17876 @item info variables
17877 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17878 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17879 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17880 their respective source line numbers.
17881
17882 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17883 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17884 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17885 @var{regexp}.
17886
17887 @kindex info classes
17888 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17889 @item info classes
17890 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17891 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17892 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17893 expression.
17894
17895 @kindex info selectors
17896 @item info selectors
17897 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17898 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17899 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17900 expression.
17901
17902 @ignore
17903 This was never implemented.
17904 @kindex info methods
17905 @item info methods
17906 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17907 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17908 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17909 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17910 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17911 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17912 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17913 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17914 @end ignore
17915
17916 @cindex opaque data types
17917 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17918 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17919 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17920 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17921 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17922 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17923 another source file. The default is on.
17924
17925 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17926 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17927
17928 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17929 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17930 is printed as follows:
17931 @smallexample
17932 @{<no data fields>@}
17933 @end smallexample
17934
17935 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17936 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17937 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17938
17939 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17940 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17941 @item set print symbol-loading
17942 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17943 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17944 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17945 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17946 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17947 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17948 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17949 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17950 can be annoying.
17951 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17952 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17953 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17954 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17955
17956 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17957 @item show print symbol-loading
17958 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17959 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17960
17961 @kindex maint print symbols
17962 @cindex symbol dump
17963 @kindex maint print psymbols
17964 @cindex partial symbol dump
17965 @kindex maint print msymbols
17966 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17967 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17968 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17969 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17970 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17971 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17972 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17973 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17974 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17975 that objfile.
17976 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17977 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17978 @code{main}.
17979 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17980 source file.
17981
17982 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17983 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17984 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17985 tables.
17986 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17987 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17988 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17989 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17990 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17991 ``ELF symbols''.
17992
17993 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17994 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17995
17996 @kindex maint info symtabs
17997 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17998 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17999 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18000 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18001 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18002 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18003 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18004
18005 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18006 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18007 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18008 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18009 structure in more detail. For example:
18010
18011 @smallexample
18012 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18013 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18014 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18015 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18016 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18017 readin no
18018 fullname (null)
18019 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18020 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18021 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18022 dependencies (none)
18023 @}
18024 @}
18025 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18026 (@value{GDBP})
18027 @end smallexample
18028 @noindent
18029 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18030 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18031 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18032 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18033 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18034
18035 @smallexample
18036 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18037 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18038 line 1574.
18039 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18040 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18041 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18042 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18043 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18044 dirname (null)
18045 fullname (null)
18046 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18047 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18048 debugformat DWARF 2
18049 @}
18050 @}
18051 (@value{GDBP})
18052 @end smallexample
18053
18054 @kindex maint info line-table
18055 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18056 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18057 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18058
18059 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18060 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18061 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18062
18063 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18064 @cindex symbol cache size
18065 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18066 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18067 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18068 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18069 with different sizes.
18070
18071 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18072 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18073 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18074
18075 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18076 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18077 @item maint print symbol-cache
18078 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18079 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18080
18081 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18082 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18083 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18084 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18085 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18086
18087 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18088 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18089 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18090 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18091 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18092 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18093
18094 @end table
18095
18096 @node Altering
18097 @chapter Altering Execution
18098
18099 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18100 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18101 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18102 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18103 program.
18104
18105 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18106 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18107 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18108
18109 @menu
18110 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18111 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18112 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18113 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18114 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18115 * Patching:: Patching your program
18116 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18117 @end menu
18118
18119 @node Assignment
18120 @section Assignment to Variables
18121
18122 @cindex assignment
18123 @cindex setting variables
18124 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18125 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18126
18127 @smallexample
18128 print x=4
18129 @end smallexample
18130
18131 @noindent
18132 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18133 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18134 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18135 information on operators in supported languages.
18136
18137 @kindex set variable
18138 @cindex variables, setting
18139 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18140 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18141 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18142 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18143 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18144
18145 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18146 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18147 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18148 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18149 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18150 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18151 command @code{set width}:
18152
18153 @smallexample
18154 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18155 type = double
18156 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18157 $4 = 13
18158 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18159 Invalid syntax in expression.
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 @noindent
18163 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18164 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18165
18166 @smallexample
18167 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18168 @end smallexample
18169
18170 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18171 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18172 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18173 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18174 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18175 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18176
18177 @smallexample
18178 @group
18179 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18180 type = double
18181 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18182 $1 = 1
18183 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18184 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18185 $2 = 1
18186 (@value{GDBP}) r
18187 The program being debugged has been started already.
18188 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18189 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18190 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18191 Invalid bfd target.
18192 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18193 The current BFD target is "=4".
18194 @end group
18195 @end smallexample
18196
18197 @noindent
18198 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18199 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18200 @code{g}, use
18201
18202 @smallexample
18203 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18204 @end smallexample
18205
18206 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18207 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18208 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18209 same length or shorter.
18210 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18211 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18212
18213 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18214 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18215 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18216 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18217 and representation in memory), and
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18221 @end smallexample
18222
18223 @noindent
18224 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18225
18226 @node Jumping
18227 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18228
18229 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18230 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18231 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18232
18233 @table @code
18234 @kindex jump
18235 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18236 @item jump @var{location}
18237 @itemx j @var{location}
18238 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18239 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18240 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18241 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18242 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18243
18244 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18245 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18246 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18247 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18248 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18249 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18250 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18251 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18252 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18253 @end table
18254
18255 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18256 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18257 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18258 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18259 example,
18260
18261 @smallexample
18262 set $pc = 0x485
18263 @end smallexample
18264
18265 @noindent
18266 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18267 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18268 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18269
18270 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18271 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18272 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18273 detail.
18274
18275 @c @group
18276 @node Signaling
18277 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18278 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18279
18280 @table @code
18281 @kindex signal
18282 @item signal @var{signal}
18283 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18284 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18285 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18286 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18287
18288 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18289 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18290 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18291 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18292 signal.
18293
18294 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18295 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18296 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18297 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18298 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18299 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18300 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18301 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18302
18303 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18304 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18305 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18306 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18307 passes the signal directly to your program.
18308
18309 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18310 after executing the command.
18311
18312 @kindex queue-signal
18313 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18314 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18315 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18316 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18317 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18318 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18319 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18320 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18321 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18322
18323 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18324 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18325 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18326 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18327 @code{continue} command.
18328
18329 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18330 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18331 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18332 (@pxref{Signals}).
18333 @end table
18334 @c @end group
18335
18336 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18337 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18338
18339 @node Returning
18340 @section Returning from a Function
18341
18342 @table @code
18343 @cindex returning from a function
18344 @kindex return
18345 @item return
18346 @itemx return @var{expression}
18347 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18348 command. If you give an
18349 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18350 value.
18351 @end table
18352
18353 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18354 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18355 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18356 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18357
18358 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18359 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18360 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18361 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18362 of functions.
18363
18364 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18365 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18366 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18367 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18368 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18369
18370 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18371 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18372 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18373 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18374 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18375 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18376 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18377 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18378 assignment into the right register(s).
18379
18380 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18381 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18382 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18383 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18384 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18385 into a @code{long long int}:
18386
18387 @smallexample
18388 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18389 29 return 31;
18390 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18391 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18392 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18393 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18394 (@value{GDBP})
18395 @end smallexample
18396
18397 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18398 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18399 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18400 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18401 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18402 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18403 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18404 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18405
18406 @smallexample
18407 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18408 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18409 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18410 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18411 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18412 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18413 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18414 (@value{GDBP})
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 @node Calling
18418 @section Calling Program Functions
18419
18420 @table @code
18421 @cindex calling functions
18422 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18423 @item print @var{expr}
18424 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18425 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18426 debugged.
18427
18428 @kindex call
18429 @item call @var{expr}
18430 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18431 returned values.
18432
18433 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18434 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18435 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18436 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18437 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18438 value history.
18439 @end table
18440
18441 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18442 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18443 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18444 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18445
18446 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18447 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18448 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18449 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18450 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18451 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18452 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18453 in that case is controlled by the
18454 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18455
18456 @table @code
18457 @item set unwindonsignal
18458 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18459 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18460 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18461 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18462 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18463 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18464 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18465 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18466 received.
18467
18468 @item show unwindonsignal
18469 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18470 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18471 @value{GDBN}.
18472
18473 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18474 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18475 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18476 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18477 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18478 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18479 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18480 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18481 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18482 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18483
18484 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18485 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18486 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18487 @value{GDBN}.
18488
18489 @end table
18490
18491 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18492
18493 @cindex no debug info functions
18494 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18495 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18496 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18497 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18498 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18499 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18500
18501 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18502 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18503 declared return type. For example:
18504
18505 @smallexample
18506 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18507 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18508 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18509 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18510 @end smallexample
18511
18512 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18513 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18514 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18515 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18516
18517 @smallexample
18518 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18519 @end smallexample
18520
18521 @noindent
18522 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18523
18524 @smallexample
18525 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 @noindent
18529 these calls are equivalent:
18530
18531 @smallexample
18532 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18533 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18534 @end smallexample
18535
18536 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18537 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18538 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18539 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18540 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18541 float parameters, and no debug info:
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 float
18545 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18546 float v1, v2;
18547 @{
18548 return v1 * v2;
18549 @}
18550 @end smallexample
18551
18552 @noindent
18553 you call it like this:
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18557 @end smallexample
18558
18559 @node Patching
18560 @section Patching Programs
18561
18562 @cindex patching binaries
18563 @cindex writing into executables
18564 @cindex writing into corefiles
18565
18566 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18567 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18568 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18569 patching your program's binary.
18570
18571 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18572 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18573 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18574 repairs.
18575
18576 @table @code
18577 @kindex set write
18578 @item set write on
18579 @itemx set write off
18580 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18581 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18582 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18583
18584 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18585 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18586 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18587
18588 @item show write
18589 @kindex show write
18590 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18591 as well as reading.
18592 @end table
18593
18594 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18595 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18596 @cindex injecting code
18597 @cindex writing into executables
18598 @cindex compiling code
18599
18600 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18601 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18602 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18603 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18604
18605 @table @code
18606 @kindex compile code
18607 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18608 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18609 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18610 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18611 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18612 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18613 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18614 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18615 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18616 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18617 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18618 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18619
18620 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18621 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18622 E.g.:
18623
18624 @smallexample
18625 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18626 @end smallexample
18627
18628 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18629 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18630 from actual source code. E.g.:
18631
18632 @smallexample
18633 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18634 @end smallexample
18635
18636 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18637 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18638 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18639 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18640 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18641 editor.
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 compile code
18645 >printf ("hello\n");
18646 >printf ("world\n");
18647 >end
18648 @end smallexample
18649
18650 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18651 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18652 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18653 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18654 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18655 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18656 inferior symbols otherwise.
18657
18658 @kindex compile file
18659 @item compile file @var{filename}
18660 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18661 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18662
18663 @smallexample
18664 compile file /home/user/example.c
18665 @end smallexample
18666 @end table
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @item compile print @var{expr}
18670 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18671 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18672 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18673 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18674 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18675 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18676 Formats}.
18677
18678 @item compile print
18679 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18680 @cindex reprint the last value
18681 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18682 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18683 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18684 multiple-line editor.
18685 @end table
18686
18687 @noindent
18688 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18689
18690 @table @code
18691 @anchor{set debug compile}
18692 @item set debug compile
18693 @cindex compile command debugging info
18694 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18695 injecting the code. The default is off.
18696
18697 @item show debug compile
18698 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18699 compiling and injecting the code.
18700
18701 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18702 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18703 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18704 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18705 The default is off.
18706
18707 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18708 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18709 C@t{++} type conversion.
18710 @end table
18711
18712 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18713
18714 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18715 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18716 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18717 injecting process.
18718
18719 @noindent
18720 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18721
18722 @table @asis
18723 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18724 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18725 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18726 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18727
18728 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18729 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18730 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18731 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18732 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18733 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18734 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18735 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18736
18737 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18738 @end table
18739
18740 @noindent
18741 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18742
18743 @table @code
18744 @item set compile-args
18745 @cindex compile command options override
18746 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18747 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18748 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18749 compilation.
18750
18751 @item show compile-args
18752 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18753 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18754 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18755 @end table
18756
18757 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18758
18759 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18760 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18761 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18762
18763 @table @asis
18764 @item C code examples and caveats
18765 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18766 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18767 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18768 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18769 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18770
18771 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18772 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18773 much like any other normal debugging session.
18774
18775 @smallexample
18776 void function1 (void)
18777 @{
18778 int i = 42;
18779 printf ("function 1\n");
18780 @}
18781
18782 void function2 (void)
18783 @{
18784 int j = 12;
18785 function1 ();
18786 @}
18787
18788 int main(void)
18789 @{
18790 int k = 6;
18791 int *p;
18792 function2 ();
18793 return 0;
18794 @}
18795 @end smallexample
18796
18797 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18798 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18799 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18800
18801 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18802 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18803 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18804 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18805 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18806
18807 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18808 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18809 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18810 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18811 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18812 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18813 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18814 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18815 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18816 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18817
18818 @smallexample
18819 compile code k = 3;
18820 @end smallexample
18821
18822 @noindent
18823 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18824 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18825 @code{compile} command changes it.
18826
18827 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18828 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18829 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18830 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18831 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18832
18833 @smallexample
18834 compile code j = 3;
18835 @end smallexample
18836
18837 @noindent
18838 will result in a compilation error message.
18839
18840 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18841 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18842 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18843
18844 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18845 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18846 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18847 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18854 command has completed:
18855
18856 @smallexample
18857 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860 @noindent
18861 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18862 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18863 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18864 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18865 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18866
18867 @smallexample
18868 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18872 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18873 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18874 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18875 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18876 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18877 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18878 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18879
18880 @smallexample
18881 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18882 @end smallexample
18883
18884 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18885 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18886 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18887 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18888 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18889 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18890 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18891
18892 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18893 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18894 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18895 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18896 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18897 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18898
18899 @smallexample
18900 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18901 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18902 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18903 Compilation failed.
18904 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18905 42
18906 @end smallexample
18907
18908 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18909 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18910 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18911 will print to the console.
18912 @end table
18913
18914 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18915
18916 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18917 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18918 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18919 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18920 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18921 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18922 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18923 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18924
18925
18926 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18927 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18928 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18929 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18930 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18931 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18932 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18933
18934 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18935 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18936 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18937 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18938 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18939 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18940 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18941
18942 @table @code
18943 @item set compile-gcc
18944 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18945 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18946 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18947 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18948 default.
18949
18950 @item show compile-gcc
18951 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18952 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18953 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18954 @end table
18955
18956 @node GDB Files
18957 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18958
18959 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18960 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18961 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18962 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18963
18964 @menu
18965 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18966 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18967 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18968 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18969 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18970 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18971 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18972 @end menu
18973
18974 @node Files
18975 @section Commands to Specify Files
18976
18977 @cindex symbol table
18978 @cindex core dump file
18979
18980 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18981 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18982 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18983 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18984
18985 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18986 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18987 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18988 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18989 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18990 new files are useful.
18991
18992 @table @code
18993 @cindex executable file
18994 @kindex file
18995 @item file @var{filename}
18996 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18997 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18998 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18999 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19000 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19001 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19002 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19003 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19004
19005 @cindex unlinked object files
19006 @cindex patching object files
19007 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19008 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19009 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19010 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19011 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19012 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19013 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19014 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19015
19016 @item file
19017 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19018 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19019
19020 @kindex exec-file
19021 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19022 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19023 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19024 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19025 discard information on the executable file.
19026
19027 @kindex symbol-file
19028 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19029 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19030 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19031 table and program to run from the same file.
19032
19033 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19034 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19035 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19036 enabled.
19037
19038 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19039 program's symbol table.
19040
19041 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19042 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19043 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19044 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19045 @value{GDBN}.
19046
19047 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19048 executing it once.
19049
19050 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19051 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19052 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19053 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19054 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19055 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19056 optimized code.
19057
19058 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19059 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19060 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19061 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19062 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19063
19064 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19065 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19066 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19067 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19068 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19069 Warnings and Messages}.)
19070
19071 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19072 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19073 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19074 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19075 in stabs format.
19076
19077 @kindex readnow
19078 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19079 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19080 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19081 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19082 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19083 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19084 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19085 entire symbol table available.
19086
19087 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19088 @cindex never read symbols
19089 @cindex symbols, never read
19090 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19091 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19092 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19093 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19094 @xref{--readnever}.
19095
19096 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19097 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19098 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19099 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19100 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19101 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19102 @c files.
19103
19104 @kindex core-file
19105 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19106 @itemx core
19107 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19108 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19109 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19110 executable file itself for other parts.
19111
19112 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19113 to be used.
19114
19115 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19116 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19117 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19118 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19119 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19120
19121 @kindex add-symbol-file
19122 @cindex dynamic linking
19123 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19124 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19125 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19126 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19127 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19128 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19129 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19130 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19131 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19132 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19133 can be given as an expression.
19134
19135 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19136 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19137 specified explicitly.
19138
19139 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19140 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19141 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19142 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19143
19144 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19145
19146 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19147 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19148 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19149 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19150 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19151 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19152 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19153 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19154 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19155
19156 @itemize @bullet
19157 @item
19158 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19159 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19160 @item
19161 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19162 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19163 @item
19164 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19165 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19166 @end itemize
19167
19168 @noindent
19169 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19170 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19171 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19172 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19173 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19174 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19175 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19176 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19177 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19178 way.
19179
19180 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19181
19182 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19183 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19184 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19185 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19186 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19187 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19188
19189 @smallexample
19190 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19191 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19192 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19193 (y or n) y
19194 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19195 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19196 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19197 (gdb)
19198 @end smallexample
19199
19200
19201 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19202
19203 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19204 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19205 @cindex load symbols from memory
19206 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19207 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19208 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19209 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19210 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19211 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19212 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19213 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19214 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19215
19216 @kindex section
19217 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19218 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19219 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19220 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19221 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19222 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19223 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19224 their addresses.
19225
19226 @kindex info files
19227 @kindex info target
19228 @item info files
19229 @itemx info target
19230 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19231 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19232 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19233 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19234 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19235 current ones.
19236
19237 @kindex maint info sections
19238 @item maint info sections
19239 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19240 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19241 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19242 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19243 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19244 may be arbitrarily combined):
19245
19246 @table @code
19247 @item ALLOBJ
19248 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19249 @item @var{sections}
19250 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19251 @item @var{section-flags}
19252 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19253 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19254 @table @code
19255 @item ALLOC
19256 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19257 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19258 @item LOAD
19259 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19260 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19261 @item RELOC
19262 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19263 @item READONLY
19264 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19265 @item CODE
19266 Section contains executable code only.
19267 @item DATA
19268 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19269 @item ROM
19270 Section will reside in ROM.
19271 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19272 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19273 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19274 Section is not empty.
19275 @item NEVER_LOAD
19276 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19277 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19278 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19279 COFF shared library information.
19280 @item IS_COMMON
19281 Section contains common symbols.
19282 @end table
19283 @end table
19284 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19285 @cindex read-only sections
19286 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19287 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19288 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19289 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19290 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19291 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19292 enhancement to debugging performance.
19293
19294 The default is off.
19295
19296 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19297 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19298 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19299 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19300
19301 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19302 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19303 @end table
19304
19305 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19306 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19307 name and remembers it that way.
19308
19309 @cindex shared libraries
19310 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19311 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19312 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19313 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19314
19315 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19316 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19317
19318 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19319 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19320 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19321 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19322 debugging a core file).
19323
19324 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19325 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19326 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19327
19328 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19329 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19330 particularly large or there are many of them.
19331
19332 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19333 commands:
19334
19335 @table @code
19336 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19337 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19338 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19339 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19340 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19341 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19342 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19343 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19344
19345 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19346 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19347 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19348 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19349 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19350 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19351 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19352 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19353 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19354
19355 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19356 @item show auto-solib-add
19357 Display the current autoloading mode.
19358 @end table
19359
19360 @cindex load shared library
19361 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19362 command:
19363
19364 @table @code
19365 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19366 @kindex info share
19367 @item info share @var{regex}
19368 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19369 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19370 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19371 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19372
19373 @kindex info dll
19374 @item info dll @var{regex}
19375 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19376
19377 @kindex sharedlibrary
19378 @kindex share
19379 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19380 @itemx share @var{regex}
19381 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19382 Unix regular expression.
19383 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19384 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19385 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19386 loaded.
19387
19388 @item nosharedlibrary
19389 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19390 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19391 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19392 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19393 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19394 discarded.
19395 @end table
19396
19397 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19398 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19399 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19400 Catchpoints}).
19401
19402 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19403 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19404 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19405 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19406
19407 @table @code
19408 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19409 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19410 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19411 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19412 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19413 shared library.
19414
19415 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19416 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19417 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19418 library events happen.
19419 @end table
19420
19421 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19422 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19423 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19424 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19425 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19426 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19427 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19428 not.
19429
19430 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19431 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19432 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19433 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19434 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19435
19436 @table @code
19437 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19438 @cindex system root, alternate
19439 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19440 @kindex set sysroot
19441 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19442 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19443 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19444 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19445 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19446 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19447 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19448 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19449 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19450 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19451 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19452 @var{path}.
19453
19454 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19455 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19456 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19457 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19458 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19459 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19460 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19461 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19462 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19463 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19464 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19465 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19466 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19467 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19468
19469 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19470 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19471 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19472 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19473 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19474
19475 @smallexample
19476 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19477 @end smallexample
19478
19479 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19480 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19481 system:
19482
19483 @smallexample
19484 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19485 @end smallexample
19486
19487 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19488 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19489 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19490 colons:
19491
19492 @smallexample
19493 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19494 @end smallexample
19495
19496 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19497 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19498 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19499 @samp{z}):
19500
19501 @smallexample
19502 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19503 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19504 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 @noindent
19508 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19509 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19510 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19511
19512 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19513 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19514
19515 @smallexample
19516 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19517 @end smallexample
19518
19519 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19520 if you don't want or need to.
19521
19522 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19523 sysroot}.
19524
19525 @cindex default system root
19526 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19527 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19528 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19529 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19530 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19531 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19532 location.
19533
19534 @kindex show sysroot
19535 @item show sysroot
19536 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19537
19538 @kindex set solib-search-path
19539 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19540 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19541 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19542 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19543 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19544 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19545 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19546 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19547 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19548 of shared library symbols.
19549
19550 @kindex show solib-search-path
19551 @item show solib-search-path
19552 Display the current shared library search path.
19553
19554 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19555 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19556 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19557 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19558 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19559
19560 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19561 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19562 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19563 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19564 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19565 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19566 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19567 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19568 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19569 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19570 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19571 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19572 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19573 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19574 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19575 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19576 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19577 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19578 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19579 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19580 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19581 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19582
19583 @table @code
19584 @item unix
19585 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19586 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19587 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19588 the forward slash.
19589
19590 @item dos-based
19591 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19592 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19593 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19594 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19595 considered directory separators.
19596
19597 @item auto
19598 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19599 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19600 This is the default.
19601 @end table
19602 @end table
19603
19604 @cindex file name canonicalization
19605 @cindex base name differences
19606 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19607 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19608 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19609 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19610 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19611 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19612 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19613 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19614 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19615 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19616 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19617 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19618 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19619 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19620 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19621
19622 @table @code
19623 @item set basenames-may-differ
19624 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19625 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19626
19627 @item show basenames-may-differ
19628 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19629 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19630 @end table
19631
19632 @node File Caching
19633 @section File Caching
19634 @cindex caching of opened files
19635 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19636
19637 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19638 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19639 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19640 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19641
19642 @table @code
19643 @kindex maint info bfds
19644 @item maint info bfds
19645 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19646 @value{GDBN}.
19647
19648 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19649 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19650 @kindex bfd caching
19651 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19652 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19653 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19654 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19655 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19656 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19657 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19658 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19659 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19660
19661 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19662 @kindex bfd caching
19663 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19664 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19665
19666 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19667 @kindex bfd caching
19668 @item show debug bfd-cache
19669 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19670 @end table
19671
19672 @node Separate Debug Files
19673 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19674 @cindex separate debugging information files
19675 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19676 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19677 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19678 @cindex global debugging information directories
19679 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19680 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19681
19682 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19683 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19684 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19685 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19686 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19687 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19688 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19689
19690 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19691 file:
19692
19693 @itemize @bullet
19694 @item
19695 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19696 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19697 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19698 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19699 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19700 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19701 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19702 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19703
19704 @item
19705 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19706 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19707 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19708 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19709 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19710 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19711 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19712 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19713 below.
19714 @end itemize
19715
19716 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19717 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19718
19719 @itemize @bullet
19720 @item
19721 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19722 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19723 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19724 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19725 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19726
19727 @item
19728 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19729 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19730 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19731 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19732 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19733 hex characters, not 10.)
19734 @end itemize
19735
19736 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19737 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19738 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19739 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19740 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19741 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19742
19743 @itemize @minus
19744 @item
19745 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19746 @item
19747 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19748 @item
19749 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19750 @item
19751 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19752 @end itemize
19753
19754 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19755 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19756 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19757 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19758 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19759
19760 @table @code
19761
19762 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19763 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19764 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19765 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19766 concatenating them by a path separator.
19767
19768 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19769 @item show debug-file-directory
19770 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19771 information files.
19772
19773 @end table
19774
19775 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19776 @cindex debug link sections
19777 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19778 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19779
19780 @itemize
19781 @item
19782 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19783 a zero byte,
19784 @item
19785 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19786 boundary within the section, and
19787 @item
19788 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19789 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19790 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19791 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19792 @end itemize
19793
19794 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19795 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19796 described above.
19797
19798 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19799 @cindex build ID sections
19800 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19801 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19802 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19803 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19804 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19805 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19806 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19807 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19808 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19809
19810 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19811 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19812 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19813 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19814 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19815 in an ordinary executable.
19816
19817 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19818 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19819 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19820 following commands:
19821
19822 @smallexample
19823 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19824 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19825 @end smallexample
19826
19827 @noindent
19828 These commands remove the debugging
19829 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19830 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19831 two files:
19832
19833 @itemize @bullet
19834 @item
19835 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19836 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19837
19838 @smallexample
19839 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19840 @end smallexample
19841
19842 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19843 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19844 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19845 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19846
19847 @item
19848 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19849 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19850 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19851 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19852 @end itemize
19853
19854 @noindent
19855
19856 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19857 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19858 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19859
19860 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19861 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19862 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19863 @c different ways!
19864 @ifhtml
19865 @display
19866 @html
19867 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19868 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19869 @end html
19870 @end display
19871 @end ifhtml
19872 @ifnothtml
19873 @display
19874 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19875 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19876 @end display
19877 @end ifnothtml
19878
19879 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19880 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19881 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19882 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19883 CRC.
19884
19885 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19886 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19887 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19888 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19889 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19890
19891 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19892 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19893 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19894 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19895 @code{0xffffffff}.
19896
19897 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19898 @smallexample
19899 unsigned long
19900 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19901 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19902 @{
19903 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19904 @{
19905 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19906 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19907 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19908 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19909 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19910 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19911 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19912 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19913 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19914 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19915 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19916 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19917 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19918 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19919 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19920 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19921 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19922 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19923 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19924 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19925 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19926 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19927 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19928 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19929 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19930 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19931 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19932 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19933 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19934 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19935 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19936 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19937 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19938 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19939 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19940 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19941 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19942 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19943 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19944 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19945 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19946 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19947 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19948 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19949 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19950 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19951 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19952 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19953 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19954 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19955 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19956 0x2d02ef8d
19957 @};
19958 unsigned char *end;
19959
19960 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19961 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19962 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19963 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19964 @}
19965 @end smallexample
19966
19967 @noindent
19968 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19969
19970 @node MiniDebugInfo
19971 @section Debugging information in a special section
19972 @cindex separate debug sections
19973 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19974
19975 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19976 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19977 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19978 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19979
19980 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19981 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19982 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19983 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19984 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19985 debugging information might be included in the section.
19986
19987 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19988 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19989 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19990
19991 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19992 standard utilities:
19993
19994 @smallexample
19995 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19996 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19997 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19998 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19999
20000 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20001 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20002 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20003 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20004 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20005 | sort > funcsyms
20006
20007 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20008 # table.
20009 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20010
20011 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20012 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20013
20014 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20015 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20016 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20017 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20018
20019 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20020 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20021
20022 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20023 # original binary.
20024 xz mini_debuginfo
20025 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20026 @end smallexample
20027
20028 @node Index Files
20029 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20030 @cindex index files
20031 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20032
20033 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20034 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20035 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20036 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20037 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20038 startup.
20039
20040 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20041 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20042 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20043
20044 @smallexample
20045 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20046 @end smallexample
20047
20048 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20049
20050 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20051 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20052
20053 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20054 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20055 using @command{objcopy}.
20056
20057 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20058
20059 @table @code
20060 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20061 @kindex save gdb-index
20062 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20063 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20064 default creates it produces a single file
20065 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20066 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20067 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20068 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20069 given @var{directory}.
20070 @end table
20071
20072 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20073 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20077 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20078 @end smallexample
20079
20080 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20084 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20085 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20086 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20087 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20088 @end smallexample
20089
20090 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20091 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20092 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20093 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20094 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20095 The default is @code{off}.
20096 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20097 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20098
20099 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20100 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20101
20102 @smallexample
20103 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20104 @end smallexample
20105
20106 Instead you must do, for example,
20107
20108 @smallexample
20109 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20110 @end smallexample
20111
20112 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20113 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20114 currently work for programs using Ada.
20115
20116 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20117
20118 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20119 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20120 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20121 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20122
20123 @table @code
20124
20125 @item set index-cache on
20126 @itemx set index-cache off
20127 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20128
20129 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20130 @itemx show index-cache directory
20131 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved. By default, the index
20132 is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of the directory pointed to by the
20133 @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment variable, if it is defined, else in the
20134 @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory of your home directory.
20135
20136 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20137 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20138
20139 @item show index-cache stats
20140 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20141
20142 @end table
20143
20144 @node Symbol Errors
20145 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20146
20147 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20148 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20149 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20150 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20151 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20152 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20153 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20154 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20155 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20156 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20157 Messages}).
20158
20159 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20160
20161 @table @code
20162 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20163
20164 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20165 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20166 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20167 in its outer scope blocks.
20168
20169 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20170 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20171 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20172 function.
20173
20174 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20175
20176 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20177 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20178 do so.
20179
20180 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20181 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20182 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20183 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20184 Messages}.)
20185
20186 @item bad block start address patched
20187
20188 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20189 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20190 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20191
20192 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20193 starting on the previous source line.
20194
20195 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20196
20197 @cindex foo
20198 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20199 larger than the size of the string table.
20200
20201 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20202 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20203 with this name.
20204
20205 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20206
20207 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20208 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20209 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20210
20211 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20212 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20213 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20214 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20215 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20216 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20217
20218 @item stub type has NULL name
20219
20220 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20221
20222 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20223 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20224 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20225 it.
20226
20227 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20228
20229 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20230
20231 @end table
20232
20233 @node Data Files
20234 @section GDB Data Files
20235
20236 @cindex prefix for data files
20237 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20238 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20239
20240 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20241 is currently using.
20242
20243 @table @code
20244 @kindex set data-directory
20245 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20246 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20247 to @var{directory}.
20248
20249 @kindex show data-directory
20250 @item show data-directory
20251 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20252 @end table
20253
20254 @cindex default data directory
20255 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20256 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20257 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20258 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20259 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20260 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20261 location.
20262
20263 The data directory may also be specified with the
20264 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20265 @xref{Mode Options}.
20266
20267 @node Targets
20268 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20269
20270 @cindex debugging target
20271 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20272
20273 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20274 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20275 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20276 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20277 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20278 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20279 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20280 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20281
20282 @cindex target architecture
20283 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20284 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20285 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20286 command.
20287
20288 @table @code
20289 @kindex set architecture
20290 @kindex show architecture
20291 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20292 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20293 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20294 supported architectures.
20295
20296 @item show architecture
20297 Show the current target architecture.
20298
20299 @item set processor
20300 @itemx processor
20301 @kindex set processor
20302 @kindex show processor
20303 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20304 and @code{show architecture}.
20305 @end table
20306
20307 @menu
20308 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20309 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20310 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20311 @end menu
20312
20313 @node Active Targets
20314 @section Active Targets
20315
20316 @cindex stacking targets
20317 @cindex active targets
20318 @cindex multiple targets
20319
20320 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20321 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20322 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20323 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20324 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20325 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20326 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20327 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20328 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20329
20330 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20331 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20332 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20333 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20334
20335 @node Target Commands
20336 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20337
20338 @table @code
20339 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20340 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20341 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20342 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20343 protocol of the target machine.
20344
20345 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20346 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20347 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20348
20349 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20350 after executing the command.
20351
20352 @kindex help target
20353 @item help target
20354 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20355 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20356 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20357
20358 @item help target @var{name}
20359 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20360 select it.
20361
20362 @kindex set gnutarget
20363 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20364 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20365 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20366 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20367 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20368 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20369
20370 @quotation
20371 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20372 you must know the actual BFD name.
20373 @end quotation
20374
20375 @noindent
20376 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20377
20378 @kindex show gnutarget
20379 @item show gnutarget
20380 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20381 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20382 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20383 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20384 @end table
20385
20386 @cindex common targets
20387 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20388 configuration):
20389
20390 @table @code
20391 @kindex target
20392 @item target exec @var{program}
20393 @cindex executable file target
20394 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20395 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20396
20397 @item target core @var{filename}
20398 @cindex core dump file target
20399 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20400 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20401
20402 @item target remote @var{medium}
20403 @cindex remote target
20404 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20405 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20406 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20407
20408 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20409 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20410
20411 @smallexample
20412 target remote /dev/ttya
20413 @end smallexample
20414
20415 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20416 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20417 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20418 clobbered by the download.
20419
20420 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20421 @cindex built-in simulator target
20422 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20423 In general,
20424 @smallexample
20425 target sim
20426 load
20427 run
20428 @end smallexample
20429 @noindent
20430 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20431 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20432 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20433 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20434 Processors}.
20435
20436 @item target native
20437 @cindex native target
20438 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20439 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20440 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20441 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20442
20443 @end table
20444
20445 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20446 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20447
20448 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20449 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20450 various aspects of this process.
20451
20452 @table @code
20453
20454 @item set hash
20455 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20456 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20457 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20458 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20459 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20460 monitor.
20461
20462 @item show hash
20463 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20464 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20465
20466 @item set debug monitor
20467 @kindex set debug monitor
20468 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20469 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20470 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20471
20472 @item show debug monitor
20473 @kindex show debug monitor
20474 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20475 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20476 @end table
20477
20478 @table @code
20479
20480 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20481 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20482 @anchor{load}
20483 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20484 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20485 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20486 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20487 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20488 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20489
20490 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20491 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20492 target is @dots{}}''
20493
20494 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20495 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20496 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20497 specifies a fixed address.
20498 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20499
20500 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20501 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20502 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20503
20504 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20505 load programs into flash memory.
20506
20507 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20508 @end table
20509
20510 @table @code
20511
20512 @kindex flash-erase
20513 @item flash-erase
20514 @anchor{flash-erase}
20515
20516 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20517
20518 @end table
20519
20520 @node Byte Order
20521 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20522
20523 @cindex choosing target byte order
20524 @cindex target byte order
20525
20526 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20527 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20528 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20529 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20530 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20531 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20532
20533 @table @code
20534 @kindex set endian
20535 @item set endian big
20536 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20537
20538 @item set endian little
20539 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20540
20541 @item set endian auto
20542 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20543 executable.
20544
20545 @item show endian
20546 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20547
20548 @end table
20549
20550 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20551 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20552 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20553 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20554 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20555 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20556 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20557 and @code{big} otherwise.
20558
20559 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20560 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20561 target system.
20562
20563
20564 @node Remote Debugging
20565 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20566 @cindex remote debugging
20567
20568 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20569 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20570 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20571 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20572 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20573
20574 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20575 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20576 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20577 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20578 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20579 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20580
20581 Other remote targets may be available in your
20582 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20583
20584 @menu
20585 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20586 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20587 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20588 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20589 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20590 @end menu
20591
20592 @node Connecting
20593 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20594 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20595 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20596 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20597 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20598 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20599 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20600
20601 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20602 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20603 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20604 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20605
20606 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20607
20608 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20609 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20610 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20611 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20612
20613 @table @asis
20614
20615 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20616 @item Result of detach or program exit
20617 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20618 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20619 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20620
20621 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20622 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20623 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20624 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20625
20626 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20627 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20628 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20629 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20630
20631 @item Specifying the program to debug
20632 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20633 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20634 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20635 target.
20636
20637 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20638 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20639 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20640
20641 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20642 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20643 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20644 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20645
20646 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20647 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20648 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20649 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20650 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20651 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20652 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20653 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20654 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20655
20656 @item The @code{run} command
20657 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20658 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20659 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20660 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20661 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20662
20663 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20664 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20665 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20666 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20667 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20668
20669 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20670 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20671 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20672 @code{target remote} mode.
20673
20674 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20675 @item Attaching
20676 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20677 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20678 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20679
20680 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20681 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20682 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20683 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20684 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20685
20686 @end table
20687
20688 @anchor{Host and target files}
20689 @subsection Host and Target Files
20690 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20691 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20692
20693 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20694 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20695 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20696 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20697 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20698
20699 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20700 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20701 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20702 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20703 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20704
20705 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20706 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20707 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20708 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20709 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20710 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20711 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20712 target libraries.
20713
20714 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20715 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20716 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20717 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20718 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20719 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20720 programs.
20721
20722 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20723 @cindex remote connection commands
20724 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20725 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20726 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20727 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20728 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20729 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20730 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20731
20732 @table @code
20733
20734 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20735 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20736 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20737 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20738 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20739
20740 @smallexample
20741 target remote /dev/ttyb
20742 @end smallexample
20743
20744 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20745 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20746 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20747 @code{target} command.
20748
20749 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20750 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20751 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20752 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20753 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20754 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20755 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20756 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20757 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20758 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20759 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20760 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20761 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20762 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20763 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20764 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20765 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20766 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20767 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20768 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20769 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20770 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20771
20772 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20773 @code{manyfarms}:
20774
20775 @smallexample
20776 target remote manyfarms:2828
20777 @end smallexample
20778
20779 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20780 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20781 square bracket syntax:
20782
20783 @smallexample
20784 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20785 @end smallexample
20786
20787 @noindent
20788 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20789
20790 @smallexample
20791 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20792 @end smallexample
20793
20794 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20795 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20796 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20797 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20798 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20799 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20800
20801 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20802 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20803 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20804 port 1234 on your local machine:
20805
20806 @smallexample
20807 target remote :1234
20808 @end smallexample
20809 @noindent
20810
20811 Note that the colon is still required here.
20812
20813 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20814 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20815 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20816 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20817 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20818 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20819 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20820 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20821 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20822 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20823 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20824 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20825 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20826
20827 @smallexample
20828 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20829 @end smallexample
20830
20831 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20832 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20833 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20834 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20835
20836 @item target remote | @var{command}
20837 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20838 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20839 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20840 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20841 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20842 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20843 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20844 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20845 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20846
20847 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20848 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20849 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20850
20851 @end table
20852
20853 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20854 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20855 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20856 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20857 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20858 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20859 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20860
20861 @smallexample
20862 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20863 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20864 @end smallexample
20865
20866 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20867 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20868 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20869 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20870
20871 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20872 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20873
20874 @table @code
20875 @kindex detach (remote)
20876 @item detach
20877 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20878 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20879 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20880 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20881 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20882 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20883 still connected to the target.
20884
20885 @kindex disconnect
20886 @item disconnect
20887 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20888 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20889 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20890 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20891 another target.
20892
20893 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20894 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20895 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20896 @kindex monitor
20897 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20898 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20899 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20900 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20901 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20902 and implement.
20903 @end table
20904
20905 @node File Transfer
20906 @section Sending files to a remote system
20907 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20908 @cindex file transfer
20909 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20910
20911 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20912 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20913 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20914 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20915 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20916 the only way to upload or download files.
20917
20918 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20919
20920 @table @code
20921 @kindex remote put
20922 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20923 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20924 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20925
20926 @kindex remote get
20927 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20928 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20929 on the host system.
20930
20931 @kindex remote delete
20932 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20933 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20934
20935 @end table
20936
20937 @node Server
20938 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20939
20940 @kindex gdbserver
20941 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20942 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20943 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20944 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20945 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20946
20947 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20948 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20949 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20950 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20951 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20952 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20953 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20954 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20955 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20956 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20957 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20958 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20959 choice for debugging.
20960
20961 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20962 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20963 protocol.
20964
20965 @quotation
20966 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20967 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20968 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20969 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20970 @code{gdbserver}.
20971 @end quotation
20972
20973 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20974 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20975 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20976 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20977
20978 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20979 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20980 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20981 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20982 system does all the symbol handling.
20983
20984 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20985 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20986 syntax is:
20987
20988 @smallexample
20989 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20990 @end smallexample
20991
20992 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20993 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20994 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20995 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20996 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20997 @file{/dev/com1}:
20998
20999 @smallexample
21000 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21001 @end smallexample
21002
21003 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21004 with it.
21005
21006 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21007
21008 @smallexample
21009 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21010 @end smallexample
21011
21012 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21013 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21014 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21015 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21016 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21017 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21018 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21019 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21020 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21021 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21022 @code{target remote} command.
21023
21024 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21025 with ssh:
21026
21027 @smallexample
21028 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21029 @end smallexample
21030
21031 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21032 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21033 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21034 You could elide it if you want to.
21035
21036 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21037 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21038 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21039 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21040
21041 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21042 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21043 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21044 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21045
21046 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21047 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21048
21049 @smallexample
21050 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21051 @end smallexample
21052
21053 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21054 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21055
21056 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21057 @value{GDBN} attach command
21058 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21059
21060 @pindex pidof
21061 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21062 @code{pidof} utility:
21063
21064 @smallexample
21065 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21066 @end smallexample
21067
21068 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21069 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21070 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21071
21072 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21073
21074 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21075 port.
21076
21077 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21078 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21079 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21080 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21081 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21082 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21083 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21084 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21085
21086 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21087 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21088 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21089
21090 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21091 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21092 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21093 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21094 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21095 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21096 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21097 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21098 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21099 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21100 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21101 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21102
21103 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21104 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21105
21106 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21107 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21108 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21109 program. For more information,
21110 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21111
21112 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21113 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21114 status information about the debugging process.
21115 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21116 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21117 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21118 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21119
21120 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21121 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21122 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21123 Possible options are:
21124
21125 @table @code
21126 @item none
21127 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21128 @item all
21129 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21130 @item timestamps
21131 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21132 @end table
21133
21134 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21135 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21136
21137 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21138 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21139 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21140 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21141 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21142
21143 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21144 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21145 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21146 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21147
21148 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21149 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21150 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21151 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21152
21153 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21154 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21155 environment:
21156
21157 @smallexample
21158 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21159 @end smallexample
21160
21161 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21162 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21163
21164 @smallexample
21165 $ gdbserver --selftest
21166 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21167 @end smallexample
21168
21169 These tests are disabled in release.
21170 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21171
21172 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21173 @itemize
21174
21175 @item
21176 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21177
21178 @item
21179 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21180 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21181 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21182 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21183 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21184 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21185
21186 @item
21187 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21188 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21189 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21190 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21191 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21192 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21193 program is already on the target.
21194
21195 @end itemize
21196
21197 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21198 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21199 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21200
21201 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21202 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21203 Here are the available commands.
21204
21205 @table @code
21206 @item monitor help
21207 List the available monitor commands.
21208
21209 @item monitor set debug 0
21210 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21211 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21212
21213 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21214 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21215 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21216 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21217
21218 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21219 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21220 Possible options are:
21221
21222 @table @code
21223 @item none
21224 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21225 @item all
21226 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21227 @item timestamps
21228 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21229 @end table
21230
21231 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21232 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21233
21234 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21235 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21236 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21237 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21238 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21239 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21240
21241 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21242 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21243
21244 @item monitor exit
21245 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21246 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21247 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21248 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21249 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21250
21251 @end table
21252
21253 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21254 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21255
21256 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21257 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21258
21259 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21260 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21261 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21262 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21263 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21264 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21265 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21266 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21267 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21268 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21269 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21270 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21271
21272 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21273
21274 @table @code
21275 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21276
21277 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21278 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21279 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21280
21281 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21282
21283 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21284 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21285 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21286 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21287 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21288 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21289
21290 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21291
21292 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21293 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21294 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21295 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21296 command for that. For example:
21297
21298 @smallexample
21299 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21300 @end smallexample
21301
21302 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21303 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21304 @end table
21305
21306 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21307 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21308 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21309 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21310 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21311 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21312 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21313 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21314 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21315 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21316
21317 @smallexample
21318 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21319 @end smallexample
21320
21321 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21322
21323 @smallexample
21324 $ gdb myprogram
21325 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21326 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21327 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21328 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21329 @end smallexample
21330
21331 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21332 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21333 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21334 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21335 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21336 tracing.
21337
21338 @node Remote Configuration
21339 @section Remote Configuration
21340
21341 @kindex set remote
21342 @kindex show remote
21343 This section documents the configuration options available when
21344 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21345 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21346 system-call-allowed}.
21347
21348 @table @code
21349 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21350 @cindex address size for remote targets
21351 @cindex bits in remote address
21352 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21353 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21354 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21355 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21356
21357 @item show remoteaddresssize
21358 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21359
21360 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21361 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21362 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21363 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21364 remote targets.
21365
21366 @item show serial baud
21367 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21368
21369 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21370 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21371 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21372
21373 @item show serial parity
21374 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21375
21376 @item set remotebreak
21377 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21378 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21379 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21380 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21381 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21382 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21383 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21384 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21385
21386 @item show remotebreak
21387 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21388 interrupt the remote program.
21389
21390 @item set remoteflow on
21391 @itemx set remoteflow off
21392 @kindex set remoteflow
21393 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21394 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21395
21396 @item show remoteflow
21397 @kindex show remoteflow
21398 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21399
21400 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21401 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21402 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21403 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21404 @code{ascii}.
21405
21406 @item show remotelogbase
21407 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21408 protocol.
21409
21410 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21411 @cindex record serial communications on file
21412 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21413 default is not to record at all.
21414
21415 @item show remotelogfile.
21416 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21417 serial communications.
21418
21419 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21420 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21421 @cindex remote timeout
21422 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21423 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21424
21425 @item show remotetimeout
21426 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21427 responses.
21428
21429 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21430 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21431 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21432 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21433 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21434 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21435 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21436 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21437 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21438 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21439
21440 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21441 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21442 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21443 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21444
21445 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21446 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21447 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21448 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21449 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21450 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21451 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21452 length.
21453
21454 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21455 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21456 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21457
21458 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21459 @itemx show remote exec-file
21460 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21461 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21462 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21463 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21464 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21465 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21466
21467 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21468 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21469 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21470 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21471 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21472 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21473 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21474 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21475 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21476 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21477
21478 @item show interrupt-sequence
21479 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21480 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21481 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21482 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21483
21484 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21485 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21486 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21487 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21488 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21489 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21490
21491 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21492 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21493 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21494
21495 @kindex set tcp
21496 @kindex show tcp
21497 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21498 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21499 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21500 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21501 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21502 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21503 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21504 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21505 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21506
21507 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21508 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21509
21510 @item show tcp auto-retry
21511 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21512
21513 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21514 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21515 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21516 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21517 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21518 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21519 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21520 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21521 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21522 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21523 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21524
21525 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21526 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21527 @end table
21528
21529 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21530 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21531 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21532 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21533 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21534 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21535 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21536 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21537 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21538
21539 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21540 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21541 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21542 @value{GDBN} developers.
21543
21544 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21545 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21546 are:
21547
21548 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21549 @item Command Name
21550 @tab Remote Packet
21551 @tab Related Features
21552
21553 @item @code{fetch-register}
21554 @tab @code{p}
21555 @tab @code{info registers}
21556
21557 @item @code{set-register}
21558 @tab @code{P}
21559 @tab @code{set}
21560
21561 @item @code{binary-download}
21562 @tab @code{X}
21563 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21564
21565 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21566 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21567 @tab @code{info auxv}
21568
21569 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21570 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21571 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21572
21573 @item @code{attach}
21574 @tab @code{vAttach}
21575 @tab @code{attach}
21576
21577 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21578 @tab @code{vCont}
21579 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21580
21581 @item @code{run}
21582 @tab @code{vRun}
21583 @tab @code{run}
21584
21585 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21586 @tab @code{Z0}
21587 @tab @code{break}
21588
21589 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21590 @tab @code{Z1}
21591 @tab @code{hbreak}
21592
21593 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21594 @tab @code{Z2}
21595 @tab @code{watch}
21596
21597 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21598 @tab @code{Z3}
21599 @tab @code{rwatch}
21600
21601 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21602 @tab @code{Z4}
21603 @tab @code{awatch}
21604
21605 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21606 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21607 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21608
21609 @item @code{target-features}
21610 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21611 @tab @code{set architecture}
21612
21613 @item @code{library-info}
21614 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21615 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21616
21617 @item @code{memory-map}
21618 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21619 @tab @code{info mem}
21620
21621 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21622 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21623 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21624
21625 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21626 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21627 @tab @code{info spu}
21628
21629 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21630 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21631 @tab @code{info spu}
21632
21633 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21634 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21635 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21636
21637 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21638 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21639 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21640
21641 @item @code{threads}
21642 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21643 @tab @code{info threads}
21644
21645 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21646 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21647 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21648
21649 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21650 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21651 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21652
21653 @item @code{search-memory}
21654 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21655 @tab @code{find}
21656
21657 @item @code{supported-packets}
21658 @tab @code{qSupported}
21659 @tab Remote communications parameters
21660
21661 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21662 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21663 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21664
21665 @item @code{pass-signals}
21666 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21667 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21668
21669 @item @code{program-signals}
21670 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21671 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21672
21673 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21674 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21675 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21676
21677 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21678 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21679 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21680
21681 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21682 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21683 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21684
21685 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21686 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21687 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21688
21689 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21690 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21691 @tab @code{remote delete}
21692
21693 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21694 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21695 @tab Host I/O
21696
21697 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21698 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21699 @tab Host I/O
21700
21701 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21702 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21703 @tab Host I/O
21704
21705 @item @code{noack-packet}
21706 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21707 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21708
21709 @item @code{osdata}
21710 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21711 @tab @code{info os}
21712
21713 @item @code{query-attached}
21714 @tab @code{qAttached}
21715 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21716
21717 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21718 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21719 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21720
21721 @item @code{trace-status}
21722 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21723 @tab @code{tstatus}
21724
21725 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21726 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21727 @tab Traceframe info
21728
21729 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21730 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21731 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21732
21733 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21734 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21735 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21736
21737 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21738 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21739 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21740
21741 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21742 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21743 @tab @code{set environment}
21744
21745 @item @code{environment-unset}
21746 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21747 @tab @code{unset environment}
21748
21749 @item @code{environment-reset}
21750 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21751 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21752
21753 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21754 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21755 @tab @code{set cwd}
21756
21757 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21758 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21759 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21760
21761 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21762 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21763 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21764
21765 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21766 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21767 @tab @code{break}
21768
21769 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21770 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21771 @tab @code{hbreak}
21772
21773 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21774 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21775 @tab @code{fork}
21776
21777 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21778 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21779 @tab @code{vfork}
21780
21781 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21782 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21783 @tab @code{exec}
21784
21785 @item @code{thread-events}
21786 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21787 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21788
21789 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21790 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21791 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21792
21793 @end multitable
21794
21795 @node Remote Stub
21796 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21797
21798 @cindex debugging stub, example
21799 @cindex remote stub, example
21800 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21801 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21802 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21803 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21804 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21805 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21806 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21807 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21808
21809 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21810 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21811 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21812 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21813 program, you need:
21814
21815 @enumerate
21816 @item
21817 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21818 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21819 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21820
21821 @item
21822 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21823 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21824
21825 @item
21826 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21827 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21828 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21829 documentation.
21830 @end enumerate
21831
21832 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21833 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21834 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21835
21836 @table @emph
21837 @item On the host,
21838 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21839 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21840 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21841
21842 @item On the target,
21843 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21844 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21845 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21846
21847 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21848 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21849 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21850 @end table
21851
21852 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21853 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21854 @sc{sparc} boards.
21855
21856 @cindex remote serial stub list
21857 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21858
21859 @table @code
21860
21861 @item i386-stub.c
21862 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21863 @cindex Intel
21864 @cindex i386
21865 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21866
21867 @item m68k-stub.c
21868 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21869 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21870 @cindex m680x0
21871 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21872
21873 @item sh-stub.c
21874 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21875 @cindex Renesas
21876 @cindex SH
21877 For Renesas SH architectures.
21878
21879 @item sparc-stub.c
21880 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21881 @cindex Sparc
21882 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21883
21884 @item sparcl-stub.c
21885 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21886 @cindex Fujitsu
21887 @cindex SparcLite
21888 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21889
21890 @end table
21891
21892 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21893 recently added stubs.
21894
21895 @menu
21896 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21897 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21898 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21899 @end menu
21900
21901 @node Stub Contents
21902 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21903
21904 @cindex remote serial stub
21905 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21906 subroutines:
21907
21908 @table @code
21909 @item set_debug_traps
21910 @findex set_debug_traps
21911 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21912 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21913 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21914 program's startup code.
21915
21916 @item handle_exception
21917 @findex handle_exception
21918 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21919 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21920 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21921 run when a trap is triggered.
21922
21923 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21924 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21925 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21926 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21927 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21928 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21929 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21930 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21931 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21932 machine.
21933
21934 @item breakpoint
21935 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21936 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21937 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21938 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21939 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21940 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21941 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21942 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21943 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21944 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21945 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21946
21947 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21948 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21949 start of your debugging session.
21950 @end table
21951
21952 @node Bootstrapping
21953 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21954
21955 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21956 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21957 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21958 debugging target machine.
21959
21960 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21961 serial port.
21962
21963 @table @code
21964 @item int getDebugChar()
21965 @findex getDebugChar
21966 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21967 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21968 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21969
21970 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21971 @findex putDebugChar
21972 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21973 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21974 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21975 @end table
21976
21977 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21978 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21979 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21980 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21981 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21982 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21983 remote system to stop.
21984
21985 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21986 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21987 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21988 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21989
21990 Other routines you need to supply are:
21991
21992 @table @code
21993 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21994 @findex exceptionHandler
21995 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21996 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21997 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21998 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21999 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22000 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22001 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22002 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22003 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22004 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22005 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22006 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22007 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22008
22009 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22010 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22011 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22012 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22013 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22014
22015 @item void flush_i_cache()
22016 @findex flush_i_cache
22017 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22018 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22019 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22020
22021 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22022 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22023 @end table
22024
22025 @noindent
22026 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22027
22028 @table @code
22029 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22030 @findex memset
22031 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22032 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22033 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22034 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22035 @end table
22036
22037 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22038 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22039 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22040 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22041
22042
22043 @node Debug Session
22044 @subsection Putting it All Together
22045
22046 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22047 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22048 steps.
22049
22050 @enumerate
22051 @item
22052 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22053 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22054 @display
22055 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22056 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22057 @end display
22058
22059 @item
22060 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22061 procedure is called:
22062
22063 @smallexample
22064 set_debug_traps();
22065 breakpoint();
22066 @end smallexample
22067
22068 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22069 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22070 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22071 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22072 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22073 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22074 progress.
22075
22076 @item
22077 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22078 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22079
22080 @smallexample
22081 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22082 @end smallexample
22083
22084 @noindent
22085 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22086 function in your program, that function is called when
22087 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22088 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22089 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22090
22091 @item
22092 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22093 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22094
22095 @item
22096 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22097 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22098
22099 @item
22100 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22101 @c document that. FIXME.
22102 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22103 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22104
22105 @item
22106 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22107 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22108
22109 @end enumerate
22110
22111 @node Configurations
22112 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22113
22114 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22115 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22116 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22117
22118 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22119 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22120 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22121 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22122 are quite different from each other.
22123
22124 @menu
22125 * Native::
22126 * Embedded OS::
22127 * Embedded Processors::
22128 * Architectures::
22129 @end menu
22130
22131 @node Native
22132 @section Native
22133
22134 This section describes details specific to particular native
22135 configurations.
22136
22137 @menu
22138 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22139 * Process Information:: Process information
22140 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22141 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22142 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22143 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22144 @end menu
22145
22146 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22147 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22148
22149 @cindex libkvm
22150 @cindex kernel memory image
22151 @cindex kernel crash dump
22152
22153 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22154 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22155 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22156 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22157 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22158 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22159 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22160 @code{kvm} target:
22161
22162 @smallexample
22163 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22164 @end smallexample
22165
22166 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22167 argument:
22168
22169 @smallexample
22170 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22171 @end smallexample
22172
22173 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22174 available:
22175
22176 @table @code
22177 @kindex kvm
22178 @item kvm pcb
22179 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22180
22181 @item kvm proc
22182 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22183 modern FreeBSD systems.
22184 @end table
22185
22186 @node Process Information
22187 @subsection Process Information
22188 @cindex /proc
22189 @cindex examine process image
22190 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22191
22192 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22193 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22194 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22195 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22196 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22197 any process running on your system.
22198
22199 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22200 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22201 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22202 systems.
22203
22204 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22205 information.
22206
22207 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22208 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22209 information available from a live process. Process information is
22210 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22211 systems.
22212
22213 @table @code
22214 @kindex info proc
22215 @cindex process ID
22216 @item info proc
22217 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22218 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
22219 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22220 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22221 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22222 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22223 executable file's absolute file name.
22224
22225 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22226 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22227 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22228 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22229 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22230 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22231
22232 @item info proc cmdline
22233 @cindex info proc cmdline
22234 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22235 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22236
22237 @item info proc cwd
22238 @cindex info proc cwd
22239 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22240 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22241
22242 @item info proc exe
22243 @cindex info proc exe
22244 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22245 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22246
22247 @item info proc mappings
22248 @cindex memory address space mappings
22249 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program. On
22250 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22251 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22252 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22253 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22254
22255 @item info proc stat
22256 @itemx info proc status
22257 @cindex process detailed status information
22258 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22259 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22260 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22261 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22262 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22263
22264 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22265 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22266
22267 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22268 proc status}.
22269
22270 @item info proc all
22271 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22272 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22273
22274 @ignore
22275 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22276 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22277 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22278 @kindex info proc times
22279 @item info proc times
22280 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22281 its children.
22282
22283 @kindex info proc id
22284 @item info proc id
22285 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22286 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22287 @end ignore
22288
22289 @item set procfs-trace
22290 @kindex set procfs-trace
22291 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22292 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22293
22294 @item show procfs-trace
22295 @kindex show procfs-trace
22296 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22297
22298 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22299 @kindex set procfs-file
22300 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22301 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22302 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22303 standard output.
22304
22305 @item show procfs-file
22306 @kindex show procfs-file
22307 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22308
22309 @item proc-trace-entry
22310 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22311 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22312 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22313 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22314 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22315 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22316 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22317 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22318 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22319
22320 @item info pidlist
22321 @kindex info pidlist
22322 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22323 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22324 processes and all the threads within each process.
22325
22326 @item info meminfo
22327 @kindex info meminfo
22328 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22329 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22330 @end table
22331
22332 @node DJGPP Native
22333 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22334 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22335 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22336 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22337
22338 @cindex DPMI
22339 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22340 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22341 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22342 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22343
22344 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22345 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22346 subsection describes those commands.
22347
22348 @table @code
22349 @kindex info dos
22350 @item info dos
22351 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22352 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22353
22354 @kindex sysinfo
22355 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22356 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22357 @item info dos sysinfo
22358 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22359 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22360 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22361
22362 @cindex GDT
22363 @cindex LDT
22364 @cindex IDT
22365 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22366 @cindex descriptor tables display
22367 @item info dos gdt
22368 @itemx info dos ldt
22369 @itemx info dos idt
22370 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22371 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22372 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22373 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22374 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22375 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22376 rights.
22377
22378 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22379 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22380 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22381 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22382 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22383
22384 @cindex garbled pointers
22385 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22386 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22387 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22388 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22389 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22390 debugged program's data segment:
22391
22392 @smallexample
22393 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22394 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22395 @end smallexample
22396
22397 @noindent
22398 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22399 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22400
22401 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22402 @item info dos pde
22403 @itemx info dos pte
22404 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22405 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22406 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22407 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22408 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22409 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22410 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22411 that is currently in use.
22412
22413 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22414 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22415 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22416 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22417 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22418 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22419 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22420
22421 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22422 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22423 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22424 controller.
22425
22426 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22427
22428 @cindex physical address from linear address
22429 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22430 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22431 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22432 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22433 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22434 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22435 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22436
22437 @smallexample
22438 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22439 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22440 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22441 @end smallexample
22442
22443 @noindent
22444 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22445 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22446 attributes of that page.
22447
22448 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22449 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22450 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22451 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22452 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22453 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22454
22455 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22456 transfer buffer:
22457
22458 @smallexample
22459 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22460 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22461 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22462 @end smallexample
22463
22464 @noindent
22465 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22466 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22467 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22468 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22469 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22470
22471 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22472 @end table
22473
22474 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22475 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22476 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22477 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22478
22479 @table @code
22480 @kindex set com1base
22481 @kindex set com1irq
22482 @kindex set com2base
22483 @kindex set com2irq
22484 @kindex set com3base
22485 @kindex set com3irq
22486 @kindex set com4base
22487 @kindex set com4irq
22488 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22489 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22490 port.
22491
22492 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22493 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22494 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22495
22496 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22497 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22498 other 3 COM ports.
22499
22500 @kindex show com1base
22501 @kindex show com1irq
22502 @kindex show com2base
22503 @kindex show com2irq
22504 @kindex show com3base
22505 @kindex show com3irq
22506 @kindex show com4base
22507 @kindex show com4irq
22508 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22509 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22510 lines used by the COM ports.
22511
22512 @item info serial
22513 @kindex info serial
22514 @cindex DOS serial port status
22515 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22516 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22517 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22518 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22519 @end table
22520
22521
22522 @node Cygwin Native
22523 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22524 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22525 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22526 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22527
22528 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22529 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22530
22531 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22532 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22533 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22534 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22535 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22536 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22537 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22538 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22539
22540 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22541 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22542 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22543
22544 @table @code
22545 @kindex info w32
22546 @item info w32
22547 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22548 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22549
22550 @item info w32 selector
22551 This command displays information returned by
22552 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22553 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22554 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22555 Without argument, this command displays information
22556 about the six segment registers.
22557
22558 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22559 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22560 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22561 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22562
22563 @kindex signal-event
22564 @item signal-event @var{id}
22565 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22566 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22567
22568 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22569 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22570 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22571 (for x86_64 versions):
22572
22573 @itemize @minus
22574 @item
22575 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22576 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22577 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22578
22579 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22580 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22581 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22582 to attach.
22583
22584 @item
22585 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22586 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22587 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22588 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22589 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22590 @end itemize
22591
22592 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22593 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22594 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22595 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22596 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22597 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22598 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22599 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22600 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22601 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22602 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22603
22604 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22605 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22606 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22607 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22608
22609 @kindex set new-console
22610 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22611 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22612 be started in a new console on next start.
22613 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22614 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22615
22616 @kindex show new-console
22617 @item show new-console
22618 Displays whether a new console is used
22619 when the debuggee is started.
22620
22621 @kindex set new-group
22622 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22623 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22624 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22625 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22626 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22627
22628 @kindex show new-group
22629 @item show new-group
22630 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22631
22632 @kindex set debugevents
22633 @item set debugevents
22634 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22635 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22636 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22637 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22638 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22639
22640 @kindex set debugexec
22641 @item set debugexec
22642 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22643 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22644
22645 @kindex set debugexceptions
22646 @item set debugexceptions
22647 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22648 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22649
22650 @kindex set debugmemory
22651 @item set debugmemory
22652 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22653 and writes by the debugger.
22654
22655 @kindex set shell
22656 @item set shell
22657 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22658 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22659
22660 @kindex show shell
22661 @item show shell
22662 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22663
22664 @end table
22665
22666 @menu
22667 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22668 @end menu
22669
22670 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22671 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22672 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22673 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22674
22675 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22676 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22677 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22678 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22679 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22680 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22681 ``minimal symbols''.
22682
22683 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22684 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22685 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22686 program run once to completion.
22687
22688 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22689
22690 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22691 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22692 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22693 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22694 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22695 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22696 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22697 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22698 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22699
22700 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22701 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22702 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22703 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22704 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22705 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22706
22707 @smallexample
22708 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22709 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22710
22711 Non-debugging symbols:
22712 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22713 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22714 @end smallexample
22715
22716 @smallexample
22717 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22718 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22719
22720 Non-debugging symbols:
22721 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22722 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22723 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22724 [etc...]
22725 @end smallexample
22726
22727 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22728
22729 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22730 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22731 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22732 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22733 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22734 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22735 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22736
22737 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22738 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22739 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22740 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22741 problem:
22742
22743 @smallexample
22744 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22745 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22746 @end smallexample
22747
22748 @smallexample
22749 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22750 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22751 @end smallexample
22752
22753 And two possible solutions:
22754
22755 @smallexample
22756 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22757 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22758 @end smallexample
22759
22760 @smallexample
22761 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22762 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22763 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22764 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22765 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22766 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22767 @end smallexample
22768
22769 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22770 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22771 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22772 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22773 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22774
22775 @smallexample
22776 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22777 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22778 @end smallexample
22779
22780 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22781 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22782 safe.
22783
22784 @node Hurd Native
22785 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22786 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22787
22788 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22789 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22790
22791 @table @code
22792 @item set signals
22793 @itemx set sigs
22794 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22795 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22796 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22797 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22798 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22799 @code{signals}.
22800
22801 @item show signals
22802 @itemx show sigs
22803 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22804 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22805 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22806
22807 @item set signal-thread
22808 @itemx set sigthread
22809 @kindex set signal-thread
22810 @kindex set sigthread
22811 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22812 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22813 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22814 signal-thread}.
22815
22816 @item show signal-thread
22817 @itemx show sigthread
22818 @kindex show signal-thread
22819 @kindex show sigthread
22820 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22821 delivered a signal.
22822
22823 @item set stopped
22824 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22825 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22826 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22827 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22828
22829 @item show stopped
22830 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22831 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22832 stopped.
22833
22834 @item set exceptions
22835 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22836 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22837 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22838 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22839 trapping on.
22840
22841 @item show exceptions
22842 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22843 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22844
22845 @item set task pause
22846 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22847 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22848 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22849 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22850 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22851 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22852 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22853 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22854 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22855
22856 @item show task pause
22857 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22858 Show the current state of task suspension.
22859
22860 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22861 @cindex task suspend count
22862 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22863 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22864 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22865
22866 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22867 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22868
22869 @item set task exception-port
22870 @itemx set task excp
22871 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22872 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22873 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22874 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22875
22876 @item set noninvasive
22877 @cindex noninvasive task options
22878 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22879 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22880 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22881 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22882
22883 @item info send-rights
22884 @itemx info receive-rights
22885 @itemx info port-rights
22886 @itemx info port-sets
22887 @itemx info dead-names
22888 @itemx info ports
22889 @itemx info psets
22890 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22891 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22892 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22893 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22894 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22895 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22896 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22897 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22898 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22899
22900 @item set thread pause
22901 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22902 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22903 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22904 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22905 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22906 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22907 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22908 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22909 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22910 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22911 only the current thread.
22912
22913 @item show thread pause
22914 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22915 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22916
22917 @item set thread run
22918 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22919
22920 @item show thread run
22921 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22922
22923 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22924 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22925 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22926 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22927 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22928 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22929 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22930
22931 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22932 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22933 detaching.
22934
22935 @item set thread exception-port
22936 @itemx set thread excp
22937 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22938 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22939 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22940
22941 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22942 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22943 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22944 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22945
22946 @item set thread default
22947 @itemx show thread default
22948 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22949 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22950 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22951 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22952 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22953 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22954 the non-default commands.
22955 @end table
22956
22957 @node Darwin
22958 @subsection Darwin
22959 @cindex Darwin
22960
22961 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22962
22963 @table @code
22964 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22965 @kindex set debug darwin
22966 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22967 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22968
22969 @item show debug darwin
22970 @kindex show debug darwin
22971 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22972
22973 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22974 @kindex set debug mach-o
22975 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22976 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22977 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22978 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22979 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22980 usage.
22981
22982 @item show debug mach-o
22983 @kindex show debug mach-o
22984 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22985
22986 @item set mach-exceptions on
22987 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22988 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22989 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22990 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22991 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22992 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22993
22994 @item show mach-exceptions
22995 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22996 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22997 @end table
22998
22999
23000 @node Embedded OS
23001 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23002
23003 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23004 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23005 architectures.
23006
23007 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23008 various real-time operating systems.
23009
23010 @node Embedded Processors
23011 @section Embedded Processors
23012
23013 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23014 configurations.
23015
23016 @cindex send command to simulator
23017 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23018 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23019
23020 @table @code
23021 @item sim @var{command}
23022 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23023 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23024 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23025 acceptable commands.
23026 @end table
23027
23028
23029 @menu
23030 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23031 * ARM:: ARM
23032 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23033 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23034 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23035 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23036 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23037 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23038 * CRIS:: CRIS
23039 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23040 @end menu
23041
23042 @node ARC
23043 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23044 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23045 @cindex ARC specific commands
23046 @cindex ARC600
23047 @cindex ARC700
23048 @cindex ARC EM
23049 @cindex ARC HS
23050
23051 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23052
23053 @table @code
23054 @item set debug arc
23055 @kindex set debug arc
23056 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23057 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23058
23059 @item show debug arc
23060 @kindex show debug arc
23061 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23062
23063 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23064 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23065 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23066
23067 @end table
23068
23069 @node ARM
23070 @subsection ARM
23071
23072 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23073
23074 @table @code
23075 @item set arm disassembler
23076 @kindex set arm
23077 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23078 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23079
23080 @item show arm disassembler
23081 @kindex show arm
23082 Show the current disassembly style.
23083
23084 @item set arm apcs32
23085 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23086 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23087
23088 @item show arm apcs32
23089 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23090
23091 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23092 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23093 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23094
23095 @table @code
23096 @item auto
23097 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23098 @item softfpa
23099 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23100 processors.
23101 @item fpa
23102 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23103 @item softvfp
23104 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23105 @item vfp
23106 VFP co-processor.
23107 @end table
23108
23109 @item show arm fpu
23110 Show the current type of the FPU.
23111
23112 @item set arm abi
23113 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23114
23115 @item show arm abi
23116 Show the currently used ABI.
23117
23118 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23119 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23120 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23121 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23122 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23123 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23124 register).
23125
23126 @item show arm fallback-mode
23127 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23128
23129 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23130 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23131 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23132 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23133 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23134
23135 @item show arm force-mode
23136 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23137
23138 @item set debug arm
23139 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23140 target support subsystem.
23141
23142 @item show debug arm
23143 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23144 @end table
23145
23146 @table @code
23147 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23148 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23149
23150 @table @code
23151 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23152 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23153 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23154 The default value is @code{all}.
23155
23156 @table @code
23157 @item none
23158 @item demon
23159 @item angel
23160 @item redboot
23161 @item all
23162 @end table
23163 @end table
23164 @end table
23165
23166 @node M68K
23167 @subsection M68k
23168
23169 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23170
23171 @node MicroBlaze
23172 @subsection MicroBlaze
23173 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23174 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23175
23176 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23177 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23178 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23179 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23180 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23181 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23182 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23183 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23184 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23185 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23186 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23187
23188 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23189
23190 @table @code
23191 @item target remote :1234
23192 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23193 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23194
23195 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23196 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23197 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23198
23199 @item load
23200 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23201
23202 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23203 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23204
23205 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23206 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23207 @end table
23208
23209 @node MIPS Embedded
23210 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23211
23212 @noindent
23213 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23214
23215 @table @code
23216 @item set mipsfpu double
23217 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23218 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23219 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23220 @itemx show mipsfpu
23221 @kindex set mipsfpu
23222 @kindex show mipsfpu
23223 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23224 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23225 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23226 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23227 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23228 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23229 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23230 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23231 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23232 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23233 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23234 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23235 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23236
23237 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23238 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23239 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23240
23241 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23242 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23243 @end table
23244
23245 @node OpenRISC 1000
23246 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23247 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23248
23249 @noindent
23250 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23251 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23252 FPGA's.
23253
23254 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23255 a target:
23256
23257 @table @code
23258
23259 @kindex target sim
23260 @item target sim
23261
23262 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23263 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23264 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23265 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23266
23267 Example: @code{target sim}
23268
23269 @item set debug or1k
23270 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23271 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23272
23273 @item show debug or1k
23274 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23275 @end table
23276
23277 @node PowerPC Embedded
23278 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23279
23280 @cindex DVC register
23281 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23282 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23283
23284 @smallexample
23285 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23286 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23287 @end smallexample
23288
23289 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23290 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23291 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23292 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23293 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23294 or newer.
23295
23296 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23297 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23298 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23299 watching variables of scalar types.
23300
23301 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23302 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23303
23304 @smallexample
23305 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23306 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23307 @end smallexample
23308
23309 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23310 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23311
23312 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23313 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23314 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23315 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23316 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23317 use the @code{break-range} command.
23318
23319 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23320
23321 @table @code
23322 @kindex break-range
23323 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23324 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23325 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23326 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23327 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23328 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23329 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23330 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23331 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23332
23333 @kindex set powerpc
23334 @item set powerpc soft-float
23335 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23336 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23337 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23338 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23339
23340 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23341 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23342 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23343 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23344 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23345 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23346 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23347 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23348
23349 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23350 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23351 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23352 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23353 address of its first byte.
23354
23355 @end table
23356
23357 @node AVR
23358 @subsection Atmel AVR
23359 @cindex AVR
23360
23361 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23362 following AVR-specific commands:
23363
23364 @table @code
23365 @item info io_registers
23366 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23367 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23368 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23369 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23370 @end table
23371
23372 @node CRIS
23373 @subsection CRIS
23374 @cindex CRIS
23375
23376 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23377 following CRIS-specific commands:
23378
23379 @table @code
23380 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23381 @cindex CRIS version
23382 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23383 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23384 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23385
23386 @item show cris-version
23387 Show the current CRIS version.
23388
23389 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23390 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23391 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23392 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23393 @code{R59}.
23394
23395 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23396 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23397
23398 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23399 @cindex CRIS mode
23400 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23401 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23402 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23403
23404 @item show cris-mode
23405 Show the current CRIS mode.
23406 @end table
23407
23408 @node Super-H
23409 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23410 @cindex Super-H
23411
23412 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23413 commands:
23414
23415 @table @code
23416 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23417 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23418 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23419 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23420 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23421 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23422 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23423 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23424 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23425 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23426 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23427 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23428
23429 @item show sh calling-convention
23430 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23431 Show the current calling convention setting.
23432
23433 @end table
23434
23435
23436 @node Architectures
23437 @section Architectures
23438
23439 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23440 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23441
23442 @menu
23443 * AArch64::
23444 * i386::
23445 * Alpha::
23446 * MIPS::
23447 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23448 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23449 * PowerPC::
23450 * Nios II::
23451 * Sparc64::
23452 @end menu
23453
23454 @node AArch64
23455 @subsection AArch64
23456 @cindex AArch64 support
23457
23458 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23459 following special commands:
23460
23461 @table @code
23462 @item set debug aarch64
23463 @kindex set debug aarch64
23464 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23465 messages are to be displayed.
23466
23467 @item show debug aarch64
23468 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23469
23470 @end table
23471
23472 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23473 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23474
23475 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23476 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23477 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23478 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23479 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23480 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23481
23482 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23483 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23484 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23485 target process.
23486
23487
23488 @node i386
23489 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23490
23491 @table @code
23492 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23493 @kindex set struct-convention
23494 @cindex struct return convention
23495 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23496 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23497 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23498 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23499 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23500 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23501 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23502 be returned in a register.
23503
23504 @item show struct-convention
23505 @kindex show struct-convention
23506 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23507 from functions.
23508 @end table
23509
23510
23511 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23512 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23513
23514 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23515 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23516 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23517 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23518 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23519 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23520 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23521
23522 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23523 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23524 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23525 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23526 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23527 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23528
23529 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23530 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23531 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23532
23533 @smallexample
23534 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23535 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23536 @end smallexample
23537
23538 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23539 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23540 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23541 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23542 the pointer.
23543
23544 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23545 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23546 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23547 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23548 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23549
23550 @table @code
23551 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23552 @kindex show mpx bound
23553 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23554
23555 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23556 @kindex set mpx bound
23557 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23558 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23559 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23560 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23561 @end table
23562
23563 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23564 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23565 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23566 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23567
23568 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23569 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23570 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23571 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23572 function.
23573
23574 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23575 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23576 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23577 continuing the execution. For example:
23578
23579 @smallexample
23580 $ break *upper
23581 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23582 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23583 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23584 $ print $bnd0
23585 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23586 @end smallexample
23587
23588 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23589 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23590 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23591
23592 @node Alpha
23593 @subsection Alpha
23594
23595 See the following section.
23596
23597 @node MIPS
23598 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23599
23600 @cindex stack on Alpha
23601 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23602 @cindex Alpha stack
23603 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23604 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23605 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23606 find the beginning of a function.
23607
23608 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23609 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23610 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23611 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23612 commands:
23613
23614 @table @code
23615 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23616 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23617 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23618 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23619 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23620 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23621 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23622 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23623
23624 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23625 Display the current limit.
23626 @end table
23627
23628 @noindent
23629 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23630 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23631
23632 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23633 programs:
23634
23635 @table @code
23636 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23637 @kindex set mips abi
23638 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23639 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23640 values of @var{arg} are:
23641
23642 @table @samp
23643 @item auto
23644 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23645 default).
23646 @item o32
23647 @item o64
23648 @item n32
23649 @item n64
23650 @item eabi32
23651 @item eabi64
23652 @end table
23653
23654 @item show mips abi
23655 @kindex show mips abi
23656 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23657
23658 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23659 @kindex set mips compression
23660 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23661 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23662 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23663 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23664 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23665 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23666 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23667 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23668 provided by the executable.
23669
23670 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23671 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23672 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23673 identified as such.
23674
23675 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23676 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23677 implicitly from an executable.
23678
23679 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23680 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23681 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23682 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23683 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23684
23685 @item show mips compression
23686 @kindex show mips compression
23687 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23688 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23689
23690 @item set mipsfpu
23691 @itemx show mipsfpu
23692 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23693
23694 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23695 @kindex set mips mask-address
23696 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23697 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23698 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23699 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23700 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23701
23702 @item show mips mask-address
23703 @kindex show mips mask-address
23704 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23705 not.
23706
23707 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23708 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23709 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23710 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23711 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23712 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23713
23714 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23715 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23716 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23717
23718 @item set debug mips
23719 @kindex set debug mips
23720 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23721 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23722
23723 @item show debug mips
23724 @kindex show debug mips
23725 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23726 @end table
23727
23728
23729 @node HPPA
23730 @subsection HPPA
23731 @cindex HPPA support
23732
23733 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23734 following special commands:
23735
23736 @table @code
23737 @item set debug hppa
23738 @kindex set debug hppa
23739 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23740 messages are to be displayed.
23741
23742 @item show debug hppa
23743 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23744
23745 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23746 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23747 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23748 given @var{address}.
23749
23750 @end table
23751
23752
23753 @node SPU
23754 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23755 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23756 @cindex SPU
23757
23758 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23759 it provides the following special commands:
23760
23761 @table @code
23762 @item info spu event
23763 @kindex info spu
23764 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23765 and pending event status.
23766
23767 @item info spu signal
23768 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23769 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23770 notification channels.
23771
23772 @item info spu mailbox
23773 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23774 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23775 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23776
23777 @item info spu dma
23778 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23779 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23780 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23781
23782 @item info spu proxydma
23783 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23784 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23785 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23786
23787 @end table
23788
23789 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23790 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23791 special commands:
23792
23793 @table @code
23794 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23795 @kindex set spu
23796 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23797 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23798 function. The default is @code{off}.
23799
23800 @item show spu stop-on-load
23801 @kindex show spu
23802 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23803
23804 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23805 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23806 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23807 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23808 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23809 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23810
23811 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23812 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23813
23814 @end table
23815
23816 @node PowerPC
23817 @subsection PowerPC
23818 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23819
23820 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23821 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23822 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23823 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23824 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23825
23826 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23827 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23828 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23829
23830 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23831 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23832
23833 @node Nios II
23834 @subsection Nios II
23835 @cindex Nios II architecture
23836
23837 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23838 it provides the following special commands:
23839
23840 @table @code
23841
23842 @item set debug nios2
23843 @kindex set debug nios2
23844 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23845 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23846
23847 @item show debug nios2
23848 @kindex show debug nios2
23849 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23850 @end table
23851
23852 @node Sparc64
23853 @subsection Sparc64
23854 @cindex Sparc64 support
23855 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23856 @subsubsection ADI Support
23857
23858 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23859 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23860 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23861 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23862 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23863 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23864 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23865 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23866 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23867 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23868 signal.
23869
23870 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23871 ADI-enabled.
23872
23873 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23874 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23875
23876
23877 @table @code
23878 @kindex adi examine
23879 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23880
23881 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23882 cacheline.
23883
23884 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23885 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23886 block size, to display.
23887
23888 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23889 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23890
23891 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23892
23893 @smallexample
23894 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23895 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23896 @end smallexample
23897
23898 @kindex adi assign
23899 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23900
23901 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23902 to an address.
23903
23904 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23905 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23906 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23907
23908 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23909 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23910
23911 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23912
23913 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23914 variable "shmaddr":
23915
23916 @smallexample
23917 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23918 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23919 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23920 @end smallexample
23921
23922 @end table
23923
23924 @node Controlling GDB
23925 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23926
23927 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23928 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23929 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23930 described here.
23931
23932 @menu
23933 * Prompt:: Prompt
23934 * Editing:: Command editing
23935 * Command History:: Command history
23936 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23937 * Numbers:: Numbers
23938 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23939 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23940 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23941 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23942 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23943 @end menu
23944
23945 @node Prompt
23946 @section Prompt
23947
23948 @cindex prompt
23949
23950 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23951 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23952 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23953 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23954 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23955 which one you are talking to.
23956
23957 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23958 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23959 or a prompt that does not.
23960
23961 @table @code
23962 @kindex set prompt
23963 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23964 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23965
23966 @kindex show prompt
23967 @item show prompt
23968 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23969 @end table
23970
23971 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23972 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23973 are:
23974
23975 @table @code
23976 @kindex set extended-prompt
23977 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23978 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23979 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23980 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23981 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23982 is displayed.
23983
23984 For example:
23985
23986 @smallexample
23987 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23988 @end smallexample
23989
23990 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23991 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23992
23993 @kindex show extended-prompt
23994 @item show extended-prompt
23995 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23996 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23997 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23998 @end table
23999
24000 @node Editing
24001 @section Command Editing
24002 @cindex readline
24003 @cindex command line editing
24004
24005 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24006 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24007 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24008 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24009 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24010 debugging sessions.
24011
24012 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24013 command @code{set}.
24014
24015 @table @code
24016 @kindex set editing
24017 @cindex editing
24018 @item set editing
24019 @itemx set editing on
24020 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24021
24022 @item set editing off
24023 Disable command line editing.
24024
24025 @kindex show editing
24026 @item show editing
24027 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24028 @end table
24029
24030 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24031 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24032 @end ifset
24033 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24034 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24035 @end ifclear
24036 for more details about the Readline
24037 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24038 encouraged to read that chapter.
24039
24040 @node Command History
24041 @section Command History
24042 @cindex command history
24043
24044 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24045 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24046 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24047 history facility.
24048
24049 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24050 package, to provide the history facility.
24051 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24052 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24053 @end ifset
24054 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24055 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24056 @end ifclear
24057 for the detailed description of the History library.
24058
24059 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24060 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24061 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24062 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24063 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24064 pressed on a line by itself.
24065
24066 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24067 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24068 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24069 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24070
24071 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24072 history.
24073
24074 @table @code
24075 @cindex history substitution
24076 @cindex history file
24077 @kindex set history filename
24078 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24079 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24080 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24081 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24082 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24083 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24084 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24085 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24086 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24087 is not set.
24088
24089 @cindex save command history
24090 @kindex set history save
24091 @item set history save
24092 @itemx set history save on
24093 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24094 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24095
24096 @item set history save off
24097 Stop recording command history in a file.
24098
24099 @cindex history size
24100 @kindex set history size
24101 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24102 @item set history size @var{size}
24103 @itemx set history size unlimited
24104 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24105 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24106 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24107 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24108 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24109 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24110
24111 @cindex remove duplicate history
24112 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24113 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24114 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24115 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24116 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24117 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24118 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24119 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24120 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24121
24122 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24123 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24124
24125 @end table
24126
24127 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24128 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24129 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24130 @end ifset
24131 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24132 @xref{Event Designators},
24133 @end ifclear
24134 for more details.
24135
24136 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24137 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24138 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24139 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24140 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24141 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24142 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24143 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24144
24145 The commands to control history expansion are:
24146
24147 @table @code
24148 @item set history expansion on
24149 @itemx set history expansion
24150 @kindex set history expansion
24151 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24152
24153 @item set history expansion off
24154 Disable history expansion.
24155
24156 @c @group
24157 @kindex show history
24158 @item show history
24159 @itemx show history filename
24160 @itemx show history save
24161 @itemx show history size
24162 @itemx show history expansion
24163 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24164 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24165 @c @end group
24166 @end table
24167
24168 @table @code
24169 @kindex show commands
24170 @cindex show last commands
24171 @cindex display command history
24172 @item show commands
24173 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24174
24175 @item show commands @var{n}
24176 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24177
24178 @item show commands +
24179 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24180 @end table
24181
24182 @node Screen Size
24183 @section Screen Size
24184 @cindex size of screen
24185 @cindex screen size
24186 @cindex pagination
24187 @cindex page size
24188 @cindex pauses in output
24189
24190 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24191 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24192 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24193 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24194 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24195 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24196 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24197 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24198 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24199 following line.
24200
24201 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24202 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24203 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24204 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24205 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24206 width} commands:
24207
24208 @table @code
24209 @kindex set height
24210 @kindex set width
24211 @kindex show width
24212 @kindex show height
24213 @item set height @var{lpp}
24214 @itemx set height unlimited
24215 @itemx show height
24216 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24217 @itemx set width unlimited
24218 @itemx show width
24219 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24220 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24221 commands display the current settings.
24222
24223 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24224 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24225 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24226 buffer.
24227
24228 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24229 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24230
24231 @item set pagination on
24232 @itemx set pagination off
24233 @kindex set pagination
24234 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24235 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24236 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24237 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24238
24239 @item show pagination
24240 @kindex show pagination
24241 Show the current pagination mode.
24242 @end table
24243
24244 @node Numbers
24245 @section Numbers
24246 @cindex number representation
24247 @cindex entering numbers
24248
24249 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24250 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24251 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24252 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24253 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24254 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24255 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24256 both input and output with the commands described below.
24257
24258 @table @code
24259 @kindex set input-radix
24260 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24261 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24262 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24263 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24264 example, any of
24265
24266 @smallexample
24267 set input-radix 012
24268 set input-radix 10.
24269 set input-radix 0xa
24270 @end smallexample
24271
24272 @noindent
24273 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24274 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24275 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24276 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24277 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24278 change the radix.
24279
24280 @kindex set output-radix
24281 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24282 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24283 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24284 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24285
24286 @kindex show input-radix
24287 @item show input-radix
24288 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24289
24290 @kindex show output-radix
24291 @item show output-radix
24292 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24293
24294 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24295 @itemx show radix
24296 @kindex set radix
24297 @kindex show radix
24298 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24299 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24300 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24301 default value of 10.
24302
24303 @end table
24304
24305 @node ABI
24306 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24307
24308 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24309 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24310 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24311 current ABI.
24312
24313 @cindex OS ABI
24314 @kindex set osabi
24315 @kindex show osabi
24316 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24317
24318 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24319 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24320 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24321 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24322 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24323 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24324 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24325 platform provides.
24326
24327 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24328 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24329 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24330 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24331
24332 @table @code
24333 @item show osabi
24334 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24335
24336 @item set osabi
24337 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24338
24339 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24340 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24341 @end table
24342
24343 @cindex float promotion
24344
24345 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24346 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24347 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24348 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24349 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24350 @code{double} and then passed.
24351
24352 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24353 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24354 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24355
24356 @table @code
24357 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24358 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24359 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24360 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24361 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24362
24363 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24364 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24365 functions.
24366
24367 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24368 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24369 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24370 @end table
24371
24372 @kindex set cp-abi
24373 @kindex show cp-abi
24374 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24375 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24376 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24377 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24378 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24379 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24380 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24381 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24382 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24383 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24384 ``auto''.
24385
24386 @table @code
24387 @item show cp-abi
24388 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24389
24390 @item set cp-abi
24391 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24392
24393 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24394 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24395 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24396 @end table
24397
24398 @node Auto-loading
24399 @section Automatically loading associated files
24400 @cindex auto-loading
24401
24402 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24403 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24404 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24405 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24406 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24407 sources).
24408
24409 @menu
24410 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24411 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24412
24413 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24414 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24415 @end menu
24416
24417 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24418 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24419 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24420
24421 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24422 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24423 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24424
24425 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24426 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24427
24428 @table @code
24429 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24430 @kindex set auto-load off
24431 @item set auto-load off
24432 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24433 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24434 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24435 @smallexample
24436 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24437 @end smallexample
24438
24439 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24440 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24441 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24442 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24443 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24444 @code{set auto-load no}.
24445
24446 @anchor{show auto-load}
24447 @kindex show auto-load
24448 @item show auto-load
24449 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24450 or disabled.
24451
24452 @smallexample
24453 (gdb) show auto-load
24454 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24455 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24456 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24457 is on.
24458 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24459 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24460 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24461 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24462 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24463 @end smallexample
24464
24465 @anchor{info auto-load}
24466 @kindex info auto-load
24467 @item info auto-load
24468 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24469 not.
24470
24471 @smallexample
24472 (gdb) info auto-load
24473 gdb-scripts:
24474 Loaded Script
24475 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24476 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24477 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24478 loaded.
24479 python-scripts:
24480 Loaded Script
24481 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24482 @end smallexample
24483 @end table
24484
24485 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24486
24487 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24488 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24489 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24490 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24491 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24492 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24493 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24494 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24495 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24496 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24497 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24498 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24499 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24500 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24501 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24502 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24503 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24504 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24505 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24506 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24507 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24508 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24509 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24510 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24511 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24512 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24513 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24514 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24515 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24516 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24517 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24518 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24519 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24520 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24521 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24522 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24523 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24524 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24525 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24526 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24527 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24528 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24529 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24530 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24531 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24532 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24533 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24534 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24535 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24536 @end multitable
24537
24538 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24539 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24540 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24541
24542 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24543 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24544 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24545
24546 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24547 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24548
24549 @table @code
24550 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24551 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24552 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24553 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24554 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24555
24556 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24557 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24558 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24559 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24560 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24561
24562 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24563 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24564 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24565 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24566 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24567 @end table
24568
24569 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24570 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24571 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24572
24573 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24574
24575 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24576 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24577
24578 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24579 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24580 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24581 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24582 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24583 library.
24584
24585 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24586 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24587
24588 @table @code
24589 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24590 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24591 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24592 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24593
24594 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24595 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24596 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24597 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24598 enabled or disabled.
24599
24600 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24601 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24602 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24603 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24604 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24605 @end table
24606
24607 @node Auto-loading safe path
24608 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24609 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24610
24611 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24612 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24613 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24614 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24615 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24616
24617 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24618 get loaded:
24619
24620 @smallexample
24621 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24622 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24623 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24624 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24625 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24626 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24627 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24628 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24629 @end smallexample
24630
24631 @noindent
24632 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24633 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24634
24635 @smallexample
24636 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24637 @end smallexample
24638
24639 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24640
24641 @table @code
24642 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24643 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24644 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24645 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24646 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24647 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24648 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24649 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24650 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24651 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24652
24653 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24654 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24655 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24656
24657 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24658 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24659 @item show auto-load safe-path
24660 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24661 scripts.
24662
24663 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24664 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24665 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24666 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24667 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24668 by the host platform path separator in use.
24669 @end table
24670
24671 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24672 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24673 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24674 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24675 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24676
24677 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24678 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24679 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24680 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24681 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24682 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24683 init file in the current directory
24684 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24685
24686 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24687 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24688
24689 @table @asis
24690 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24691 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24692 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24693 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24694
24695 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24696 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24697 @value{GDBN} session.
24698
24699 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24700 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24701 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24702 from trusted sources.
24703
24704 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24705 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24706 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24707 trusted sources.
24708 @end table
24709
24710 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24711 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24712
24713 @table @asis
24714 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24715 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24716
24717 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24718 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24719 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24720 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24721 @end table
24722
24723 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24724 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24725 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24726 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24727 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24728 recommended to be entered.
24729
24730 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24731 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24732 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24733
24734 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24735 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24736 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24737 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24738 be printed.
24739
24740 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24741 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24742 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24743
24744 @smallexample
24745 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24746 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24747 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24748 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24749 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24750 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24751 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24752 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24753 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24754 @end smallexample
24755
24756 @table @code
24757 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24758 @kindex set debug auto-load
24759 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24760 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24761
24762 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24763 @kindex show debug auto-load
24764 @item show debug auto-load
24765 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24766 on or off.
24767 @end table
24768
24769 @node Messages/Warnings
24770 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24771
24772 @cindex verbose operation
24773 @cindex optional warnings
24774 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24775 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24776 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24777 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24778
24779 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24780 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24781 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24782
24783 @table @code
24784 @kindex set verbose
24785 @item set verbose on
24786 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24787
24788 @item set verbose off
24789 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24790
24791 @kindex show verbose
24792 @item show verbose
24793 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24794 @end table
24795
24796 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24797 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24798 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24799 Symbol Files}).
24800
24801 @table @code
24802
24803 @kindex set complaints
24804 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24805 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24806 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24807 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24808 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24809
24810 @kindex show complaints
24811 @item show complaints
24812 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24813
24814 @end table
24815
24816 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24817 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24818 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24819 you try to run a program which is already running:
24820
24821 @smallexample
24822 (@value{GDBP}) run
24823 The program being debugged has been started already.
24824 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24825 @end smallexample
24826
24827 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24828 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24829
24830 @table @code
24831
24832 @kindex set confirm
24833 @cindex flinching
24834 @cindex confirmation
24835 @cindex stupid questions
24836 @item set confirm off
24837 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24838 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24839 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24840
24841 @item set confirm on
24842 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24843
24844 @kindex show confirm
24845 @item show confirm
24846 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24847
24848 @end table
24849
24850 @cindex command tracing
24851 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24852 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24853 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24854 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24855
24856 @table @code
24857 @kindex set trace-commands
24858 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24859 @item set trace-commands on
24860 Enable command tracing.
24861 @item set trace-commands off
24862 Disable command tracing.
24863 @item show trace-commands
24864 Display the current state of command tracing.
24865 @end table
24866
24867 @node Debugging Output
24868 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24869 @cindex optional debugging messages
24870
24871 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24872 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24873 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24874 section documents those commands.
24875
24876 @table @code
24877 @kindex set exec-done-display
24878 @item set exec-done-display
24879 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24880 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24881 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24882 @kindex show exec-done-display
24883 @item show exec-done-display
24884 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24885 notification.
24886 @kindex set debug
24887 @cindex ARM AArch64
24888 @item set debug aarch64
24889 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24890 The default is off.
24891 @kindex show debug
24892 @item show debug aarch64
24893 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24894 ARM AArch64.
24895 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24896 @cindex architecture debugging info
24897 @item set debug arch
24898 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24899 @item show debug arch
24900 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24901 @item set debug aix-solib
24902 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24903 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24904 support module. The default is off.
24905 @item show debug aix-thread
24906 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24907 @item set debug aix-thread
24908 @cindex AIX threads
24909 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24910 module.
24911 @item show debug aix-thread
24912 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24913 @item set debug check-physname
24914 @cindex physname
24915 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24916 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24917 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24918 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24919 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24920 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24921 @item show debug check-physname
24922 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24923 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24924 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24925 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24926 exported symbols. The default is off.
24927 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24928 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24929 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24930 @item set debug dwarf-die
24931 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24932 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24933 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24934 A value of zero turns off the display.
24935 @item show debug dwarf-die
24936 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24937 @item set debug dwarf-line
24938 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24939 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24940 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24941 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24942 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24943 @item show debug dwarf-line
24944 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24945 @item set debug dwarf-read
24946 @cindex DWARF Reading
24947 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24948 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24949 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24950 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24951 @item show debug dwarf-read
24952 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24953 @item set debug displaced
24954 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24955 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24956 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24957 @item show debug displaced
24958 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24959 related to displaced stepping.
24960 @item set debug event
24961 @cindex event debugging info
24962 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24963 default is off.
24964 @item show debug event
24965 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24966 info.
24967 @item set debug expression
24968 @cindex expression debugging info
24969 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24970 expression parsing. The default is off.
24971 @item show debug expression
24972 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24973 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24974 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24975 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24976 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24977 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24978 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24979 @item set debug fbsd-nat
24980 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
24981 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
24982 @item show debug fbsd-nat
24983 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
24984 @item set debug frame
24985 @cindex frame debugging info
24986 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24987 default is off.
24988 @item show debug frame
24989 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24990 info.
24991 @item set debug gnu-nat
24992 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24993 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24994 @item show debug gnu-nat
24995 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24996 @item set debug infrun
24997 @cindex inferior debugging info
24998 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24999 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25000 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25001 @item show debug infrun
25002 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25003 @item set debug jit
25004 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25005 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25006 @item show debug jit
25007 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25008 @item set debug lin-lwp
25009 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25010 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25011 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25012 @item show debug lin-lwp
25013 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25014 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25015 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25016 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25017 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25018 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25019 @item set debug mach-o
25020 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25021 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25022 processing. The default is off.
25023 @item show debug mach-o
25024 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25025 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25026 @item set debug notification
25027 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25028 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25029 The default is off.
25030 @item show debug notification
25031 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25032 @item set debug observer
25033 @cindex observer debugging info
25034 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25035 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25036 @item show debug observer
25037 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25038 @item set debug overload
25039 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25040 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25041 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25042 is off.
25043 @item show debug overload
25044 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25045 debugging info.
25046 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25047 @cindex debug expression parser
25048 @item set debug parser
25049 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25050 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25051 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25052 details. The default is off.
25053 @item show debug parser
25054 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25055 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25056 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25057 @cindex debug remote protocol
25058 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25059 @cindex display remote packets
25060 @item set debug remote
25061 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25062 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25063 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25064 @item show debug remote
25065 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25066
25067 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25068 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25069 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25070 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25071
25072 @item set debug serial
25073 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25074 default is off.
25075 @item show debug serial
25076 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25077 info.
25078 @item set debug solib-frv
25079 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25080 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25081 @item show debug solib-frv
25082 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25083 messages.
25084 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25085 @cindex symbol lookup
25086 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25087 The default is 0 (off).
25088 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25089 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25090 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25091 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25092 @item set debug symfile
25093 @cindex symbol file functions
25094 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25095 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25096 @item show debug symfile
25097 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25098 @item set debug symtab-create
25099 @cindex symbol table creation
25100 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25101 The default is 0 (off).
25102 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25103 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25104 @item show debug symtab-create
25105 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25106 @item set debug target
25107 @cindex target debugging info
25108 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25109 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25110 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25111 value of large memory transfers.
25112 @item show debug target
25113 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25114 info.
25115 @item set debug timestamp
25116 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25117 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25118 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25119 message.
25120 @item show debug timestamp
25121 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25122 debugging info.
25123 @item set debug varobj
25124 @cindex variable object debugging info
25125 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25126 info. The default is off.
25127 @item show debug varobj
25128 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25129 debugging info.
25130 @item set debug xml
25131 @cindex XML parser debugging
25132 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25133 @item show debug xml
25134 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25135 @end table
25136
25137 @node Other Misc Settings
25138 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25139 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25140
25141 @table @code
25142 @kindex set interactive-mode
25143 @item set interactive-mode
25144 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25145 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25146 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25147 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25148 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25149 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25150 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25151 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25152
25153 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25154 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25155 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25156 inside a cygwin window.
25157
25158 @kindex show interactive-mode
25159 @item show interactive-mode
25160 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25161 @end table
25162
25163 @node Extending GDB
25164 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25165 @cindex extending GDB
25166
25167 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25168 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25169 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25170 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25171 being debugged.
25172
25173 @menu
25174 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25175 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25176 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25177 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25178 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25179 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25180 @end menu
25181
25182 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25183 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25184 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25185 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25186 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25187 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25188
25189 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25190 setting:
25191
25192 @table @code
25193 @kindex set script-extension
25194 @kindex show script-extension
25195 @item set script-extension off
25196 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25197
25198 @item set script-extension soft
25199 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25200 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25201 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25202 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25203
25204 @item set script-extension strict
25205 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25206 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25207 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25208
25209 @item show script-extension
25210 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25211
25212 @end table
25213
25214 @node Sequences
25215 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25216
25217 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25218 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25219 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25220 files.
25221
25222 @menu
25223 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25224 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25225 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25226 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25227 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25228 @end menu
25229
25230 @node Define
25231 @subsection User-defined Commands
25232
25233 @cindex user-defined command
25234 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25235 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25236 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25237 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25238 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25239 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25240
25241 @smallexample
25242 define adder
25243 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25244 end
25245 @end smallexample
25246
25247 @noindent
25248 To execute the command use:
25249
25250 @smallexample
25251 adder 1 2 3
25252 @end smallexample
25253
25254 @noindent
25255 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25256 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25257 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25258 functions calls.
25259
25260 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25261 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25262 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25263 been passed.
25264
25265 @smallexample
25266 define adder
25267 if $argc == 2
25268 print $arg0 + $arg1
25269 end
25270 if $argc == 3
25271 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25272 end
25273 end
25274 @end smallexample
25275
25276 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25277 to process a variable number of arguments:
25278
25279 @smallexample
25280 define adder
25281 set $i = 0
25282 set $sum = 0
25283 while $i < $argc
25284 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25285 set $i = $i + 1
25286 end
25287 print $sum
25288 end
25289 @end smallexample
25290
25291 @table @code
25292
25293 @kindex define
25294 @item define @var{commandname}
25295 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25296 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25297 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25298 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25299 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25300 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25301
25302 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25303 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25304 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25305
25306 @kindex document
25307 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25308 @item document @var{commandname}
25309 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25310 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25311 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25312 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25313 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25314 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25315
25316 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25317 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25318 does not change the documentation.
25319
25320 @kindex dont-repeat
25321 @cindex don't repeat command
25322 @item dont-repeat
25323 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25324 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25325 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25326
25327 @kindex help user-defined
25328 @item help user-defined
25329 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25330 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25331 included (if any).
25332
25333 @kindex show user
25334 @item show user
25335 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25336 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25337 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25338 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25339 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25340
25341 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25342 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25343 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25344 @item show max-user-call-depth
25345 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25346 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25347 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25348 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25349 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25350 @end table
25351
25352 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25353 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25354
25355 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25356 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25357 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25358
25359 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25360 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25361 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25362 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25363
25364 @node Hooks
25365 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25366 @cindex command hooks
25367 @cindex hooks, for commands
25368 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25369
25370 @kindex hook
25371 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25372 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25373 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25374 before that command.
25375
25376 @cindex hooks, post-command
25377 @kindex hookpost
25378 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25379 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25380 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25381 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25382 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25383
25384 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25385 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25386
25387 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25388 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25389
25390 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25391 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25392 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25393 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25394 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25395
25396 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25397 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25398 you could define:
25399
25400 @smallexample
25401 define hook-stop
25402 handle SIGALRM nopass
25403 end
25404
25405 define hook-run
25406 handle SIGALRM pass
25407 end
25408
25409 define hook-continue
25410 handle SIGALRM pass
25411 end
25412 @end smallexample
25413
25414 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25415 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25416 you could define:
25417
25418 @smallexample
25419 define hook-echo
25420 echo <<<---
25421 end
25422
25423 define hookpost-echo
25424 echo --->>>\n
25425 end
25426
25427 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25428 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25429 (@value{GDBP})
25430
25431 @end smallexample
25432
25433 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25434 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25435 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25436 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25437 @c or not?
25438 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25439 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25440 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25441
25442 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25443 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25444 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25445
25446 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25447 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25448
25449 @node Command Files
25450 @subsection Command Files
25451
25452 @cindex command files
25453 @cindex scripting commands
25454 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25455 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25456 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25457 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25458 terminal.
25459
25460 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25461 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25462 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25463 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25464 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25465
25466 @table @code
25467 @kindex source
25468 @cindex execute commands from a file
25469 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25470 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25471 @end table
25472
25473 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25474 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25475 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25476 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25477 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25478
25479 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25480 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25481 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25482 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25483 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25484 is not relevant to scripts.
25485
25486 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25487 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25488 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25489 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25490 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25491 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25492 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25493 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25494 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25495 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25496 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25497 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25498 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25499 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25500
25501 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25502 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25503 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25504
25505 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25506 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25507 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25508 when called from command files.
25509
25510 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25511 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25512 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25513 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25514 the next command.
25515
25516 @smallexample
25517 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25518 @end smallexample
25519
25520 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25521 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25522 would be directed to @file{log}.
25523
25524 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25525 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25526 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25527 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25528 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25529 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25530 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25531 conditionally, etc.
25532
25533 @table @code
25534 @kindex if
25535 @kindex else
25536 @item if
25537 @itemx else
25538 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25539 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25540 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25541 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25542 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25543 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25544 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25545
25546 @kindex while
25547 @item while
25548 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25549 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25550 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25551 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25552 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25553 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25554
25555 @kindex loop_break
25556 @item loop_break
25557 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25558 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25559 line.
25560
25561 @kindex loop_continue
25562 @item loop_continue
25563 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25564 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25565 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25566 the controlling expression.
25567
25568 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25569 @item end
25570 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25571 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25572 @end table
25573
25574
25575 @node Output
25576 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25577
25578 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25579 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25580 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25581 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25582 want.
25583
25584 @table @code
25585 @kindex echo
25586 @item echo @var{text}
25587 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25588 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25589 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25590 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25591 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25592 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25593 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25594 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25595 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25596 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25597 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25598
25599 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25600 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25601
25602 @smallexample
25603 echo This is some text\n\
25604 which is continued\n\
25605 onto several lines.\n
25606 @end smallexample
25607
25608 produces the same output as
25609
25610 @smallexample
25611 echo This is some text\n
25612 echo which is continued\n
25613 echo onto several lines.\n
25614 @end smallexample
25615
25616 @kindex output
25617 @item output @var{expression}
25618 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25619 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25620 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25621 on expressions.
25622
25623 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25624 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25625 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25626 Formats}, for more information.
25627
25628 @kindex printf
25629 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25630 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25631 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25632 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25633 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25634 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25635 executing the code below:
25636
25637 @smallexample
25638 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25639 @end smallexample
25640
25641 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25642 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25643 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25644 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25645 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25646 printed.
25647
25648 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25649
25650 @smallexample
25651 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25652 @end smallexample
25653
25654 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25655 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25656 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25657
25658 @itemize @bullet
25659 @item
25660 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25661
25662 @item
25663 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25664 width.
25665
25666 @item
25667 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25668 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25669
25670 @item
25671 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25672 supported.
25673
25674 @item
25675 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25676
25677 @item
25678 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25679 @end itemize
25680
25681 @noindent
25682 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25683 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25684 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25685 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25686
25687 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25688 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25689 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25690 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25691 supported.
25692
25693 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25694 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25695 together with a floating point specifier.
25696 letters:
25697
25698 @itemize @bullet
25699 @item
25700 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25701
25702 @item
25703 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25704
25705 @item
25706 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25707 @end itemize
25708
25709 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25710 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25711 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25712
25713 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25714 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25715
25716 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25717 @smallexample
25718 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25719 @end smallexample
25720
25721 @anchor{eval}
25722 @kindex eval
25723 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25724 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25725 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25726
25727 @end table
25728
25729 @node Auto-loading sequences
25730 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25731 @cindex native script auto-loading
25732
25733 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25734 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25735 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25736 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25737
25738 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25739 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25740
25741 @table @code
25742 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25743 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25744 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25745 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25746
25747 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25748 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25749 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25750 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25751 disabled.
25752
25753 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25754 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25755 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25756 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25757 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25758 auto-loaded.
25759 @end table
25760
25761 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25762 matching names are printed.
25763
25764 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25765 @include python.texi
25766
25767 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25768 @include guile.texi
25769
25770 @node Auto-loading extensions
25771 @section Auto-loading extensions
25772 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25773
25774 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25775 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25776 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25777 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25778 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25779
25780 @menu
25781 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25782 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25783 * Which flavor to choose?::
25784 @end menu
25785
25786 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25787 debugging commands and features.
25788
25789 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25790 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25791 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25792 for more information.
25793 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25794 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25795
25796 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25797 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25798
25799 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25800 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25801 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25802 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25803 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25804
25805 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25806 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25807 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25808 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25809
25810 @table @code
25811 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25812 GDB's own command language
25813 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25814 Python
25815 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25816 Guile
25817 @end table
25818
25819 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25820 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25821 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25822 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25823 script in the specified extension language.
25824
25825 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25826 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25827
25828 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25829 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25830
25831 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25832 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25833 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25834 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25835 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25836 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25837
25838 @table @code
25839 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25840 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25841 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25842 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25843 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25844 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25845
25846 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25847 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25848
25849 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25850 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25851 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25852 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25853
25854 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25855 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25856 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25857 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25858 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25859 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25860 platform.
25861
25862 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25863 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25864 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25865
25866 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25867 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25868 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25869 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25870
25871 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25872 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25873 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25874 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25875 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25876 @end table
25877
25878 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25879 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25880 @var{objfile} is opened.
25881 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25882 is evaluated more than once.
25883
25884 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25885 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25886 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25887
25888 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25889 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25890 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25891 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25892 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25893 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25894 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25895
25896 The following entries are supported:
25897
25898 @table @code
25899 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25900 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25901 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25902 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25903 @end table
25904
25905 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25906
25907 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25908 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25909 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25910 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25911 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25912
25913 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25914 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25915
25916 @example
25917 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25918 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25919 asm("\
25920 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25921 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25922 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25923 .popsection \n\
25924 ");
25925 @end example
25926
25927 @noindent
25928 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25929 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25930
25931 @example
25932 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25933 @end example
25934
25935 The script name may include directories if desired.
25936
25937 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25938 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25939
25940 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25941 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25942 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25943 will remove duplicates.
25944
25945 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25946
25947 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25948 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25949 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25950 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25951 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25952 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25953 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25954 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25955 on its name.
25956
25957 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25958 testsuite.
25959
25960 @example
25961 #include "symcat.h"
25962 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25963 asm(
25964 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25965 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25966 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25967 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25968 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25969 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25970 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25971 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25972 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25973 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25974 ".byte 0\n"
25975 ".popsection\n"
25976 );
25977 @end example
25978
25979 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25980 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25981 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25982 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25983
25984 @node Which flavor to choose?
25985 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25986
25987 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25988 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25989
25990 @noindent
25991 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25992
25993 @itemize @bullet
25994 @item
25995 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25996
25997 @item
25998 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25999
26000 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26001 in the source search path.
26002 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26003 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26004
26005 @item
26006 Doesn't require source code additions.
26007 @end itemize
26008
26009 @noindent
26010 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26011
26012 @itemize @bullet
26013 @item
26014 Works with static linking.
26015
26016 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26017 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26018 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26019 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26020 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26021
26022 @item
26023 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26024
26025 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26026 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26027
26028 @item
26029 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26030
26031 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26032 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26033 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26034 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26035 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26036 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26037 @end itemize
26038
26039 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26040 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26041
26042 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26043 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26044 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26045
26046 @subsection Python comes first
26047
26048 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26049 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26050 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26051 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26052 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26053 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26054 pretty-printed form of a value).
26055 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26056 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26057 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26058
26059 @node Aliases
26060 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26061 @cindex aliases for commands
26062
26063 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26064 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26065 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26066 that involves less typing.
26067
26068 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26069 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26070 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26071
26072 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26073 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26074 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26075
26076 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26077
26078 @table @code
26079
26080 @kindex alias
26081 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26082
26083 @end table
26084
26085 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26086 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26087 underscores.
26088
26089 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26090 that is being aliased.
26091
26092 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26093 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26094 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26095
26096 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26097 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26098
26099 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26100 of a command so that there is less to type.
26101 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26102 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26103 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26104 The following will accomplish this.
26105
26106 @smallexample
26107 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26108 @end smallexample
26109
26110 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26111 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26112 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26113 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26114
26115 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26116 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26117 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26118 of a command.
26119
26120 @smallexample
26121 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26122 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26123 (gdb) set p elms 20
26124 (gdb) show p elms
26125 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26126 @end smallexample
26127
26128 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26129 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26130 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26131
26132 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26133 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26134
26135 @smallexample
26136 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26137 @end smallexample
26138
26139 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26140 alias for a more complex command.
26141 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26142
26143 @smallexample
26144 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26145 (gdb) spe 20
26146 @end smallexample
26147
26148 @node Interpreters
26149 @chapter Command Interpreters
26150 @cindex command interpreters
26151
26152 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26153 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26154 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26155
26156 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26157 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26158 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26159 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26160
26161 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26162 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26163 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26164 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26165
26166 @table @code
26167 @item console
26168 @cindex console interpreter
26169 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26170 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26171 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26172
26173 @item mi
26174 @cindex mi interpreter
26175 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26176 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26177 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26178 Interface}.
26179
26180 @item mi2
26181 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26182 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26183
26184 @item mi1
26185 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26186 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26187
26188 @end table
26189
26190 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26191
26192 @kindex interpreter-exec
26193 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26194 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26195 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26196
26197 @smallexample
26198 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26199 @end smallexample
26200
26201 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26202 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26203
26204 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26205 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26206 permanently.
26207
26208 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26209
26210 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26211 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26212 device (usually a tty).
26213
26214 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26215 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26216 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26217 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26218 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26219 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26220 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26221 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26222 the separate MI interpreter.
26223
26224 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26225 @code{new-ui} command:
26226
26227 @kindex new-ui
26228 @cindex new user interface
26229 @smallexample
26230 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26231 @end smallexample
26232
26233 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26234 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26235 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26236 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26237 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26238 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26239
26240 @smallexample
26241 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26242 @end smallexample
26243
26244 @noindent
26245 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26246
26247 @node TUI
26248 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26249 @cindex TUI
26250 @cindex Text User Interface
26251
26252 @menu
26253 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26254 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26255 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26256 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26257 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26258 @end menu
26259
26260 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26261 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26262 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26263 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26264 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26265 is available.
26266
26267 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26268 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26269 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26270 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26271 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26272 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26273
26274 @node TUI Overview
26275 @section TUI Overview
26276
26277 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26278
26279 @table @emph
26280 @item command
26281 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26282 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26283 managed using readline.
26284
26285 @item source
26286 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26287 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26288
26289 @item assembly
26290 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26291
26292 @item register
26293 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26294 when their values change.
26295 @end table
26296
26297 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26298 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26299 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26300 indicates the breakpoint type:
26301
26302 @table @code
26303 @item B
26304 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26305
26306 @item b
26307 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26308
26309 @item H
26310 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26311
26312 @item h
26313 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26314 @end table
26315
26316 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26317
26318 @table @code
26319 @item +
26320 Breakpoint is enabled.
26321
26322 @item -
26323 Breakpoint is disabled.
26324 @end table
26325
26326 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26327 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26328 changes.
26329
26330 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26331 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26332 layouts:
26333
26334 @itemize @bullet
26335 @item
26336 source only,
26337
26338 @item
26339 assembly only,
26340
26341 @item
26342 source and assembly,
26343
26344 @item
26345 source and registers, or
26346
26347 @item
26348 assembly and registers.
26349 @end itemize
26350
26351 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26352
26353 @table @emph
26354 @item target
26355 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26356 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26357
26358 @item process
26359 Gives the current process or thread number.
26360 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26361
26362 @item function
26363 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26364 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26365 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26366 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26367
26368 @item line
26369 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26370 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26371
26372 @item pc
26373 Indicates the current program counter address.
26374 @end table
26375
26376 @node TUI Keys
26377 @section TUI Key Bindings
26378 @cindex TUI key bindings
26379
26380 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26381 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26382 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26383 @end ifset
26384 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26385 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26386 @end ifclear
26387 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26388 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26389
26390 @table @kbd
26391 @kindex C-x C-a
26392 @item C-x C-a
26393 @kindex C-x a
26394 @itemx C-x a
26395 @kindex C-x A
26396 @itemx C-x A
26397 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26398 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26399 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26400 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26401 The screen is then refreshed.
26402
26403 @kindex C-x 1
26404 @item C-x 1
26405 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26406 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26407 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26408
26409 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26410
26411 @kindex C-x 2
26412 @item C-x 2
26413 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26414 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26415 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26416 previous layout and the new one.
26417
26418 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26419
26420 @kindex C-x o
26421 @item C-x o
26422 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26423 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26424 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26425
26426 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26427
26428 @kindex C-x s
26429 @item C-x s
26430 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26431 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26432 @end table
26433
26434 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26435
26436 @table @asis
26437 @kindex PgUp
26438 @item @key{PgUp}
26439 Scroll the active window one page up.
26440
26441 @kindex PgDn
26442 @item @key{PgDn}
26443 Scroll the active window one page down.
26444
26445 @kindex Up
26446 @item @key{Up}
26447 Scroll the active window one line up.
26448
26449 @kindex Down
26450 @item @key{Down}
26451 Scroll the active window one line down.
26452
26453 @kindex Left
26454 @item @key{Left}
26455 Scroll the active window one column left.
26456
26457 @kindex Right
26458 @item @key{Right}
26459 Scroll the active window one column right.
26460
26461 @kindex C-L
26462 @item @kbd{C-L}
26463 Refresh the screen.
26464 @end table
26465
26466 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26467 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26468 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26469 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26470 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26471
26472 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26473 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26474 @cindex TUI single key mode
26475
26476 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26477 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26478 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26479
26480 @table @kbd
26481 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26482 @item c
26483 continue
26484
26485 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26486 @item d
26487 down
26488
26489 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26490 @item f
26491 finish
26492
26493 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26494 @item n
26495 next
26496
26497 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26498 @item o
26499 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26500
26501 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26502 @item q
26503 exit the SingleKey mode.
26504
26505 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26506 @item r
26507 run
26508
26509 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26510 @item s
26511 step
26512
26513 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26514 @item i
26515 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26516
26517 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26518 @item u
26519 up
26520
26521 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26522 @item v
26523 info locals
26524
26525 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26526 @item w
26527 where
26528 @end table
26529
26530 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26531 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26532 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26533 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26534 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26535 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26536
26537
26538 @node TUI Commands
26539 @section TUI-specific Commands
26540 @cindex TUI commands
26541
26542 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26543 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26544 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26545 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26546
26547 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26548 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26549 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26550 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26551 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26552
26553 @table @code
26554 @item tui enable
26555 @kindex tui enable
26556 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26557 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26558 otherwise a default layout is used.
26559
26560 @item tui disable
26561 @kindex tui disable
26562 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26563
26564 @item info win
26565 @kindex info win
26566 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26567
26568 @item layout @var{name}
26569 @kindex layout
26570 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26571 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26572 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26573
26574 @table @code
26575 @item next
26576 Display the next layout.
26577
26578 @item prev
26579 Display the previous layout.
26580
26581 @item src
26582 Display the source and command windows.
26583
26584 @item asm
26585 Display the assembly and command windows.
26586
26587 @item split
26588 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26589
26590 @item regs
26591 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26592 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26593 register, assembler, and command windows.
26594 @end table
26595
26596 @item focus @var{name}
26597 @kindex focus
26598 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26599 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26600
26601 @table @code
26602 @item next
26603 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26604
26605 @item prev
26606 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26607
26608 @item src
26609 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26610
26611 @item asm
26612 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26613
26614 @item regs
26615 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26616
26617 @item cmd
26618 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26619 @end table
26620
26621 @item refresh
26622 @kindex refresh
26623 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26624
26625 @item tui reg @var{group}
26626 @kindex tui reg
26627 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26628 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26629 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26630 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26631 following groups are available on most targets:
26632 @table @code
26633 @item next
26634 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26635 through all of the available register groups.
26636
26637 @item prev
26638 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26639 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26640 @var{next}.
26641
26642 @item general
26643 Display the general registers.
26644 @item float
26645 Display the floating point registers.
26646 @item system
26647 Display the system registers.
26648 @item vector
26649 Display the vector registers.
26650 @item all
26651 Display all registers.
26652 @end table
26653
26654 @item update
26655 @kindex update
26656 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26657
26658 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26659 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26660 @kindex winheight
26661 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26662 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26663 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26664 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26665 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26666
26667 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26668 @kindex tabset
26669 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26670 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26671 assembly windows.
26672 @end table
26673
26674 @node TUI Configuration
26675 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26676 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26677
26678 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26679
26680 @table @code
26681 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26682 @kindex set tui border-kind
26683 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26684 The possible values are the following:
26685 @table @code
26686 @item space
26687 Use a space character to draw the border.
26688
26689 @item ascii
26690 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26691
26692 @item acs
26693 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26694 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26695 @end table
26696
26697 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26698 @kindex set tui border-mode
26699 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26700 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26701 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26702 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26703 @table @code
26704 @item normal
26705 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26706
26707 @item standout
26708 Use standout mode.
26709
26710 @item reverse
26711 Use reverse video mode.
26712
26713 @item half
26714 Use half bright mode.
26715
26716 @item half-standout
26717 Use half bright and standout mode.
26718
26719 @item bold
26720 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26721
26722 @item bold-standout
26723 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26724 @end table
26725 @end table
26726
26727 @node Emacs
26728 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26729
26730 @cindex Emacs
26731 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26732 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26733 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26734 @value{GDBN}.
26735
26736 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26737 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26738 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26739 created Emacs buffer.
26740 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26741
26742 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26743 things:
26744
26745 @itemize @bullet
26746 @item
26747 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26748 the GUD buffer.
26749
26750 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26751 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26752
26753 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26754 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26755 in this way.
26756
26757 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26758 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26759 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26760 stop.
26761
26762 @item
26763 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26764
26765 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26766 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26767 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26768 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26769 and the source.
26770
26771 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26772 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26773 @end itemize
26774
26775 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26776 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26777 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26778 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26779
26780 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26781 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26782 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26783 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26784 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26785 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26786 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26787 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26788 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26789
26790 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26791 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26792 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26793 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26794
26795 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26796 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26797 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26798 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26799 one you want.
26800
26801 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26802 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26803
26804 @table @kbd
26805 @item C-h m
26806 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26807
26808 @item C-c C-s
26809 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26810 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26811
26812 @item C-c C-n
26813 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26814 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26815 to show the current file and location.
26816
26817 @item C-c C-i
26818 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26819 display window accordingly.
26820
26821 @item C-c C-f
26822 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26823 @code{finish} command.
26824
26825 @item C-c C-r
26826 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26827 command.
26828
26829 @item C-c <
26830 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26831 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26832 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26833
26834 @item C-c >
26835 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26836 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26837 @end table
26838
26839 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26840 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26841
26842 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26843 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26844 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26845 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26846 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26847 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26848 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26849
26850 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26851 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26852 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26853 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26854 frame.
26855
26856 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26857 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26858 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26859 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26860 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26861 to correspond properly with the code.
26862
26863 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26864 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26865 Emacs Manual}).
26866
26867 @node GDB/MI
26868 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26869
26870 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26871
26872 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26873 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26874 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26875 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26876 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26877 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26878
26879 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26880 in the form of a reference manual.
26881
26882 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26883 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26884 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26885
26886 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26887
26888 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26889 This chapter uses the following notation:
26890
26891 @itemize @bullet
26892 @item
26893 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26894
26895 @item
26896 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26897 it may or may not be given.
26898
26899 @item
26900 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26901 may repeat zero or more times.
26902
26903 @item
26904 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26905 may repeat one or more times.
26906
26907 @item
26908 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26909 @end itemize
26910
26911 @ignore
26912 @heading Dependencies
26913 @end ignore
26914
26915 @menu
26916 * GDB/MI General Design::
26917 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26918 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26919 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26920 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26921 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26922 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26923 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26924 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26925 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26926 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26927 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26928 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26929 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26930 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26931 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26932 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26933 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26934 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26935 @ignore
26936 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26937 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26938 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26939 @end ignore
26940 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26941 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26942 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26943 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26944 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26945 @end menu
26946
26947 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26948 @node GDB/MI General Design
26949 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26950 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26951
26952 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26953 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26954 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26955 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26956 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26957 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26958 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26959 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26960 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26961 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26962
26963 The important examples of notifications are:
26964 @itemize @bullet
26965
26966 @item
26967 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26968 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26969 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26970 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26971 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26972 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26973 command itself was successfully executed.
26974
26975 @item
26976 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26977 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26978 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26979 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26980 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26981 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26982
26983 @item
26984 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26985 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26986 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26987 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26988 orthogonal frontend design.
26989
26990 @end itemize
26991
26992 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26993 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26994 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26995 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26996 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26997 the user interface.
26998
26999
27000 @menu
27001 * Context management::
27002 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27003 * Thread groups::
27004 @end menu
27005
27006 @node Context management
27007 @subsection Context management
27008
27009 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27010
27011 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27012 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27013 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27014 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27015 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27016 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27017 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27018 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27019 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27020
27021 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27022 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27023 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27024 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27025 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27026 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27027 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27028 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27029 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27030 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27031 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27032
27033 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27034 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27035 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27036 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27037 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27038 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27039 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27040 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27041 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27042 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27043
27044 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27045 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27046 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27047 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27048 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27049 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27050 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27051 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27052 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27053 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27054 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27055 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27056 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27057 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27058 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27059 @samp{--frame} options.
27060
27061 @subsubsection Language
27062
27063 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27064 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27065 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27066 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27067 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27068 For instance:
27069
27070 @smallexample
27071 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27072 ^done,value="4"
27073 (gdb)
27074 @end smallexample
27075
27076 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27077 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27078 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27079
27080 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27081 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27082
27083 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27084 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27085 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27086 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27087 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27088 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27089 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27090 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27091 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27092
27093 @table @code
27094 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27095 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27096 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27097
27098 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27099 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27100 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27101
27102 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27103 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27104 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27105 MI commands even while the target is running.
27106
27107 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27108 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27109 @end table
27110
27111 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27112 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27113 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27114 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27115 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27116 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27117
27118 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27119 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27120 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27121 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27122 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27123 are running.
27124
27125 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27126 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27127 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27128 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27129 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27130 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27131 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27132 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27133 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27134 @samp{--thread} option).
27135
27136 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27137 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27138 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27139 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27140
27141 @node Thread groups
27142 @subsection Thread groups
27143 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27144 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27145 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27146 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27147 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27148
27149 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27150 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27151 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27152 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27153 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27154 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27155 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27156 into processes.
27157
27158 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27159 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27160 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27161 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27162 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27163 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27164 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27165 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27166 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27167 the members of specific thread group.
27168
27169 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27170 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27171 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27172 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27173 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27174 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27175 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27176 after attaching to that thread group.
27177
27178 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27179 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27180 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27181 such thread groups.
27182
27183 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27184 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27185 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27186
27187 @menu
27188 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27189 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27190 @end menu
27191
27192 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27193 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27194
27195 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27196 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27197 @table @code
27198 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27199 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27200
27201 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27202 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27203 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27204
27205 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27206 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27207 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27208
27209 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27210 "any sequence of digits"
27211
27212 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27213 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27214
27215 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27216 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27217
27218 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27219 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27220
27221 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27222 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27223 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27224
27225 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27226 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27227
27228 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27229 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27230 @end table
27231
27232 @noindent
27233 Notes:
27234
27235 @itemize @bullet
27236 @item
27237 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27238 output is described below.
27239
27240 @item
27241 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27242 finishes.
27243
27244 @item
27245 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27246 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27247 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27248 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27249 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27250 @end itemize
27251
27252 Pragmatics:
27253
27254 @itemize @bullet
27255 @item
27256 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27257
27258 @item
27259 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27260 @end itemize
27261
27262 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27263 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27264
27265 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27266 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27267 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27268 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27269 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27270 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27271
27272 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27273 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27274 @var{token}.
27275
27276 @table @code
27277 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27278 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27279
27280 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27281 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27282
27283 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27284 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27285
27286 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27287 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27288
27289 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27290 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27291
27292 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27293 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27294
27295 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27296 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27297
27298 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27299 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27300
27301 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27302 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27303
27304 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27305 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27306 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27307
27308 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27309 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27310
27311 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27312 @code{ @var{string} }
27313
27314 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27315 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27316
27317 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27318 @code{@var{c-string}}
27319
27320 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27321 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27322
27323 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27324 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27325 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27326
27327 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27328 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27329
27330 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27331 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27332
27333 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27334 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27335
27336 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27337 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27338
27339 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27340 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27341
27342 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27343 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27344 @end table
27345
27346 @noindent
27347 Notes:
27348
27349 @itemize @bullet
27350 @item
27351 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27352
27353 @item
27354 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27355 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27356 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27357 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27358 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27359 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27360 prior command.
27361
27362 @item
27363 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27364 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27365 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27366 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27367
27368 @item
27369 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27370 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27371 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27372 @samp{*}.
27373
27374 @item
27375 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27376 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27377 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27378 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27379
27380 @item
27381 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27382 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27383 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27384 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27385
27386 @item
27387 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27388 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27389 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27390
27391 @item
27392 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27393 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27394 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27395 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27396
27397 @item
27398 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27399 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27400 @var{values}.
27401
27402
27403 @end itemize
27404
27405 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27406 details about the various output records.
27407
27408 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27409 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27410 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27411
27412 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27413 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27414
27415 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27416 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27417 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27418 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27419 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27420 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27421
27422 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27423 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27424 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27425
27426 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27427 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27428 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27429 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27430
27431 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27432 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27433
27434 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27435 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27436 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27437 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27438 might change.
27439
27440 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27441 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27442 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27443 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27444
27445 @itemize @bullet
27446 @item
27447 New MI commands may be added.
27448
27449 @item
27450 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27451
27452 @item
27453 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27454 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27455
27456 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27457 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27458
27459 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27460 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27461 @end itemize
27462
27463 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27464 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27465 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27466 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27467 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27468
27469 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27470 @c version?
27471
27472 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27473 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27474 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27475 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27476 @cindex mailing lists
27477
27478 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27479 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27480 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27481
27482 @menu
27483 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27484 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27485 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27486 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27487 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27488 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27489 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27490 @end menu
27491
27492 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27493 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27494
27495 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27496 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27497 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27498 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27499
27500 @table @code
27501 @findex ^done
27502 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27503 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27504 values.
27505
27506 @item "^running"
27507 @findex ^running
27508 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27509 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27510 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27511 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27512 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27513 which threads are resumed.
27514
27515 @item "^connected"
27516 @findex ^connected
27517 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27518
27519 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27520 @findex ^error
27521 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27522 the corresponding error message.
27523
27524 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27525 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27526 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27527
27528 @table @samp
27529 @item "undefined-command"
27530 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27531 @end table
27532
27533 @item "^exit"
27534 @findex ^exit
27535 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27536
27537 @end table
27538
27539 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27540 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27541
27542 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27543 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27544 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27545 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27546 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27547
27548 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27549 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27550 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27551 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27552 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27553
27554 @table @code
27555 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27556 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27557 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27558
27559 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27560 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27561 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27562 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27563
27564 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27565 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27566 internals.
27567 @end table
27568
27569 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27570 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27571
27572 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27573 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27574 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27575 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27576 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27577 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27578
27579 The following is the list of possible async records:
27580
27581 @table @code
27582
27583 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27584 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27585 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27586 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27587 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27588 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27589 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27590 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27591 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27592 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27593 it run freely.
27594
27595 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27596 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27597 following values:
27598
27599 @table @code
27600 @item breakpoint-hit
27601 A breakpoint was reached.
27602 @item watchpoint-trigger
27603 A watchpoint was triggered.
27604 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27605 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27606 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27607 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27608 @item function-finished
27609 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27610 @item location-reached
27611 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27612 @item watchpoint-scope
27613 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27614 @item end-stepping-range
27615 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27616 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27617 @item exited-signalled
27618 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27619 @item exited
27620 The inferior exited.
27621 @item exited-normally
27622 The inferior exited normally.
27623 @item signal-received
27624 A signal was received by the inferior.
27625 @item solib-event
27626 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27627 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27628 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27629 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27630 @item fork
27631 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27632 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27633 @item vfork
27634 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27635 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27636 @item syscall-entry
27637 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27638 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27639 @item syscall-return
27640 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27641 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27642 @item exec
27643 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27644 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27645 @end table
27646
27647 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27648 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27649 Depending on whether all-stop
27650 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27651 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27652 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27653 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27654 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27655 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27656 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27657 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27658 if such information is not available.
27659
27660 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27661 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27662 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27663 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27664 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27665 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27666 cannot be used in any way.
27667
27668 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27669 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27670 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27671 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27672 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27673 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27674
27675 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27676 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27677 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27678 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27679 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27680 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27681
27682 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27683 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27684 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27685 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27686 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27687
27688 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27689 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27690 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27691 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27692 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27693 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27694 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27695 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27696 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27697
27698 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27699 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27700
27701 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27702 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27703 that thread.
27704
27705 @item =library-loaded,...
27706 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27707 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27708 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27709 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27710 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27711 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27712 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27713 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27714 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27715 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27716 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27717 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27718 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27719 to this library.
27720
27721 @item =library-unloaded,...
27722 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27723 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27724 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27725 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27726 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27727 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27728 thread groups.
27729
27730 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27731 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27732 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27733 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27734 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27735
27736 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27737 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27738 initial value @var{initial}.
27739
27740 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27741 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27742 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27743 trace state variables are deleted.
27744
27745 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27746 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27747 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27748 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27749 value of trace state variable is known.
27750
27751 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27752 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27753 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27754 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27755 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27756 user.
27757
27758 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27759 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27760 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27761
27762 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27763 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27764
27765 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27766 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27767 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27768 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27769 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27770
27771 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27772 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27773 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27774 for existing method and format values.
27775
27776 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27777 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27778 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27779 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27780 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27781 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27782
27783 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27784 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27785 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27786 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27787 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27788 executable code.
27789 @end table
27790
27791 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27792 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27793
27794 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27795 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27796 following fields:
27797
27798 @table @code
27799 @item number
27800 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27801 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27802 @samp{1.2}.
27803
27804 @item type
27805 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27806 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27807
27808 @item catch-type
27809 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27810 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27811
27812 @item disp
27813 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27814 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27815 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27816
27817 @item enabled
27818 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27819 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27820 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27821
27822 @item addr
27823 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27824 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27825 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27826 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27827 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27828
27829 @item func
27830 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27831 If not known, this field is not present.
27832
27833 @item filename
27834 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27835 If not known, this field is not present.
27836
27837 @item fullname
27838 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27839 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27840
27841 @item line
27842 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27843 If not known, this field is not present.
27844
27845 @item at
27846 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27847 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27848 by a symbol name.
27849
27850 @item pending
27851 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27852 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27853
27854 @item evaluated-by
27855 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27856 @samp{target}.
27857
27858 @item thread
27859 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27860 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27861
27862 @item task
27863 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27864 field will hold the task identifier.
27865
27866 @item cond
27867 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27868
27869 @item ignore
27870 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27871
27872 @item enable
27873 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27874
27875 @item traceframe-usage
27876 FIXME.
27877
27878 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27879 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27880
27881 @item mask
27882 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27883
27884 @item pass
27885 A tracepoint's pass count.
27886
27887 @item original-location
27888 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27889 This field is optional.
27890
27891 @item times
27892 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27893
27894 @item installed
27895 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27896 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27897 is not.
27898
27899 @item what
27900 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27901
27902 @end table
27903
27904 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27905 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27906
27907 @smallexample
27908 -> -break-insert main
27909 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27910 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27911 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27912 times="0"@}
27913 <- (gdb)
27914 @end smallexample
27915
27916 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27917 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27918
27919 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27920 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27921 fields:
27922
27923 @table @code
27924 @item level
27925 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27926 zero. This field is always present.
27927
27928 @item func
27929 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27930 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27931
27932 @item addr
27933 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27934
27935 @item file
27936 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27937 address. This field may be absent.
27938
27939 @item line
27940 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27941 may be absent.
27942
27943 @item from
27944 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27945 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27946
27947 @end table
27948
27949 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27950 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27951
27952 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27953 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27954 stated otherwise.
27955
27956 @table @code
27957 @item id
27958 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27959
27960 @item target-id
27961 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27962
27963 @item details
27964 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27965 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27966 frontend. This field is optional.
27967
27968 @item name
27969 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27970 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27971 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27972 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27973 field is omitted.
27974
27975 @item state
27976 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27977 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27978
27979 @item frame
27980 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27981 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27982 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27983
27984 @item core
27985 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27986 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27987 @end table
27988
27989 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27990 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27991
27992 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27993 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27994 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27995 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
27996 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
27997 the @code{exception-message} field.
27998
27999 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28000 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28001 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28002 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28003
28004 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28005 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28006 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28007 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28008
28009 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28010 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28011
28012 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28013
28014 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28015 information of the breakpoint.
28016
28017 @smallexample
28018 -> -break-insert main
28019 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28020 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28021 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28022 times="0"@}
28023 <- (gdb)
28024 @end smallexample
28025
28026 @subheading Program Execution
28027
28028 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28029 reason that execution stopped.
28030
28031 @smallexample
28032 -> -exec-run
28033 <- ^running
28034 <- (gdb)
28035 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28036 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28037 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28038 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28039 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28040 <- (gdb)
28041 -> -exec-continue
28042 <- ^running
28043 <- (gdb)
28044 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28045 <- (gdb)
28046 @end smallexample
28047
28048 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28049
28050 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28051
28052 @smallexample
28053 -> (gdb)
28054 <- -gdb-exit
28055 <- ^exit
28056 @end smallexample
28057
28058 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28059 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28060 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28061 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28062 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28063 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28064
28065 @subheading A Bad Command
28066
28067 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28068
28069 @smallexample
28070 -> -rubbish
28071 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28072 <- (gdb)
28073 @end smallexample
28074
28075
28076 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28077 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28078 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28079
28080 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28081 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28082
28083 @subheading Motivation
28084
28085 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28086
28087 @subheading Introduction
28088
28089 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28090
28091 @subheading Commands
28092
28093 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28094
28095 @subsubheading Synopsis
28096
28097 @smallexample
28098 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28099 @end smallexample
28100
28101 @subsubheading Result
28102
28103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28104
28105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28106
28107 @subsubheading Example
28108
28109 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28110 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28111
28112
28113 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28114 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28115 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28116
28117 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28118 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28119 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28120 breakpoints.
28121
28122 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28123 @findex -break-after
28124
28125 @subsubheading Synopsis
28126
28127 @smallexample
28128 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28129 @end smallexample
28130
28131 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28132 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28133 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28134 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28135
28136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28137
28138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28139
28140 @subsubheading Example
28141
28142 @smallexample
28143 (gdb)
28144 -break-insert main
28145 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28146 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28147 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28148 times="0"@}
28149 (gdb)
28150 -break-after 1 3
28151 ~
28152 ^done
28153 (gdb)
28154 -break-list
28155 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28156 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28157 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28158 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28159 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28160 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28161 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28162 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28163 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28164 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28165 (gdb)
28166 @end smallexample
28167
28168 @ignore
28169 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28170 @findex -break-catch
28171 @end ignore
28172
28173 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28174 @findex -break-commands
28175
28176 @subsubheading Synopsis
28177
28178 @smallexample
28179 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28180 @end smallexample
28181
28182 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28183 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28184 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28185 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28186 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28187 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28188
28189 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28190
28191 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28192
28193 @subsubheading Example
28194
28195 @smallexample
28196 (gdb)
28197 -break-insert main
28198 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28199 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28200 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28201 times="0"@}
28202 (gdb)
28203 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28204 ^done
28205 (gdb)
28206 @end smallexample
28207
28208 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28209 @findex -break-condition
28210
28211 @subsubheading Synopsis
28212
28213 @smallexample
28214 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28215 @end smallexample
28216
28217 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28218 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28219 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28220 command below).
28221
28222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28223
28224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28225
28226 @subsubheading Example
28227
28228 @smallexample
28229 (gdb)
28230 -break-condition 1 1
28231 ^done
28232 (gdb)
28233 -break-list
28234 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28235 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28236 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28237 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28238 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28239 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28240 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28241 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28242 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28243 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28244 (gdb)
28245 @end smallexample
28246
28247 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28248 @findex -break-delete
28249
28250 @subsubheading Synopsis
28251
28252 @smallexample
28253 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28254 @end smallexample
28255
28256 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28257 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28258
28259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28260
28261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28262
28263 @subsubheading Example
28264
28265 @smallexample
28266 (gdb)
28267 -break-delete 1
28268 ^done
28269 (gdb)
28270 -break-list
28271 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28272 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28273 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28274 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28275 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28276 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28277 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28278 body=[]@}
28279 (gdb)
28280 @end smallexample
28281
28282 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28283 @findex -break-disable
28284
28285 @subsubheading Synopsis
28286
28287 @smallexample
28288 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28289 @end smallexample
28290
28291 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28292 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28293
28294 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28295
28296 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28297
28298 @subsubheading Example
28299
28300 @smallexample
28301 (gdb)
28302 -break-disable 2
28303 ^done
28304 (gdb)
28305 -break-list
28306 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28307 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28308 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28309 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28310 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28311 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28312 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28313 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28314 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28315 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28316 (gdb)
28317 @end smallexample
28318
28319 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28320 @findex -break-enable
28321
28322 @subsubheading Synopsis
28323
28324 @smallexample
28325 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28326 @end smallexample
28327
28328 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28329
28330 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28331
28332 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28333
28334 @subsubheading Example
28335
28336 @smallexample
28337 (gdb)
28338 -break-enable 2
28339 ^done
28340 (gdb)
28341 -break-list
28342 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28343 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28344 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28345 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28346 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28347 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28348 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28349 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28350 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28351 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28352 (gdb)
28353 @end smallexample
28354
28355 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28356 @findex -break-info
28357
28358 @subsubheading Synopsis
28359
28360 @smallexample
28361 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28362 @end smallexample
28363
28364 @c REDUNDANT???
28365 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28366
28367 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28368 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28369 table.
28370
28371 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28372
28373 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28374
28375 @subsubheading Example
28376 N.A.
28377
28378 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28379 @findex -break-insert
28380 @anchor{-break-insert}
28381
28382 @subsubheading Synopsis
28383
28384 @smallexample
28385 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28386 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28387 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28388 @end smallexample
28389
28390 @noindent
28391 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28392
28393 @table @var
28394 @item linespec location
28395 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28396
28397 @item explicit location
28398 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28399 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28400 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28401
28402 @table @samp
28403 @item --source @var{filename}
28404 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28405 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28406
28407 @item --function @var{function}
28408 The name of a function or method.
28409
28410 @item --label @var{label}
28411 The name of a label.
28412
28413 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28414 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28415 @end table
28416
28417 @item address location
28418 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28419 @end table
28420
28421 @noindent
28422 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28423
28424 @table @samp
28425 @item -t
28426 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28427 @item -h
28428 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28429 @item -f
28430 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28431 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28432 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28433 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28434 cannot be parsed.
28435 @item -d
28436 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28437 @item -a
28438 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28439 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28440 @item -c @var{condition}
28441 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28442 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28443 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28444 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28445 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28446 @var{thread-id}.
28447 @end table
28448
28449 @subsubheading Result
28450
28451 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28452 resulting breakpoint.
28453
28454 Note: this format is open to change.
28455 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28456
28457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28458
28459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28460 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28461
28462 @subsubheading Example
28463
28464 @smallexample
28465 (gdb)
28466 -break-insert main
28467 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28468 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28469 times="0"@}
28470 (gdb)
28471 -break-insert -t foo
28472 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28473 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28474 times="0"@}
28475 (gdb)
28476 -break-list
28477 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28478 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28479 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28480 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28481 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28482 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28483 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28484 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28485 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28486 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28487 times="0"@},
28488 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28489 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28490 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28491 times="0"@}]@}
28492 (gdb)
28493 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28494 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28495 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28496 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28497 @c times="0"@}
28498 @c (gdb)
28499 @end smallexample
28500
28501 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28502 @findex -dprintf-insert
28503
28504 @subsubheading Synopsis
28505
28506 @smallexample
28507 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28508 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28509 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28510 [ @var{argument} ]
28511 @end smallexample
28512
28513 @noindent
28514 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28515 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28516
28517 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28518
28519 @table @samp
28520 @item -t
28521 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28522 @item -f
28523 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28524 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28525 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28526 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28527 cannot be parsed.
28528 @item -d
28529 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28530 @item -c @var{condition}
28531 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28532 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28533 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28534 to @var{ignore-count}.
28535 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28536 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28537 @var{thread-id}.
28538 @end table
28539
28540 @subsubheading Result
28541
28542 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28543 resulting breakpoint.
28544
28545 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28546
28547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28548
28549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28550
28551 @subsubheading Example
28552
28553 @smallexample
28554 (gdb)
28555 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28556 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28557 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28558 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28559 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28560 original-location="foo"@}
28561 (gdb)
28562 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28563 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28564 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28565 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28566 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28567 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28568 (gdb)
28569 @end smallexample
28570
28571 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28572 @findex -break-list
28573
28574 @subsubheading Synopsis
28575
28576 @smallexample
28577 -break-list
28578 @end smallexample
28579
28580 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28581
28582 @table @samp
28583 @item Number
28584 number of the breakpoint
28585 @item Type
28586 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28587 @item Disposition
28588 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28589 or @samp{nokeep}
28590 @item Enabled
28591 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28592 @item Address
28593 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28594 @item What
28595 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28596 name, line number
28597 @item Thread-groups
28598 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28599 @item Times
28600 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28601 @end table
28602
28603 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28604 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28605
28606 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28607
28608 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28609
28610 @subsubheading Example
28611
28612 @smallexample
28613 (gdb)
28614 -break-list
28615 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28616 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28617 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28618 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28619 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28620 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28621 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28622 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28623 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28624 times="0"@},
28625 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28626 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28627 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28628 (gdb)
28629 @end smallexample
28630
28631 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28632
28633 @smallexample
28634 (gdb)
28635 -break-list
28636 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28637 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28638 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28639 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28640 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28641 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28642 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28643 body=[]@}
28644 (gdb)
28645 @end smallexample
28646
28647 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28648 @findex -break-passcount
28649
28650 @subsubheading Synopsis
28651
28652 @smallexample
28653 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28654 @end smallexample
28655
28656 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28657 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28658 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28659 command @samp{passcount}.
28660
28661 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28662 @findex -break-watch
28663
28664 @subsubheading Synopsis
28665
28666 @smallexample
28667 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28668 @end smallexample
28669
28670 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28671 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28672 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28673 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28674 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28675 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28676 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28677 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28678
28679 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28680 breakpoints inserted.
28681
28682 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28683
28684 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28685 @samp{rwatch}.
28686
28687 @subsubheading Example
28688
28689 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28690
28691 @smallexample
28692 (gdb)
28693 -break-watch x
28694 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28695 (gdb)
28696 -exec-continue
28697 ^running
28698 (gdb)
28699 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28700 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28701 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28702 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28703 (gdb)
28704 @end smallexample
28705
28706 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28707 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28708 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28709
28710 @smallexample
28711 (gdb)
28712 -break-watch C
28713 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28714 (gdb)
28715 -exec-continue
28716 ^running
28717 (gdb)
28718 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28719 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28720 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28721 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28722 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28723 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28724 (gdb)
28725 -exec-continue
28726 ^running
28727 (gdb)
28728 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28729 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28730 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28731 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28732 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28733 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28734 (gdb)
28735 @end smallexample
28736
28737 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28738 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28739 deleted.
28740
28741 @smallexample
28742 (gdb)
28743 -break-watch C
28744 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28745 (gdb)
28746 -break-list
28747 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28748 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28749 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28750 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28751 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28752 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28753 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28754 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28755 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28756 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28757 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28758 times="1"@},
28759 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28760 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28761 (gdb)
28762 -exec-continue
28763 ^running
28764 (gdb)
28765 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28766 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28767 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28768 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28769 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28770 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28771 (gdb)
28772 -break-list
28773 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28774 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28775 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28776 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28777 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28778 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28779 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28780 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28781 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28782 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28783 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28784 times="1"@},
28785 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28786 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28787 (gdb)
28788 -exec-continue
28789 ^running
28790 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28791 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28792 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28793 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28794 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28795 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28796 (gdb)
28797 -break-list
28798 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28799 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28800 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28801 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28802 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28803 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28804 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28805 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28806 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28807 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28808 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28809 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28810 (gdb)
28811 @end smallexample
28812
28813
28814 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28815 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28816 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28817
28818 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28819 catchpoints.
28820
28821 @menu
28822 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28823 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28824 @end menu
28825
28826 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28827 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28828
28829 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28830 @findex -catch-load
28831
28832 @subsubheading Synopsis
28833
28834 @smallexample
28835 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28836 @end smallexample
28837
28838 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28839 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28840 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28841 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28842 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28843
28844
28845 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28846
28847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28848
28849 @subsubheading Example
28850
28851 @smallexample
28852 -catch-load -t foo.so
28853 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28854 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28855 (gdb)
28856 @end smallexample
28857
28858
28859 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28860 @findex -catch-unload
28861
28862 @subsubheading Synopsis
28863
28864 @smallexample
28865 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28866 @end smallexample
28867
28868 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28869 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28870 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28871 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28872 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28873
28874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28875
28876 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28877
28878 @subsubheading Example
28879
28880 @smallexample
28881 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28882 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28883 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28884 (gdb)
28885 @end smallexample
28886
28887 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28888 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28889
28890 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28891 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28892
28893 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28894 @findex -catch-assert
28895
28896 @subsubheading Synopsis
28897
28898 @smallexample
28899 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28900 @end smallexample
28901
28902 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28903
28904 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28905
28906 @table @samp
28907 @item -c @var{condition}
28908 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28909 @item -d
28910 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28911 @item -t
28912 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28913 @end table
28914
28915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28916
28917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28918
28919 @subsubheading Example
28920
28921 @smallexample
28922 -catch-assert
28923 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28924 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28925 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28926 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28927 (gdb)
28928 @end smallexample
28929
28930 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28931 @findex -catch-exception
28932
28933 @subsubheading Synopsis
28934
28935 @smallexample
28936 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28937 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28938 @end smallexample
28939
28940 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28941 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28942 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28943 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28944 catchpoints.
28945
28946 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28947
28948 @table @samp
28949 @item -c @var{condition}
28950 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28951 @item -d
28952 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28953 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28954 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28955 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28956 @item -t
28957 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28958 @item -u
28959 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28960 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28961 @end table
28962
28963 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28964
28965 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28966 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28967
28968 @subsubheading Example
28969
28970 @smallexample
28971 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28972 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28973 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28974 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28975 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28976 (gdb)
28977 @end smallexample
28978
28979 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
28980 @findex -catch-handlers
28981
28982 @subsubheading Synopsis
28983
28984 @smallexample
28985 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28986 [ -t ]
28987 @end smallexample
28988
28989 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
28990 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28991 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28992 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28993 catchpoints.
28994
28995 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28996
28997 @table @samp
28998 @item -c @var{condition}
28999 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29000 @item -d
29001 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29002 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29003 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29004 @item -t
29005 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29006 @end table
29007
29008 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29009
29010 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29011
29012 @subsubheading Example
29013
29014 @smallexample
29015 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29016 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29017 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29018 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29019 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29020 (gdb)
29021 @end smallexample
29022
29023 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29024 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29025 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29026
29027 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29028 @findex -exec-arguments
29029
29030
29031 @subsubheading Synopsis
29032
29033 @smallexample
29034 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29035 @end smallexample
29036
29037 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29038 @samp{-exec-run}.
29039
29040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29041
29042 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29043
29044 @subsubheading Example
29045
29046 @smallexample
29047 (gdb)
29048 -exec-arguments -v word
29049 ^done
29050 (gdb)
29051 @end smallexample
29052
29053
29054 @ignore
29055 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29056 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29057
29058 @subsubheading Synopsis
29059
29060 @smallexample
29061 -exec-show-arguments
29062 @end smallexample
29063
29064 Print the arguments of the program.
29065
29066 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29067
29068 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29069
29070 @subsubheading Example
29071 N.A.
29072 @end ignore
29073
29074
29075 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29076 @findex -environment-cd
29077
29078 @subsubheading Synopsis
29079
29080 @smallexample
29081 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29082 @end smallexample
29083
29084 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29085
29086 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29087
29088 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29089
29090 @subsubheading Example
29091
29092 @smallexample
29093 (gdb)
29094 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29095 ^done
29096 (gdb)
29097 @end smallexample
29098
29099
29100 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29101 @findex -environment-directory
29102
29103 @subsubheading Synopsis
29104
29105 @smallexample
29106 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29107 @end smallexample
29108
29109 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29110 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29111 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29112 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29113 occurs as normal.
29114 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29115 multiple directories in a single command
29116 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29117 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29118 If blanks are needed as
29119 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29120 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29121 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29122 character must not be used
29123 in any directory name.
29124 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29125
29126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29127
29128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29129
29130 @subsubheading Example
29131
29132 @smallexample
29133 (gdb)
29134 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29135 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29136 (gdb)
29137 -environment-directory ""
29138 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29139 (gdb)
29140 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29141 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29142 (gdb)
29143 -environment-directory -r
29144 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29145 (gdb)
29146 @end smallexample
29147
29148
29149 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29150 @findex -environment-path
29151
29152 @subsubheading Synopsis
29153
29154 @smallexample
29155 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29156 @end smallexample
29157
29158 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29159 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29160 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29161 supplied in addition to the
29162 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29163 occurs as normal.
29164 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29165 multiple directories in a single command
29166 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29167 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29168 If blanks are needed as
29169 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29170 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29171 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29172 character must not be used
29173 in any directory name.
29174 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29175
29176
29177 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29178
29179 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29180
29181 @subsubheading Example
29182
29183 @smallexample
29184 (gdb)
29185 -environment-path
29186 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29187 (gdb)
29188 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29189 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29190 (gdb)
29191 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29192 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29193 (gdb)
29194 @end smallexample
29195
29196
29197 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29198 @findex -environment-pwd
29199
29200 @subsubheading Synopsis
29201
29202 @smallexample
29203 -environment-pwd
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206 Show the current working directory.
29207
29208 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29209
29210 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29211
29212 @subsubheading Example
29213
29214 @smallexample
29215 (gdb)
29216 -environment-pwd
29217 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29218 (gdb)
29219 @end smallexample
29220
29221 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29222 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29223 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29224
29225
29226 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29227 @findex -thread-info
29228
29229 @subsubheading Synopsis
29230
29231 @smallexample
29232 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29233 @end smallexample
29234
29235 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29236 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29237 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29238 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29239 current thread.
29240
29241 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29242
29243 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29244 about all threads.
29245
29246 @subsubheading Result
29247
29248 The result contains the following attributes:
29249
29250 @table @samp
29251 @item threads
29252 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29253 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29254
29255 @item current-thread-id
29256 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29257 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29258 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29259 the command.
29260
29261 @end table
29262
29263 @subsubheading Example
29264
29265 @smallexample
29266 -thread-info
29267 ^done,threads=[
29268 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29269 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29270 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29271 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29272 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29273 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29274 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29275 state="running"@}],
29276 current-thread-id="1"
29277 (gdb)
29278 @end smallexample
29279
29280 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29281 @findex -thread-list-ids
29282
29283 @subsubheading Synopsis
29284
29285 @smallexample
29286 -thread-list-ids
29287 @end smallexample
29288
29289 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29290 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29291 threads.
29292
29293 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29294 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29295
29296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29297
29298 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29299
29300 @subsubheading Example
29301
29302 @smallexample
29303 (gdb)
29304 -thread-list-ids
29305 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29306 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29307 (gdb)
29308 @end smallexample
29309
29310
29311 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29312 @findex -thread-select
29313
29314 @subsubheading Synopsis
29315
29316 @smallexample
29317 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29318 @end smallexample
29319
29320 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29321 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29322 topmost frame for that thread.
29323
29324 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29325 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29326
29327 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29328
29329 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29330
29331 @subsubheading Example
29332
29333 @smallexample
29334 (gdb)
29335 -exec-next
29336 ^running
29337 (gdb)
29338 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29339 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29340 (gdb)
29341 -thread-list-ids
29342 ^done,
29343 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29344 number-of-threads="3"
29345 (gdb)
29346 -thread-select 3
29347 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29348 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29349 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29350 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29351 (gdb)
29352 @end smallexample
29353
29354 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29355 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29356 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29357
29358 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29359 @findex -ada-task-info
29360
29361 @subsubheading Synopsis
29362
29363 @smallexample
29364 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29365 @end smallexample
29366
29367 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29368 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29369
29370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29371
29372 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29373 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29374
29375 @subsubheading Result
29376
29377 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29378 defined for each Ada task:
29379
29380 @table @samp
29381 @item current
29382 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29383
29384 @item id
29385 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29386
29387 @item task-id
29388 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29389
29390 @item thread-id
29391 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29392 task.
29393
29394 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29395 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29396 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29397
29398 @item parent-id
29399 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29400 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29401
29402 @item priority
29403 The base priority of the task.
29404
29405 @item state
29406 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29407 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29408
29409 @item name
29410 The name of the task.
29411
29412 @end table
29413
29414 @subsubheading Example
29415
29416 @smallexample
29417 -ada-task-info
29418 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29419 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29420 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29421 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29422 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29423 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29424 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29425 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29426 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29427 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29428 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29429 (gdb)
29430 @end smallexample
29431
29432 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29433 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29434 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29435
29436 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29437 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29438 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29439 other cases.
29440
29441 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29442 @findex -exec-continue
29443
29444 @subsubheading Synopsis
29445
29446 @smallexample
29447 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29448 @end smallexample
29449
29450 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29451 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29452 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29453 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29454 @itemize @bullet
29455 @item
29456 breakpoints or watchpoints
29457 @item
29458 signals or exceptions
29459 @item
29460 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29461 @item
29462 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29463 @end itemize
29464 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29465 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29466 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29467 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29468 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29469 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29470
29471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29472
29473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29474
29475 @subsubheading Example
29476
29477 @smallexample
29478 -exec-continue
29479 ^running
29480 (gdb)
29481 @@Hello world
29482 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29483 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29484 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29485 (gdb)
29486 @end smallexample
29487
29488
29489 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29490 @findex -exec-finish
29491
29492 @subsubheading Synopsis
29493
29494 @smallexample
29495 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29496 @end smallexample
29497
29498 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29499 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29500 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29501 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29502 function was called.
29503
29504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29505
29506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29507
29508 @subsubheading Example
29509
29510 Function returning @code{void}.
29511
29512 @smallexample
29513 -exec-finish
29514 ^running
29515 (gdb)
29516 @@hello from foo
29517 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29518 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29523 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29524 value itself.
29525
29526 @smallexample
29527 -exec-finish
29528 ^running
29529 (gdb)
29530 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29531 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29532 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29533 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29534 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29535 (gdb)
29536 @end smallexample
29537
29538
29539 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29540 @findex -exec-interrupt
29541
29542 @subsubheading Synopsis
29543
29544 @smallexample
29545 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29546 @end smallexample
29547
29548 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29549 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29550 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29551 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29552 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29553
29554 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29555 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29556 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29557 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29558
29559 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29560 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29561 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29562 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29563
29564 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29565
29566 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29567
29568 @subsubheading Example
29569
29570 @smallexample
29571 (gdb)
29572 111-exec-continue
29573 111^running
29574
29575 (gdb)
29576 222-exec-interrupt
29577 222^done
29578 (gdb)
29579 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29580 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29581 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29582 (gdb)
29583
29584 (gdb)
29585 -exec-interrupt
29586 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29587 (gdb)
29588 @end smallexample
29589
29590 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29591 @findex -exec-jump
29592
29593 @subsubheading Synopsis
29594
29595 @smallexample
29596 -exec-jump @var{location}
29597 @end smallexample
29598
29599 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29600 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29601 different forms of @var{location}.
29602
29603 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29604
29605 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29606
29607 @subsubheading Example
29608
29609 @smallexample
29610 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29611 *running,thread-id="all"
29612 ^running
29613 @end smallexample
29614
29615
29616 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29617 @findex -exec-next
29618
29619 @subsubheading Synopsis
29620
29621 @smallexample
29622 -exec-next [--reverse]
29623 @end smallexample
29624
29625 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29626 of the next source line is reached.
29627
29628 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29629 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29630 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29631 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29632 source line where the function was called.
29633
29634
29635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29636
29637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29638
29639 @subsubheading Example
29640
29641 @smallexample
29642 -exec-next
29643 ^running
29644 (gdb)
29645 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29646 (gdb)
29647 @end smallexample
29648
29649
29650 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29651 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29652
29653 @subsubheading Synopsis
29654
29655 @smallexample
29656 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29657 @end smallexample
29658
29659 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29660 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29661 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29662 printed as well.
29663
29664 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29665 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29666 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29667 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29668 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29669
29670 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29671
29672 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29673
29674 @subsubheading Example
29675
29676 @smallexample
29677 (gdb)
29678 -exec-next-instruction
29679 ^running
29680
29681 (gdb)
29682 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29683 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29684 (gdb)
29685 @end smallexample
29686
29687
29688 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29689 @findex -exec-return
29690
29691 @subsubheading Synopsis
29692
29693 @smallexample
29694 -exec-return
29695 @end smallexample
29696
29697 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29698 Displays the new current frame.
29699
29700 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29701
29702 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29703
29704 @subsubheading Example
29705
29706 @smallexample
29707 (gdb)
29708 200-break-insert callee4
29709 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29710 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29711 (gdb)
29712 000-exec-run
29713 000^running
29714 (gdb)
29715 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29716 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29717 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29718 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29719 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29720 (gdb)
29721 205-break-delete
29722 205^done
29723 (gdb)
29724 111-exec-return
29725 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29726 args=[@{name="strarg",
29727 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29728 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29729 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29730 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29731 (gdb)
29732 @end smallexample
29733
29734
29735 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29736 @findex -exec-run
29737
29738 @subsubheading Synopsis
29739
29740 @smallexample
29741 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29742 @end smallexample
29743
29744 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29745 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29746 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29747 the program has exited exceptionally.
29748
29749 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29750 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29751 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29752 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29753 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29754
29755 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29756 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29757 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29758 (@pxref{Starting}).
29759
29760 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29761
29762 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29763
29764 @subsubheading Examples
29765
29766 @smallexample
29767 (gdb)
29768 -break-insert main
29769 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29770 (gdb)
29771 -exec-run
29772 ^running
29773 (gdb)
29774 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29775 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29776 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29777 (gdb)
29778 @end smallexample
29779
29780 @noindent
29781 Program exited normally:
29782
29783 @smallexample
29784 (gdb)
29785 -exec-run
29786 ^running
29787 (gdb)
29788 x = 55
29789 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29790 (gdb)
29791 @end smallexample
29792
29793 @noindent
29794 Program exited exceptionally:
29795
29796 @smallexample
29797 (gdb)
29798 -exec-run
29799 ^running
29800 (gdb)
29801 x = 55
29802 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29803 (gdb)
29804 @end smallexample
29805
29806 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29807 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29808
29809 @smallexample
29810 (gdb)
29811 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29812 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29813 @end smallexample
29814
29815
29816 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29817
29818
29819 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29820 @findex -exec-step
29821
29822 @subsubheading Synopsis
29823
29824 @smallexample
29825 -exec-step [--reverse]
29826 @end smallexample
29827
29828 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29829 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29830 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29831 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29832 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29833 previously executed source line.
29834
29835 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29836
29837 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29838
29839 @subsubheading Example
29840
29841 Stepping into a function:
29842
29843 @smallexample
29844 -exec-step
29845 ^running
29846 (gdb)
29847 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29848 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29849 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29850 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29851 (gdb)
29852 @end smallexample
29853
29854 Regular stepping:
29855
29856 @smallexample
29857 -exec-step
29858 ^running
29859 (gdb)
29860 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29861 (gdb)
29862 @end smallexample
29863
29864
29865 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29866 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29867
29868 @subsubheading Synopsis
29869
29870 @smallexample
29871 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29872 @end smallexample
29873
29874 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29875 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29876 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29877 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29878 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29879 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29880 as well.
29881
29882 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29883
29884 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29885
29886 @subsubheading Example
29887
29888 @smallexample
29889 (gdb)
29890 -exec-step-instruction
29891 ^running
29892
29893 (gdb)
29894 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29895 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29896 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29897 (gdb)
29898 -exec-step-instruction
29899 ^running
29900
29901 (gdb)
29902 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29903 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29904 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29905 (gdb)
29906 @end smallexample
29907
29908
29909 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29910 @findex -exec-until
29911
29912 @subsubheading Synopsis
29913
29914 @smallexample
29915 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29916 @end smallexample
29917
29918 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29919 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29920 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29921 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29922
29923 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29924
29925 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29926
29927 @subsubheading Example
29928
29929 @smallexample
29930 (gdb)
29931 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29932 ^running
29933 (gdb)
29934 x = 55
29935 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29936 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
29937 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29938 (gdb)
29939 @end smallexample
29940
29941 @ignore
29942 @subheading -file-clear
29943 Is this going away????
29944 @end ignore
29945
29946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29947 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29949
29950 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29951 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29952
29953 @smallexample
29954 -enable-frame-filters
29955 @end smallexample
29956
29957 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29958 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29959 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29960 request that this functionality be enabled.
29961
29962 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29963
29964 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29965 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29966
29967 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29968 @findex -stack-info-frame
29969
29970 @subsubheading Synopsis
29971
29972 @smallexample
29973 -stack-info-frame
29974 @end smallexample
29975
29976 Get info on the selected frame.
29977
29978 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29979
29980 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29981 (without arguments).
29982
29983 @subsubheading Example
29984
29985 @smallexample
29986 (gdb)
29987 -stack-info-frame
29988 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29989 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29990 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
29991 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29992 (gdb)
29993 @end smallexample
29994
29995 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29996 @findex -stack-info-depth
29997
29998 @subsubheading Synopsis
29999
30000 @smallexample
30001 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30002 @end smallexample
30003
30004 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30005 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30006
30007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30008
30009 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30010
30011 @subsubheading Example
30012
30013 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30014
30015 @smallexample
30016 (gdb)
30017 -stack-info-depth
30018 ^done,depth="12"
30019 (gdb)
30020 -stack-info-depth 4
30021 ^done,depth="4"
30022 (gdb)
30023 -stack-info-depth 12
30024 ^done,depth="12"
30025 (gdb)
30026 -stack-info-depth 11
30027 ^done,depth="11"
30028 (gdb)
30029 -stack-info-depth 13
30030 ^done,depth="12"
30031 (gdb)
30032 @end smallexample
30033
30034 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30035 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30036 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30037
30038 @subsubheading Synopsis
30039
30040 @smallexample
30041 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30042 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30043 @end smallexample
30044
30045 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30046 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30047 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30048 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30049 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30050 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30051 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30052 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30053
30054 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30055 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30056 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30057 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30058 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30059 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30060
30061 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30062 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30063 are still displayed, however.
30064
30065 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30066 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30067
30068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30069
30070 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30071 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30072 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30073
30074 @subsubheading Example
30075
30076 @smallexample
30077 (gdb)
30078 -stack-list-frames
30079 ^done,
30080 stack=[
30081 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30082 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30083 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30084 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30085 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30086 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30087 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30088 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30089 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30090 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30091 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30092 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30093 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30094 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30095 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30096 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30097 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30098 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30099 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30100 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30101 (gdb)
30102 -stack-list-arguments 0
30103 ^done,
30104 stack-args=[
30105 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30106 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30107 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30108 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30109 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30110 (gdb)
30111 -stack-list-arguments 1
30112 ^done,
30113 stack-args=[
30114 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30115 frame=@{level="1",
30116 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30117 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30118 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30119 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30120 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30121 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30122 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30123 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30124 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30125 (gdb)
30126 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30127 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30128 (gdb)
30129 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30130 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30131 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30132 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30133 (gdb)
30134 @end smallexample
30135
30136 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30137
30138
30139 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30140 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30141 @findex -stack-list-frames
30142
30143 @subsubheading Synopsis
30144
30145 @smallexample
30146 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30147 @end smallexample
30148
30149 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30150 following info:
30151
30152 @table @samp
30153 @item @var{level}
30154 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30155 @item @var{addr}
30156 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30157 @item @var{func}
30158 Function name.
30159 @item @var{file}
30160 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30161 @item @var{fullname}
30162 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30163 @item @var{line}
30164 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30165 @item @var{from}
30166 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30167 if the frame's function is not known.
30168 @item @var{arch}
30169 Frame's architecture.
30170 @end table
30171
30172 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30173 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30174 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30175 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30176 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30177 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30178 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30179 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30180 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30181
30182 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30183
30184 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30185
30186 @subsubheading Example
30187
30188 Full stack backtrace:
30189
30190 @smallexample
30191 (gdb)
30192 -stack-list-frames
30193 ^done,stack=
30194 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30195 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30196 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30197 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30198 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30199 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30200 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30201 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30202 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30203 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30204 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30205 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30206 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30207 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30208 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30209 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30210 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30211 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30212 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30213 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30214 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30215 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30216 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30217 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30218 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30219 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30220 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30221 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30222 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30223 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30224 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30225 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30226 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30227 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30228 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30229 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30230 (gdb)
30231 @end smallexample
30232
30233 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30234
30235 @smallexample
30236 (gdb)
30237 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30238 ^done,stack=
30239 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30240 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30241 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30242 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30243 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30244 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30245 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30246 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30247 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30248 (gdb)
30249 @end smallexample
30250
30251 Show a single frame:
30252
30253 @smallexample
30254 (gdb)
30255 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30256 ^done,stack=
30257 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30258 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30259 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30260 (gdb)
30261 @end smallexample
30262
30263
30264 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30265 @findex -stack-list-locals
30266 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30267
30268 @subsubheading Synopsis
30269
30270 @smallexample
30271 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30272 @end smallexample
30273
30274 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30275 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30276 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30277 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30278 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30279 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30280 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30281 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30282 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30283 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30284
30285 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30286 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30287 variables are still displayed, however.
30288
30289 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30290 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30291
30292 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30293
30294 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30295
30296 @subsubheading Example
30297
30298 @smallexample
30299 (gdb)
30300 -stack-list-locals 0
30301 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30302 (gdb)
30303 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30304 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30305 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30306 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30307 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30308 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30309 (gdb)
30310 @end smallexample
30311
30312 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30313 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30314 @findex -stack-list-variables
30315
30316 @subsubheading Synopsis
30317
30318 @smallexample
30319 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30320 @end smallexample
30321
30322 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30323 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30324 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30325 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30326 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30327 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30328 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30329
30330 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30331 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30332 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30333
30334 @subsubheading Example
30335
30336 @smallexample
30337 (gdb)
30338 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30339 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30340 (gdb)
30341 @end smallexample
30342
30343
30344 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30345 @findex -stack-select-frame
30346
30347 @subsubheading Synopsis
30348
30349 @smallexample
30350 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30351 @end smallexample
30352
30353 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30354 the stack.
30355
30356 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30357 option to every command.
30358
30359 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30360
30361 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30362 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30363
30364 @subsubheading Example
30365
30366 @smallexample
30367 (gdb)
30368 -stack-select-frame 2
30369 ^done
30370 (gdb)
30371 @end smallexample
30372
30373 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30374 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30375 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30376
30377 @ignore
30378
30379 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30380
30381 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30382 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30383 used by @code{Insight}.
30384
30385 The two main reasons for that are:
30386
30387 @enumerate 1
30388 @item
30389 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30390
30391 @item
30392 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30393 now).
30394 @end enumerate
30395
30396 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30397 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30398 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30399 hints about their use.
30400
30401 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30402 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30403 least, the following operations:
30404
30405 @itemize @bullet
30406 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30407 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30408 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30409 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30410 @end itemize
30411
30412 @end ignore
30413
30414 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30415
30416 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30417
30418 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30419 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30420 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30421 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30422 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30423 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30424 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30425 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30426 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30427 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30428 object, or to change display format.
30429
30430 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30431 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30432 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30433 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30434 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30435 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30436 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30437 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30438 child will be created.
30439
30440 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30441 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30442 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30443 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30444 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30445
30446 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30447 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30448 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30449 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30450 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30451 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30452 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30453 variables that frontend has created.
30454
30455 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30456 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30457 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30458 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30459 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30460 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30461 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30462 implicitly updated.
30463
30464 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30465 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30466 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30467 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30468 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30469 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30470 frame. Consider this example:
30471
30472 @smallexample
30473 void do_work(...)
30474 @{
30475 struct work_state state;
30476
30477 if (...)
30478 do_work(...);
30479 @}
30480 @end smallexample
30481
30482 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30483 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30484 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30485 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30486 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30487
30488 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30489 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30490 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30491 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30492 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30493 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30494
30495 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30496 access this functionality:
30497
30498 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30499 @item @strong{Operation}
30500 @tab @strong{Description}
30501
30502 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30503 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30504 @item @code{-var-create}
30505 @tab create a variable object
30506 @item @code{-var-delete}
30507 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30508 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30509 @tab set the display format of this variable
30510 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30511 @tab show the display format of this variable
30512 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30513 @tab tells how many children this object has
30514 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30515 @tab return a list of the object's children
30516 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30517 @tab show the type of this variable object
30518 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30519 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30520 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30521 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30522 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30523 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30524 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30525 @tab get the value of this variable
30526 @item @code{-var-assign}
30527 @tab set the value of this variable
30528 @item @code{-var-update}
30529 @tab update the variable and its children
30530 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30531 @tab set frozeness attribute
30532 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30533 @tab set range of children to display on update
30534 @end multitable
30535
30536 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30537 how it can be used.
30538
30539 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30540
30541 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30542 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30543
30544 @smallexample
30545 -enable-pretty-printing
30546 @end smallexample
30547
30548 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30549 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30550 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30551 request that this functionality be enabled.
30552
30553 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30554
30555 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30556 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30557
30558 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30559 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30560
30561 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30562 @findex -var-create
30563
30564 @subsubheading Synopsis
30565
30566 @smallexample
30567 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30568 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30569 @end smallexample
30570
30571 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30572 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30573 register.
30574
30575 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30576 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30577 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30578 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30579 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30580
30581 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30582 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30583 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30584 object must be created.
30585
30586 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30587 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30588
30589 @itemize @bullet
30590 @item
30591 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30592
30593 @item
30594 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30595
30596 @item
30597 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30598 @end itemize
30599
30600 @cindex dynamic varobj
30601 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30602 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30603 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30604 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30605 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30606 compatibility for existing clients.
30607
30608 @subsubheading Result
30609
30610 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30611 are:
30612
30613 @table @samp
30614 @item name
30615 The name of the varobj.
30616
30617 @item numchild
30618 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30619 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30620 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30621
30622 @item value
30623 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30624 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30625 will not be interesting.
30626
30627 @item type
30628 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30629 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30630 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30631 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30632 @emph{declared} one.
30633
30634 @item thread-id
30635 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30636 thread's global identifier.
30637
30638 @item has_more
30639 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30640 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30641
30642 @item dynamic
30643 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30644 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30645 then this attribute will not be present.
30646
30647 @item displayhint
30648 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30649 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30650 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30651 @end table
30652
30653 Typical output will look like this:
30654
30655 @smallexample
30656 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30657 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30658 @end smallexample
30659
30660
30661 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30662 @findex -var-delete
30663
30664 @subsubheading Synopsis
30665
30666 @smallexample
30667 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30668 @end smallexample
30669
30670 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30671 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30672
30673 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30674
30675
30676 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30677 @findex -var-set-format
30678
30679 @subsubheading Synopsis
30680
30681 @smallexample
30682 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30683 @end smallexample
30684
30685 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30686 @var{format-spec}.
30687
30688 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30689 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30693 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30694 @end smallexample
30695
30696 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30697 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30698 for pointers, etc.).
30699
30700 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30701 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30702 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30703 zero-hexadecimal format.
30704
30705 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30706 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30707
30708 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30709 @findex -var-show-format
30710
30711 @subsubheading Synopsis
30712
30713 @smallexample
30714 -var-show-format @var{name}
30715 @end smallexample
30716
30717 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30718
30719 @smallexample
30720 @var{format} @expansion{}
30721 @var{format-spec}
30722 @end smallexample
30723
30724
30725 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30726 @findex -var-info-num-children
30727
30728 @subsubheading Synopsis
30729
30730 @smallexample
30731 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30732 @end smallexample
30733
30734 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30735
30736 @smallexample
30737 numchild=@var{n}
30738 @end smallexample
30739
30740 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30741 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30742 be available.
30743
30744
30745 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30746 @findex -var-list-children
30747
30748 @subsubheading Synopsis
30749
30750 @smallexample
30751 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30752 @end smallexample
30753 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30754
30755 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30756 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30757 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30758 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30759 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30760 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30761 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30762 and unions.
30763
30764 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30765 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30766 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30767 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30768 reported.
30769
30770 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30771 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30772 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30773 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30774 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30775 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30776 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30777 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30778 the visible items.
30779
30780 For each child the following results are returned:
30781
30782 @table @var
30783
30784 @item name
30785 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30786
30787 @item exp
30788 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30789 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30790
30791 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30792 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30793
30794 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30795 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30796 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30797 type and value are not present.
30798
30799 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30800 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30801 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30802
30803 @item numchild
30804 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30805 0.
30806
30807 @item type
30808 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30809 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30810 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30811 @emph{declared} one.
30812
30813 @item value
30814 If values were requested, this is the value.
30815
30816 @item thread-id
30817 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30818 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30819
30820 @item frozen
30821 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30822
30823 @item displayhint
30824 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30825 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30826 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30827
30828 @item dynamic
30829 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30830 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30831 then this attribute will not be present.
30832
30833 @end table
30834
30835 The result may have its own attributes:
30836
30837 @table @samp
30838 @item displayhint
30839 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30840 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30841 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30842
30843 @item has_more
30844 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30845 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30846 @end table
30847
30848 @subsubheading Example
30849
30850 @smallexample
30851 (gdb)
30852 -var-list-children n
30853 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30854 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30855 (gdb)
30856 -var-list-children --all-values n
30857 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30858 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30859 @end smallexample
30860
30861
30862 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30863 @findex -var-info-type
30864
30865 @subsubheading Synopsis
30866
30867 @smallexample
30868 -var-info-type @var{name}
30869 @end smallexample
30870
30871 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30872 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30873 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30874
30875 @smallexample
30876 type=@var{typename}
30877 @end smallexample
30878
30879
30880 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30881 @findex -var-info-expression
30882
30883 @subsubheading Synopsis
30884
30885 @smallexample
30886 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30887 @end smallexample
30888
30889 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30890 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30891 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30892
30893 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30894 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30895
30896 @smallexample
30897 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30898 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30899 @end smallexample
30900
30901 @noindent
30902 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30903 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30904
30905 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30906 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30907 is of limited use.
30908
30909 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30910 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30911
30912 @subsubheading Synopsis
30913
30914 @smallexample
30915 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30916 @end smallexample
30917
30918 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30919 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30920 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30921 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30922 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30923 watchpoint from a variable object.
30924
30925 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30926 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30927
30928 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30929 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30930 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30931 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30932 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30933 @smallexample
30934 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30935 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30936 @end smallexample
30937
30938 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30939 @findex -var-show-attributes
30940
30941 @subsubheading Synopsis
30942
30943 @smallexample
30944 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30945 @end smallexample
30946
30947 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30948
30949 @smallexample
30950 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30951 @end smallexample
30952
30953 @noindent
30954 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30955
30956 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30957 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30958
30959 @subsubheading Synopsis
30960
30961 @smallexample
30962 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30963 @end smallexample
30964
30965 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30966 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30967 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30968 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30969 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30970 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30971 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30972
30973 @smallexample
30974 value=@var{value}
30975 @end smallexample
30976
30977 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30978 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30979
30980 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30981 @findex -var-assign
30982
30983 @subsubheading Synopsis
30984
30985 @smallexample
30986 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30987 @end smallexample
30988
30989 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30990 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30991 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30992 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30993
30994 @subsubheading Example
30995
30996 @smallexample
30997 (gdb)
30998 -var-assign var1 3
30999 ^done,value="3"
31000 (gdb)
31001 -var-update *
31002 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31003 (gdb)
31004 @end smallexample
31005
31006 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31007 @findex -var-update
31008
31009 @subsubheading Synopsis
31010
31011 @smallexample
31012 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31013 @end smallexample
31014
31015 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31016 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31017 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31018 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31019 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31020 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31021 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31022 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31023 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31024 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31025 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31026 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31027 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31028
31029 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31030 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31031 diagnostic.
31032
31033 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31034 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31035
31036 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31037 @samp{changelist}.
31038
31039 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31040
31041 @table @samp
31042 @item name
31043 The name of the varobj.
31044
31045 @item value
31046 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31047 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31048
31049 @item in_scope
31050 @anchor{-var-update}
31051 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31052
31053 @table @code
31054 @item "true"
31055 The variable object's current value is valid.
31056
31057 @item "false"
31058 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31059 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31060 scope.
31061
31062 @item "invalid"
31063 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31064 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31065 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31066 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31067 objects.
31068 @end table
31069
31070 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31071 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31072
31073 @item type_changed
31074 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31075 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31076 be @samp{false}.
31077
31078 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31079 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31080 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31081 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31082 unset.
31083
31084 @item new_type
31085 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31086 hold the new type.
31087
31088 @item new_num_children
31089 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31090 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31091
31092 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31093 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31094 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31095 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31096 children which may be available.
31097
31098 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31099 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31100 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31101 only happen at the end of the update range).
31102
31103 @item displayhint
31104 The display hint, if any.
31105
31106 @item has_more
31107 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31108 available outside the varobj's update range.
31109
31110 @item dynamic
31111 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31112 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31113 then this attribute will not be present.
31114
31115 @item new_children
31116 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31117 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31118 be listed in this attribute.
31119 @end table
31120
31121 @subsubheading Example
31122
31123 @smallexample
31124 (gdb)
31125 -var-assign var1 3
31126 ^done,value="3"
31127 (gdb)
31128 -var-update --all-values var1
31129 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31130 type_changed="false"@}]
31131 (gdb)
31132 @end smallexample
31133
31134 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31135 @findex -var-set-frozen
31136 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31137
31138 @subsubheading Synopsis
31139
31140 @smallexample
31141 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31142 @end smallexample
31143
31144 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31145 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31146 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31147 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31148 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31149 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31150 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31151 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31152 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31153 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31154 @code{-var-update} does.
31155
31156 @subsubheading Example
31157
31158 @smallexample
31159 (gdb)
31160 -var-set-frozen V 1
31161 ^done
31162 (gdb)
31163 @end smallexample
31164
31165 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31166 @findex -var-set-update-range
31167 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31168
31169 @subsubheading Synopsis
31170
31171 @smallexample
31172 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31173 @end smallexample
31174
31175 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31176 @code{-var-update}.
31177
31178 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31179 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31180 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31181 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31182
31183 @subsubheading Example
31184
31185 @smallexample
31186 (gdb)
31187 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31188 ^done
31189 @end smallexample
31190
31191 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31192 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31193 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31194
31195 @subsubheading Synopsis
31196
31197 @smallexample
31198 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31199 @end smallexample
31200
31201 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31202
31203 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31204 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31205
31206 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31207 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31208 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31209 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31210 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31211 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31212 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31213
31214 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31215 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31216 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31217 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31218
31219 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31220 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31221 can be used to check this.
31222
31223 @subsubheading Example
31224
31225 Resetting the visualizer:
31226
31227 @smallexample
31228 (gdb)
31229 -var-set-visualizer V None
31230 ^done
31231 @end smallexample
31232
31233 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31234
31235 @smallexample
31236 (gdb)
31237 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31238 ^done
31239 @end smallexample
31240
31241 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31242 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31243
31244 @smallexample
31245 (gdb)
31246 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31247 ^done
31248 @end smallexample
31249
31250 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31251 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31252 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31253
31254 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31255 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31256 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31257 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31258
31259 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31260 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31261
31262 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31263 @c @subheading -data-assign
31264 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31265 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31266 @c set variable
31267 @c @subsubheading Example
31268 @c N.A.
31269
31270 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31271 @findex -data-disassemble
31272
31273 @subsubheading Synopsis
31274
31275 @smallexample
31276 -data-disassemble
31277 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31278 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31279 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31280 -- @var{mode}
31281 @end smallexample
31282
31283 @noindent
31284 Where:
31285
31286 @table @samp
31287 @item @var{start-addr}
31288 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31289 @item @var{end-addr}
31290 is the end address
31291 @item @var{addr}
31292 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31293 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31294 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31295 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31296 @item @var{filename}
31297 is the name of the file to disassemble
31298 @item @var{linenum}
31299 is the line number to disassemble around
31300 @item @var{lines}
31301 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31302 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31303 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31304 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31305 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31306 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31307 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31308 are displayed.
31309 @item @var{mode}
31310 is one of:
31311 @itemize @bullet
31312 @item 0 disassembly only
31313 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31314 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31315 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31316 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31317 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31318 @end itemize
31319
31320 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31321 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31322 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31323 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31324 @end table
31325
31326 @subsubheading Result
31327
31328 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31329 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31330 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31331
31332 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31333 following fields:
31334
31335 @table @code
31336 @item address
31337 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31338
31339 @item func-name
31340 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31341
31342 @item offset
31343 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31344
31345 @item inst
31346 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31347
31348 @item opcodes
31349 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31350 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31351
31352 @end table
31353
31354 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31355 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31356
31357 @table @code
31358 @item line
31359 The line number within @samp{file}.
31360
31361 @item file
31362 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31363 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31364 used.
31365
31366 @item fullname
31367 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31368 using the source file search path
31369 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31370 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31371
31372 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31373 present in the debug information.
31374
31375 @item line_asm_insn
31376 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31377 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31378 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31379 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31380 @samp{opcodes}.
31381
31382 @end table
31383
31384 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31385 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31386 adjust its format.
31387
31388 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31389
31390 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31391
31392 @subsubheading Example
31393
31394 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31395
31396 @smallexample
31397 (gdb)
31398 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31399 ^done,
31400 asm_insns=[
31401 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31402 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31403 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31404 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31405 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31406 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31407 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31408 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31409 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31410 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31411 (gdb)
31412 @end smallexample
31413
31414 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31415 @code{main}.
31416
31417 @smallexample
31418 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31419 ^done,asm_insns=[
31420 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31421 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31422 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31423 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31424 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31425 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31426 [@dots{}]
31427 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31428 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31429 (gdb)
31430 @end smallexample
31431
31432 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31433
31434 @smallexample
31435 (gdb)
31436 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31437 ^done,asm_insns=[
31438 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31439 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31440 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31441 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31442 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31443 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31444 (gdb)
31445 @end smallexample
31446
31447 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31448
31449 @smallexample
31450 (gdb)
31451 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31452 ^done,asm_insns=[
31453 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31454 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31455 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31456 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31457 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31458 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31459 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31460 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31461 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31462 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31463 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31464 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31465 (gdb)
31466 @end smallexample
31467
31468
31469 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31470 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31471
31472 @subsubheading Synopsis
31473
31474 @smallexample
31475 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31476 @end smallexample
31477
31478 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31479 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31480 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31481
31482 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31483
31484 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31485 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31486 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31487
31488 @subsubheading Example
31489
31490 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31491 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31492 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31493 output.
31494
31495 @smallexample
31496 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31497 211^done,value="1"
31498 (gdb)
31499 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31500 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31501 (gdb)
31502 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31503 411^done,value="4"
31504 (gdb)
31505 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31506 511^done,value="4"
31507 (gdb)
31508 @end smallexample
31509
31510
31511 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31512 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31513
31514 @subsubheading Synopsis
31515
31516 @smallexample
31517 -data-list-changed-registers
31518 @end smallexample
31519
31520 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31521
31522 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31523
31524 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31525 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31526
31527 @subsubheading Example
31528
31529 On a PPC MBX board:
31530
31531 @smallexample
31532 (gdb)
31533 -exec-continue
31534 ^running
31535
31536 (gdb)
31537 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31538 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31539 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31540 (gdb)
31541 -data-list-changed-registers
31542 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31543 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31544 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31545 (gdb)
31546 @end smallexample
31547
31548
31549 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31550 @findex -data-list-register-names
31551
31552 @subsubheading Synopsis
31553
31554 @smallexample
31555 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31556 @end smallexample
31557
31558 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31559 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31560 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31561 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31562 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31563 include empty register names.
31564
31565 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31566
31567 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31568 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31569 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31570
31571 @subsubheading Example
31572
31573 For the PPC MBX board:
31574 @smallexample
31575 (gdb)
31576 -data-list-register-names
31577 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31578 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31579 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31580 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31581 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31582 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31583 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31584 (gdb)
31585 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31586 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31587 (gdb)
31588 @end smallexample
31589
31590 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31591 @findex -data-list-register-values
31592
31593 @subsubheading Synopsis
31594
31595 @smallexample
31596 -data-list-register-values
31597 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31598 @end smallexample
31599
31600 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31601 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31602 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31603 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31604 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31605 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31606
31607 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31608
31609 @table @code
31610 @item x
31611 Hexadecimal
31612 @item o
31613 Octal
31614 @item t
31615 Binary
31616 @item d
31617 Decimal
31618 @item r
31619 Raw
31620 @item N
31621 Natural
31622 @end table
31623
31624 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31625
31626 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31627 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31628
31629 @subsubheading Example
31630
31631 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31632 don't appear in the actual output):
31633
31634 @smallexample
31635 (gdb)
31636 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31637 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31638 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31639 (gdb)
31640 -data-list-register-values x
31641 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31642 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31643 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31644 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31645 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31646 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31647 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31648 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31649 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31650 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31651 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31652 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31653 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31654 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31655 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31656 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31657 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31658 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31659 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31660 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31661 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31662 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31663 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31664 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31665 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31666 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31667 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31668 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31669 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31670 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31671 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31672 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31673 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31674 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31675 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31676 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31677 (gdb)
31678 @end smallexample
31679
31680
31681 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31682 @findex -data-read-memory
31683
31684 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31685
31686 @subsubheading Synopsis
31687
31688 @smallexample
31689 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31690 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31691 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31692 @end smallexample
31693
31694 @noindent
31695 where:
31696
31697 @table @samp
31698 @item @var{address}
31699 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31700 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31701 quoted using the C convention.
31702
31703 @item @var{word-format}
31704 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31705 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31706 ,Output Formats}).
31707
31708 @item @var{word-size}
31709 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31710
31711 @item @var{nr-rows}
31712 The number of rows in the output table.
31713
31714 @item @var{nr-cols}
31715 The number of columns in the output table.
31716
31717 @item @var{aschar}
31718 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31719 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31720 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31721 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31722
31723 @item @var{byte-offset}
31724 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31725 @end table
31726
31727 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31728 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31729 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31730 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31731 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31732 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31733 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31734 @samp{addr}.
31735
31736 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31737 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31738 @samp{prev-page}.
31739
31740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31741
31742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31743 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31744
31745 @subsubheading Example
31746
31747 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31748 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31749 word. Display each word in hex.
31750
31751 @smallexample
31752 (gdb)
31753 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31754 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31755 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31756 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31757 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31758 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31759 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31760 (gdb)
31761 @end smallexample
31762
31763 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31764 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31765
31766 @smallexample
31767 (gdb)
31768 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31769 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31770 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31771 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31772 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31773 (gdb)
31774 @end smallexample
31775
31776 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31777 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31778 used as the non-printable character.
31779
31780 @smallexample
31781 (gdb)
31782 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31783 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31784 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31785 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31786 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31787 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31788 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31789 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31790 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31791 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31792 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31793 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31794 (gdb)
31795 @end smallexample
31796
31797 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31798 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31799
31800 @subsubheading Synopsis
31801
31802 @smallexample
31803 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31804 @var{address} @var{count}
31805 @end smallexample
31806
31807 @noindent
31808 where:
31809
31810 @table @samp
31811 @item @var{address}
31812 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31813 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31814 quoted using the C convention.
31815
31816 @item @var{count}
31817 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31818 literal.
31819
31820 @item @var{offset}
31821 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31822 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31823 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31824 arithmetics itself.
31825
31826 @end table
31827
31828 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31829 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31830 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31831 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31832 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31833 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31834
31835 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31836 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31837 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31838 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31839 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31840 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31841 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31842 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31843
31844 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31845 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31846 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31847 and has the following fields:
31848
31849 @table @code
31850 @item begin
31851 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31852
31853 @item end
31854 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31855
31856 @item offset
31857 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31858 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31859
31860 @item contents
31861 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31862
31863 @end table
31864
31865
31866
31867 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31868
31869 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31870
31871 @subsubheading Example
31872
31873 @smallexample
31874 (gdb)
31875 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31876 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31877 end="0xbffff15e",
31878 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31879 (gdb)
31880 @end smallexample
31881
31882
31883 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31884 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31885
31886 @subsubheading Synopsis
31887
31888 @smallexample
31889 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31890 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31891 @end smallexample
31892
31893 @noindent
31894 where:
31895
31896 @table @samp
31897 @item @var{address}
31898 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31899 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31900 be quoted using the C convention.
31901
31902 @item @var{contents}
31903 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31904 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31905
31906 @item @var{count}
31907 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31908 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31909 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31910 @var{count} memory units.
31911
31912 @end table
31913
31914 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31915
31916 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31917
31918 @subsubheading Example
31919
31920 @smallexample
31921 (gdb)
31922 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31923 ^done
31924 (gdb)
31925 @end smallexample
31926
31927 @smallexample
31928 (gdb)
31929 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31930 ^done
31931 (gdb)
31932 @end smallexample
31933
31934 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31935 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31936 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31937
31938 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31939 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31940
31941 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31942 @findex -trace-find
31943
31944 @subsubheading Synopsis
31945
31946 @smallexample
31947 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31948 @end smallexample
31949
31950 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31951 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31952 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31953
31954 @table @samp
31955
31956 @item none
31957 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31958
31959 @item frame-number
31960 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31961 that index.
31962
31963 @item tracepoint-number
31964 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31965 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31966
31967 @item pc
31968 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31969 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31970 address.
31971
31972 @item pc-inside-range
31973 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31974 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31975 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31976
31977 @item pc-outside-range
31978 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31979 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31980 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31981
31982 @item line
31983 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31984 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31985 the specified location.
31986
31987 @end table
31988
31989 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31990 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31991
31992 @table @samp
31993 @item found
31994 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31995 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31996
31997 @item traceframe
31998 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31999 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32000
32001 @item tracepoint
32002 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32003 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32004
32005 @item frame
32006 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32007 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32008 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32009
32010 @end table
32011
32012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32013
32014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32015
32016 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32017 @findex -trace-define-variable
32018
32019 @subsubheading Synopsis
32020
32021 @smallexample
32022 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32023 @end smallexample
32024
32025 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32026 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32027 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32028 with the @samp{$} character.
32029
32030 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32031
32032 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32033
32034 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32035 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32036
32037 @subsubheading Synopsis
32038
32039 @smallexample
32040 -trace-frame-collected
32041 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32042 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32043 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32044 [--memory-contents]
32045 @end smallexample
32046
32047 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32048 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32049 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32050 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32051 See the output description table below for more details.
32052
32053 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32054 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32055 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32056 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32057 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32058
32059 For instance, if the actions were
32060 @smallexample
32061 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32062 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32063 @end smallexample
32064
32065 @noindent
32066 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32067 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32068 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32069 objects would be computed expressions.
32070
32071 An example output would be:
32072
32073 @smallexample
32074 (gdb)
32075 -trace-frame-collected
32076 ^done,
32077 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32078 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32079 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32080 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32081 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32082 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32083 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32084 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32085 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32086 ...
32087 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32088 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32089 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32090 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32091 (gdb)
32092 @end smallexample
32093
32094 Where:
32095
32096 @table @code
32097 @item explicit-variables
32098 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32099 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32100 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32101 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32102 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32103 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32104 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32105 arrays, structures and unions.
32106
32107 @item computed-expressions
32108 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32109 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32110 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32111 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32112
32113 @item registers
32114 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32115 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32116 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32117 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32118 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32119
32120 @item tvars
32121 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32122 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32123 current value are returned.
32124
32125 @item memory
32126 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32127 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32128 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32129
32130 @table @code
32131 @item address
32132 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32133
32134 @item length
32135 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32136
32137 @item contents
32138 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32139 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32140
32141 @end table
32142
32143 @end table
32144
32145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32146
32147 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32148
32149 @subsubheading Example
32150
32151 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32152 @findex -trace-list-variables
32153
32154 @subsubheading Synopsis
32155
32156 @smallexample
32157 -trace-list-variables
32158 @end smallexample
32159
32160 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32161 table has the following fields:
32162
32163 @table @samp
32164 @item name
32165 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32166
32167 @item initial
32168 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32169 field is always present.
32170
32171 @item current
32172 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32173 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32174 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32175 presently running.
32176
32177 @end table
32178
32179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32180
32181 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32182
32183 @subsubheading Example
32184
32185 @smallexample
32186 (gdb)
32187 -trace-list-variables
32188 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32189 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32190 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32191 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32192 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32193 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32194 (gdb)
32195 @end smallexample
32196
32197 @subheading -trace-save
32198 @findex -trace-save
32199
32200 @subsubheading Synopsis
32201
32202 @smallexample
32203 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32204 @end smallexample
32205
32206 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32207 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32208 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32209 to perform the save.
32210
32211 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32212 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32213 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32214
32215 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32216
32217 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32218
32219
32220 @subheading -trace-start
32221 @findex -trace-start
32222
32223 @subsubheading Synopsis
32224
32225 @smallexample
32226 -trace-start
32227 @end smallexample
32228
32229 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32230 have any fields.
32231
32232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32233
32234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32235
32236 @subheading -trace-status
32237 @findex -trace-status
32238
32239 @subsubheading Synopsis
32240
32241 @smallexample
32242 -trace-status
32243 @end smallexample
32244
32245 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32246 the following fields:
32247
32248 @table @samp
32249
32250 @item supported
32251 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32252 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32253 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32254 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32255 started. This field is always present.
32256
32257 @item running
32258 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32259 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32260 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32261
32262 @item stop-reason
32263 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32264 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32265 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32266 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32267 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32268 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32269 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32270 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32271 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32272
32273 @item stopping-tracepoint
32274 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32275 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32276 @samp{passcount}.
32277
32278 @item frames
32279 @itemx frames-created
32280 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32281 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32282 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32283 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32284
32285 @item buffer-size
32286 @itemx buffer-free
32287 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32288 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32289
32290 @item circular
32291 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32292 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32293 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32294 and may fill up.
32295
32296 @item disconnected
32297 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32298 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32299 that the trace run will stop.
32300
32301 @item trace-file
32302 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32303 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32304
32305 @end table
32306
32307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32308
32309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32310
32311 @subheading -trace-stop
32312 @findex -trace-stop
32313
32314 @subsubheading Synopsis
32315
32316 @smallexample
32317 -trace-stop
32318 @end smallexample
32319
32320 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32321 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32322 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32323
32324 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32325
32326 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32327
32328
32329 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32330 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32331 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32332
32333
32334 @ignore
32335 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32336 @findex -symbol-info-address
32337
32338 @subsubheading Synopsis
32339
32340 @smallexample
32341 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32342 @end smallexample
32343
32344 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32345
32346 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32347
32348 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32349
32350 @subsubheading Example
32351 N.A.
32352
32353
32354 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32355 @findex -symbol-info-file
32356
32357 @subsubheading Synopsis
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 -symbol-info-file
32361 @end smallexample
32362
32363 Show the file for the symbol.
32364
32365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32366
32367 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32368 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32369
32370 @subsubheading Example
32371 N.A.
32372
32373
32374 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32375 @findex -symbol-info-function
32376
32377 @subsubheading Synopsis
32378
32379 @smallexample
32380 -symbol-info-function
32381 @end smallexample
32382
32383 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32384
32385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32386
32387 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32388
32389 @subsubheading Example
32390 N.A.
32391
32392
32393 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32394 @findex -symbol-info-line
32395
32396 @subsubheading Synopsis
32397
32398 @smallexample
32399 -symbol-info-line
32400 @end smallexample
32401
32402 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32403
32404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32405
32406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32407 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32408
32409 @subsubheading Example
32410 N.A.
32411
32412
32413 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32414 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32415
32416 @subsubheading Synopsis
32417
32418 @smallexample
32419 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32420 @end smallexample
32421
32422 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32423
32424 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32425
32426 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32427
32428 @subsubheading Example
32429 N.A.
32430
32431
32432 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32433 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32434
32435 @subsubheading Synopsis
32436
32437 @smallexample
32438 -symbol-list-functions
32439 @end smallexample
32440
32441 List the functions in the executable.
32442
32443 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32444
32445 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32446 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32447
32448 @subsubheading Example
32449 N.A.
32450 @end ignore
32451
32452
32453 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32454 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32455
32456 @subsubheading Synopsis
32457
32458 @smallexample
32459 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32460 @end smallexample
32461
32462 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32463 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32464 ascending PC order.
32465
32466 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32467
32468 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32469
32470 @subsubheading Example
32471 @smallexample
32472 (gdb)
32473 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32474 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32475 (gdb)
32476 @end smallexample
32477
32478
32479 @ignore
32480 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32481 @findex -symbol-list-types
32482
32483 @subsubheading Synopsis
32484
32485 @smallexample
32486 -symbol-list-types
32487 @end smallexample
32488
32489 List all the type names.
32490
32491 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32492
32493 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32494 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32495
32496 @subsubheading Example
32497 N.A.
32498
32499
32500 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32501 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32502
32503 @subsubheading Synopsis
32504
32505 @smallexample
32506 -symbol-list-variables
32507 @end smallexample
32508
32509 List all the global and static variable names.
32510
32511 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32512
32513 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32514
32515 @subsubheading Example
32516 N.A.
32517
32518
32519 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32520 @findex -symbol-locate
32521
32522 @subsubheading Synopsis
32523
32524 @smallexample
32525 -symbol-locate
32526 @end smallexample
32527
32528 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32529
32530 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32531
32532 @subsubheading Example
32533 N.A.
32534
32535
32536 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32537 @findex -symbol-type
32538
32539 @subsubheading Synopsis
32540
32541 @smallexample
32542 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32543 @end smallexample
32544
32545 Show type of @var{variable}.
32546
32547 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32548
32549 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32550 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32551
32552 @subsubheading Example
32553 N.A.
32554 @end ignore
32555
32556
32557 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32558 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32559 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32560
32561 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32562 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32563
32564 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32565 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32566
32567 @subsubheading Synopsis
32568
32569 @smallexample
32570 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32571 @end smallexample
32572
32573 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32574 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32575 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32576 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32577 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32578 notification.
32579
32580 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32581
32582 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32583
32584 @subsubheading Example
32585
32586 @smallexample
32587 (gdb)
32588 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32589 ^done
32590 (gdb)
32591 @end smallexample
32592
32593
32594 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32595 @findex -file-exec-file
32596
32597 @subsubheading Synopsis
32598
32599 @smallexample
32600 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32601 @end smallexample
32602
32603 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32604 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32605 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32606 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32607 notification.
32608
32609 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32610
32611 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32612
32613 @subsubheading Example
32614
32615 @smallexample
32616 (gdb)
32617 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32618 ^done
32619 (gdb)
32620 @end smallexample
32621
32622
32623 @ignore
32624 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32625 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32626
32627 @subsubheading Synopsis
32628
32629 @smallexample
32630 -file-list-exec-sections
32631 @end smallexample
32632
32633 List the sections of the current executable file.
32634
32635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32636
32637 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32638 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32639 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32640
32641 @subsubheading Example
32642 N.A.
32643 @end ignore
32644
32645
32646 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32647 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32648
32649 @subsubheading Synopsis
32650
32651 @smallexample
32652 -file-list-exec-source-file
32653 @end smallexample
32654
32655 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32656 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32657 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32658 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32659
32660 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32661
32662 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32663
32664 @subsubheading Example
32665
32666 @smallexample
32667 (gdb)
32668 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32669 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32670 (gdb)
32671 @end smallexample
32672
32673
32674 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32675 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32676
32677 @subsubheading Synopsis
32678
32679 @smallexample
32680 -file-list-exec-source-files
32681 @end smallexample
32682
32683 List the source files for the current executable.
32684
32685 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32686 name) of a source file.
32687
32688 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32689
32690 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32691 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32692
32693 @subsubheading Example
32694 @smallexample
32695 (gdb)
32696 -file-list-exec-source-files
32697 ^done,files=[
32698 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32699 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32700 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32701 (gdb)
32702 @end smallexample
32703
32704 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32705 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32706
32707 @subsubheading Synopsis
32708
32709 @smallexample
32710 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32711 @end smallexample
32712
32713 List the shared libraries in the program.
32714 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32715 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32716
32717 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32718
32719 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32720 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32721 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32722 library. Each range has the following fields:
32723
32724 @table @samp
32725 @item from
32726 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32727 @item to
32728 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32729 @end table
32730
32731 @subsubheading Example
32732 @smallexample
32733 (gdb)
32734 -file-list-exec-source-files
32735 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32736 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32737 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32738 (gdb)
32739 @end smallexample
32740
32741
32742 @ignore
32743 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32744 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32745
32746 @subsubheading Synopsis
32747
32748 @smallexample
32749 -file-list-symbol-files
32750 @end smallexample
32751
32752 List symbol files.
32753
32754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32755
32756 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32757
32758 @subsubheading Example
32759 N.A.
32760 @end ignore
32761
32762
32763 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32764 @findex -file-symbol-file
32765
32766 @subsubheading Synopsis
32767
32768 @smallexample
32769 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32770 @end smallexample
32771
32772 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32773 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32774 produced, except for a completion notification.
32775
32776 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32777
32778 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32779
32780 @subsubheading Example
32781
32782 @smallexample
32783 (gdb)
32784 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32785 ^done
32786 (gdb)
32787 @end smallexample
32788
32789 @ignore
32790 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32791 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32792 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32793
32794 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32795
32796 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32797
32798 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32799
32800 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32801
32802 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32803
32804 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32805
32806 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32807
32808 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32809
32810 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32811 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32812 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32813
32814 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32815
32816 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32817
32818 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32819
32820 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32821 @end ignore
32822
32823
32824 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32825 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32826 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32827
32828
32829 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32830 @findex -target-attach
32831
32832 @subsubheading Synopsis
32833
32834 @smallexample
32835 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32836 @end smallexample
32837
32838 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32839 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32840 group, the id previously returned by
32841 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32842
32843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32844
32845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32846
32847 @subsubheading Example
32848 @smallexample
32849 (gdb)
32850 -target-attach 34
32851 =thread-created,id="1"
32852 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32853 ^done
32854 (gdb)
32855 @end smallexample
32856
32857 @ignore
32858 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32859 @findex -target-compare-sections
32860
32861 @subsubheading Synopsis
32862
32863 @smallexample
32864 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32865 @end smallexample
32866
32867 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32868 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32869
32870 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32871
32872 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32873
32874 @subsubheading Example
32875 N.A.
32876 @end ignore
32877
32878
32879 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32880 @findex -target-detach
32881
32882 @subsubheading Synopsis
32883
32884 @smallexample
32885 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32886 @end smallexample
32887
32888 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32889 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32890 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32891
32892 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32893
32894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32895
32896 @subsubheading Example
32897
32898 @smallexample
32899 (gdb)
32900 -target-detach
32901 ^done
32902 (gdb)
32903 @end smallexample
32904
32905
32906 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32907 @findex -target-disconnect
32908
32909 @subsubheading Synopsis
32910
32911 @smallexample
32912 -target-disconnect
32913 @end smallexample
32914
32915 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32916 generally not resumed.
32917
32918 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32919
32920 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32921
32922 @subsubheading Example
32923
32924 @smallexample
32925 (gdb)
32926 -target-disconnect
32927 ^done
32928 (gdb)
32929 @end smallexample
32930
32931
32932 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32933 @findex -target-download
32934
32935 @subsubheading Synopsis
32936
32937 @smallexample
32938 -target-download
32939 @end smallexample
32940
32941 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32942 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32943
32944 @table @samp
32945 @item section
32946 The name of the section.
32947 @item section-sent
32948 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32949 @item section-size
32950 The size of the section.
32951 @item total-sent
32952 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32953 @item total-size
32954 The size of the overall executable to download.
32955 @end table
32956
32957 @noindent
32958 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32959 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32960
32961 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32962 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32963
32964 @table @samp
32965 @item section
32966 The name of the section.
32967 @item section-size
32968 The size of the section.
32969 @item total-size
32970 The size of the overall executable to download.
32971 @end table
32972
32973 @noindent
32974 At the end, a summary is printed.
32975
32976 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32977
32978 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32979
32980 @subsubheading Example
32981
32982 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32983 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32984
32985 @smallexample
32986 (gdb)
32987 -target-download
32988 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32989 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32990 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32991 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32992 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32993 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32994 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32995 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32996 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32997 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32998 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32999 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33000 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33001 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33002 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33003 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33004 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33005 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33006 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33007 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33008 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33009 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33010 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33011 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33012 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33013 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33014 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33015 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33016 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33017 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33018 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33019 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33020 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33021 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33022 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33023 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33024 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33025 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33026 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33027 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33028 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33029 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33030 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33031 write-rate="429"
33032 (gdb)
33033 @end smallexample
33034
33035
33036 @ignore
33037 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33038 @findex -target-exec-status
33039
33040 @subsubheading Synopsis
33041
33042 @smallexample
33043 -target-exec-status
33044 @end smallexample
33045
33046 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33047 not, for instance).
33048
33049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33050
33051 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33052
33053 @subsubheading Example
33054 N.A.
33055
33056
33057 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33058 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33059
33060 @subsubheading Synopsis
33061
33062 @smallexample
33063 -target-list-available-targets
33064 @end smallexample
33065
33066 List the possible targets to connect to.
33067
33068 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33069
33070 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33071
33072 @subsubheading Example
33073 N.A.
33074
33075
33076 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33077 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33078
33079 @subsubheading Synopsis
33080
33081 @smallexample
33082 -target-list-current-targets
33083 @end smallexample
33084
33085 Describe the current target.
33086
33087 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33088
33089 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33090 other things).
33091
33092 @subsubheading Example
33093 N.A.
33094
33095
33096 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33097 @findex -target-list-parameters
33098
33099 @subsubheading Synopsis
33100
33101 @smallexample
33102 -target-list-parameters
33103 @end smallexample
33104
33105 @c ????
33106 @end ignore
33107
33108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33109
33110 No equivalent.
33111
33112 @subsubheading Example
33113 N.A.
33114
33115 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33116 @findex -target-flash-erase
33117
33118 @subsubheading Synopsis
33119
33120 @smallexample
33121 -target-flash-erase
33122 @end smallexample
33123
33124 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33125
33126 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33127
33128 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33129 addresses and memory region sizes.
33130
33131 @smallexample
33132 (gdb)
33133 -target-flash-erase
33134 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33135 (gdb)
33136 @end smallexample
33137
33138 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33139 @findex -target-select
33140
33141 @subsubheading Synopsis
33142
33143 @smallexample
33144 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33145 @end smallexample
33146
33147 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33148
33149 @table @samp
33150 @item @var{type}
33151 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33152 @item @var{parameters}
33153 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33154 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33155 @end table
33156
33157 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33158 which the target program is, in the following form:
33159
33160 @smallexample
33161 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33162 args=[@var{arg list}]
33163 @end smallexample
33164
33165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33166
33167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33168
33169 @subsubheading Example
33170
33171 @smallexample
33172 (gdb)
33173 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33174 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33175 (gdb)
33176 @end smallexample
33177
33178 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33179 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33180 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33181
33182
33183 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33184 @findex -target-file-put
33185
33186 @subsubheading Synopsis
33187
33188 @smallexample
33189 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33190 @end smallexample
33191
33192 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33193 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33194
33195 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33196
33197 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33198
33199 @subsubheading Example
33200
33201 @smallexample
33202 (gdb)
33203 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33204 ^done
33205 (gdb)
33206 @end smallexample
33207
33208
33209 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33210 @findex -target-file-get
33211
33212 @subsubheading Synopsis
33213
33214 @smallexample
33215 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33216 @end smallexample
33217
33218 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33219 on the host system.
33220
33221 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33222
33223 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33224
33225 @subsubheading Example
33226
33227 @smallexample
33228 (gdb)
33229 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33230 ^done
33231 (gdb)
33232 @end smallexample
33233
33234
33235 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33236 @findex -target-file-delete
33237
33238 @subsubheading Synopsis
33239
33240 @smallexample
33241 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33242 @end smallexample
33243
33244 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33245
33246 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33247
33248 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33249
33250 @subsubheading Example
33251
33252 @smallexample
33253 (gdb)
33254 -target-file-delete remotefile
33255 ^done
33256 (gdb)
33257 @end smallexample
33258
33259
33260 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33261 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33262 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33263
33264 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33265 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33266
33267 @subsubheading Synopsis
33268
33269 @smallexample
33270 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33271 @end smallexample
33272
33273 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33274 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33275 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33276
33277 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33278
33279 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33280
33281 @subsubheading Result
33282
33283 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33284 defined for each exception:
33285
33286 @table @samp
33287 @item name
33288 The name of the exception.
33289
33290 @item address
33291 The address of the exception.
33292
33293 @end table
33294
33295 @subsubheading Example
33296
33297 @smallexample
33298 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33299 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33300 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33301 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33302 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33303 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33304 @end smallexample
33305
33306 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33307
33308 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33309 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33310 Catchpoint Commands}.
33311
33312
33313 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33314 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33315 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33316
33317 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33318 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33319 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33320 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33321
33322 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33323 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33324 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33325
33326 @subsubheading Synopsis
33327
33328 @smallexample
33329 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33330 @end smallexample
33331
33332 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33333
33334 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33335 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33336 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33337 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33338 dash.
33339
33340 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33341
33342 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33343
33344 @subsubheading Result
33345
33346 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33347
33348 @table @samp
33349 @item exists
33350 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33351 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33352
33353 @end table
33354
33355 @subsubheading Example
33356
33357 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33358
33359 @smallexample
33360 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33361 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33362 @end smallexample
33363
33364 @noindent
33365 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33366 to the debugger:
33367
33368 @smallexample
33369 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33370 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33371 @end smallexample
33372
33373 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33374 @findex -list-features
33375 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33376
33377 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33378 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33379 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33380 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33381 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33382 startup.
33383
33384 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33385 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33386 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33387 is given below.
33388
33389 Example output:
33390
33391 @smallexample
33392 (gdb) -list-features
33393 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33394 @end smallexample
33395
33396 The current list of features is:
33397
33398 @ftable @samp
33399 @item frozen-varobjs
33400 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33401 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33402 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33403 @item pending-breakpoints
33404 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33405 command.
33406 @item python
33407 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33408 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33409 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33410 @item thread-info
33411 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33412 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33413 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33414 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33415 @item breakpoint-notifications
33416 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33417 CLI will be announced via async records.
33418 @item ada-task-info
33419 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33420 @item language-option
33421 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33422 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33423 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33424 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33425 @item undefined-command-error-code
33426 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33427 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33428 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33429 @item exec-run-start-option
33430 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33431 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33432 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33433 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33434 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33435 @end ftable
33436
33437 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33438 @findex -list-target-features
33439
33440 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33441 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33442 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33443 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33444 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33445 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33446 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33447 Example output:
33448
33449 @smallexample
33450 (gdb) -list-target-features
33451 ^done,result=["async"]
33452 @end smallexample
33453
33454 The current list of features is:
33455
33456 @table @samp
33457 @item async
33458 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33459 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33460 while the target is running.
33461
33462 @item reverse
33463 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33464 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33465
33466 @end table
33467
33468 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33469 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33470 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33471
33472 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33473
33474 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33475 @findex -gdb-exit
33476
33477 @subsubheading Synopsis
33478
33479 @smallexample
33480 -gdb-exit
33481 @end smallexample
33482
33483 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33484
33485 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33486
33487 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33488
33489 @subsubheading Example
33490
33491 @smallexample
33492 (gdb)
33493 -gdb-exit
33494 ^exit
33495 @end smallexample
33496
33497
33498 @ignore
33499 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33500 @findex -exec-abort
33501
33502 @subsubheading Synopsis
33503
33504 @smallexample
33505 -exec-abort
33506 @end smallexample
33507
33508 Kill the inferior running program.
33509
33510 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33511
33512 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33513
33514 @subsubheading Example
33515 N.A.
33516 @end ignore
33517
33518
33519 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33520 @findex -gdb-set
33521
33522 @subsubheading Synopsis
33523
33524 @smallexample
33525 -gdb-set
33526 @end smallexample
33527
33528 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33529 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33530
33531 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33532
33533 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33534
33535 @subsubheading Example
33536
33537 @smallexample
33538 (gdb)
33539 -gdb-set $foo=3
33540 ^done
33541 (gdb)
33542 @end smallexample
33543
33544
33545 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33546 @findex -gdb-show
33547
33548 @subsubheading Synopsis
33549
33550 @smallexample
33551 -gdb-show
33552 @end smallexample
33553
33554 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33555
33556 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33557
33558 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33559
33560 @subsubheading Example
33561
33562 @smallexample
33563 (gdb)
33564 -gdb-show annotate
33565 ^done,value="0"
33566 (gdb)
33567 @end smallexample
33568
33569 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33570
33571
33572 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33573 @findex -gdb-version
33574
33575 @subsubheading Synopsis
33576
33577 @smallexample
33578 -gdb-version
33579 @end smallexample
33580
33581 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33582
33583 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33584
33585 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33586 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33587
33588 @subsubheading Example
33589
33590 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33591 @c box in TeX.
33592 @smallexample
33593 (gdb)
33594 -gdb-version
33595 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33596 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33597 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33598 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33599 ~ certain conditions.
33600 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33601 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33602 ~ details.
33603 ~This GDB was configured as
33604 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33605 ^done
33606 (gdb)
33607 @end smallexample
33608
33609 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33610 @findex -list-thread-groups
33611
33612 @subheading Synopsis
33613
33614 @smallexample
33615 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33616 @end smallexample
33617
33618 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33619 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33620 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33621 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33622 top-level thread groups.
33623
33624 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33625 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33626 available on the target.
33627
33628 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33629 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33630 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33631 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33632 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33633 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33634 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33635 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33636
33637 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33638 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33639 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33640 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33641 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33642 @samp{threads} field.
33643
33644 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33645 the following caveats:
33646
33647 @itemize @bullet
33648 @item
33649 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33650 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33651 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33652
33653 @item
33654 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33655 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33656 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33657 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33658 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33659 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33660
33661 @end itemize
33662
33663 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33664 have the following fields:
33665
33666 @table @code
33667 @item id
33668 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33669 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33670 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33671
33672 @item type
33673 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33674 valid type.
33675
33676 @item pid
33677 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33678 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33679
33680 @item exit-code
33681 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33682 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33683 only if the process is not running.
33684
33685 @item num_children
33686 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33687 absent for an available thread group.
33688
33689 @item threads
33690 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33691 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33692 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33693
33694 @item cores
33695 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33696 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33697 such information is not available.
33698
33699 @item executable
33700 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33701 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33702 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33703
33704 @end table
33705
33706 @subheading Example
33707
33708 @smallexample
33709 @value{GDBP}
33710 -list-thread-groups
33711 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33712 -list-thread-groups 17
33713 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33714 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33715 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33716 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33717 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33718 -list-thread-groups --available
33719 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33720 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33721 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33722 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33723 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33724 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33725 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33726 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33727 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33728 @end smallexample
33729
33730 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33731 @findex -info-os
33732
33733 @subsubheading Synopsis
33734
33735 @smallexample
33736 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33737 @end smallexample
33738
33739 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33740 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33741 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33742 of data of that type.
33743
33744 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33745 system.
33746
33747 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33748
33749 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33750
33751 @subsubheading Example
33752
33753 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33754 like this:
33755
33756 @smallexample
33757 @value{GDBP}
33758 -info-os
33759 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33760 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33761 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33762 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33763 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33764 col2="CPUs"@},
33765 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33766 col2="File descriptors"@},
33767 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33768 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33769 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33770 col2="Message queues"@},
33771 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33772 col2="Processes"@},
33773 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33774 col2="Process groups"@},
33775 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33776 col2="Semaphores"@},
33777 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33778 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33779 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33780 col2="Sockets"@},
33781 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33782 col2="Threads"@}]
33783 @value{GDBP}
33784 -info-os processes
33785 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33786 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33787 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33788 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33789 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33790 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33791 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33792 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33793 ...
33794 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33795 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33796 (gdb)
33797 @end smallexample
33798
33799 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33800 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33801 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33802 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33803 @code{info os} omits it.)
33804
33805 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33806 @findex -add-inferior
33807
33808 @subheading Synopsis
33809
33810 @smallexample
33811 -add-inferior
33812 @end smallexample
33813
33814 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33815 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33816 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33817 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33818 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33819 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33820
33821 @subheading Example
33822
33823 @smallexample
33824 @value{GDBP}
33825 -add-inferior
33826 ^done,inferior="i3"
33827 @end smallexample
33828
33829 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33830 @findex -interpreter-exec
33831
33832 @subheading Synopsis
33833
33834 @smallexample
33835 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33836 @end smallexample
33837 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33838
33839 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33840
33841 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33842
33843 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33844
33845 @subheading Example
33846
33847 @smallexample
33848 (gdb)
33849 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33850 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33851 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33852 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33853 ^done
33854 (gdb)
33855 @end smallexample
33856
33857 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33858 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33859
33860 @subheading Synopsis
33861
33862 @smallexample
33863 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33864 @end smallexample
33865
33866 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33867
33868 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33869
33870 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33871
33872 @subheading Example
33873
33874 @smallexample
33875 (gdb)
33876 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33877 ^done
33878 (gdb)
33879 @end smallexample
33880
33881 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33882 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33883
33884 @subheading Synopsis
33885
33886 @smallexample
33887 -inferior-tty-show
33888 @end smallexample
33889
33890 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33891
33892 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33893
33894 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33895
33896 @subheading Example
33897
33898 @smallexample
33899 (gdb)
33900 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33901 ^done
33902 (gdb)
33903 -inferior-tty-show
33904 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33905 (gdb)
33906 @end smallexample
33907
33908 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33909 @findex -enable-timings
33910
33911 @subheading Synopsis
33912
33913 @smallexample
33914 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33915 @end smallexample
33916
33917 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33918 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33919 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33920 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33921
33922 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33923
33924 No equivalent.
33925
33926 @subheading Example
33927
33928 @smallexample
33929 (gdb)
33930 -enable-timings
33931 ^done
33932 (gdb)
33933 -break-insert main
33934 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33935 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33936 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33937 times="0"@},
33938 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33939 (gdb)
33940 -enable-timings no
33941 ^done
33942 (gdb)
33943 -exec-run
33944 ^running
33945 (gdb)
33946 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33947 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33948 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33949 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33950 (gdb)
33951 @end smallexample
33952
33953 @node Annotations
33954 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33955
33956 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33957 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33958 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33959 relatively high level.
33960
33961 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33962 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33963
33964 @ignore
33965 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33966 @end ignore
33967
33968 @menu
33969 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33970 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33971 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33972 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33973 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33974 * Annotations for Running::
33975 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33976 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33977 @end menu
33978
33979 @node Annotations Overview
33980 @section What is an Annotation?
33981 @cindex annotations
33982
33983 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33984 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33985 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33986 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33987 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33988 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33989 cannot contain newline characters.
33990
33991 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33992 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33993 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33994 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33995 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33996 means those three characters as output.
33997
33998 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33999 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34000 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34001 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34002 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34003 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34004 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34005 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34006 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34007
34008 @table @code
34009 @kindex set annotate
34010 @item set annotate @var{level}
34011 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34012 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34013
34014 @item show annotate
34015 @kindex show annotate
34016 Show the current annotation level.
34017 @end table
34018
34019 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34020
34021 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34022
34023 @smallexample
34024 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34025 GNU gdb 6.0
34026 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34027 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34028 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34029 under certain conditions.
34030 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34031 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34032 for details.
34033 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34034
34035 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34036 (@value{GDBP})
34037 ^Z^Zprompt
34038 @kbd{quit}
34039
34040 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34041 $
34042 @end smallexample
34043
34044 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34045 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34046 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34047 output from @value{GDBN}.
34048
34049 @node Server Prefix
34050 @section The Server Prefix
34051 @cindex server prefix
34052
34053 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34054 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34055 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34056 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34057 a transparent manner.
34058
34059 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34060 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34061 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34062 @code{print} command.
34063
34064 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34065 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34066
34067 @node Prompting
34068 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34069
34070 @cindex annotations for prompts
34071 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34072 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34073 over, etc.
34074
34075 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34076 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34077 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34078 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34079 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34080 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34081 features the following annotations:
34082
34083 @smallexample
34084 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34085 ^Z^Zprompt
34086 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34087 @end smallexample
34088
34089 The input types are
34090
34091 @table @code
34092 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34093 @findex prompt annotation
34094 @findex post-prompt annotation
34095 @item prompt
34096 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34097
34098 @findex pre-commands annotation
34099 @findex commands annotation
34100 @findex post-commands annotation
34101 @item commands
34102 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34103 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34104
34105 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34106 @findex overload-choice annotation
34107 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34108 @item overload-choice
34109 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34110
34111 @findex pre-query annotation
34112 @findex query annotation
34113 @findex post-query annotation
34114 @item query
34115 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34116
34117 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34118 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34119 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34120 @item prompt-for-continue
34121 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34122 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34123 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34124 presence of annotations.
34125 @end table
34126
34127 @node Errors
34128 @section Errors
34129 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34130
34131 @findex quit annotation
34132 @smallexample
34133 ^Z^Zquit
34134 @end smallexample
34135
34136 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34137
34138 @findex error annotation
34139 @smallexample
34140 ^Z^Zerror
34141 @end smallexample
34142
34143 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34144
34145 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34146 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34147 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34148 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34149 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34150 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34151 to the top level.
34152
34153 @findex error-begin annotation
34154 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34155
34156 @smallexample
34157 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34158 @end smallexample
34159
34160 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34161 message.
34162
34163 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34164 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34165 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34166
34167 @node Invalidation
34168 @section Invalidation Notices
34169
34170 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34171 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34172 changed.
34173
34174 @table @code
34175 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34176 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34177
34178 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34179 have changed.
34180
34181 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34182 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34183
34184 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34185 deleted a breakpoint.
34186 @end table
34187
34188 @node Annotations for Running
34189 @section Running the Program
34190 @cindex annotations for running programs
34191
34192 @findex starting annotation
34193 @findex stopping annotation
34194 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34195 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34196
34197 @smallexample
34198 ^Z^Zstarting
34199 @end smallexample
34200
34201 is output. When the program stops,
34202
34203 @smallexample
34204 ^Z^Zstopped
34205 @end smallexample
34206
34207 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34208 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34209
34210 @table @code
34211 @findex exited annotation
34212 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34213 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34214 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34215
34216 @findex signalled annotation
34217 @findex signal-name annotation
34218 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34219 @findex signal-string annotation
34220 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34221 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34222 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34223 annotation continues:
34224
34225 @smallexample
34226 @var{intro-text}
34227 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34228 @var{name}
34229 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34230 @var{middle-text}
34231 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34232 @var{string}
34233 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34234 @var{end-text}
34235 @end smallexample
34236
34237 @noindent
34238 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34239 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34240 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34241 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34242 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34243
34244 @findex signal annotation
34245 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34246 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34247 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34248 terminated with it.
34249
34250 @findex breakpoint annotation
34251 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34252 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34253
34254 @findex watchpoint annotation
34255 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34256 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34257 @end table
34258
34259 @node Source Annotations
34260 @section Displaying Source
34261 @cindex annotations for source display
34262
34263 @findex source annotation
34264 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34265
34266 @smallexample
34267 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34268 @end smallexample
34269
34270 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34271 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34272 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34273 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34274 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34275 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34276 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34277 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34278 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34279 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34280 depend on the language).
34281
34282 @node JIT Interface
34283 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34284 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34285 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34286
34287 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34288 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34289 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34290 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34291
34292 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34293 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34294 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34295 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34296 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34297 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34298
34299 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34300 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34301 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34302 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34303 LLVM JIT.
34304
34305 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34306 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34307 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34308 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34309 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34310 out about additional code.
34311
34312 @menu
34313 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34314 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34315 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34316 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34317 @end menu
34318
34319 @node Declarations
34320 @section JIT Declarations
34321
34322 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34323 implement the interface:
34324
34325 @smallexample
34326 typedef enum
34327 @{
34328 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34329 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34330 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34331 @} jit_actions_t;
34332
34333 struct jit_code_entry
34334 @{
34335 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34336 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34337 const char *symfile_addr;
34338 uint64_t symfile_size;
34339 @};
34340
34341 struct jit_descriptor
34342 @{
34343 uint32_t version;
34344 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34345 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34346 uint32_t action_flag;
34347 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34348 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34349 @};
34350
34351 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34352 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34353
34354 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34355 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34356 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34357 @end smallexample
34358
34359 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34360 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34361 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34362
34363 @node Registering Code
34364 @section Registering Code
34365
34366 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34367
34368 @itemize @bullet
34369 @item
34370 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34371 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34372
34373 @item
34374 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34375 file.
34376
34377 @item
34378 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34379
34380 @item
34381 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34382
34383 @item
34384 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34385 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34386 @end itemize
34387
34388 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34389 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34390 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34391 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34392
34393 @node Unregistering Code
34394 @section Unregistering Code
34395
34396 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34397
34398 @itemize @bullet
34399 @item
34400 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34401
34402 @item
34403 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34404
34405 @item
34406 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34407 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34408 @end itemize
34409
34410 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34411 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34412
34413 @node Custom Debug Info
34414 @section Custom Debug Info
34415 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34416 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34417
34418 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34419 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34420 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34421 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34422 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34423 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34424 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34425 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34426 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34427
34428 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34429 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34430 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34431 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34432 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34433 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34434 compiler.
34435
34436 @menu
34437 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34438 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34439 @end menu
34440
34441 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34442 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34443 @kindex jit-reader-load
34444 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34445
34446 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34447 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34448
34449 @table @code
34450 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34451 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34452 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34453 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34454 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34455 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34456 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34457
34458 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34459 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34460 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34461 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34462 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34463
34464 @item jit-reader-unload
34465 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34466
34467 @end table
34468
34469 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34470 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34471 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34472
34473 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34474 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34475
34476 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34477 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34478 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34479 the system include directory.
34480
34481 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34482 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34483 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34484
34485 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34486 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34487
34488 @findex gdb_init_reader
34489 @smallexample
34490 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34491 @end smallexample
34492
34493 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34494
34495 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34496 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34497 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34498 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34499 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34500 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34501
34502 @smallexample
34503 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34504 @{
34505 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34506 int reader_version;
34507
34508 /* For use by the reader. */
34509 void *priv_data;
34510
34511 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34512 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34513 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34514 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34515 @};
34516 @end smallexample
34517
34518 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34519 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34520
34521 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34522 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34523 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34524 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34525 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34526 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34527 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34528 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34529 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34530 target's address space.
34531
34532 @node In-Process Agent
34533 @chapter In-Process Agent
34534 @cindex debugging agent
34535 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34536 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34537 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34538 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34539 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34540 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34541 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34542 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34543 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34544 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34545 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34546 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34547 behavior without interrupting it.
34548
34549 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34550 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34551 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34552 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34553 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34554 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34555 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34556 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34557 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34558
34559 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34560 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34561 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34562 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34563
34564 @anchor{Control Agent}
34565 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34566 debugging with the following commands:
34567
34568 @table @code
34569 @kindex set agent on
34570 @item set agent on
34571 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34572 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34573 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34574 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34575 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34576 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34577
34578 @kindex set agent off
34579 @item set agent off
34580 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34581 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34582
34583 @kindex show agent
34584 @item show agent
34585 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34586 the in-process agent.
34587 @end table
34588
34589 @menu
34590 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34591 @end menu
34592
34593 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34594 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34595 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34596
34597 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34598 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34599 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34600 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34601 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34602 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34603 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34604 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34605 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34606
34607 @menu
34608 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34609 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34610 @end menu
34611
34612 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34613 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34614 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34615
34616 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34617 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34618
34619 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34620 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34621 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34622 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34623
34624 @enumerate
34625 @item
34626 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34627 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34628 @item
34629 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34630 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34631 the other one.
34632 @end enumerate
34633
34634 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34635
34636 @enumerate
34637 @item
34638 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34639 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34640 @anchor{agent expression object}
34641 @item
34642 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34643 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34644 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34645 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34646 @item
34647 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34648 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34649
34650 @end enumerate
34651
34652 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34653 object:
34654
34655 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34656 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34657 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34658 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34659 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34660 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34661 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34662 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34663 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34664 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34665 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34666 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34667 memory address for collecting.
34668 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34669 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34670 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34671 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34672 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34673 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34674 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34675 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34676 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34677 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34678 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34679 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34680 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34681 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34682 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34683 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34684 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34685 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34686 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34687 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34688 @ref{agent expression object}
34689 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34690 @ref{agent expression object}
34691 @item actions @tab variable
34692 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34693 @end multitable
34694
34695 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34696 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34697 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34698
34699 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34700 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34701
34702 @table @samp
34703
34704 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34705 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34706 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34707 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34708 in IPA finally.
34709
34710 Replies:
34711 @table @samp
34712 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34713 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34714 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34715 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34716 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34717 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34718 @item E @var{NN}
34719 for an error
34720
34721 @end table
34722
34723 @item close
34724 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34725 is about to kill inferiors.
34726
34727 @item qTfSTM
34728 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34729 @item qTsSTM
34730 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34731 @item qTSTMat
34732 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34733 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34734 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34735
34736 Replies:
34737 @table @samp
34738 @item E @var{NN}
34739 for an error
34740 @end table
34741 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34742 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34743 @end table
34744
34745 @node GDB Bugs
34746 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34747 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34748 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34749
34750 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34751
34752 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34753 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34754 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34755 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34756
34757 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34758 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34759
34760 @menu
34761 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34762 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34763 @end menu
34764
34765 @node Bug Criteria
34766 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34767 @cindex bug criteria
34768
34769 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34770
34771 @itemize @bullet
34772 @cindex fatal signal
34773 @cindex debugger crash
34774 @cindex crash of debugger
34775 @item
34776 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34777 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34778
34779 @cindex error on valid input
34780 @item
34781 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34782 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34783 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34784
34785 @cindex invalid input
34786 @item
34787 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34788 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34789 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34790 for traditional practice''.
34791
34792 @item
34793 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34794 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34795 @end itemize
34796
34797 @node Bug Reporting
34798 @section How to Report Bugs
34799 @cindex bug reports
34800 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34801
34802 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34803 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34804 contact that organization first.
34805
34806 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34807 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34808 distribution.
34809 @c should add a web page ref...
34810
34811 @ifset BUGURL
34812 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34813 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34814 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34815 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34816 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34817 be used.
34818
34819 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34820 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34821 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34822 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34823
34824 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34825 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34826 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34827 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34828 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34829 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34830 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34831 bug reports to the mailing list.
34832 @end ifset
34833 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34834 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34835 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34836 @end ifclear
34837 @end ifset
34838
34839 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34840 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34841 fact or leave it out, state it!
34842
34843 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34844 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34845 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34846 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34847 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34848 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34849 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34850 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34851 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34852
34853 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34854 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34855 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34856 self-contained.
34857
34858 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34859 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34860 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34861 bugs properly.
34862
34863 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34864
34865 @itemize @bullet
34866 @item
34867 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34868 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34869 version}.
34870
34871 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34872 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34873
34874 @item
34875 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34876 version number.
34877
34878 @item
34879 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34880 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34881 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34882 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34883
34884 @item
34885 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34886 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34887
34888 @item
34889 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34890 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34891 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34892 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34893 those compilers.
34894
34895 @item
34896 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34897 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34898 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34899 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34900
34901 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34902 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34903
34904 @item
34905 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34906 reproduce the bug.
34907
34908 @item
34909 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34910 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34911
34912 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34913 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34914 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34915 a chance to make a mistake.
34916
34917 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34918 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34919 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34920 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34921 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34922 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34923 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34924 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34925
34926 @pindex script
34927 @cindex recording a session script
34928 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34929 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34930 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34931 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34932
34933 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34934 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34935
34936 @item
34937 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34938 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34939 it by context, not by line number.
34940
34941 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34942 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34943
34944 @end itemize
34945
34946 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34947
34948 @itemize @bullet
34949 @item
34950 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34951
34952 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34953 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34954 changes will not affect it.
34955
34956 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34957 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34958 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34959 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34960
34961 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34962 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34963 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34964 less time, and so on.
34965
34966 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34967 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34968
34969 @item
34970 A patch for the bug.
34971
34972 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34973 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34974 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34975 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34976
34977 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34978 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34979 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34980 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34981
34982 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34983 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34984 help us to understand.
34985
34986 @item
34987 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34988
34989 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34990 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34991 @end itemize
34992
34993 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34994 @c and consists of the two following files:
34995 @c rluser.texi
34996 @c hsuser.texi
34997 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34998 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34999 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35000 @include rluser.texi
35001 @include hsuser.texi
35002 @end ifclear
35003
35004 @node In Memoriam
35005 @appendix In Memoriam
35006
35007 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35008 contributors:
35009
35010 @table @code
35011 @item Fred Fish
35012 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35013 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35014 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35015
35016 @item Michael Snyder
35017 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35018 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35019 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35020 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35021 @end table
35022
35023 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35024 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35025
35026 @node Formatting Documentation
35027 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35028
35029 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35030 @cindex reference card
35031 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35032 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35033 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35034 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35035 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35036 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35037
35038 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35039 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35040
35041 @smallexample
35042 make refcard.dvi
35043 @end smallexample
35044
35045 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35046 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35047 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35048 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35049 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35050
35051 @cindex documentation
35052
35053 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35054 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35055 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35056 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35057 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35058 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35059
35060 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35061 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35062 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35063 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35064 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35065 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35066 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35067 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35068
35069 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35070 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35071 @code{makeinfo}.
35072
35073 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35074 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35075 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35076
35077 @smallexample
35078 cd gdb
35079 make gdb.info
35080 @end smallexample
35081
35082 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35083 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35084 Texinfo definitions file.
35085
35086 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35087 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35088 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35089 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35090 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35091 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35092 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35093
35094 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35095 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35096 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35097 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35098 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35099 directory.
35100
35101 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35102 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35103 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35104 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35105
35106 @smallexample
35107 make gdb.dvi
35108 @end smallexample
35109
35110 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35111
35112 @node Installing GDB
35113 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35114 @cindex installation
35115
35116 @menu
35117 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35118 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35119 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35120 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35121 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35122 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35123 @end menu
35124
35125 @node Requirements
35126 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35127 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35128
35129 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35130 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35131
35132 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35133 @table @asis
35134 @item ISO C90 compiler
35135 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
35136 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35137
35138 @end table
35139
35140 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35141 @table @asis
35142 @item Expat
35143 @anchor{Expat}
35144 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35145 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35146 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35147 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35148 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35149 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35150
35151 Expat is used for:
35152
35153 @itemize @bullet
35154 @item
35155 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35156 @item
35157 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35158 @item
35159 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35160 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35161 @item
35162 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35163 @item
35164 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35165 @item
35166 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35167 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35168 @end itemize
35169
35170 @item MPFR
35171 @anchor{MPFR}
35172 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35173 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35174 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35175 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35176 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35177 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35178 option to specify its location.
35179
35180 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35181 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35182 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35183 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35184
35185 @item zlib
35186 @cindex compressed debug sections
35187 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35188 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35189 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35190 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35191 information in such binaries.
35192
35193 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35194 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35195 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35196
35197 @item iconv
35198 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35199 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35200 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35201 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35202
35203 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35204 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
35205 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
35206 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
35207
35208 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
35209 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
35210 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
35211
35212 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35213 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35214 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35215 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35216 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35217 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35218 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
35219 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
35220 @end table
35221
35222 @node Running Configure
35223 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35224 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35225 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35226 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35227 build the @code{gdb} program.
35228 @iftex
35229 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35230 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35231 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35232 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35233 @end iftex
35234
35235 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35236 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35237 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35238
35239 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35240 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35241
35242 @table @code
35243 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35244 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35245
35246 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35247 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35248
35249 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35250 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35251
35252 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35253 @sc{gnu} include files
35254
35255 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35256 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35257
35258 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35259 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35260
35261 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35262 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35263
35264 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
35265 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
35266
35267 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
35268 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
35269 @end table
35270
35271 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35272 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35273 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35274
35275 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35276 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35277 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35278 argument.
35279
35280 For example:
35281
35282 @smallexample
35283 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35284 ./configure @var{host}
35285 make
35286 @end smallexample
35287
35288 @noindent
35289 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
35290 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
35291 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
35292 correct value by examining your system.)
35293
35294 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
35295 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
35296 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
35297 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
35298
35299 @need 750
35300 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35301 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35302 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35303
35304 @smallexample
35305 sh configure @var{host}
35306 @end smallexample
35307
35308 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
35309 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
35310 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
35311 @file{configure}
35312 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
35313 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
35314
35315 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35316 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35317 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35318 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35319 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35320 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35321 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35322 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35323 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35324
35325 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
35326 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
35327 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
35328 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
35329 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
35330
35331 @node Separate Objdir
35332 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35333
35334 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35335 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35336 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35337 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35338 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35339 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35340 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35341 program specified there.
35342
35343 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35344 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35345 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35346 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35347 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35348 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35349
35350 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35351 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35352
35353 @smallexample
35354 @group
35355 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35356 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35357 cd ../gdb-sun4
35358 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
35359 make
35360 @end group
35361 @end smallexample
35362
35363 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35364 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35365 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35366 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35367 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35368 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35369
35370 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35371 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35372 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35373 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35374 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35375
35376 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35377 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35378 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35379 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35380 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35381 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35382
35383 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35384 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35385 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35386
35387 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35388 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35389 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35390 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35391 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35392
35393 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35394 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35395 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35396 with each other.
35397
35398 @node Config Names
35399 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35400
35401 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35402 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35403 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35404 of information in the following pattern:
35405
35406 @smallexample
35407 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35408 @end smallexample
35409
35410 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35411 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35412 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35413
35414 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35415 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35416 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35417 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35418 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35419 abbreviations---for example:
35420
35421 @smallexample
35422 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35423 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35424 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35425 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35426 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35427 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35428 % sh config.sub sun4
35429 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35430 % sh config.sub sun3
35431 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35432 % sh config.sub i986v
35433 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35434 @end smallexample
35435
35436 @noindent
35437 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35438 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35439
35440 @node Configure Options
35441 @section @file{configure} Options
35442
35443 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35444 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
35445 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
35446 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
35447
35448 @smallexample
35449 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35450 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35451 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35452 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35453 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
35454 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35455 @var{host}
35456 @end smallexample
35457
35458 @noindent
35459 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35460 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35461 @samp{--}.
35462
35463 @table @code
35464 @item --help
35465 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35466
35467 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35468 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35469 @file{@var{dir}}.
35470
35471 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35472 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35473 @file{@var{dir}}.
35474
35475 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35476 @need 2000
35477 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35478 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
35479 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
35480 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35481 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35482 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35483 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35484 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35485 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35486 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35487 @var{dirname}.
35488
35489 @item --norecursion
35490 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
35491 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
35492
35493 @item --target=@var{target}
35494 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35495 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35496 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35497
35498 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
35499
35500 @item @var{host} @dots{}
35501 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
35502
35503 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
35504 @end table
35505
35506 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
35507 needed for special purposes only.
35508
35509 @node System-wide configuration
35510 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35511 @cindex system-wide init file
35512
35513 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35514 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35515 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35516
35517 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35518
35519 @table @code
35520 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35521 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35522 @var{file}.
35523 @end table
35524
35525 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35526 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35527
35528 @itemize @bullet
35529 @item
35530 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35531 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35532 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35533 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35534 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35535 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35536
35537 @item
35538 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35539 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35540 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35541 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35542 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35543 @end itemize
35544
35545 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35546 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35547 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35548 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35549 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35550 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35551 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35552 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35553 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35554 reread.
35555
35556 @menu
35557 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35558 @end menu
35559
35560 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35561 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35562 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35563
35564 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35565 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35566 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35567 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35568 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35569 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35570
35571 The following scripts are currently available:
35572 @itemize @bullet
35573
35574 @item @file{elinos.py}
35575 @pindex elinos.py
35576 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35577 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35578 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35579 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35580 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35581 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35582
35583 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35584 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35585 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35586 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35587 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35588 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35589
35590 @end itemize
35591
35592 @node Maintenance Commands
35593 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35594 @cindex maintenance commands
35595 @cindex internal commands
35596
35597 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35598 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35599 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35600 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35601 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35602
35603 @table @code
35604 @kindex maint agent
35605 @kindex maint agent-eval
35606 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35607 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35608 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35609 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35610 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35611 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35612 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35613 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35614 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35615 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35616 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35617 addition and return the sum.
35618 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35619 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35620
35621 @kindex maint agent-printf
35622 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35623 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35624 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35625 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35626 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35627
35628 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35629 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35630 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35631 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35632 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35633 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35634 is shown:
35635
35636 @table @code
35637 @item breakpoint
35638 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35639
35640 @item watchpoint
35641 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35642
35643 @item longjmp
35644 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35645 @code{longjmp} calls.
35646
35647 @item longjmp resume
35648 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35649
35650 @item until
35651 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35652
35653 @item finish
35654 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35655
35656 @item shlib events
35657 Shared library events.
35658
35659 @end table
35660
35661 @kindex maint info btrace
35662 @item maint info btrace
35663 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35664
35665 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35666 @item maint btrace packet-history
35667 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35668 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35669 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35670 recording format.
35671
35672 @table @code
35673 @item bts
35674 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35675 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35676
35677 @table @asis
35678 @item Block number
35679 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35680 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35681 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35682 @end table
35683
35684 @item pt
35685 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35686 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35687 information is printed:
35688
35689 @table @asis
35690 @item Packet number
35691 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35692 @item Trace offset
35693 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35694 @item Packet opcode and payload
35695 @end table
35696 @end table
35697
35698 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35699 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35700 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35701 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35702 needed.
35703
35704 @kindex maint btrace clear
35705 @item maint btrace clear
35706 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35707 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35708
35709 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35710 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35711 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35712 buffer.
35713
35714 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35715 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35716 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35717 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35718 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35719 packet history.
35720
35721 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35722 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35723 @cindex displaced stepping support
35724 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35725 @item set displaced-stepping
35726 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35727 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35728 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35729 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35730 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35731 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35732
35733 @table @code
35734 @item set displaced-stepping on
35735 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35736 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35737
35738 @item set displaced-stepping off
35739 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35740 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35741
35742 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35743 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35744 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35745 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35746 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35747 @end table
35748
35749 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35750 @item maint check-psymtabs
35751 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35752 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35753
35754 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35755 @item maint check-symtabs
35756 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35757
35758 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35759 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35760 Expand symbol tables.
35761 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35762 names matching @var{regexp}.
35763
35764 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35765 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35766 @cindex demangler crashes
35767 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35768 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35769 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35770 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35771 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35772 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35773 option to terminate the current session.
35774
35775 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35776 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35777 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35778
35779 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35780 @item maint cplus namespace
35781 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35782
35783 @kindex maint deprecate
35784 @kindex maint undeprecate
35785 @cindex deprecated commands
35786 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35787 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35788 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35789 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35790 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35791 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35792 the replacement as part of the warning.
35793
35794 @kindex maint dump-me
35795 @item maint dump-me
35796 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35797 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35798 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35799 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35800
35801 @kindex maint internal-error
35802 @kindex maint internal-warning
35803 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35804 @cindex demangler crashes
35805 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35806 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35807 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35808
35809 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35810 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35811 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35812 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35813 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35814 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35815 @value{GDBN} session.
35816
35817 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35818 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35819
35820 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35821
35822 @smallexample
35823 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35824 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35825 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35826 debugging may prove unreliable.
35827 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35828 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35829 (@value{GDBP})
35830 @end smallexample
35831
35832 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35833 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35834 @cindex demangler crashes
35835
35836 @kindex maint set internal-error
35837 @kindex maint show internal-error
35838 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35839 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35840 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35841 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35842 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35843 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35844 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35845 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35846 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35847 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35848 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35849 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35850 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35851 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35852 described in the table below.
35853
35854 @table @samp
35855 @item quit
35856 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35857 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35858
35859 @item corefile
35860 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35861 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35862 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35863 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35864 disabled.
35865 @end table
35866
35867 @kindex maint packet
35868 @item maint packet @var{text}
35869 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35870 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35871 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35872 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35873 checksum.
35874
35875 @kindex maint print architecture
35876 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35877 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35878 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35879
35880 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35881 @item maint print c-tdesc
35882 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35883 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35884 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35885 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35886 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35887 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35888 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35889 modify XML target descriptions.
35890
35891 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35892 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35893 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35894 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35895
35896 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
35897 @kindex maint check libthread-db
35898 @item maint check libthread-db
35899 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
35900 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
35901 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
35902 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
35903 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
35904 on some platforms when debugging core files.
35905
35906 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35907 @item maint print dummy-frames
35908 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35909
35910 @smallexample
35911 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35912 @dots{}
35913 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35914 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35915 58 return (a + b);
35916 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35917 @dots{}
35918 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35919 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35920 (@value{GDBP})
35921 @end smallexample
35922
35923 Takes an optional file parameter.
35924
35925 @kindex maint print registers
35926 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35927 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35928 @kindex maint print register-groups
35929 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35930 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35931 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35932 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35933 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35934 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35935 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35936
35937 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35938 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35939 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35940 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35941 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35942 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35943 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35944 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35945
35946 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35947 write the information.
35948
35949 @kindex maint print reggroups
35950 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35951 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35952 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35953 information.
35954
35955 The register groups info looks like this:
35956
35957 @smallexample
35958 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35959 Group Type
35960 general user
35961 float user
35962 all user
35963 vector user
35964 system user
35965 save internal
35966 restore internal
35967 @end smallexample
35968
35969 @kindex flushregs
35970 @item flushregs
35971 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35972
35973 @kindex maint print objfiles
35974 @cindex info for known object files
35975 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35976 Print a dump of all known object files.
35977 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35978 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35979 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35980
35981 @kindex maint print user-registers
35982 @cindex user registers
35983 @item maint print user-registers
35984 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35985 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35986 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35987 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35988 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35989 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35990 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35991
35992 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35993 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35994 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35995 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35996 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35997 matching @var{regexp}.
35998 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35999 and the full path if known.
36000 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36001
36002 @kindex maint print statistics
36003 @cindex bcache statistics
36004 @item maint print statistics
36005 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36006 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36007 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36008 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36009 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36010 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36011 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36012 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36013 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36014 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36015 lengths.
36016
36017 @kindex maint print target-stack
36018 @cindex target stack description
36019 @item maint print target-stack
36020 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36021 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36022 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36023 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36024 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36025 address.
36026
36027 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36028 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36029
36030 @kindex maint print type
36031 @cindex type chain of a data type
36032 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36033 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36034 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36035 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36036 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36037 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36038
36039 @kindex maint selftest
36040 @cindex self tests
36041 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36042 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36043 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36044 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36045 name will by ran.
36046
36047 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36048 @cindex self tests
36049 @item maint info selftests
36050 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36051
36052 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36053 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36054 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36055 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36056 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36057 information.
36058
36059 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36060 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36061 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36062 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36063 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36064 always see the disassembly form.
36065
36066 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36067
36068 @smallexample
36069 (gdb) info addr argc
36070 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36071 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36072 @end smallexample
36073
36074 For more information on these expressions, see
36075 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36076
36077 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36078 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36079 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36080 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36081 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36082
36083 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36084 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36085 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36086 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36087 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36088 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36089 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36090 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36091 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36092
36093 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36094 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36095 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36096 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36097 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36098
36099 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36100 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36101 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36102 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36103 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36104 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36105
36106 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36107 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36108 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36109
36110 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36111 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36112 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36113 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36114
36115 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36116 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36117 @kindex maint set profile
36118 @kindex maint show profile
36119 @cindex profiling GDB
36120 @item maint set profile
36121 @itemx maint show profile
36122 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36123
36124 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36125 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36126 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36127 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36128 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36129 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36130 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36131
36132 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36133 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36134
36135 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36136 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36137 @cindex hardware debug registers
36138 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36139 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36140 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36141 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36142 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36143 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36144 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36145
36146 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36147 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36148 @item maint set show-all-tib
36149 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36150 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36151 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36152 command.
36153
36154 @kindex maint set target-async
36155 @kindex maint show target-async
36156 @item maint set target-async
36157 @itemx maint show target-async
36158 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36159 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36160 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36161 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36162
36163 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36164 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36165 @item maint set target-non-stop
36166 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36167
36168 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36169 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36170 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36171 if supported by the target.
36172
36173 @table @code
36174 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36175 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36176 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36177
36178 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36179 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36180 does not indicate support.
36181
36182 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36183 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36184 target supports it.
36185 @end table
36186
36187 @kindex maint set per-command
36188 @kindex maint show per-command
36189 @item maint set per-command
36190 @itemx maint show per-command
36191 @cindex resources used by commands
36192
36193 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36194 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36195
36196 @table @code
36197 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36198 @itemx maint show per-command space
36199 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36200 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36201 took, following the command's own output.
36202 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36203 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36204
36205 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36206 @itemx maint show per-command time
36207 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36208 for each command.
36209 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36210 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36211 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36212 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36213 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36214 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36215 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36216 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36217 spent by the program been debugged.
36218 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36219 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36220
36221 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36222 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36223 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36224 for each command.
36225 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36226
36227 @enumerate a
36228 @item
36229 number of symbol tables
36230 @item
36231 number of primary symbol tables
36232 @item
36233 number of blocks in the blockvector
36234 @end enumerate
36235 @end table
36236
36237 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36238 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36239 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36240 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36241 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36242 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36243 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36244 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36245 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36246 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36247
36248 @kindex maint space
36249 @cindex memory used by commands
36250 @item maint space @var{value}
36251 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36252 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36253
36254 @kindex maint time
36255 @cindex time of command execution
36256 @item maint time @var{value}
36257 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36258 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36259
36260 @kindex maint translate-address
36261 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36262 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36263 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36264 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36265 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36266 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36267 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36268
36269 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36270 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36271 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36272
36273 @end table
36274
36275 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36276 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36277
36278 @table @code
36279 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36280 @kindex set watchdog
36281 @cindex watchdog timer
36282 @cindex timeout for commands
36283 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36284 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36285 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36286
36287 @item show watchdog
36288 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36289 @end table
36290
36291 @node Remote Protocol
36292 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36293
36294 @menu
36295 * Overview::
36296 * Packets::
36297 * Stop Reply Packets::
36298 * General Query Packets::
36299 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36300 * Tracepoint Packets::
36301 * Host I/O Packets::
36302 * Interrupts::
36303 * Notification Packets::
36304 * Remote Non-Stop::
36305 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36306 * Examples::
36307 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36308 * Library List Format::
36309 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36310 * Memory Map Format::
36311 * Thread List Format::
36312 * Traceframe Info Format::
36313 * Branch Trace Format::
36314 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36315 @end menu
36316
36317 @node Overview
36318 @section Overview
36319
36320 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36321 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36322 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36323 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36324
36325 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36326 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36327
36328 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36329 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36330 @cindex remote serial protocol
36331 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36332 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36333 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36334 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36335 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36336
36337 @smallexample
36338 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36339 @end smallexample
36340 @noindent
36341
36342 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36343 @noindent
36344 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36345 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36346 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36347
36348 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36349 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36350
36351 @smallexample
36352 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36353 @end smallexample
36354
36355 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36356 @noindent
36357 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36358 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36359 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36360
36361 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36362 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36363 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36364 retransmission):
36365
36366 @smallexample
36367 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36368 <- @code{+}
36369 @end smallexample
36370 @noindent
36371
36372 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36373 once a connection is established.
36374 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36375
36376 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36377 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36378 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36379 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36380 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36381 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36382 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36383
36384 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36385 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36386 exceptions).
36387
36388 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36389 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36390 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36391 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36392
36393 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36394 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36395 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36396
36397 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36398 @anchor{Binary Data}
36399 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36400 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36401 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36402 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36403 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36404 binary data.
36405
36406 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36407 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36408 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36409 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36410 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36411 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36412 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36413 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36414 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36415 (described next).
36416
36417 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36418 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36419 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36420 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36421 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36422 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36423 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36424 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36425 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36426 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36427 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36428 3}} more times.
36429
36430 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36431 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36432 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36433 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36434 @samp{0*"00}.
36435
36436 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36437 error number. That number is not well defined.
36438
36439 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36440 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36441 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36442 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36443 on that response.
36444
36445 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36446 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36447 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36448 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36449 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36450 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36451
36452 @node Packets
36453 @section Packets
36454
36455 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36456 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36457 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36458 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36459
36460 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36461 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36462 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36463 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36464 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36465 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36466 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36467 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36468 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36469 @var{baz}.
36470
36471 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36472 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36473 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36474 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36475 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36476 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36477 pick any thread.
36478
36479 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36480 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36481 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36482 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36483 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36484 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36485 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36486 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36487 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36488 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36489 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36490 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36491 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36492
36493 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36494 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36495 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36496 more information.
36497
36498 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36499 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36500
36501 Here are the packet descriptions.
36502
36503 @table @samp
36504
36505 @item !
36506 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36507 @anchor{extended mode}
36508 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36509 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36510 debugged.
36511
36512 Reply:
36513 @table @samp
36514 @item OK
36515 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36516 @end table
36517
36518 @item ?
36519 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36520 @anchor{? packet}
36521 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36522 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36523 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36524
36525 Reply:
36526 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36527
36528 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36529 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36530 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36531 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36532 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36533
36534 Reply:
36535 @table @samp
36536 @item OK
36537 The arguments were set.
36538 @item E @var{NN}
36539 An error occurred.
36540 @end table
36541
36542 @item b @var{baud}
36543 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36544 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36545 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36546
36547 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36548 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36549 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36550
36551 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36552 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36553 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36554 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36555 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36556
36557 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36558 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36559 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36560 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36561
36562 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36563 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36564
36565 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36566 @anchor{bc}
36567 @item bc
36568 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36569 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36570
36571 Reply:
36572 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36573
36574 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36575 @anchor{bs}
36576 @item bs
36577 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36578 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36579
36580 Reply:
36581 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36582
36583 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36584 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36585 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36586 is omitted, resume at current address.
36587
36588 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36589 packet}.
36590
36591 Reply:
36592 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36593
36594 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36595 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36596 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36597 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36598
36599 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36600 packet}.
36601
36602 Reply:
36603 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36604
36605 @item d
36606 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36607 Toggle debug flag.
36608
36609 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36610 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36611
36612 @item D
36613 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36614 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36615 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36616 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36617 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36618
36619 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36620 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36621 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36622 big-endian hex string.
36623
36624 Reply:
36625 @table @samp
36626 @item OK
36627 for success
36628 @item E @var{NN}
36629 for an error
36630 @end table
36631
36632 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36633 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36634 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36635 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36636 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36637
36638 @item g
36639 @anchor{read registers packet}
36640 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36641 Read general registers.
36642
36643 Reply:
36644 @table @samp
36645 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36646 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36647 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36648 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36649 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36650 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36651
36652 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36653 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36654 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36655 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36656 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36657 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36658 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36659 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36660
36661 @smallexample
36662 -> @code{g}
36663 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36664 @end smallexample
36665
36666 @item E @var{NN}
36667 for an error.
36668 @end table
36669
36670 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36671 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36672 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36673 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36674
36675 Reply:
36676 @table @samp
36677 @item OK
36678 for success
36679 @item E @var{NN}
36680 for an error
36681 @end table
36682
36683 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36684 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36685 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36686 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36687 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36688 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36689 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36690 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36691 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36692
36693 Reply:
36694 @table @samp
36695 @item OK
36696 for success
36697 @item E @var{NN}
36698 for an error
36699 @end table
36700
36701 @c FIXME: JTC:
36702 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36703 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36704 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36705 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36706 @c described. For example:
36707 @c
36708 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36709 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36710 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36711 @c
36712 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36713 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36714 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36715
36716 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36717 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36718 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36719 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36720 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36721 step starting at that address.
36722
36723 @item I
36724 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36725 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36726 step packet}.
36727
36728 @item k
36729 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36730 Kill request.
36731
36732 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36733
36734 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36735 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36736
36737 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36738
36739 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36740 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36741 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36742
36743 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36744 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36745 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36746
36747 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36748 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36749 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36750 (@pxref{? packet}).
36751
36752 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36753 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36754 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36755 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36756 any particular boundary.
36757
36758 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36759 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
36760 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
36761 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
36762 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
36763 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
36764 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
36765 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
36766
36767 Reply:
36768 @table @samp
36769 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36770 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36771 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
36772 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
36773 @item E @var{NN}
36774 @var{NN} is errno
36775 @end table
36776
36777 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36778 @cindex @samp{M} packet
36779 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36780 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
36781 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36782
36783 Reply:
36784 @table @samp
36785 @item OK
36786 for success
36787 @item E @var{NN}
36788 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
36789 written).
36790 @end table
36791
36792 @item p @var{n}
36793 @cindex @samp{p} packet
36794 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
36795 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
36796 register value is encoded.
36797
36798 Reply:
36799 @table @samp
36800 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36801 the register's value
36802 @item E @var{NN}
36803 for an error
36804 @item @w{}
36805 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36806 @end table
36807
36808 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36809 @anchor{write register packet}
36810 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36811 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36812 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36813 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36814
36815 Reply:
36816 @table @samp
36817 @item OK
36818 for success
36819 @item E @var{NN}
36820 for an error
36821 @end table
36822
36823 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36824 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36825 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36826 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36827 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36828 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36829
36830 @item r
36831 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36832 Reset the entire system.
36833
36834 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36835
36836 @item R @var{XX}
36837 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36838 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36839 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36840
36841 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36842
36843 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36844 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36845 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36846 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36847
36848 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36849 packet}.
36850
36851 Reply:
36852 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36853
36854 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36855 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36856 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36857 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36858 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36859
36860 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36861 packet}.
36862
36863 Reply:
36864 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36865
36866 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36867 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36868 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36869 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36870 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36871
36872 @item T @var{thread-id}
36873 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36874 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36875
36876 Reply:
36877 @table @samp
36878 @item OK
36879 thread is still alive
36880 @item E @var{NN}
36881 thread is dead
36882 @end table
36883
36884 @item v
36885 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36886 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36887
36888 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36889 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36890 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36891 The process ID is a
36892 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36893 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36894 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36895
36896 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36897 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36898 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36899 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36900 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36901 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36902 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36903 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36904
36905 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36906
36907 Reply:
36908 @table @samp
36909 @item E @var{nn}
36910 for an error
36911 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36912 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36913 @item OK
36914 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36915 @end table
36916
36917 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36918 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36919 @anchor{vCont packet}
36920 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36921
36922 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36923 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36924 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36925 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36926 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36927 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36928 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36929 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36930 error.
36931
36932 Currently supported actions are:
36933
36934 @table @samp
36935 @item c
36936 Continue.
36937 @item C @var{sig}
36938 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36939 @item s
36940 Step.
36941 @item S @var{sig}
36942 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36943 @item t
36944 Stop.
36945 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36946 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36947 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36948 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36949 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36950 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36951
36952 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36953 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36954 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36955 jumps to @var{start}).
36956
36957 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36958 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36959 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36960
36961 @end table
36962
36963 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36964 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36965 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36966
36967 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36968 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36969 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36970 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36971 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36972 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36973 as an implementation detail.
36974
36975 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36976 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36977 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36978 stopped.
36979
36980 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36981 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36982 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36983
36984 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36985 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36986
36987 Reply:
36988 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36989
36990 @item vCont?
36991 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36992 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36993
36994 Reply:
36995 @table @samp
36996 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36997 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36998 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36999 @item @w{}
37000 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37001 @end table
37002
37003 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37004 @item vCtrlC
37005 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37006 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37007 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37008 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37009 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37010 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37011 variant.
37012
37013 Reply:
37014 @table @samp
37015 @item E @var{nn}
37016 for an error
37017 @item OK
37018 for success
37019 @end table
37020
37021 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37022 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37023 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37024 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37025
37026 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37027 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37028 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37029 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37030 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37031 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37032 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37033 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37034 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37035 packet is received.
37036
37037 Reply:
37038 @table @samp
37039 @item OK
37040 for success
37041 @item E @var{NN}
37042 for an error
37043 @end table
37044
37045 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37046 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37047 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37048 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37049 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37050 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37051 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37052 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37053 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37054 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37055 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37056 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37057
37058
37059 Reply:
37060 @table @samp
37061 @item OK
37062 for success
37063 @item E.memtype
37064 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37065 @item E @var{NN}
37066 for an error
37067 @end table
37068
37069 @item vFlashDone
37070 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37071 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37072 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37073 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37074 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37075 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37076 request is completed.
37077
37078 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37079 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37080 @anchor{vKill packet}
37081 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37082 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37083 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37084 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37085
37086 Reply:
37087 @table @samp
37088 @item E @var{nn}
37089 for an error
37090 @item OK
37091 for success
37092 @end table
37093
37094 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37095 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37096 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37097 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37098 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37099
37100 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37101 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37102 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37103 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37104 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37105 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37106
37107 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37108 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37109 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37110 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37111 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37112 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37113 state.
37114
37115 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37116
37117 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37118
37119 Reply:
37120 @table @samp
37121 @item E @var{nn}
37122 for an error
37123 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37124 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37125 @end table
37126
37127 @item vStopped
37128 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37129 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37130
37131 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37132 @anchor{X packet}
37133 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37134 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37135 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37136 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37137 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37138
37139 Reply:
37140 @table @samp
37141 @item OK
37142 for success
37143 @item E @var{NN}
37144 for an error
37145 @end table
37146
37147 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37148 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37149 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37150 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37151 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37152 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37153 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37154
37155 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37156 separately.
37157
37158 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37159 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37160 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37161 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37162 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37163 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37164
37165 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37166 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37167 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37168 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37169 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37170 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37171
37172 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37173 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37174 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37175 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37176 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37177 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37178 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37179 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37180 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37181 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37182 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37183 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37184 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37185
37186 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37187 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37188
37189 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37190 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37191
37192 @table @samp
37193
37194 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37195 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37196 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37197
37198 @end table
37199
37200 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37201 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37202 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37203 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37204 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37205 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37206 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37207
37208 @table @samp
37209
37210 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37211 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37212 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37213
37214 @end table
37215
37216 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37217 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37218 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37219 target, is not defined.}
37220
37221 Reply:
37222 @table @samp
37223 @item OK
37224 success
37225 @item @w{}
37226 not supported
37227 @item E @var{NN}
37228 for an error
37229 @end table
37230
37231 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37232 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37233 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37234 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37235 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37236 address @var{addr}.
37237
37238 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37239 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37240 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37241 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37242
37243 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37244 movement.}
37245
37246 Reply:
37247 @table @samp
37248 @item OK
37249 success
37250 @item @w{}
37251 not supported
37252 @item E @var{NN}
37253 for an error
37254 @end table
37255
37256 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37257 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37258 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37259 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37260 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37261 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37262
37263 Reply:
37264 @table @samp
37265 @item OK
37266 success
37267 @item @w{}
37268 not supported
37269 @item E @var{NN}
37270 for an error
37271 @end table
37272
37273 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37274 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37275 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37276 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37277 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37278 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37279
37280 Reply:
37281 @table @samp
37282 @item OK
37283 success
37284 @item @w{}
37285 not supported
37286 @item E @var{NN}
37287 for an error
37288 @end table
37289
37290 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37291 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37292 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37293 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37294 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37295 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37296
37297 Reply:
37298 @table @samp
37299 @item OK
37300 success
37301 @item @w{}
37302 not supported
37303 @item E @var{NN}
37304 for an error
37305 @end table
37306
37307 @end table
37308
37309 @node Stop Reply Packets
37310 @section Stop Reply Packets
37311 @cindex stop reply packets
37312
37313 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37314 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37315 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37316 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37317 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37318 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37319 @value{GDBN} source code.
37320
37321 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37322 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37323 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37324
37325 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37326 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37327 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37328 components.
37329
37330 @table @samp
37331
37332 @item S @var{AA}
37333 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37334 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37335 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37336
37337 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37338 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37339 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37340 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37341 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37342 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37343 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37344 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37345
37346 @itemize @bullet
37347 @item
37348 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37349 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37350 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37351 two-digit hex number.
37352
37353 @item
37354 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37355 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37356
37357 @item
37358 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37359 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37360
37361 @item
37362 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37363 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37364 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37365 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37366
37367 @item
37368 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37369 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37370 future.
37371 @end itemize
37372
37373 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37374
37375 @table @samp
37376 @item watch
37377 @itemx rwatch
37378 @itemx awatch
37379 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37380 hex.
37381
37382 @item syscall_entry
37383 @itemx syscall_return
37384 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37385 syscall number, in hex.
37386
37387 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37388 @item library
37389 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37390 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37391 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37392
37393 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37394 @item replaylog
37395 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37396 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37397 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37398 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37399 for more information.
37400
37401 @item swbreak
37402 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37403 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37404 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37405 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37406 part must be left empty.
37407
37408 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37409 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37410 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37411 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37412 address.
37413
37414 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37415 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37416 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37417 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37418 indicating support.
37419
37420 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37421
37422 @item hwbreak
37423 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37424 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37425
37426 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37427 apply.
37428
37429 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37430 @item fork
37431 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37432 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37433 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37434 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37435 fork events.
37436
37437 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37438 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37439 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37440 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37441 indicating support.
37442
37443 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37444 @item vfork
37445 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37446 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37447 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37448 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37449 vfork events.
37450
37451 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37452 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37453 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37454 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37455 indicating support.
37456
37457 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37458 @item vforkdone
37459 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37460 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37461 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37462 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37463 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37464
37465 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37466 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37467 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37468 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37469 indicating support.
37470
37471 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37472 @item exec
37473 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37474 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37475 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37476
37477 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37478 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37479 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37480 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37481 indicating support.
37482
37483 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37484 @anchor{thread create event}
37485 @item create
37486 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37487 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37488 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37489 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37490 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37491 @var{r} part is ignored.
37492
37493 @end table
37494
37495 @item W @var{AA}
37496 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37497 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37498 applicable to certain targets.
37499
37500 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37501 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37502 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37503 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37504 hex strings.
37505
37506 @item X @var{AA}
37507 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37508 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37509
37510 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37511 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37512 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37513 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37514 hex strings.
37515
37516 @anchor{thread exit event}
37517 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37518 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37519
37520 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37521 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37522 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37523 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37524
37525 @item N
37526 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37527 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37528 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37529 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37530 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37531 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37532 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37533 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37534 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37535 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37536 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37537 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37538 support.
37539
37540 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37541 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37542 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37543 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37544 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37545
37546 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37547 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37548 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37549 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37550 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37551 system calls.
37552
37553 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37554 this very system call.
37555
37556 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37557 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37558 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37559 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37560 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37561 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37562
37563 @end table
37564
37565 @node General Query Packets
37566 @section General Query Packets
37567 @cindex remote query requests
37568
37569 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37570 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37571 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37572 sending information to and from the stub.
37573
37574 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37575 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37576 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37577 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37578 conventions:
37579
37580 @itemize @bullet
37581 @item
37582 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37583 @item
37584 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37585 letter.
37586 @item
37587 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37588 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37589 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37590 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37591 @end itemize
37592
37593 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37594 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37595 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37596 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37597 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37598 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37599 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37600 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37601 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37602 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37603 packet.}.
37604
37605 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37606 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37607 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37608 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37609 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37610
37611 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37612
37613 @table @samp
37614
37615 @item QAgent:1
37616 @itemx QAgent:0
37617 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37618 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37619
37620 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37621 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37622 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37623 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37624 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37625 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37626 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37627 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37628 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37629 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37630 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37631
37632 @item qC
37633 @cindex current thread, remote request
37634 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37635 Return the current thread ID.
37636
37637 Reply:
37638 @table @samp
37639 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37640 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37641 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37642 @item @r{(anything else)}
37643 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37644 @end table
37645
37646 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37647 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37648 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37649 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37650 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37651 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37652 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37653 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37654
37655 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37656 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37657 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37658 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37659 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37660 detect trailing zeros.
37661
37662 Reply:
37663 @table @samp
37664 @item E @var{NN}
37665 An error (such as memory fault)
37666 @item C @var{crc32}
37667 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37668 @end table
37669
37670 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37671 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37672 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37673 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37674 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37675 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37676 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37677 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37678 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37679 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37680 randomization.
37681
37682 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37683
37684 Reply:
37685 @table @samp
37686 @item OK
37687 The request succeeded.
37688
37689 @item E @var{nn}
37690 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37691
37692 @item @w{}
37693 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37694 by the stub.
37695 @end table
37696
37697 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37698 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37699 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37700 address space randomization.
37701
37702 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37703 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37704 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37705 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37706 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37707 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37708 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37709 inferior using a shell or not.
37710
37711 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37712 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37713 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37714 values are considered an error.
37715
37716 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37717 mode}).
37718
37719 Reply:
37720 @table @samp
37721 @item OK
37722 The request succeeded.
37723
37724 @item E @var{nn}
37725 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37726 @end table
37727
37728 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37729 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37730 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37731 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37732
37733 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37734 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37735
37736 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37737 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37738 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37739 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37740 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37741 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37742 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37743 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37744 environment}).
37745
37746 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37747 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37748 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37749 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37750 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37751 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37752 not be present.
37753
37754 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37755 mode}).
37756
37757 Reply:
37758 @table @samp
37759 @item OK
37760 The request succeeded.
37761 @end table
37762
37763 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37764 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37765 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37766 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37767 inferior.
37768
37769 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
37770 @pxref{set environment}.
37771
37772 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
37773 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
37774 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
37775 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
37776 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
37777 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
37778 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
37779 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
37780
37781 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37782 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
37783
37784 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37785 mode}).
37786
37787 Reply:
37788 @table @samp
37789 @item OK
37790 The request succeeded.
37791 @end table
37792
37793 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37794 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37795 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37796 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37797 inferior.
37798
37799 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
37800 @pxref{unset environment}.
37801
37802 @item QEnvironmentReset
37803 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37804 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37805 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37806 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37807 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37808 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37809 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37810 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37811 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37812 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37813 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37814
37815 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37816 mode}).
37817
37818 Reply:
37819 @table @samp
37820 @item OK
37821 The request succeeded.
37822 @end table
37823
37824 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37825 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37826 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37827 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37828 inferior.
37829
37830 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37831 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37832 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37833 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37834 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37835 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37836
37837 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37838 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37839 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37840 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37841 directory to its original, empty value.
37842
37843 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37844 mode}).
37845
37846 Reply:
37847 @table @samp
37848 @item OK
37849 The request succeeded.
37850 @end table
37851
37852 @item qfThreadInfo
37853 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37854 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37855 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37856 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37857 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37858 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37859 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37860 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37861 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37862 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37863
37864 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37865
37866 Reply:
37867 @table @samp
37868 @item m @var{thread-id}
37869 A single thread ID
37870 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37871 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37872 @item l
37873 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37874 @end table
37875
37876 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37877 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37878 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37879 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37880 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37881 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37882 fields.
37883
37884 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37885 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37886 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37887 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37888 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37889
37890 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37891 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37892 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37893 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37894 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37895
37896 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37897 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37898
37899 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37900 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37901 information associated with the variable.)
37902
37903 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37904 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37905 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37906 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37907 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37908 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37909
37910 Reply:
37911 @table @samp
37912 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37913 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37914 local storage requested.
37915
37916 @item E @var{nn}
37917 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37918
37919 @item @w{}
37920 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37921 @end table
37922
37923 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37924 @cindex get thread information block address
37925 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37926 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37927
37928 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37929
37930 Reply:
37931 @table @samp
37932 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37933 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37934 thread information block.
37935
37936 @item E @var{nn}
37937 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37938 address could not be retrieved.
37939
37940 @item @w{}
37941 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37942 @end table
37943
37944 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37945 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37946 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37947 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37948 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37949 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37950 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37951
37952 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37953
37954 Reply:
37955 @table @samp
37956 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37957 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37958 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37959 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37960 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37961 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37962 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37963 @end table
37964
37965 @item qOffsets
37966 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37967 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37968 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37969 image.
37970
37971 Reply:
37972 @table @samp
37973 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37974 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37975 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37976 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37977 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37978 segments by the supplied offsets.
37979
37980 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37981 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37982 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37983
37984 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37985 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37986 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37987 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37988 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37989 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37990 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37991 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37992 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37993 @end table
37994
37995 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37996 @cindex thread information, remote request
37997 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37998 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37999 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38000 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38001
38002 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38003 (see below).
38004
38005 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38006
38007 @item QNonStop:1
38008 @itemx QNonStop:0
38009 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38010 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38011 @anchor{QNonStop}
38012 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38013 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38014
38015 Reply:
38016 @table @samp
38017 @item OK
38018 The request succeeded.
38019
38020 @item E @var{nn}
38021 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38022
38023 @item @w{}
38024 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38025 the stub.
38026 @end table
38027
38028 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38029 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38030 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38031 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38032
38033 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38034 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38035 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38036 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38037 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38038 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38039 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38040
38041 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38042 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38043 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38044
38045 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38046 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38047 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38048 report the requested syscalls.
38049
38050 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38051 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38052
38053 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38054 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38055 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38056 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38057
38058 Reply:
38059 @table @samp
38060 @item OK
38061 The request succeeded.
38062
38063 @item E @var{nn}
38064 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38065
38066 @item @w{}
38067 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38068 the stub.
38069 @end table
38070
38071 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38072 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38073 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38074 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38075
38076 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38077 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38078 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38079 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38080 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38081 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38082 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38083 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38084 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38085 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38086 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38087 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38088 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38089
38090 Reply:
38091 @table @samp
38092 @item OK
38093 The request succeeded.
38094
38095 @item E @var{nn}
38096 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38097
38098 @item @w{}
38099 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38100 the stub.
38101 @end table
38102
38103 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38104 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38105 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38106 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38107
38108 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38109 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38110 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38111 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38112 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38113 Others should be silently discarded.
38114
38115 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38116 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38117 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38118 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38119 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38120 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38121 signals.
38122
38123 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38124 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38125
38126 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38127 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38128 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38129 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38130 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38131
38132 Reply:
38133 @table @samp
38134 @item OK
38135 The request succeeded.
38136
38137 @item E @var{nn}
38138 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38139
38140 @item @w{}
38141 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38142 by the stub.
38143 @end table
38144
38145 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38146 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38147 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38148 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38149
38150 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38151 @item QThreadEvents:1
38152 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38153 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38154 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38155
38156 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38157 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38158 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38159 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38160 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38161 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38162 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38163 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38164 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38165 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38166
38167 Reply:
38168 @table @samp
38169 @item OK
38170 The request succeeded.
38171
38172 @item E @var{nn}
38173 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38174
38175 @item @w{}
38176 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38177 the stub.
38178 @end table
38179
38180 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38181 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38182
38183 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38184 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38185 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38186 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38187 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38188 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38189 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38190 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38191 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38192
38193 Reply:
38194 @table @samp
38195 @item OK
38196 A command response with no output.
38197 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38198 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38199 @item E @var{NN}
38200 Indicate a badly formed request.
38201 @item @w{}
38202 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38203 @end table
38204
38205 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38206 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38207 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38208 packets.)
38209
38210 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38211 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38212 @ifnotinfo
38213 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38214 @end ifnotinfo
38215 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38216 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38217 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38218 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38219 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38220
38221 Reply:
38222 @table @samp
38223 @item 0
38224 The pattern was not found.
38225 @item 1,address
38226 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38227 @item E @var{NN}
38228 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38229 @item @w{}
38230 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38231 @end table
38232
38233 @item QStartNoAckMode
38234 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38235 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38236 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38237 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38238
38239 Reply:
38240 @table @samp
38241 @item OK
38242 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38243 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38244 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38245 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38246 @item @w{}
38247 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38248 @end table
38249
38250 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38251 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38252 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38253 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38254 @anchor{qSupported}
38255 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38256 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38257 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38258 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38259 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38260 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38261 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38262 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38263 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38264 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38265 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38266 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38267 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38268 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38269
38270 Reply:
38271 @table @samp
38272 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38273 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38274 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38275 possible forms).
38276 @item @w{}
38277 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38278 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38279 @end table
38280
38281 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38282 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38283 are:
38284
38285 @table @samp
38286 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38287 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38288 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38289 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38290 @item @var{name}+
38291 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38292 need an associated value.
38293 @item @var{name}-
38294 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38295 @item @var{name}?
38296 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38297 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38298 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38299 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38300 @end table
38301
38302 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38303 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38304 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38305 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38306 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38307
38308 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38309 are defined:
38310
38311 @table @samp
38312 @item multiprocess
38313 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38314 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38315 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38316 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38317 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38318
38319 @item xmlRegisters
38320 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38321 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38322 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38323 description.
38324
38325 @item qRelocInsn
38326 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38327 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38328 instruction reply packet}).
38329
38330 @item swbreak
38331 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38332 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38333
38334 @item hwbreak
38335 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38336 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38337
38338 @item fork-events
38339 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38340 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38341 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38342 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38343
38344 @item vfork-events
38345 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38346 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38347 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38348 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38349
38350 @item exec-events
38351 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38352 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38353 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38354 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38355
38356 @item vContSupported
38357 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38358 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38359 @end table
38360
38361 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38362 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38363 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38364 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38365 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38366 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38367 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38368 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38369 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38370 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38371 all the features it supports.
38372
38373 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38374 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38375
38376 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38377 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38378 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38379 form response.
38380
38381 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38382 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38383 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38384 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38385
38386 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38387 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38388 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38389 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38390 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38391
38392 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38393
38394 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38395 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38396 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38397 @item Feature Name
38398 @tab Value Required
38399 @tab Default
38400 @tab Probe Allowed
38401
38402 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38403 @tab Yes
38404 @tab @samp{-}
38405 @tab No
38406
38407 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38408 @tab No
38409 @tab @samp{-}
38410 @tab Yes
38411
38412 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38413 @tab No
38414 @tab @samp{-}
38415 @tab Yes
38416
38417 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38418 @tab No
38419 @tab @samp{-}
38420 @tab Yes
38421
38422 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38423 @tab No
38424 @tab @samp{-}
38425 @tab Yes
38426
38427 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38428 @tab No
38429 @tab @samp{-}
38430 @tab Yes
38431
38432 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38433 @tab No
38434 @tab @samp{-}
38435 @tab Yes
38436
38437 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38438 @tab No
38439 @tab @samp{-}
38440 @tab Yes
38441
38442 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38443 @tab No
38444 @tab @samp{-}
38445 @tab No
38446
38447 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38448 @tab No
38449 @tab @samp{-}
38450 @tab Yes
38451
38452 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38453 @tab No
38454 @tab @samp{-}
38455 @tab Yes
38456
38457 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38458 @tab No
38459 @tab @samp{-}
38460 @tab Yes
38461
38462 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38463 @tab No
38464 @tab @samp{-}
38465 @tab Yes
38466
38467 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38468 @tab No
38469 @tab @samp{-}
38470 @tab Yes
38471
38472 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38473 @tab No
38474 @tab @samp{-}
38475 @tab Yes
38476
38477 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38478 @tab No
38479 @tab @samp{-}
38480 @tab Yes
38481
38482 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38483 @tab No
38484 @tab @samp{-}
38485 @tab Yes
38486
38487 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38488 @tab No
38489 @tab @samp{-}
38490 @tab Yes
38491
38492 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38493 @tab No
38494 @tab @samp{-}
38495 @tab Yes
38496
38497 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38498 @tab Yes
38499 @tab @samp{-}
38500 @tab Yes
38501
38502 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38503 @tab Yes
38504 @tab @samp{-}
38505 @tab Yes
38506
38507 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38508 @tab Yes
38509 @tab @samp{-}
38510 @tab Yes
38511
38512 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38513 @tab Yes
38514 @tab @samp{-}
38515 @tab Yes
38516
38517 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38518 @tab Yes
38519 @tab @samp{-}
38520 @tab Yes
38521
38522 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38523 @tab No
38524 @tab @samp{-}
38525 @tab Yes
38526
38527 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38528 @tab No
38529 @tab @samp{-}
38530 @tab Yes
38531
38532 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38533 @tab No
38534 @tab @samp{-}
38535 @tab Yes
38536
38537 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38538 @tab No
38539 @tab @samp{-}
38540 @tab Yes
38541
38542 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38543 @tab No
38544 @tab @samp{-}
38545 @tab No
38546
38547 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38548 @tab No
38549 @tab @samp{-}
38550 @tab No
38551
38552 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38553 @tab No
38554 @tab @samp{-}
38555 @tab No
38556
38557 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38558 @tab No
38559 @tab @samp{-}
38560 @tab No
38561
38562 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38563 @tab No
38564 @tab @samp{-}
38565 @tab No
38566
38567 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38568 @tab No
38569 @tab @samp{-}
38570 @tab No
38571
38572 @item @samp{QAgent}
38573 @tab No
38574 @tab @samp{-}
38575 @tab No
38576
38577 @item @samp{QAllow}
38578 @tab No
38579 @tab @samp{-}
38580 @tab No
38581
38582 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38583 @tab No
38584 @tab @samp{-}
38585 @tab No
38586
38587 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38588 @tab No
38589 @tab @samp{-}
38590 @tab No
38591
38592 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38593 @tab No
38594 @tab @samp{-}
38595 @tab No
38596
38597 @item @samp{tracenz}
38598 @tab No
38599 @tab @samp{-}
38600 @tab No
38601
38602 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38603 @tab No
38604 @tab @samp{-}
38605 @tab No
38606
38607 @item @samp{swbreak}
38608 @tab No
38609 @tab @samp{-}
38610 @tab No
38611
38612 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38613 @tab No
38614 @tab @samp{-}
38615 @tab No
38616
38617 @item @samp{fork-events}
38618 @tab No
38619 @tab @samp{-}
38620 @tab No
38621
38622 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38623 @tab No
38624 @tab @samp{-}
38625 @tab No
38626
38627 @item @samp{exec-events}
38628 @tab No
38629 @tab @samp{-}
38630 @tab No
38631
38632 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38633 @tab No
38634 @tab @samp{-}
38635 @tab No
38636
38637 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38638 @tab No
38639 @tab @samp{-}
38640 @tab No
38641
38642 @end multitable
38643
38644 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38645
38646 @table @samp
38647 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38648 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38649 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38650 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38651 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38652 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38653 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38654 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38655 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38656 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38657
38658 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38659 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38660 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38661
38662 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38663 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38664 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38665
38666 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38667 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38668 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38669
38670 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38671 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38672 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38673
38674 @item qXfer:features:read
38675 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38676 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38677
38678 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38679 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38680 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38681
38682 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38683 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38684 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38685
38686 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38687 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38688 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38689 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38690
38691 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38692 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38693 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38694
38695 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38696 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38697 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38698
38699 @item qXfer:spu:read
38700 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38701 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38702
38703 @item qXfer:spu:write
38704 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38705 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38706
38707 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38708 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38709 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38710
38711 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38712 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38713 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38714
38715 @item qXfer:threads:read
38716 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38717 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38718
38719 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38720 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38721 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38722
38723 @item qXfer:uib:read
38724 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38725 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38726
38727 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38728 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38729 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38730
38731 @item QNonStop
38732 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38733 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38734
38735 @item QCatchSyscalls
38736 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38737 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38738
38739 @item QPassSignals
38740 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38741 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38742
38743 @item QStartNoAckMode
38744 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38745 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38746
38747 @item multiprocess
38748 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38749 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38750 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38751 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38752 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38753 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38754 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38755 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38756 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38757 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38758 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38759
38760 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38761 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38762 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38763
38764 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38765 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38766 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38767 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38768
38769 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38770 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38771 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38772
38773 @item ReverseContinue
38774 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38775 (@pxref{bc}).
38776
38777 @item ReverseStep
38778 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38779 (@pxref{bs}).
38780
38781 @item TracepointSource
38782 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38783 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38784
38785 @item QAgent
38786 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38787
38788 @item QAllow
38789 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38790
38791 @item QDisableRandomization
38792 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38793
38794 @item StaticTracepoint
38795 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38796 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38797
38798 @item InstallInTrace
38799 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38800 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38801
38802 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38803 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38804 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38805 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38806
38807 @item QTBuffer:size
38808 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38809 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38810
38811 @item tracenz
38812 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38813 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38814 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38815
38816 @item BreakpointCommands
38817 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38818 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38819 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38820
38821 @item Qbtrace:off
38822 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38823
38824 @item Qbtrace:bts
38825 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38826
38827 @item Qbtrace:pt
38828 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38829
38830 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38831 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38832
38833 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38834 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38835
38836 @item swbreak
38837 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38838 breakpoints.
38839
38840 @item hwbreak
38841 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38842 breakpoints.
38843
38844 @item fork-events
38845 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38846
38847 @item vfork-events
38848 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38849 and vforkdone events.
38850
38851 @item exec-events
38852 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38853
38854 @item vContSupported
38855 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38856 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38857
38858 @item QThreadEvents
38859 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38860
38861 @item no-resumed
38862 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38863
38864 @end table
38865
38866 @item qSymbol::
38867 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38868 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38869 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38870 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38871
38872 Reply:
38873 @table @samp
38874 @item OK
38875 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38876 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38877 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38878 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38879 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38880 below.
38881 @end table
38882
38883 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38884 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38885
38886 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38887 target has previously requested.
38888
38889 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38890 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38891 will be empty.
38892
38893 Reply:
38894 @table @samp
38895 @item OK
38896 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38897 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38898 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38899 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38900 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38901 @end table
38902
38903 @item qTBuffer
38904 @itemx QTBuffer
38905 @itemx QTDisconnected
38906 @itemx QTDP
38907 @itemx QTDPsrc
38908 @itemx QTDV
38909 @itemx qTfP
38910 @itemx qTfV
38911 @itemx QTFrame
38912 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38913
38914 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38915
38916 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38917 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38918 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38919 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38920 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38921 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38922 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38923 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38924 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38925 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38926 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38927
38928 Reply:
38929 @table @samp
38930 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38931 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38932 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38933 the thread's attributes.
38934 @end table
38935
38936 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38937 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38938 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38939 packets.)
38940
38941 @item QTNotes
38942 @itemx qTP
38943 @itemx QTSave
38944 @itemx qTsP
38945 @itemx qTsV
38946 @itemx QTStart
38947 @itemx QTStop
38948 @itemx QTEnable
38949 @itemx QTDisable
38950 @itemx QTinit
38951 @itemx QTro
38952 @itemx qTStatus
38953 @itemx qTV
38954 @itemx qTfSTM
38955 @itemx qTsSTM
38956 @itemx qTSTMat
38957 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38958
38959 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38960 @cindex read special object, remote request
38961 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38962 @anchor{qXfer read}
38963 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38964 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38965 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38966 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38967 additional details about what data to access.
38968
38969 Reply:
38970 @table @samp
38971 @item m @var{data}
38972 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38973 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38974 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38975 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38976 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38977 request.
38978
38979 @item l @var{data}
38980 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38981 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38982 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38983
38984 @item l
38985 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38986 There is no more data to be read.
38987
38988 @item E00
38989 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38990
38991 @item E @var{nn}
38992 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38993 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38994
38995 @item @w{}
38996 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38997 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38998 @end table
38999
39000 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39001 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39002 formats, listed above.
39003
39004 @table @samp
39005 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39006 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39007 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39008 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39009
39010 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39011 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39012
39013 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39014 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39015
39016 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39017 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39018 packet may have one of the following values:
39019
39020 @table @code
39021 @item all
39022 Returns all available branch trace.
39023
39024 @item new
39025 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39026 the last read request.
39027
39028 @item delta
39029 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39030 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39031 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39032 used to stitch traces together.
39033
39034 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39035 @end table
39036
39037 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39038 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39039
39040 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39041 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39042
39043 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39044 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39045
39046 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39047 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39048
39049 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39050 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39051 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39052 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39053 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39054 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39055 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39056
39057 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39058 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39059
39060 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39061 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39062 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39063 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39064 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39065
39066 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39067 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39068
39069 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39070 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39071 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39072 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39073 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39074
39075 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39076 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39077 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39078
39079 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39080 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39081
39082 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39083 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39084 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39085 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39086 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39087 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39088 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39089 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39090
39091 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39092 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39093
39094 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39095 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39096
39097 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39098 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39099 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39100 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39101
39102 @table @code
39103 @item start=@var{address}
39104 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39105 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39106 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39107 chosen as the starting point.
39108
39109 @item prev=@var{address}
39110 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39111 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39112 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39113 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39114 exists prior to the starting point.
39115
39116 @end table
39117
39118 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39119 ignored.
39120
39121 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39122 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39123 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39124 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39125 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39126
39127 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39128 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39129
39130 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39131 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39132
39133 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39134 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39135 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39136 Action Lists}.
39137
39138 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39139 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39140 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39141
39142 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39143 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39144 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39145 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39146 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39147
39148 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39149 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39150 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39151
39152 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39153 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39154 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39155 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39156 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39157 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39158 in that context to be accessed.
39159
39160 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39161 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39162 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39163
39164 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39165 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39166 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39167 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39168 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39169
39170 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39171 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39172
39173 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39174 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39175
39176 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39177 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39178 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39179
39180 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39181 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39182
39183 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39184 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39185
39186 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39187 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39188
39189 This packet is not probed by default.
39190
39191 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39192 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39193 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39194 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39195 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39196
39197 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39198 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39199
39200 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39201 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39202 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39203 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39204
39205 @end table
39206
39207 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39208 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39209 @anchor{qXfer write}
39210 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39211 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39212 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39213 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39214 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39215 to access.
39216
39217 Reply:
39218 @table @samp
39219 @item @var{nn}
39220 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39221 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39222
39223 @item E00
39224 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39225
39226 @item E @var{nn}
39227 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39228 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39229
39230 @item @w{}
39231 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39232 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39233 @end table
39234
39235 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39236 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39237 formats, listed above.
39238
39239 @table @samp
39240 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39241 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39242 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39243 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39244 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39245
39246 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39247 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39248 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39249
39250 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39251 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39252 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39253 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39254 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39255 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39256 in that context to be accessed.
39257
39258 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39259 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39260 @end table
39261
39262 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39263 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39264 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39265 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39266 must respond with an empty packet.
39267
39268 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39269 @cindex query attached, remote request
39270 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39271 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39272 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39273 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39274 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39275 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39276 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39277
39278 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39279 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39280 the @code{quit} command.
39281
39282 Reply:
39283 @table @samp
39284 @item 1
39285 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39286 @item 0
39287 The remote server created a new process.
39288 @item E @var{NN}
39289 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39290 @end table
39291
39292 @item Qbtrace:bts
39293 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39294
39295 Reply:
39296 @table @samp
39297 @item OK
39298 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39299 @item E.errtext
39300 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39301 @end table
39302
39303 @item Qbtrace:pt
39304 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39305
39306 Reply:
39307 @table @samp
39308 @item OK
39309 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39310 @item E.errtext
39311 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39312 @end table
39313
39314 @item Qbtrace:off
39315 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39316
39317 Reply:
39318 @table @samp
39319 @item OK
39320 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39321 @item E.errtext
39322 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39323 @end table
39324
39325 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39326 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39327 btrace recording method in bts format.
39328
39329 Reply:
39330 @table @samp
39331 @item OK
39332 The ring buffer size has been set.
39333 @item E.errtext
39334 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39335 @end table
39336
39337 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39338 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39339 btrace recording method in pt format.
39340
39341 Reply:
39342 @table @samp
39343 @item OK
39344 The ring buffer size has been set.
39345 @item E.errtext
39346 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39347 @end table
39348
39349 @end table
39350
39351 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39352 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39353
39354 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39355 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39356 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39357
39358 @menu
39359 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39360 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39361 @end menu
39362
39363 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39364 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39365
39366 @menu
39367 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39368 @end menu
39369
39370 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39371 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39372 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39373
39374 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39375
39376 @table @r
39377
39378 @item 2
39379 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39380
39381 @item 3
39382 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39383
39384 @item 4
39385 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39386
39387 @end table
39388
39389 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39390 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39391
39392 @menu
39393 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39394 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39395 @end menu
39396
39397 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39398 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39399 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39400
39401 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39402 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39403 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39404 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39405 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39406 most-significant -- least-significant.
39407
39408 @table @r
39409
39410 @item MIPS32
39411 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39412 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39413 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39414
39415 @item MIPS64
39416 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39417 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39418 as @code{MIPS32}.
39419
39420 @end table
39421
39422 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39423 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39424 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39425
39426 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39427
39428 @table @r
39429
39430 @item 2
39431 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39432
39433 @item 3
39434 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39435
39436 @item 4
39437 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39438
39439 @item 5
39440 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39441
39442 @end table
39443
39444 @node Tracepoint Packets
39445 @section Tracepoint Packets
39446 @cindex tracepoint packets
39447 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39448
39449 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39450 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39451
39452 @table @samp
39453
39454 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39455 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39456 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39457 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39458 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39459 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39460 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39461 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39462 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39463 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39464 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39465 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39466 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39467 actions.
39468
39469 Replies:
39470 @table @samp
39471 @item OK
39472 The packet was understood and carried out.
39473 @item qRelocInsn
39474 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39475 @item @w{}
39476 The packet was not recognized.
39477 @end table
39478
39479 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39480 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39481 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39482 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39483 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39484 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39485 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39486
39487 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39488 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39489 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39490 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39491 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39492 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39493 tracepoint actions.
39494
39495 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39496 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39497 following forms:
39498
39499 @table @samp
39500
39501 @item R @var{mask}
39502 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39503 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39504 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39505 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39506 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39507
39508 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39509 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39510 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39511 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39512 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39513 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39514 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39515
39516 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39517 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39518 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39519 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39520 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39521 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39522 packet).
39523
39524 @end table
39525
39526 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39527 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39528 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39529 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39530 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39531 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39532 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39533 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39534
39535 Replies:
39536 @table @samp
39537 @item OK
39538 The packet was understood and carried out.
39539 @item qRelocInsn
39540 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39541 @item @w{}
39542 The packet was not recognized.
39543 @end table
39544
39545 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39546 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39547 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39548 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39549 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39550 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39551 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39552 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39553
39554 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39555 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39556 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39557 fit in a single packet.
39558 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39559 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39560
39561 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39562 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39563 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39564 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39565
39566 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39567 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39568 query packets.
39569
39570 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39571 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39572 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39573 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39574 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39575 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39576 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39577 be found.
39578
39579 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39580 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39581 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39582 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39583 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39584 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39585 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39586 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39587 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39588 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39589 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39590 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39591 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39592 variable.
39593
39594 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39595 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39596 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39597 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39598 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39599
39600 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39601 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39602 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39603 one of the following forms:
39604
39605 @table @samp
39606 @item F @var{f}
39607 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39608 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39609 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39610
39611 @item T @var{t}
39612 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39613 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39614
39615 @end table
39616
39617 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39618 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39619 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39620 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39621
39622 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39623 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39624 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39625 is a hexadecimal number.
39626
39627 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39628 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39629 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39630 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39631 numbers.
39632
39633 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39634 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39635 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39636
39637 @item qTMinFTPILen
39638 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39639 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39640 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39641 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39642 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39643 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39644 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39645 arrange for that.
39646
39647 Replies:
39648
39649 @table @samp
39650 @item 0
39651 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39652 @item @var{length}
39653 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39654 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39655 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39656 regardless of size.
39657 @item E
39658 An error has occurred.
39659 @item @w{}
39660 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39661 @end table
39662
39663 @item QTStart
39664 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39665 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39666 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39667 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39668 instruction reply packet}).
39669
39670 @item QTStop
39671 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39672 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39673
39674 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39675 @anchor{QTEnable}
39676 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39677 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39678 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39679 of data from it will resume.
39680
39681 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39682 @anchor{QTDisable}
39683 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39684 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39685 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39686 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39687
39688 @item QTinit
39689 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39690 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39691
39692 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39693 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39694 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39695 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39696 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39697
39698 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39699 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39700 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39701 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39702
39703 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39704 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39705 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39706 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39707 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39708 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39709
39710 @item qTStatus
39711 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39712 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39713
39714 The reply has the form:
39715
39716 @table @samp
39717
39718 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39719 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39720 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39721 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39722
39723 @end table
39724
39725 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39726 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39727
39728 @table @samp
39729
39730 @item tnotrun:0
39731 No trace has been run yet.
39732
39733 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39734 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39735 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39736 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39737 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39738
39739 @item tfull:0
39740 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39741
39742 @item tdisconnected:0
39743 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39744
39745 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39746 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39747
39748 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39749 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39750 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39751 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39752 is hex encoded.
39753
39754 @item tunknown:0
39755 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39756
39757 @end table
39758
39759 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39760 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39761 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39762 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39763 trace.
39764
39765 @table @samp
39766
39767 @item tframes:@var{n}
39768 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39769
39770 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39771 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39772 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39773
39774 @item tsize:@var{n}
39775 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39776
39777 @item tfree:@var{n}
39778 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39779
39780 @item circular:@var{n}
39781 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39782 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39783 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39784 and may fill up.
39785
39786 @item disconn:@var{n}
39787 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39788 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39789 that the trace run will stop.
39790
39791 @end table
39792
39793 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39794 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39795 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39796 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39797 address @var{addr}.
39798
39799 Replies:
39800 @table @samp
39801 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39802 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39803 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39804 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39805 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39806
39807 @end table
39808
39809 @item qTV:@var{var}
39810 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39811 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39812 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39813
39814 Replies:
39815 @table @samp
39816 @item V@var{value}
39817 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39818 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39819 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39820 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39821 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39822 program is running.
39823
39824 @item U
39825 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39826 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39827 was not collected.
39828 @end table
39829
39830 @item qTfP
39831 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39832 @itemx qTsP
39833 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39834 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39835 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39836 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39837 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39838 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39839
39840 @item qTfV
39841 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39842 @itemx qTsV
39843 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39844 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39845 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39846 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39847 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39848 trace state variables.
39849
39850 @item qTfSTM
39851 @itemx qTsSTM
39852 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39853 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39854 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39855 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39856 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39857 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39858 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39859 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39860
39861 Reply:
39862 @table @samp
39863 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39864 A single marker
39865 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39866 a comma-separated list of markers
39867 @item l
39868 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39869 @item E @var{nn}
39870 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39871 @item @w{}
39872 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39873 stub.
39874 @end table
39875
39876 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39877 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39878
39879 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39880 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39881 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39882 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39883 @dfn{last}).
39884
39885 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39886 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39887 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39888 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39889 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39890 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39891 tracepoint markers.
39892
39893 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39894 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39895 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39896 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39897 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39898 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39899
39900 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39901 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39902 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39903 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39904 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39905 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39906 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39907 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39908 available.
39909
39910 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39911 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39912 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39913
39914 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39915 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39916 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39917 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39918 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39919 use whatever size it prefers.
39920
39921 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39922 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39923 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39924 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39925 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39926
39927 @end table
39928
39929 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39930 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39931 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39932 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39933 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39934 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39935 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39936 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39937 it had executed in the original location.
39938
39939 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39940 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39941 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39942 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39943 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39944 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39945 format of the request is:
39946
39947 @table @samp
39948 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39949
39950 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39951 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39952 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39953 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39954 memory starting at @var{to}.
39955 @end table
39956
39957 Replies:
39958 @table @samp
39959 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39960 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39961 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39962 @item E @var{NN}
39963 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39964 relocating the instruction.
39965 @end table
39966
39967 @node Host I/O Packets
39968 @section Host I/O Packets
39969 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39970 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39971
39972 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39973 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39974 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39975 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39976 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39977 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39978 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39979 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39980 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39981 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39982
39983 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39984 its arguments. They have this format:
39985
39986 @table @samp
39987
39988 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39989 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39990 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39991 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39992 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39993 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39994 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39995 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39996 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39997
39998 @end table
39999
40000 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40001
40002 @table @samp
40003
40004 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40005 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40006 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40007 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40008 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40009 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40010 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40011 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40012 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40013 @var{attachment}.
40014
40015 @item @w{}
40016 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40017
40018 @end table
40019
40020 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40021
40022 @table @samp
40023 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40024 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40025 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40026 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40027 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40028 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40029 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40030
40031 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40032 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40033 -1 if an error occurs.
40034
40035 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40036 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40037 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40038 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40039 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40040 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40041 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40042 @var{count} was zero.
40043
40044 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40045 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40046 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40047 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40048 some characters were escaped.
40049
40050 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40051 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40052 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40053 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40054 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40055 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40056 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40057 error occurred.
40058
40059 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40060 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40061 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40062 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40063 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40064 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40065
40066 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40067 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40068 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40069
40070 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40071 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40072 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40073
40074 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40075 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40076 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40077 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40078 some characters were escaped.
40079
40080 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40081 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40082 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40083 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40084 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40085 inferior(s).
40086
40087 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40088 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40089 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40090 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40091 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40092 operation.
40093
40094 @end table
40095
40096 @node Interrupts
40097 @section Interrupts
40098 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40099 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40100
40101 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40102 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40103 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40104 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40105
40106 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40107 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40108 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40109 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40110 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40111
40112 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40113 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40114 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40115 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40116 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40117 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40118 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40119 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40120
40121 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40122 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40123 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40124
40125 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40126 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40127 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40128 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40129 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40130 @code{0x03}.
40131
40132 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40133 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40134 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40135 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40136 currently-executing threads and processes.
40137 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40138 running program, it should send one of the stop
40139 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40140 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40141 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40142 Interrupts received while the
40143 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40144 it is resumed next time.
40145
40146 @node Notification Packets
40147 @section Notification Packets
40148 @cindex notification packets
40149 @cindex packets, notification
40150
40151 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40152 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40153 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40154 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40155 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40156 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40157 is not a problem.
40158
40159 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40160 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40161 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40162 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40163 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40164 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40165 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40166
40167 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40168 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40169
40170 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40171 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40172 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40173 not they understand it.
40174
40175 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40176 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40177 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40178 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40179 recipients.
40180
40181 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40182 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40183 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40184 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40185 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40186
40187 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40188 @table @samp
40189 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40190 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40191 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40192 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40193 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40194 @item @var{ack}
40195 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40196 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40197 @end table
40198
40199 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40200 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40201
40202 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40203 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40204 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40205 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40206 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40207 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40208 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40209 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40210 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40211 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40212
40213 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40214 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40215 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40216 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40217 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40218 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40219
40220 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40221 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40222 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40223 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40224 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40225
40226 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40227 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40228 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40229 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40230 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40231 normally.
40232
40233 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40234 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40235 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40236 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40237 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40238 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40239 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40240 the process shall be repeated.
40241
40242 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40243 following example:
40244 @smallexample
40245 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40246 @code{...}
40247 -> @code{vStopped}
40248 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40249 -> @code{vStopped}
40250 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40251 -> @code{vStopped}
40252 <- @code{OK}
40253 @end smallexample
40254
40255 The following notifications are defined:
40256 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40257
40258 @item Notification
40259 @tab Ack
40260 @tab Event
40261 @tab Description
40262
40263 @item Stop
40264 @tab vStopped
40265 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40266 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40267 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40268 @value{GDBN}.
40269 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40270
40271 @end multitable
40272
40273 @node Remote Non-Stop
40274 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40275
40276 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40277 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40278 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40279 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40280
40281 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40282 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40283 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40284 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40285 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40286 probe the target state after a mode change.
40287
40288 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40289 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40290 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40291 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40292 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40293 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40294 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40295 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40296 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40297 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40298 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40299
40300 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40301 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40302 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40303 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40304 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40305 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40306 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40307 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40308 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40309 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40310 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40311 @samp{OK}.
40312
40313 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40314 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40315 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40316 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40317 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40318 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40319 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40320 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40321 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40322 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40323 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40324 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40325 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40326
40327 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40328 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40329
40330 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40331 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40332 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40333 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40334 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40335 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40336 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40337
40338 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40339 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40340 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40341 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40342 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40343
40344 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40345 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40346 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40347 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40348
40349 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40350 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40351 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40352 @pxref{qSupported}.
40353 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40354 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40355 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40356 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40357 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40358 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40359 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40360
40361 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40362 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40363 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40364 connection.
40365 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40366 new connection is established,
40367 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40368 for the current connection, once disabled.
40369
40370 @node Examples
40371 @section Examples
40372
40373 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40374 does not get any direct output:
40375
40376 @smallexample
40377 -> @code{R00}
40378 <- @code{+}
40379 @emph{target restarts}
40380 -> @code{?}
40381 <- @code{+}
40382 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40383 -> @code{+}
40384 @end smallexample
40385
40386 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40387
40388 @smallexample
40389 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40390 <- @code{+}
40391 -> @code{s}
40392 <- @code{+}
40393 @emph{time passes}
40394 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40395 -> @code{+}
40396 -> @code{g}
40397 <- @code{+}
40398 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40399 -> @code{+}
40400 @end smallexample
40401
40402 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40403 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40404 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40405
40406 @menu
40407 * File-I/O Overview::
40408 * Protocol Basics::
40409 * The F Request Packet::
40410 * The F Reply Packet::
40411 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40412 * Console I/O::
40413 * List of Supported Calls::
40414 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40415 * Constants::
40416 * File-I/O Examples::
40417 @end menu
40418
40419 @node File-I/O Overview
40420 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40421 @cindex file-i/o overview
40422
40423 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40424 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40425 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40426 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40427 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40428 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40429
40430 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40431 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40432 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40433 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40434 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40435
40436 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40437 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40438 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40439 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40440 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40441 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40442 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40443
40444 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40445 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40446 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40447 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40448 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40449
40450 @smallexample
40451 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40452 <- target requests 'system call X'
40453 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40454 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40455 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40456 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40457 @end smallexample
40458
40459 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40460 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40461 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40462 system are not supported by this protocol.
40463
40464 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40465
40466 @node Protocol Basics
40467 @subsection Protocol Basics
40468 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40469
40470 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40471 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40472 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40473 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40474 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40475 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40476 to call the appropriate host system call:
40477
40478 @itemize @bullet
40479 @item
40480 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40481
40482 @item
40483 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40484 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40485 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40486 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40487
40488 @end itemize
40489
40490 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40491
40492 @itemize @bullet
40493 @item
40494 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40495 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40496 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40497 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40498 packet.
40499
40500 @item
40501 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40502 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40503
40504 @item
40505 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40506
40507 @item
40508 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40509
40510 @item
40511 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40512 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40513 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40514 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40515 packet.
40516
40517 @end itemize
40518
40519 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40520 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40521
40522 @itemize @bullet
40523 @item
40524 Return value.
40525
40526 @item
40527 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40528
40529 @item
40530 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40531
40532 @end itemize
40533
40534 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40535 the latest continue or step action.
40536
40537 @node The F Request Packet
40538 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40539 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40540 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40541
40542 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40543
40544 @table @samp
40545 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40546
40547 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40548 This is just the name of the function.
40549
40550 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40551 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40552 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40553 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40554 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40555 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40556 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40557
40558 @end table
40559
40560
40561
40562 @node The F Reply Packet
40563 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40564 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40565 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40566
40567 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40568
40569 @table @samp
40570
40571 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40572
40573 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40574
40575 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40576 representation.
40577 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40578
40579 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40580 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40581 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40582
40583 @smallexample
40584 F0,0,C
40585 @end smallexample
40586
40587 @noindent
40588 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40589
40590 @smallexample
40591 F-1,4,C
40592 @end smallexample
40593
40594 @noindent
40595 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40596
40597 @end table
40598
40599
40600 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40601 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40602 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40603
40604 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40605 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40606 the target should behave as if it had
40607 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40608 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40609 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40610 packet.
40611
40612 It's important for the target to know in which
40613 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40614
40615 @itemize @bullet
40616 @item
40617 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40618
40619 @item
40620 The system call on the host has been finished.
40621
40622 @end itemize
40623
40624 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40625 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40626 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40627 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40628 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40629 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40630
40631 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40632 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40633 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40634 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40635 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40636 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40637 or the full action has been completed.
40638
40639 @node Console I/O
40640 @subsection Console I/O
40641 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40642
40643 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40644 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40645 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40646 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40647 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40648 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40649 conditions is met:
40650
40651 @itemize @bullet
40652 @item
40653 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40654 @code{read}
40655 system call is treated as finished.
40656
40657 @item
40658 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40659 newline.
40660
40661 @item
40662 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40663 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40664
40665 @end itemize
40666
40667 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40668 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40669 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40670 is stopped at the user's request.
40671
40672
40673 @node List of Supported Calls
40674 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40675 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40676
40677 @menu
40678 * open::
40679 * close::
40680 * read::
40681 * write::
40682 * lseek::
40683 * rename::
40684 * unlink::
40685 * stat/fstat::
40686 * gettimeofday::
40687 * isatty::
40688 * system::
40689 @end menu
40690
40691 @node open
40692 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40693 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40694
40695 @table @asis
40696 @item Synopsis:
40697 @smallexample
40698 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40699 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40700 @end smallexample
40701
40702 @item Request:
40703 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40704
40705 @noindent
40706 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40707
40708 @table @code
40709 @item O_CREAT
40710 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40711 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40712 are concerned.
40713
40714 @item O_EXCL
40715 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40716 an error and open() fails.
40717
40718 @item O_TRUNC
40719 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40720 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40721 truncated to zero length.
40722
40723 @item O_APPEND
40724 The file is opened in append mode.
40725
40726 @item O_RDONLY
40727 The file is opened for reading only.
40728
40729 @item O_WRONLY
40730 The file is opened for writing only.
40731
40732 @item O_RDWR
40733 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40734 @end table
40735
40736 @noindent
40737 Other bits are silently ignored.
40738
40739
40740 @noindent
40741 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40742
40743 @table @code
40744 @item S_IRUSR
40745 User has read permission.
40746
40747 @item S_IWUSR
40748 User has write permission.
40749
40750 @item S_IRGRP
40751 Group has read permission.
40752
40753 @item S_IWGRP
40754 Group has write permission.
40755
40756 @item S_IROTH
40757 Others have read permission.
40758
40759 @item S_IWOTH
40760 Others have write permission.
40761 @end table
40762
40763 @noindent
40764 Other bits are silently ignored.
40765
40766
40767 @item Return value:
40768 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40769 occurred.
40770
40771 @item Errors:
40772
40773 @table @code
40774 @item EEXIST
40775 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40776
40777 @item EISDIR
40778 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40779
40780 @item EACCES
40781 The requested access is not allowed.
40782
40783 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40784 @var{pathname} was too long.
40785
40786 @item ENOENT
40787 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40788
40789 @item ENODEV
40790 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40791
40792 @item EROFS
40793 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40794 write access was requested.
40795
40796 @item EFAULT
40797 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40798
40799 @item ENOSPC
40800 No space on device to create the file.
40801
40802 @item EMFILE
40803 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40804
40805 @item ENFILE
40806 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40807 has been reached.
40808
40809 @item EINTR
40810 The call was interrupted by the user.
40811 @end table
40812
40813 @end table
40814
40815 @node close
40816 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40817 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40818
40819 @table @asis
40820 @item Synopsis:
40821 @smallexample
40822 int close(int fd);
40823 @end smallexample
40824
40825 @item Request:
40826 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40827
40828 @item Return value:
40829 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40830
40831 @item Errors:
40832
40833 @table @code
40834 @item EBADF
40835 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40836
40837 @item EINTR
40838 The call was interrupted by the user.
40839 @end table
40840
40841 @end table
40842
40843 @node read
40844 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40845 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40846
40847 @table @asis
40848 @item Synopsis:
40849 @smallexample
40850 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40851 @end smallexample
40852
40853 @item Request:
40854 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40855
40856 @item Return value:
40857 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40858 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40859 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40860
40861 @item Errors:
40862
40863 @table @code
40864 @item EBADF
40865 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40866 reading.
40867
40868 @item EFAULT
40869 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40870
40871 @item EINTR
40872 The call was interrupted by the user.
40873 @end table
40874
40875 @end table
40876
40877 @node write
40878 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40879 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40880
40881 @table @asis
40882 @item Synopsis:
40883 @smallexample
40884 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40885 @end smallexample
40886
40887 @item Request:
40888 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40889
40890 @item Return value:
40891 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40892 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40893 is returned.
40894
40895 @item Errors:
40896
40897 @table @code
40898 @item EBADF
40899 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40900 writing.
40901
40902 @item EFAULT
40903 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40904
40905 @item EFBIG
40906 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40907 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40908
40909 @item ENOSPC
40910 No space on device to write the data.
40911
40912 @item EINTR
40913 The call was interrupted by the user.
40914 @end table
40915
40916 @end table
40917
40918 @node lseek
40919 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40920 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40921
40922 @table @asis
40923 @item Synopsis:
40924 @smallexample
40925 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40926 @end smallexample
40927
40928 @item Request:
40929 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40930
40931 @var{flag} is one of:
40932
40933 @table @code
40934 @item SEEK_SET
40935 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40936
40937 @item SEEK_CUR
40938 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40939 bytes.
40940
40941 @item SEEK_END
40942 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40943 bytes.
40944 @end table
40945
40946 @item Return value:
40947 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40948 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40949 value of -1 is returned.
40950
40951 @item Errors:
40952
40953 @table @code
40954 @item EBADF
40955 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40956
40957 @item ESPIPE
40958 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40959
40960 @item EINVAL
40961 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40962
40963 @item EINTR
40964 The call was interrupted by the user.
40965 @end table
40966
40967 @end table
40968
40969 @node rename
40970 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40971 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40972
40973 @table @asis
40974 @item Synopsis:
40975 @smallexample
40976 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40977 @end smallexample
40978
40979 @item Request:
40980 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40981
40982 @item Return value:
40983 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40984
40985 @item Errors:
40986
40987 @table @code
40988 @item EISDIR
40989 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40990 directory.
40991
40992 @item EEXIST
40993 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40994
40995 @item EBUSY
40996 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40997 process.
40998
40999 @item EINVAL
41000 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41001 of itself.
41002
41003 @item ENOTDIR
41004 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41005 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41006 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41007
41008 @item EFAULT
41009 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41010
41011 @item EACCES
41012 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41013
41014 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41015
41016 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41017
41018 @item ENOENT
41019 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41020
41021 @item EROFS
41022 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41023
41024 @item ENOSPC
41025 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41026 directory entry.
41027
41028 @item EINTR
41029 The call was interrupted by the user.
41030 @end table
41031
41032 @end table
41033
41034 @node unlink
41035 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41036 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41037
41038 @table @asis
41039 @item Synopsis:
41040 @smallexample
41041 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41042 @end smallexample
41043
41044 @item Request:
41045 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41046
41047 @item Return value:
41048 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41049
41050 @item Errors:
41051
41052 @table @code
41053 @item EACCES
41054 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41055
41056 @item EPERM
41057 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41058
41059 @item EBUSY
41060 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41061 being used by another process.
41062
41063 @item EFAULT
41064 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41065
41066 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41067 @var{pathname} was too long.
41068
41069 @item ENOENT
41070 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41071
41072 @item ENOTDIR
41073 A component of the path is not a directory.
41074
41075 @item EROFS
41076 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41077
41078 @item EINTR
41079 The call was interrupted by the user.
41080 @end table
41081
41082 @end table
41083
41084 @node stat/fstat
41085 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41086 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41087 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41088
41089 @table @asis
41090 @item Synopsis:
41091 @smallexample
41092 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41093 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41094 @end smallexample
41095
41096 @item Request:
41097 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41098 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41099
41100 @item Return value:
41101 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41102
41103 @item Errors:
41104
41105 @table @code
41106 @item EBADF
41107 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41108
41109 @item ENOENT
41110 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41111 path is an empty string.
41112
41113 @item ENOTDIR
41114 A component of the path is not a directory.
41115
41116 @item EFAULT
41117 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41118
41119 @item EACCES
41120 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41121
41122 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41123 @var{pathname} was too long.
41124
41125 @item EINTR
41126 The call was interrupted by the user.
41127 @end table
41128
41129 @end table
41130
41131 @node gettimeofday
41132 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41133 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41134
41135 @table @asis
41136 @item Synopsis:
41137 @smallexample
41138 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41139 @end smallexample
41140
41141 @item Request:
41142 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41143
41144 @item Return value:
41145 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41146
41147 @item Errors:
41148
41149 @table @code
41150 @item EINVAL
41151 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41152
41153 @item EFAULT
41154 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41155 @end table
41156
41157 @end table
41158
41159 @node isatty
41160 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41161 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41162
41163 @table @asis
41164 @item Synopsis:
41165 @smallexample
41166 int isatty(int fd);
41167 @end smallexample
41168
41169 @item Request:
41170 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41171
41172 @item Return value:
41173 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41174
41175 @item Errors:
41176
41177 @table @code
41178 @item EINTR
41179 The call was interrupted by the user.
41180 @end table
41181
41182 @end table
41183
41184 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41185 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41186 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41187 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41188 needed.
41189
41190
41191 @node system
41192 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41193 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41194
41195 @table @asis
41196 @item Synopsis:
41197 @smallexample
41198 int system(const char *command);
41199 @end smallexample
41200
41201 @item Request:
41202 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41203
41204 @item Return value:
41205 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41206 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41207 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41208 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41209 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41210 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41211 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41212
41213 @item Errors:
41214
41215 @table @code
41216 @item EINTR
41217 The call was interrupted by the user.
41218 @end table
41219
41220 @end table
41221
41222 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41223 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41224 the host is simplified before it's returned
41225 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41226 is discarded, and the return value consists
41227 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41228
41229 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41230 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41231 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41232
41233 @table @code
41234 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41235 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41236 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41237 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41238
41239 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41240 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41241 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41242 protocol.
41243 @end table
41244
41245 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41246 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41247 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41248
41249 @menu
41250 * Integral Datatypes::
41251 * Pointer Values::
41252 * Memory Transfer::
41253 * struct stat::
41254 * struct timeval::
41255 @end menu
41256
41257 @node Integral Datatypes
41258 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41259 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41260
41261 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41262 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41263 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41264
41265 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41266 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41267
41268 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41269
41270 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41271 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41272
41273 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41274
41275 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41276 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41277 byte order.
41278
41279 @node Pointer Values
41280 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41281 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41282
41283 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41284 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41285 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41286 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41287
41288 @smallexample
41289 @code{1aaf/12}
41290 @end smallexample
41291
41292 @noindent
41293 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41294 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41295 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41296 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41297
41298 @smallexample
41299 @code{123456/d}
41300 @end smallexample
41301
41302 @node Memory Transfer
41303 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41304 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41305
41306 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41307 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41308 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41309 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41310 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41311 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41312 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41313
41314
41315 @node struct stat
41316 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41317 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41318
41319 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41320 is defined as follows:
41321
41322 @smallexample
41323 struct stat @{
41324 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41325 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41326 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41327 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41328 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41329 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41330 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41331 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41332 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41333 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41334 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41335 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41336 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41337 @};
41338 @end smallexample
41339
41340 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41341 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41342 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41343
41344 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41345 range of values.
41346
41347 @table @code
41348
41349 @item st_dev
41350 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41351
41352 @item st_ino
41353 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41354
41355 @item st_mode
41356 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41357 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41358
41359 @item st_uid
41360 @itemx st_gid
41361 @itemx st_rdev
41362 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41363
41364 @item st_atime
41365 @itemx st_mtime
41366 @itemx st_ctime
41367 These values have a host and file system dependent
41368 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41369 support exact timing values.
41370 @end table
41371
41372 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41373 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41374 continuing.
41375
41376 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41377 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41378 get truncated on the target.
41379
41380 @node struct timeval
41381 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41382 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41383
41384 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41385 is defined as follows:
41386
41387 @smallexample
41388 struct timeval @{
41389 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41390 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41391 @};
41392 @end smallexample
41393
41394 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41395 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41396 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41397
41398 @node Constants
41399 @subsection Constants
41400 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41401
41402 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41403 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41404 values before and after the call as needed.
41405
41406 @menu
41407 * Open Flags::
41408 * mode_t Values::
41409 * Errno Values::
41410 * Lseek Flags::
41411 * Limits::
41412 @end menu
41413
41414 @node Open Flags
41415 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41416 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41417
41418 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41419
41420 @smallexample
41421 O_RDONLY 0x0
41422 O_WRONLY 0x1
41423 O_RDWR 0x2
41424 O_APPEND 0x8
41425 O_CREAT 0x200
41426 O_TRUNC 0x400
41427 O_EXCL 0x800
41428 @end smallexample
41429
41430 @node mode_t Values
41431 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41432 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41433
41434 All values are given in octal representation.
41435
41436 @smallexample
41437 S_IFREG 0100000
41438 S_IFDIR 040000
41439 S_IRUSR 0400
41440 S_IWUSR 0200
41441 S_IXUSR 0100
41442 S_IRGRP 040
41443 S_IWGRP 020
41444 S_IXGRP 010
41445 S_IROTH 04
41446 S_IWOTH 02
41447 S_IXOTH 01
41448 @end smallexample
41449
41450 @node Errno Values
41451 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41452 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41453
41454 All values are given in decimal representation.
41455
41456 @smallexample
41457 EPERM 1
41458 ENOENT 2
41459 EINTR 4
41460 EBADF 9
41461 EACCES 13
41462 EFAULT 14
41463 EBUSY 16
41464 EEXIST 17
41465 ENODEV 19
41466 ENOTDIR 20
41467 EISDIR 21
41468 EINVAL 22
41469 ENFILE 23
41470 EMFILE 24
41471 EFBIG 27
41472 ENOSPC 28
41473 ESPIPE 29
41474 EROFS 30
41475 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41476 EUNKNOWN 9999
41477 @end smallexample
41478
41479 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41480 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41481
41482 @node Lseek Flags
41483 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41484 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41485
41486 @smallexample
41487 SEEK_SET 0
41488 SEEK_CUR 1
41489 SEEK_END 2
41490 @end smallexample
41491
41492 @node Limits
41493 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41494 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41495
41496 All values are given in decimal representation.
41497
41498 @smallexample
41499 INT_MIN -2147483648
41500 INT_MAX 2147483647
41501 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41502 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41503 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41504 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41505 @end smallexample
41506
41507 @node File-I/O Examples
41508 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41509 @cindex file-i/o examples
41510
41511 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41512 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41513
41514 @smallexample
41515 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41516 @emph{request memory read from target}
41517 -> @code{m1234,6}
41518 <- XXXXXX
41519 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41520 -> @code{F6}
41521 @end smallexample
41522
41523 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41524 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41525
41526 @smallexample
41527 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41528 @emph{request memory write to target}
41529 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41530 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41531 -> @code{F6}
41532 @end smallexample
41533
41534 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41535 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41536
41537 @smallexample
41538 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41539 -> @code{F-1,9}
41540 @end smallexample
41541
41542 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41543 host is called:
41544
41545 @smallexample
41546 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41547 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41548 <- @code{T02}
41549 @end smallexample
41550
41551 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41552 host is called:
41553
41554 @smallexample
41555 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41556 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41557 <- @code{T02}
41558 @end smallexample
41559
41560 @node Library List Format
41561 @section Library List Format
41562 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41563
41564 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41565 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41566 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41567 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41568 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41569 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41570 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41571 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41572 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41573 are loaded.
41574
41575 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41576 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41577 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41578 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41579
41580 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41581 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41582 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41583 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41584 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41585 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41586
41587 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41588 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41589
41590 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41591 offset, looks like this:
41592
41593 @smallexample
41594 <library-list>
41595 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41596 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41597 </library>
41598 </library-list>
41599 @end smallexample
41600
41601 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41602 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41603
41604 @smallexample
41605 <library-list>
41606 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41607 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41608 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41609 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41610 </library>
41611 </library-list>
41612 @end smallexample
41613
41614 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41615
41616 @smallexample
41617 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41618 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41619 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41620 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41621 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41622 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41623 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41624 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41625 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41626 @end smallexample
41627
41628 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41629 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41630 section for each library.
41631
41632 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41633 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41634 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41635
41636 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41637 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41638 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41639 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41640
41641 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41642 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41643 target, the following parameters are reported:
41644
41645 @itemize @minus
41646 @item
41647 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41648 @code{struct link_map}.
41649 @item
41650 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41651 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41652 @item
41653 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41654 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41655 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41656 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41657 @item
41658 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41659 @end itemize
41660
41661 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41662 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41663 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41664
41665 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41666 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41667
41668 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41669 looks like this:
41670
41671 @smallexample
41672 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41673 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41674 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41675 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41676 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41677 </library-list-svr>
41678 @end smallexample
41679
41680 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41681
41682 @smallexample
41683 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41684 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41685 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41686 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41687 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41688 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41689 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41690 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41691 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41692 @end smallexample
41693
41694 @node Memory Map Format
41695 @section Memory Map Format
41696 @cindex memory map format
41697
41698 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41699 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41700 memory map.
41701
41702 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41703 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41704 lists memory regions.
41705
41706 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41707 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41708
41709 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41710
41711 @smallexample
41712 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41713 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41714 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41715 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41716 <memory-map>
41717 region...
41718 </memory-map>
41719 @end smallexample
41720
41721 Each region can be either:
41722
41723 @itemize
41724
41725 @item
41726 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41727 bytes from there:
41728
41729 @smallexample
41730 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41731 @end smallexample
41732
41733
41734 @item
41735 A region of read-only memory:
41736
41737 @smallexample
41738 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41739 @end smallexample
41740
41741
41742 @item
41743 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41744 bytes in length:
41745
41746 @smallexample
41747 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41748 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41749 </memory>
41750 @end smallexample
41751
41752 @end itemize
41753
41754 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41755 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41756 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41757
41758 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41759
41760 @smallexample
41761 <!-- ................................................... -->
41762 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41763 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41764 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41765 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41766 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41767 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
41768 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41769 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
41770 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41771 and its type, or device. -->
41772 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
41773 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41774 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41775 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41776 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41777 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
41778 @end smallexample
41779
41780 @node Thread List Format
41781 @section Thread List Format
41782 @cindex thread list format
41783
41784 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41785 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41786 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41787 the following structure:
41788
41789 @smallexample
41790 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41791 <threads>
41792 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
41793 ... description ...
41794 </thread>
41795 </threads>
41796 @end smallexample
41797
41798 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41799 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41800 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41801 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
41802 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
41803 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41804 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41805 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41806
41807
41808 @node Traceframe Info Format
41809 @section Traceframe Info Format
41810 @cindex traceframe info format
41811
41812 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41813 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41814 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41815 collected in a traceframe.
41816
41817 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41818 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41819
41820 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41821 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41822
41823 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41824
41825 @smallexample
41826 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41827 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41828 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41829 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41830 <traceframe-info>
41831 block...
41832 </traceframe-info>
41833 @end smallexample
41834
41835 Each traceframe block can be either:
41836
41837 @itemize
41838
41839 @item
41840 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41841 @var{length} bytes from there:
41842
41843 @smallexample
41844 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41845 @end smallexample
41846
41847 @item
41848 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41849 collected:
41850
41851 @smallexample
41852 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41853 @end smallexample
41854
41855 @end itemize
41856
41857 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41858
41859 @smallexample
41860 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41861 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41862
41863 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41864 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41865 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41866 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41867 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41868 @end smallexample
41869
41870 @node Branch Trace Format
41871 @section Branch Trace Format
41872 @cindex branch trace format
41873
41874 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41875 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41876 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41877 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41878
41879 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41880 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41881
41882 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41883 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41884
41885 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41886
41887 @smallexample
41888 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41889 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41890 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41891 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41892 <btrace>
41893 block...
41894 </btrace>
41895 @end smallexample
41896
41897 @itemize
41898
41899 @item
41900 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41901 and ending at @var{end}:
41902
41903 @smallexample
41904 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41905 @end smallexample
41906
41907 @end itemize
41908
41909 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41910
41911 @smallexample
41912 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41913 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41914
41915 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41916 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41917 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41918
41919 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41920
41921 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41922
41923 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41924 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41925 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41926 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41927 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41928
41929 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41930 @end smallexample
41931
41932 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41933 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41934 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41935
41936 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41937 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41938 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41939
41940 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41941 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41942
41943 @table @code
41944 @item bts
41945 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41946 @table @code
41947 @item size
41948 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41949 @end table
41950 @item pt
41951 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41952 PT}) format.
41953 @table @code
41954 @item size
41955 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41956 @end table
41957 @end table
41958
41959 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41960 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41961
41962 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41963
41964 @smallexample
41965 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41966 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41967
41968 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41969 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41970
41971 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41972 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41973 @end smallexample
41974
41975 @include agentexpr.texi
41976
41977 @node Target Descriptions
41978 @appendix Target Descriptions
41979 @cindex target descriptions
41980
41981 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41982 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41983 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41984 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41985 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41986 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41987 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41988
41989 @itemize @bullet
41990 @item
41991 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41992 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41993 @item
41994 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41995 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41996 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41997 @item
41998 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41999 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42000 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42001 @end itemize
42002
42003 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42004 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42005 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42006 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42007 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42008
42009 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42010 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42011
42012 @menu
42013 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42014 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42015 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42016 descriptions.
42017 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42018 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42019 @end menu
42020
42021 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42022 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42023
42024 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42025 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42026 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42027 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42028 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42029 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42030 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42031 Format}.
42032
42033 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42034 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42035 specify a file are:
42036
42037 @table @code
42038 @cindex set tdesc filename
42039 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42040 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42041
42042 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42043 @item unset tdesc filename
42044 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42045 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42046
42047 @cindex show tdesc filename
42048 @item show tdesc filename
42049 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42050 @end table
42051
42052
42053 @node Target Description Format
42054 @section Target Description Format
42055 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42056
42057 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42058 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42059 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42060 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42061 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42062 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42063 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42064
42065 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42066 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42067 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42068 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42069 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42070
42071 Here is a simple target description:
42072
42073 @smallexample
42074 <target version="1.0">
42075 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42076 </target>
42077 @end smallexample
42078
42079 @noindent
42080 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42081 the x86-64 architecture.
42082
42083 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42084 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42085 are explained further below.
42086
42087 @smallexample
42088 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42089 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42090 <target version="1.0">
42091 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42092 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42093 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42094 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42095 </target>
42096 @end smallexample
42097
42098 @noindent
42099 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42100 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42101 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42102 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42103 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42104 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42105 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42106 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42107 the version mismatch.
42108
42109 @subsection Inclusion
42110 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42111 @cindex XInclude
42112 @ifnotinfo
42113 @cindex <xi:include>
42114 @end ifnotinfo
42115
42116 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42117 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42118 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42119 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42120 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42121
42122 @smallexample
42123 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42124 @end smallexample
42125
42126 @noindent
42127 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42128 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42129 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42130 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42131 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42132 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42133 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42134 original description.
42135
42136 @subsection Architecture
42137 @cindex <architecture>
42138
42139 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42140
42141 @smallexample
42142 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42143 @end smallexample
42144
42145 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42146 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42147
42148 @subsection OS ABI
42149 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42150
42151 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42152 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42153
42154 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42155
42156 @smallexample
42157 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42158 @end smallexample
42159
42160 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42161 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42162
42163 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42164 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42165
42166 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42167 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42168
42169 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42170
42171 @smallexample
42172 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42173 @end smallexample
42174
42175 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42176 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42177
42178 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42179 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42180 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42181 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42182 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42183 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42184 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42185
42186 @smallexample
42187 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42188 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42189 @end smallexample
42190
42191 @subsection Features
42192 @cindex <feature>
42193
42194 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42195 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42196 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42197 has this form:
42198
42199 @smallexample
42200 <feature name="@var{name}">
42201 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42202 @var{reg}@dots{}
42203 </feature>
42204 @end smallexample
42205
42206 @noindent
42207 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42208 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42209 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42210 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42211
42212 @subsection Types
42213
42214 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42215 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42216 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42217 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42218 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42219 and enum types.
42220
42221 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42222 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42223 Types must be defined before they are used.
42224
42225 @cindex <vector>
42226 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42227 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42228 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42229 @var{count}:
42230
42231 @smallexample
42232 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42233 @end smallexample
42234
42235 @cindex <union>
42236 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42237 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42238 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42239 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42240
42241 @smallexample
42242 <union id="@var{id}">
42243 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42244 @dots{}
42245 </union>
42246 @end smallexample
42247
42248 @cindex <struct>
42249 @cindex <flags>
42250 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42251 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42252 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42253 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42254 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42255 specified.
42256
42257 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42258
42259 @smallexample
42260 <struct id="@var{id}">
42261 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42262 @dots{}
42263 </struct>
42264 @end smallexample
42265
42266 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42267 No implicit padding is added.
42268
42269 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42270
42271 @smallexample
42272 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42273 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42274 @dots{}
42275 </struct>
42276 @end smallexample
42277
42278 @smallexample
42279 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42280 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42281 @dots{}
42282 </flags>
42283 @end smallexample
42284
42285 The @var{name} value is required.
42286 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42287 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42288 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42289
42290 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42291 is optional.
42292 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42293 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42294
42295 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42296 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42297
42298 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42299
42300 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42301 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42302
42303 @itemize @bullet
42304 @item
42305 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42306 @item
42307 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42308 @end itemize
42309
42310 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42311 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42312
42313 @itemize @bullet
42314 @item
42315 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42316
42317 @smallexample
42318 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42319 $1 = 42
42320 @end smallexample
42321
42322 @end itemize
42323
42324 @subsection Registers
42325 @cindex <reg>
42326
42327 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42328
42329 @smallexample
42330 <reg name="@var{name}"
42331 bitsize="@var{size}"
42332 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42333 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42334 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42335 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42336 @end smallexample
42337
42338 @noindent
42339 The components are as follows:
42340
42341 @table @var
42342
42343 @item name
42344 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42345
42346 @item bitsize
42347 The register's size, in bits.
42348
42349 @item regnum
42350 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42351 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42352 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42353 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42354 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42355 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42356 in order of increasing register number.
42357
42358 @item save-restore
42359 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42360 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42361 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42362 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42363 ABI.
42364
42365 @item type
42366 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42367 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42368 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42369 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42370 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42371 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42372
42373 @item group
42374 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42375 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42376 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42377 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42378 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42379 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42380 @code{info registers}.
42381
42382 @end table
42383
42384 @node Predefined Target Types
42385 @section Predefined Target Types
42386 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42387
42388 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42389 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42390 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42391 types. The currently supported types are:
42392
42393 @table @code
42394
42395 @item bool
42396 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42397
42398 @item int8
42399 @itemx int16
42400 @itemx int24
42401 @itemx int32
42402 @itemx int64
42403 @itemx int128
42404 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42405
42406 @item uint8
42407 @itemx uint16
42408 @itemx uint24
42409 @itemx uint32
42410 @itemx uint64
42411 @itemx uint128
42412 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42413
42414 @item code_ptr
42415 @itemx data_ptr
42416 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42417 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42418 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42419 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42420 may be marked as data pointers.
42421
42422 @item ieee_single
42423 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42424
42425 @item ieee_double
42426 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42427
42428 @item arm_fpa_ext
42429 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42430
42431 @item i387_ext
42432 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42433
42434 @item i386_eflags
42435 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42436
42437 @item i386_mxcsr
42438 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42439
42440 @end table
42441
42442 @node Enum Target Types
42443 @section Enum Target Types
42444 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42445
42446 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42447 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42448
42449 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42450
42451 @smallexample
42452 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42453 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42454 @dots{}
42455 </enum>
42456 @end smallexample
42457
42458 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42459
42460 @smallexample
42461 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42462 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42463 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42464 </enum>
42465 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42466 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42467 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42468 </flags>
42469 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42470 @end smallexample
42471
42472 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42473 would be printed as:
42474
42475 @smallexample
42476 (gdb) info register flags
42477 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42478 @end smallexample
42479
42480 @node Standard Target Features
42481 @section Standard Target Features
42482 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42483
42484 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42485 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42486 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42487 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42488 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42489 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42490 can recognize them.
42491
42492 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42493 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42494 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42495 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42496 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42497 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42498 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42499 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42500
42501 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42502 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42503 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42504
42505 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42506 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42507 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42508 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42509
42510 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42511 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42512 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42513
42514 @menu
42515 * AArch64 Features::
42516 * ARC Features::
42517 * ARM Features::
42518 * i386 Features::
42519 * MicroBlaze Features::
42520 * MIPS Features::
42521 * M68K Features::
42522 * NDS32 Features::
42523 * Nios II Features::
42524 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42525 * PowerPC Features::
42526 * S/390 and System z Features::
42527 * Sparc Features::
42528 * TIC6x Features::
42529 @end menu
42530
42531
42532 @node AArch64 Features
42533 @subsection AArch64 Features
42534 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42535
42536 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42537 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42538 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42539
42540 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42541 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42542 and @samp{fpcr}.
42543
42544 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42545 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42546 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42547
42548 @node ARC Features
42549 @subsection ARC Features
42550 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42551
42552 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42553 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42554 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42555 that one of the core registers features is present.
42556 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42557
42558 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42559 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42560 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42561 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42562 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42563 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42564 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42565
42566 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42567 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42568 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42569 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42570 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42571 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42572
42573 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42574 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42575 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42576 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42577 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42578 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42579 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42580 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42581 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42582 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42583
42584 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42585 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42586
42587 @node ARM Features
42588 @subsection ARM Features
42589 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42590
42591 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42592 ARM targets.
42593 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42594 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42595
42596 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42597 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42598 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42599 and @samp{xpsr}.
42600
42601 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42602 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42603
42604 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42605 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42606 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42607 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42608
42609 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42610 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42611 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42612 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42613 halves of the double-precision registers.
42614
42615 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42616 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42617 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42618 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42619 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42620 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42621
42622 @node i386 Features
42623 @subsection i386 Features
42624 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42625
42626 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42627 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42628
42629 @itemize @minus
42630 @item
42631 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42632 @item
42633 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42634 @item
42635 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42636 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42637 @item
42638 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42639 @item
42640 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42641 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42642 @end itemize
42643
42644 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42645
42646 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42647 describe registers:
42648
42649 @itemize @minus
42650 @item
42651 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42652 @item
42653 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42654 @item
42655 @samp{mxcsr}
42656 @end itemize
42657
42658 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42659 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42660 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42661
42662 @itemize @minus
42663 @item
42664 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42665 @item
42666 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42667 @end itemize
42668
42669 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42670 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42671
42672 @itemize @minus
42673 @item
42674 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42675 @item
42676 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42677 @end itemize
42678
42679 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42680 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42681
42682 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42683 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42684
42685 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42686 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42687 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42688
42689 @itemize @minus
42690 @item
42691 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42692 @end itemize
42693
42694 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42695
42696 @itemize @minus
42697 @item
42698 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42699 @end itemize
42700
42701 It should
42702 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42703
42704 @itemize @minus
42705 @item
42706 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42707 @item
42708 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42709 @end itemize
42710
42711 It should
42712 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42713
42714 @itemize @minus
42715 @item
42716 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42717 @end itemize
42718
42719 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42720 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42721 valid for i386 and amd64.
42722
42723 @node MicroBlaze Features
42724 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42725 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42726
42727 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42728 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42729 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42730 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42731 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42732
42733 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42734 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42735
42736 @node MIPS Features
42737 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42738 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42739
42740 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42741 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42742 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42743 on the target.
42744
42745 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42746 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42747 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42748
42749 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42750 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42751 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42752 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42753
42754 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42755 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42756 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42757 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42758
42759 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42760 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42761 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42762
42763 @node M68K Features
42764 @subsection M68K Features
42765 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42766
42767 @table @code
42768 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42769 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42770 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42771 One of those features must be always present.
42772 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42773 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42774 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42775 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42776
42777 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42778 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42779 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42780 @samp{fpiaddr}.
42781 @end table
42782
42783 @node NDS32 Features
42784 @subsection NDS32 Features
42785 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
42786
42787 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
42788 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
42789 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
42790 and @samp{pc}.
42791
42792 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42793 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
42794 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
42795 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
42796
42797 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
42798 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
42799 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
42800 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
42801 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
42802 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
42803 support to it could be totally removed some day.
42804
42805 @node Nios II Features
42806 @subsection Nios II Features
42807 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42808
42809 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42810 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42811 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42812 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42813 @samp{mpuacc}).
42814
42815 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
42816 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
42817 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
42818
42819 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
42820 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
42821 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
42822
42823 @node PowerPC Features
42824 @subsection PowerPC Features
42825 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42826
42827 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42828 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42829 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42830 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42831
42832 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42833 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42834
42835 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42836 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42837 and @samp{vrsave}.
42838
42839 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42840 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42841 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42842 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42843 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42844 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42845
42846 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42847 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42848 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42849 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42850 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42851 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42852 user.
42853
42854 @node S/390 and System z Features
42855 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42856 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42857 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42858
42859 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42860 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42861 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42862 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42863 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42864 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42865 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42866 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42867 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42868
42869 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42870 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42871 @samp{fpc}.
42872
42873 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42874 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42875
42876 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42877 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42878 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42879 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42880 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42881 32-bit wide.
42882
42883 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42884 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42885 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42886
42887 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42888 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42889 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42890 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42891 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42892 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42893 @samp{v31}.
42894
42895 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42896 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42897 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42898
42899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42900 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42901 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42902
42903 @node Sparc Features
42904 @subsection Sparc Features
42905 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42906 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42907 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42908 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42909
42910 @itemize @minus
42911 @item
42912 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42913 @item
42914 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42915 @item
42916 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42917 @item
42918 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42919 @end itemize
42920
42921 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42922
42923 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42924 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42925
42926 @itemize @minus
42927 @item
42928 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42929 @item
42930 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42931 @end itemize
42932
42933 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42934 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42935
42936 @itemize @minus
42937 @item
42938 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42939 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42940 @item
42941 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42942 for sparc64
42943 @end itemize
42944
42945 @node TIC6x Features
42946 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42947 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42948 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42949 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42950 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42951 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42952
42953 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42954 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42955 through @samp{B31}.
42956
42957 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42958 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42959
42960 @node Operating System Information
42961 @appendix Operating System Information
42962 @cindex operating system information
42963
42964 @menu
42965 * Process list::
42966 @end menu
42967
42968 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42969 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42970 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42971 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42972 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42973 on a different aspect of target.
42974
42975 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42976 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42977 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42978 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42979
42980 @node Process list
42981 @appendixsection Process list
42982 @cindex operating system information, process list
42983
42984 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42985 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42986 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42987 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42988
42989 An example document is:
42990
42991 @smallexample
42992 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42993 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42994 <osdata type="processes">
42995 <item>
42996 <column name="pid">1</column>
42997 <column name="user">root</column>
42998 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42999 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43000 </item>
43001 </osdata>
43002 @end smallexample
43003
43004 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43005 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43006 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43007 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43008 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43009 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43010 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43011
43012 @node Trace File Format
43013 @appendix Trace File Format
43014 @cindex trace file format
43015
43016 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43017 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43018
43019 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43020 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43021 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43022 in the future.
43023
43024 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43025 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43026 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43027 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43028 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43029 of this section.
43030
43031 @table @code
43032 @item R @var{size}
43033 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43034 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43035 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43036 a single trace file.
43037
43038 @item status @var{status}
43039 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43040 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43041 file.
43042
43043 @item tp @var{payload}
43044 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43045 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43046 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43047 reply packets.
43048
43049 @item tsv @var{payload}
43050 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43051 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43052 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43053 reply packets.
43054
43055 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43056 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43057 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43058 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43059 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43060 file. Includes are not allowed.
43061
43062 @end table
43063
43064 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43065 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43066 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43067 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43068 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43069 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43070 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43071 endianness.
43072
43073 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43074
43075 @table @code
43076 @item R @var{bytes}
43077 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43078 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43079 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43080
43081 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43082 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43083 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43084 @var{length} bytes.
43085
43086 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43087 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43088 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43089
43090 @end table
43091
43092 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43093 of blocks.
43094
43095 @node Index Section Format
43096 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43097 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43098 @cindex index section format
43099
43100 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43101 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43102 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43103 description.
43104
43105 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43106 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43107 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43108 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43109 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43110 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43111
43112 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43113
43114 @enumerate
43115 @item
43116 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43117 unless otherwise noted:
43118
43119 @enumerate
43120 @item
43121 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43122 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43123 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43124 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43125 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43126 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43127 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43128
43129 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43130 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43131 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43132 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43133
43134 @item
43135 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43136
43137 @item
43138 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43139 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43140 to the next offset.
43141
43142 @item
43143 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43144
43145 @item
43146 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43147
43148 @item
43149 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43150 @end enumerate
43151
43152 @item
43153 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43154 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43155 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43156 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43157 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43158 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43159 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43160 CU indices.
43161
43162 @item
43163 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43164 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43165 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43166 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43167
43168 @item
43169 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43170 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43171
43172 @enumerate
43173 @item
43174 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43175
43176 @item
43177 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43178 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43179
43180 @item
43181 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43182 @end enumerate
43183
43184 @item
43185 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43186 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43187
43188 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43189 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43190 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43191 constant pool.
43192
43193 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43194 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43195 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43196
43197 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43198 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43199 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43200 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43201 index version:
43202
43203 @table @asis
43204 @item Version 4
43205 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43206
43207 @item Versions 5 to 7
43208 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43209 @end table
43210
43211 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43212
43213 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43214 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43215 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43216 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43217 collision.
43218
43219 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43220 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43221 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43222 the code.
43223
43224 @item
43225 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43226 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43227 strings.
43228
43229 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43230 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43231 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43232 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43233 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43234 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43235
43236 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43237 @end enumerate
43238
43239 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43240 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43241 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43242
43243 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43244 (bit 0 = LSB):
43245
43246 @table @asis
43247
43248 @item Bits 0-23
43249 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43250 @item Bits 24-27
43251 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43252 @item Bits 28-30
43253 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43254
43255 @table @asis
43256 @item 0
43257 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43258 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43259 with previous versions of the index.
43260 @item 1
43261 The symbol is a type.
43262 @item 2
43263 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43264 @item 3
43265 The symbol is a function.
43266 @item 4
43267 Any other kind of symbol.
43268 @item 5,6,7
43269 These values are reserved.
43270 @end table
43271
43272 @item Bit 31
43273 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43274
43275 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43276 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43277 @value{GDBN} sources.
43278
43279 @end table
43280
43281 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43282 global/static attributes in the index.
43283
43284 @smallexample
43285 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43286 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43287 switch (die->tag)
43288 @{
43289 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43290 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43291 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43292 kind = TYPE;
43293 is_static = 1;
43294 break;
43295 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43296 kind = VARIABLE;
43297 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43298 break;
43299 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43300 kind = FUNCTION;
43301 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43302 break;
43303 case DW_TAG_constant:
43304 kind = VARIABLE;
43305 is_static = ! is_external;
43306 break;
43307 case DW_TAG_variable:
43308 kind = VARIABLE;
43309 is_static = ! is_external;
43310 break;
43311 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43312 kind = TYPE;
43313 is_static = 0;
43314 break;
43315 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43316 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43317 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43318 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43319 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43320 kind = TYPE;
43321 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43322 break;
43323 default:
43324 assert (0);
43325 @}
43326 @end smallexample
43327
43328 @node Man Pages
43329 @appendix Manual pages
43330 @cindex Man pages
43331
43332 @menu
43333 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43334 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43335 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43336 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43337 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43338 @end menu
43339
43340 @node gdb man
43341 @heading gdb man
43342
43343 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43344
43345 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43346 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43347 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43348 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43349 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43350 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43351 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43352 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43353 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43354 @c man end
43355
43356 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43357 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43358 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43359 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43360
43361 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43362 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43363
43364 @itemize @bullet
43365 @item
43366 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43367
43368 @item
43369 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43370
43371 @item
43372 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43373
43374 @item
43375 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43376 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43377 @end itemize
43378
43379 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43380 Modula-2.
43381
43382 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43383 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43384 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43385 by using the command @code{help}.
43386
43387 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43388 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43389 executable program as the argument:
43390
43391 @smallexample
43392 gdb program
43393 @end smallexample
43394
43395 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43396
43397 @smallexample
43398 gdb program core
43399 @end smallexample
43400
43401 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43402 to debug a running process:
43403
43404 @smallexample
43405 gdb program 1234
43406 gdb -p 1234
43407 @end smallexample
43408
43409 @noindent
43410 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43411 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43412 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43413
43414 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43415
43416 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43417 @table @env
43418 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43419 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43420
43421 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43422 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43423
43424 @item bt
43425 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43426
43427 @item print @var{expr}
43428 Display the value of an expression.
43429
43430 @item c
43431 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43432
43433 @item next
43434 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43435 function calls in the line.
43436
43437 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43438 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43439
43440 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43441 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43442
43443 @item step
43444 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43445 function calls in the line.
43446
43447 @item help [@var{name}]
43448 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43449 about using @value{GDBN}.
43450
43451 @item quit
43452 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43453 @end table
43454
43455 @ifset man
43456 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43457 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43458 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43459 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43460 @end ifset
43461 @c man end
43462
43463 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43464 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43465 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43466 encountered with no
43467 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43468 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43469 Many options have
43470 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43471 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43472 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43473 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43474 more usual convention.)
43475
43476 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43477 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43478 option is used.
43479
43480 @table @env
43481 @item -help
43482 @itemx -h
43483 List all options, with brief explanations.
43484
43485 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43486 @itemx -s @var{file}
43487 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43488
43489 @item -write
43490 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43491
43492 @item -exec=@var{file}
43493 @itemx -e @var{file}
43494 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43495 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43496 dump.
43497
43498 @item -se=@var{file}
43499 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43500 file.
43501
43502 @item -core=@var{file}
43503 @itemx -c @var{file}
43504 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43505
43506 @item -command=@var{file}
43507 @itemx -x @var{file}
43508 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43509
43510 @item -ex @var{command}
43511 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43512
43513 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43514 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43515 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43516
43517 @item -nh
43518 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43519
43520 @item -nx
43521 @itemx -n
43522 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43523
43524 @item -quiet
43525 @itemx -q
43526 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43527 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43528
43529 @item -batch
43530 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43531 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43532 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43533 commands in the command files.
43534
43535 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43536 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43537 more useful, the message
43538
43539 @smallexample
43540 Program exited normally.
43541 @end smallexample
43542
43543 @noindent
43544 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43545 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43546
43547 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43548 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43549 instead of the current directory.
43550
43551 @item -fullname
43552 @itemx -f
43553 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43554 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43555 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43556 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43557 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43558 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43559 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43560 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43561
43562 @item -b @var{bps}
43563 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43564 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43565
43566 @item -tty=@var{device}
43567 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43568 @end table
43569 @c man end
43570
43571 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43572 @ifset man
43573 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43574 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43575 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43576
43577 @smallexample
43578 info gdb
43579 @end smallexample
43580
43581 @noindent
43582 should give you access to the complete manual.
43583
43584 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43585 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43586 @end ifset
43587 @c man end
43588
43589 @node gdbserver man
43590 @heading gdbserver man
43591
43592 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43593 @format
43594 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43595 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43596
43597 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43598
43599 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43600 @c man end
43601 @end format
43602
43603 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43604 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43605 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43606
43607 @ifclear man
43608 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43609 @end ifclear
43610 @ifset man
43611 Usage (server (target) side):
43612 @end ifset
43613
43614 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43615 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43616 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43617 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43618
43619 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43620 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43621 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43622
43623 @smallexample
43624 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43625 @end smallexample
43626
43627 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43628
43629 @smallexample
43630 @ifset man
43631 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43632 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43633 @end ifset
43634 @ifclear man
43635 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43636 @end ifclear
43637 @end smallexample
43638
43639 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43640 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43641 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43642
43643 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43644
43645 @smallexample
43646 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43647 @end smallexample
43648
43649 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43650 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43651 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43652 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43653 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43654 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43655 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43656 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43657 print an error message and exit.
43658
43659 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43660 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43661
43662 @smallexample
43663 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43664 @end smallexample
43665
43666 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43667 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43668
43669 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43670 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43671 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43672 the program you want to debug.
43673
43674 @smallexample
43675 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43676 @end smallexample
43677
43678 @ifclear man
43679 @subheading Usage (host side)
43680 @end ifclear
43681 @ifset man
43682 Usage (host side):
43683 @end ifset
43684
43685 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43686 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43687 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43688 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43689 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43690 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43691 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43692 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43693 descriptor. For example:
43694
43695 @smallexample
43696 @ifset man
43697 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43698 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43699 @end ifset
43700 @ifclear man
43701 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43702 @end ifclear
43703 @end smallexample
43704
43705 @noindent
43706 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43707
43708 @smallexample
43709 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43710 @end smallexample
43711
43712 @noindent
43713 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43714 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43715 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43716 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43717 `Connection refused'.
43718
43719 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43720 described in
43721 @ifset man
43722 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43723 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43724 @end ifset
43725 @ifclear man
43726 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43727 @end ifclear
43728 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43729
43730 @smallexample
43731 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43732 @end smallexample
43733
43734 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43735 case.
43736 @c man end
43737
43738 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43739 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43740
43741 @itemize @bullet
43742
43743 @item
43744 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43745
43746 @smallexample
43747 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43748 @end smallexample
43749
43750 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43751 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43752 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43753 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43754 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43755 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43756 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43757
43758 @item
43759 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43760 program:
43761
43762 @smallexample
43763 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43764 @end smallexample
43765
43766 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43767 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43768 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43769 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43770
43771 @item
43772 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43773
43774 @smallexample
43775 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43776 @end smallexample
43777
43778 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43779 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43780 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43781 debug several processes in the same session.
43782 @end itemize
43783
43784 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43785
43786 @table @env
43787
43788 @item --help
43789 List all options, with brief explanations.
43790
43791 @item --version
43792 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43793
43794 @item --attach
43795 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43796
43797 @smallexample
43798 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43799 @end smallexample
43800
43801 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43802 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43803
43804 @item --multi
43805 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43806 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43807 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43808 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43809
43810 @smallexample
43811 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43812 @end smallexample
43813
43814 @item --debug
43815 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43816 process.
43817 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43818 the developers.
43819
43820 @item --remote-debug
43821 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43822 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43823 the developers.
43824
43825 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43826 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43827 of debugging output.
43828 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43829
43830 @item --wrapper
43831 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43832 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43833 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43834 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43835
43836 @item --once
43837 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43838 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43839 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43840 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43841
43842 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43843
43844 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43845 @c QDisableRandomization.
43846
43847 @end table
43848 @c man end
43849
43850 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43851 @ifset man
43852 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43853 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43854 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43855
43856 @smallexample
43857 info gdb
43858 @end smallexample
43859
43860 should give you access to the complete manual.
43861
43862 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43863 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43864 @end ifset
43865 @c man end
43866
43867 @node gcore man
43868 @heading gcore
43869
43870 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43871
43872 @format
43873 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43874 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
43875 @c man end
43876 @end format
43877
43878 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43879 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
43880 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
43881 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
43882 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
43883 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
43884 its job the program remains running without any change.
43885 @c man end
43886
43887 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43888 @table @env
43889 @item -a
43890 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
43891 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
43892 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
43893 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
43894 dump-excluded-mappings}).
43895
43896 @item -o @var{prefix}
43897 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
43898 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
43899 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
43900 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
43901 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
43902 @end table
43903 @c man end
43904
43905 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43906 @ifset man
43907 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43908 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43909 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43910
43911 @smallexample
43912 info gdb
43913 @end smallexample
43914
43915 @noindent
43916 should give you access to the complete manual.
43917
43918 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43919 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43920 @end ifset
43921 @c man end
43922
43923 @node gdbinit man
43924 @heading gdbinit
43925
43926 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43927
43928 @format
43929 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43930 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43931 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43932 @end ifset
43933
43934 ~/.gdbinit
43935
43936 ./.gdbinit
43937 @c man end
43938 @end format
43939
43940 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43941 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43942 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43943 described in
43944 @ifset man
43945 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43946 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43947 @end ifset
43948 @ifclear man
43949 @ref{Sequences}.
43950 @end ifclear
43951
43952 Please read more in
43953 @ifset man
43954 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43955 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43956 @end ifset
43957 @ifclear man
43958 @ref{Startup}.
43959 @end ifclear
43960
43961 @table @env
43962 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43963 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43964 @end ifset
43965 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43966 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43967 @end ifclear
43968 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43969 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43970 See more in
43971 @ifset man
43972 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43973 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43974 @end ifset
43975 @ifclear man
43976 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43977 @end ifclear
43978
43979 @item ~/.gdbinit
43980 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43981 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43982
43983 @item ./.gdbinit
43984 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43985 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43986 See more in
43987 @ifset man
43988 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43989 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43990 @end ifset
43991 @ifclear man
43992 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43993 @end ifclear
43994 @end table
43995 @c man end
43996
43997 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43998 @ifset man
43999 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44000
44001 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44002 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44003 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44004
44005 @smallexample
44006 info gdb
44007 @end smallexample
44008
44009 should give you access to the complete manual.
44010
44011 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44012 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44013 @end ifset
44014 @c man end
44015
44016 @node gdb-add-index man
44017 @heading gdb-add-index
44018 @pindex gdb-add-index
44019 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44020
44021 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44022
44023 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44024 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44025 @c man end
44026
44027 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44028 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44029 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44030 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44031 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44032 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44033
44034 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44035 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44036 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44037 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44038 named @code{.debug_*}).
44039
44040 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44041 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44042 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44043 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44044
44045 See more in
44046 @ifset man
44047 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44048 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44049 @end ifset
44050 @ifclear man
44051 @ref{Index Files}.
44052 @end ifclear
44053 @c man end
44054
44055 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44056 @ifset man
44057 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44058 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44059 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44060
44061 @smallexample
44062 info gdb
44063 @end smallexample
44064
44065 should give you access to the complete manual.
44066
44067 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44068 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44069 @end ifset
44070 @c man end
44071
44072 @include gpl.texi
44073
44074 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44075 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44076 @include fdl.texi
44077
44078 @node Concept Index
44079 @unnumbered Concept Index
44080
44081 @printindex cp
44082
44083 @node Command and Variable Index
44084 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44085
44086 @printindex fn
44087
44088 @tex
44089 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44090 % meantime:
44091 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44092 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44093 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44094 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44095 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44096 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44097 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44098 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44099 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44100 \page\colophon
44101 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44102 @end tex
44103
44104 @bye
This page took 1.080163 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.